diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'Documentation')
197 files changed, 9961 insertions, 6999 deletions
diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/debugfs-cec-error-inj b/Documentation/ABI/testing/debugfs-cec-error-inj index 122b65c5fe62..4c3596c6d25b 100644 --- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/debugfs-cec-error-inj +++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/debugfs-cec-error-inj @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ What: /sys/kernel/debug/cec/*/error-inj Date: March 2018 -Contact: Hans Verkuil <hans.verkuil@cisco.com> +Contact: Hans Verkuil <hverkuil-cisco@xs4all.nl> Description: The CEC Framework allows for CEC error injection commands through diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/ima_policy b/Documentation/ABI/testing/ima_policy index 74c6702de74e..fc376a323908 100644 --- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/ima_policy +++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/ima_policy @@ -24,11 +24,11 @@ Description: [euid=] [fowner=] [fsname=]] lsm: [[subj_user=] [subj_role=] [subj_type=] [obj_user=] [obj_role=] [obj_type=]] - option: [[appraise_type=]] [permit_directio] - + option: [[appraise_type=]] [template=] [permit_directio] base: func:= [BPRM_CHECK][MMAP_CHECK][CREDS_CHECK][FILE_CHECK][MODULE_CHECK] [FIRMWARE_CHECK] [KEXEC_KERNEL_CHECK] [KEXEC_INITRAMFS_CHECK] + [KEXEC_CMDLINE] mask:= [[^]MAY_READ] [[^]MAY_WRITE] [[^]MAY_APPEND] [[^]MAY_EXEC] fsmagic:= hex value @@ -38,6 +38,8 @@ Description: fowner:= decimal value lsm: are LSM specific option: appraise_type:= [imasig] + template:= name of a defined IMA template type + (eg, ima-ng). Only valid when action is "measure". pcr:= decimal value default policy: diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-css b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-css index 2979c40c10e9..966f8504bd7b 100644 --- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-css +++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-bus-css @@ -33,3 +33,26 @@ Description: Contains the PIM/PAM/POM values, as reported by the in sync with the values current in the channel subsystem). Note: This is an I/O-subchannel specific attribute. Users: s390-tools, HAL + +What: /sys/bus/css/devices/.../driver_override +Date: June 2019 +Contact: Cornelia Huck <cohuck@redhat.com> + linux-s390@vger.kernel.org +Description: This file allows the driver for a device to be specified. When + specified, only a driver with a name matching the value written + to driver_override will have an opportunity to bind to the + device. The override is specified by writing a string to the + driver_override file (echo vfio-ccw > driver_override) and + may be cleared with an empty string (echo > driver_override). + This returns the device to standard matching rules binding. + Writing to driver_override does not automatically unbind the + device from its current driver or make any attempt to + automatically load the specified driver. If no driver with a + matching name is currently loaded in the kernel, the device + will not bind to any driver. This also allows devices to + opt-out of driver binding using a driver_override name such as + "none". Only a single driver may be specified in the override, + there is no support for parsing delimiters. + Note that unlike the mechanism of the same name for pci, this + file does not allow to override basic matching rules. I.e., + the driver must still match the subchannel type of the device. diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-system-cpu b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-system-cpu index 1528239f69b2..923fe2001472 100644 --- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-system-cpu +++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-devices-system-cpu @@ -538,3 +538,26 @@ Description: Intel Energy and Performance Bias Hint (EPB) This attribute is present for all online CPUs supporting the Intel EPB feature. + +What: /sys/devices/system/cpu/umwait_control + /sys/devices/system/cpu/umwait_control/enable_c02 + /sys/devices/system/cpu/umwait_control/max_time +Date: May 2019 +Contact: Linux kernel mailing list <linux-kernel@vger.kernel.org> +Description: Umwait control + + enable_c02: Read/write interface to control umwait C0.2 state + Read returns C0.2 state status: + 0: C0.2 is disabled + 1: C0.2 is enabled + + Write 'y' or '1' or 'on' to enable C0.2 state. + Write 'n' or '0' or 'off' to disable C0.2 state. + + The interface is case insensitive. + + max_time: Read/write interface to control umwait maximum time + in TSC-quanta that the CPU can reside in either C0.1 + or C0.2 state. The time is an unsigned 32-bit number. + Note that a value of zero means there is no limit. + Low order two bits must be zero. diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-iommu_groups b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-iommu_groups index 35c64e00b35c..017f5bc3920c 100644 --- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-iommu_groups +++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-kernel-iommu_groups @@ -24,3 +24,12 @@ Description: /sys/kernel/iommu_groups/reserved_regions list IOVA region is described on a single line: the 1st field is the base IOVA, the second is the end IOVA and the third field describes the type of the region. + +What: /sys/kernel/iommu_groups/reserved_regions +Date: June 2019 +KernelVersion: v5.3 +Contact: Eric Auger <eric.auger@redhat.com> +Description: In case an RMRR is used only by graphics or USB devices + it is now exposed as "direct-relaxable" instead of "direct". + In device assignment use case, for instance, those RMRR + are considered to be relaxable and safe. diff --git a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-power b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-power index 18b7dc929234..3c5130355011 100644 --- a/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-power +++ b/Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-power @@ -300,4 +300,4 @@ Description: attempt. Using this sysfs file will override any values that were - set using the kernel command line for disk offset.
\ No newline at end of file + set using the kernel command line for disk offset. diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/rcuref.txt b/Documentation/RCU/rcuref.txt index 613033ff2b9b..5e6429d66c24 100644 --- a/Documentation/RCU/rcuref.txt +++ b/Documentation/RCU/rcuref.txt @@ -12,6 +12,7 @@ please read on. Reference counting on elements of lists which are protected by traditional reader/writer spinlocks or semaphores are straightforward: +CODE LISTING A: 1. 2. add() search_and_reference() { { @@ -28,7 +29,8 @@ add() search_and_reference() release_referenced() delete() { { ... write_lock(&list_lock); - atomic_dec(&el->rc, relfunc) ... + if(atomic_dec_and_test(&el->rc)) ... + kfree(el); ... remove_element } write_unlock(&list_lock); ... @@ -44,6 +46,7 @@ search_and_reference() could potentially hold reference to an element which has already been deleted from the list/array. Use atomic_inc_not_zero() in this scenario as follows: +CODE LISTING B: 1. 2. add() search_and_reference() { { @@ -79,6 +82,7 @@ search_and_reference() code path. In such cases, the atomic_dec_and_test() may be moved from delete() to el_free() as follows: +CODE LISTING C: 1. 2. add() search_and_reference() { { @@ -114,6 +118,17 @@ element can therefore safely be freed. This in turn guarantees that if any reader finds the element, that reader may safely acquire a reference without checking the value of the reference counter. +A clear advantage of the RCU-based pattern in listing C over the one +in listing B is that any call to search_and_reference() that locates +a given object will succeed in obtaining a reference to that object, +even given a concurrent invocation of delete() for that same object. +Similarly, a clear advantage of both listings B and C over listing A is +that a call to delete() is not delayed even if there are an arbitrarily +large number of calls to search_and_reference() searching for the same +object that delete() was invoked on. Instead, all that is delayed is +the eventual invocation of kfree(), which is usually not a problem on +modern computer systems, even the small ones. + In cases where delete() can sleep, synchronize_rcu() can be called from delete(), so that el_free() can be subsumed into delete as follows: @@ -130,3 +145,7 @@ delete() kfree(el); ... } + +As additional examples in the kernel, the pattern in listing C is used by +reference counting of struct pid, while the pattern in listing B is used by +struct posix_acl. diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt b/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt index 1ab70c37921f..13e88fc00f01 100644 --- a/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt +++ b/Documentation/RCU/stallwarn.txt @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ rcupdate.rcu_task_stall_timeout This boot/sysfs parameter controls the RCU-tasks stall warning interval. A value of zero or less suppresses RCU-tasks stall warnings. A positive value sets the stall-warning interval - in jiffies. An RCU-tasks stall warning starts with the line: + in seconds. An RCU-tasks stall warning starts with the line: INFO: rcu_tasks detected stalls on tasks: diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt b/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt index 981651a8b65d..7e1a8721637a 100644 --- a/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt +++ b/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt @@ -212,7 +212,7 @@ synchronize_rcu() rcu_assign_pointer() - typeof(p) rcu_assign_pointer(p, typeof(p) v); + void rcu_assign_pointer(p, typeof(p) v); Yes, rcu_assign_pointer() -is- implemented as a macro, though it would be cool to be able to declare a function in this manner. @@ -220,9 +220,9 @@ rcu_assign_pointer() The updater uses this function to assign a new value to an RCU-protected pointer, in order to safely communicate the change - in value from the updater to the reader. This function returns - the new value, and also executes any memory-barrier instructions - required for a given CPU architecture. + in value from the updater to the reader. This macro does not + evaluate to an rvalue, but it does execute any memory-barrier + instructions required for a given CPU architecture. Perhaps just as important, it serves to document (1) which pointers are protected by RCU and (2) the point at which a diff --git a/Documentation/admin-guide/cgroup-v2.rst b/Documentation/admin-guide/cgroup-v2.rst index cf88c1f98270..a5c845338d6d 100644 --- a/Documentation/admin-guide/cgroup-v2.rst +++ b/Documentation/admin-guide/cgroup-v2.rst @@ -705,6 +705,12 @@ Conventions informational files on the root cgroup which end up showing global information available elsewhere shouldn't exist. +- The default time unit is microseconds. If a different unit is ever + used, an explicit unit suffix must be present. + +- A parts-per quantity should use a percentage decimal with at least + two digit fractional part - e.g. 13.40. + - If a controller implements weight based resource distribution, its interface file should be named "weight" and have the range [1, 10000] with 100 as the default. The values are chosen to allow diff --git a/Documentation/admin-guide/hw-vuln/l1tf.rst b/Documentation/admin-guide/hw-vuln/l1tf.rst index 31653a9f0e1b..656aee262e23 100644 --- a/Documentation/admin-guide/hw-vuln/l1tf.rst +++ b/Documentation/admin-guide/hw-vuln/l1tf.rst @@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ Guest mitigation mechanisms For further information about confining guests to a single or to a group of cores consult the cpusets documentation: - https://www.kernel.org/doc/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt + https://www.kernel.org/doc/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst .. _interrupt_isolation: diff --git a/Documentation/admin-guide/kernel-parameters.txt b/Documentation/admin-guide/kernel-parameters.txt index 138f6664b2e2..74d28efa1c40 100644 --- a/Documentation/admin-guide/kernel-parameters.txt +++ b/Documentation/admin-guide/kernel-parameters.txt @@ -478,7 +478,7 @@ others). ccw_timeout_log [S390] - See Documentation/s390/CommonIO for details. + See Documentation/s390/common_io.rst for details. cgroup_disable= [KNL] Disable a particular controller Format: {name of the controller(s) to disable} @@ -516,7 +516,7 @@ /selinux/checkreqprot. cio_ignore= [S390] - See Documentation/s390/CommonIO for details. + See Documentation/s390/common_io.rst for details. clk_ignore_unused [CLK] Prevents the clock framework from automatically gating @@ -3752,6 +3752,12 @@ the propagation of recent CPU-hotplug changes up the rcu_node combining tree. + rcutree.use_softirq= [KNL] + If set to zero, move all RCU_SOFTIRQ processing to + per-CPU rcuc kthreads. Defaults to a non-zero + value, meaning that RCU_SOFTIRQ is used by default. + Specify rcutree.use_softirq=0 to use rcuc kthreads. + rcutree.rcu_fanout_exact= [KNL] Disable autobalancing of the rcu_node combining tree. This is used by rcutorture, and might @@ -4078,7 +4084,7 @@ relax_domain_level= [KNL, SMP] Set scheduler's default relax_domain_level. - See Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt. + See Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst. reserve= [KNL,BUGS] Force kernel to ignore I/O ports or memory Format: <base1>,<size1>[,<base2>,<size2>,...] @@ -4588,7 +4594,7 @@ swapaccount=[0|1] [KNL] Enable accounting of swap in memory resource controller if no parameter or 1 is given or disable - it if 0 is given (See Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.txt) + it if 0 is given (See Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.rst) swiotlb= [ARM,IA-64,PPC,MIPS,X86] Format: { <int> | force | noforce } @@ -5100,13 +5106,12 @@ targets for exploits that can control RIP. emulate [default] Vsyscalls turn into traps and are - emulated reasonably safely. + emulated reasonably safely. The vsyscall + page is readable. - native Vsyscalls are native syscall instructions. - This is a little bit faster than trapping - and makes a few dynamic recompilers work - better than they would in emulation mode. - It also makes exploits much easier to write. + xonly Vsyscalls turn into traps and are + emulated reasonably safely. The vsyscall + page is not readable. none Vsyscalls don't work at all. This makes them quite hard to use for exploits but diff --git a/Documentation/admin-guide/mm/numa_memory_policy.rst b/Documentation/admin-guide/mm/numa_memory_policy.rst index d78c5b315f72..546f174e5d6a 100644 --- a/Documentation/admin-guide/mm/numa_memory_policy.rst +++ b/Documentation/admin-guide/mm/numa_memory_policy.rst @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ document attempts to describe the concepts and APIs of the 2.6 memory policy support. Memory policies should not be confused with cpusets -(``Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt``) +(``Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst``) which is an administrative mechanism for restricting the nodes from which memory may be allocated by a set of processes. Memory policies are a programming interface that a NUMA-aware application can take advantage of. When diff --git a/Documentation/arm64/elf_hwcaps.txt b/Documentation/arm64/elf_hwcaps.txt index b73a2519ecf2..5ae2ef2c12f3 100644 --- a/Documentation/arm64/elf_hwcaps.txt +++ b/Documentation/arm64/elf_hwcaps.txt @@ -207,6 +207,10 @@ HWCAP_FLAGM Functionality implied by ID_AA64ISAR0_EL1.TS == 0b0001. +HWCAP2_FLAGM2 + + Functionality implied by ID_AA64ISAR0_EL1.TS == 0b0010. + HWCAP_SSBS Functionality implied by ID_AA64PFR1_EL1.SSBS == 0b0010. @@ -223,6 +227,10 @@ HWCAP_PACG ID_AA64ISAR1_EL1.GPI == 0b0001, as described by Documentation/arm64/pointer-authentication.txt. +HWCAP2_FRINT + + Functionality implied by ID_AA64ISAR1_EL1.FRINTTS == 0b0001. + 4. Unused AT_HWCAP bits ----------------------- diff --git a/Documentation/atomic_t.txt b/Documentation/atomic_t.txt index dca3fb0554db..0ab747e0d5ac 100644 --- a/Documentation/atomic_t.txt +++ b/Documentation/atomic_t.txt @@ -81,9 +81,11 @@ Non-RMW ops: The non-RMW ops are (typically) regular LOADs and STOREs and are canonically implemented using READ_ONCE(), WRITE_ONCE(), smp_load_acquire() and -smp_store_release() respectively. +smp_store_release() respectively. Therefore, if you find yourself only using +the Non-RMW operations of atomic_t, you do not in fact need atomic_t at all +and are doing it wrong. -The one detail to this is that atomic_set{}() should be observable to the RMW +A subtle detail of atomic_set{}() is that it should be observable to the RMW ops. That is: C atomic-set @@ -187,13 +189,22 @@ The barriers: smp_mb__{before,after}_atomic() -only apply to the RMW ops and can be used to augment/upgrade the ordering -inherent to the used atomic op. These barriers provide a full smp_mb(). +only apply to the RMW atomic ops and can be used to augment/upgrade the +ordering inherent to the op. These barriers act almost like a full smp_mb(): +smp_mb__before_atomic() orders all earlier accesses against the RMW op +itself and all accesses following it, and smp_mb__after_atomic() orders all +later accesses against the RMW op and all accesses preceding it. However, +accesses between the smp_mb__{before,after}_atomic() and the RMW op are not +ordered, so it is advisable to place the barrier right next to the RMW atomic +op whenever possible. These helper barriers exist because architectures have varying implicit ordering on their SMP atomic primitives. For example our TSO architectures provide full ordered atomics and these barriers are no-ops. +NOTE: when the atomic RmW ops are fully ordered, they should also imply a +compiler barrier. + Thus: atomic_fetch_add(); @@ -212,7 +223,9 @@ Further, while something like: atomic_dec(&X); is a 'typical' RELEASE pattern, the barrier is strictly stronger than -a RELEASE. Similarly for something like: +a RELEASE because it orders preceding instructions against both the read +and write parts of the atomic_dec(), and against all following instructions +as well. Similarly, something like: atomic_inc(&X); smp_mb__after_atomic(); @@ -244,7 +257,8 @@ strictly stronger than ACQUIRE. As illustrated: This should not happen; but a hypothetical atomic_inc_acquire() -- (void)atomic_fetch_inc_acquire() for instance -- would allow the outcome, -since then: +because it would not order the W part of the RMW against the following +WRITE_ONCE. Thus: P1 P2 diff --git a/Documentation/block/bfq-iosched.txt b/Documentation/block/bfq-iosched.txt index 1a0f2ac02eb6..b2265cf6c9c3 100644 --- a/Documentation/block/bfq-iosched.txt +++ b/Documentation/block/bfq-iosched.txt @@ -539,7 +539,7 @@ As for cgroups-v1 (blkio controller), the exact set of stat files created, and kept up-to-date by bfq, depends on whether CONFIG_DEBUG_BLK_CGROUP is set. If it is set, then bfq creates all the stat files documented in -Documentation/cgroup-v1/blkio-controller.txt. If, instead, +Documentation/cgroup-v1/blkio-controller.rst. If, instead, CONFIG_DEBUG_BLK_CGROUP is not set, then bfq creates only the files blkio.bfq.io_service_bytes blkio.bfq.io_service_bytes_recursive diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/blkio-controller.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/blkio-controller.rst index d1a1b7bdd03a..fd3184537d23 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/blkio-controller.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/blkio-controller.rst @@ -1,5 +1,7 @@ - Block IO Controller - =================== +=================== +Block IO Controller +=================== + Overview ======== cgroup subsys "blkio" implements the block io controller. There seems to be @@ -17,24 +19,27 @@ HOWTO ===== Throttling/Upper Limit policy ----------------------------- -- Enable Block IO controller +- Enable Block IO controller:: + CONFIG_BLK_CGROUP=y -- Enable throttling in block layer +- Enable throttling in block layer:: + CONFIG_BLK_DEV_THROTTLING=y -- Mount blkio controller (see cgroups.txt, Why are cgroups needed?) +- Mount blkio controller (see cgroups.txt, Why are cgroups needed?):: + mount -t cgroup -o blkio none /sys/fs/cgroup/blkio - Specify a bandwidth rate on particular device for root group. The format - for policy is "<major>:<minor> <bytes_per_second>". + for policy is "<major>:<minor> <bytes_per_second>":: echo "8:16 1048576" > /sys/fs/cgroup/blkio/blkio.throttle.read_bps_device Above will put a limit of 1MB/second on reads happening for root group on device having major/minor number 8:16. -- Run dd to read a file and see if rate is throttled to 1MB/s or not. +- Run dd to read a file and see if rate is throttled to 1MB/s or not:: # dd iflag=direct if=/mnt/common/zerofile of=/dev/null bs=4K count=1024 1024+0 records in @@ -51,7 +56,7 @@ throttling's hierarchy support is enabled iff "sane_behavior" is enabled from cgroup side, which currently is a development option and not publicly available. -If somebody created a hierarchy like as follows. +If somebody created a hierarchy like as follows:: root / \ @@ -66,7 +71,7 @@ directly generated by tasks in that cgroup. Throttling without "sane_behavior" enabled from cgroup side will practically treat all groups at same level as if it looks like the -following. +following:: pivot / / \ \ @@ -99,27 +104,31 @@ Proportional weight policy files These rules override the default value of group weight as specified by blkio.weight. - Following is the format. + Following is the format:: + + # echo dev_maj:dev_minor weight > blkio.weight_device + + Configure weight=300 on /dev/sdb (8:16) in this cgroup:: + + # echo 8:16 300 > blkio.weight_device + # cat blkio.weight_device + dev weight + 8:16 300 + + Configure weight=500 on /dev/sda (8:0) in this cgroup:: - # echo dev_maj:dev_minor weight > blkio.weight_device - Configure weight=300 on /dev/sdb (8:16) in this cgroup - # echo 8:16 300 > blkio.weight_device - # cat blkio.weight_device - dev weight - 8:16 300 + # echo 8:0 500 > blkio.weight_device + # cat blkio.weight_device + dev weight + 8:0 500 + 8:16 300 - Configure weight=500 on /dev/sda (8:0) in this cgroup - # echo 8:0 500 > blkio.weight_device - # cat blkio.weight_device - dev weight - 8:0 500 - 8:16 300 + Remove specific weight for /dev/sda in this cgroup:: - Remove specific weight for /dev/sda in this cgroup - # echo 8:0 0 > blkio.weight_device - # cat blkio.weight_device - dev weight - 8:16 300 + # echo 8:0 0 > blkio.weight_device + # cat blkio.weight_device + dev weight + 8:16 300 - blkio.leaf_weight[_device] - Equivalents of blkio.weight[_device] for the purpose of @@ -244,30 +253,30 @@ Throttling/Upper limit policy files - blkio.throttle.read_bps_device - Specifies upper limit on READ rate from the device. IO rate is specified in bytes per second. Rules are per device. Following is - the format. + the format:: - echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_bytes_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.read_bps_device + echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_bytes_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.read_bps_device - blkio.throttle.write_bps_device - Specifies upper limit on WRITE rate to the device. IO rate is specified in bytes per second. Rules are per device. Following is - the format. + the format:: - echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_bytes_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.write_bps_device + echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_bytes_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.write_bps_device - blkio.throttle.read_iops_device - Specifies upper limit on READ rate from the device. IO rate is specified in IO per second. Rules are per device. Following is - the format. + the format:: - echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_io_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.read_iops_device + echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_io_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.read_iops_device - blkio.throttle.write_iops_device - Specifies upper limit on WRITE rate to the device. IO rate is specified in io per second. Rules are per device. Following is - the format. + the format:: - echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_io_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.write_iops_device + echo "<major>:<minor> <rate_io_per_second>" > /cgrp/blkio.throttle.write_iops_device Note: If both BW and IOPS rules are specified for a device, then IO is subjected to both the constraints. diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.rst index 059f7063eea6..46bbe7e022d4 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.rst @@ -1,35 +1,39 @@ - CGROUPS - ------- +============== +Control Groups +============== Written by Paul Menage <menage@google.com> based on -Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt +Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst Original copyright statements from cpusets.txt: + Portions Copyright (C) 2004 BULL SA. + Portions Copyright (c) 2004-2006 Silicon Graphics, Inc. + Modified by Paul Jackson <pj@sgi.com> + Modified by Christoph Lameter <cl@linux.com> -CONTENTS: -========= - -1. Control Groups - 1.1 What are cgroups ? - 1.2 Why are cgroups needed ? - 1.3 How are cgroups implemented ? - 1.4 What does notify_on_release do ? - 1.5 What does clone_children do ? - 1.6 How do I use cgroups ? -2. Usage Examples and Syntax - 2.1 Basic Usage - 2.2 Attaching processes - 2.3 Mounting hierarchies by name -3. Kernel API - 3.1 Overview - 3.2 Synchronization - 3.3 Subsystem API -4. Extended attributes usage -5. Questions +.. CONTENTS: + + 1. Control Groups + 1.1 What are cgroups ? + 1.2 Why are cgroups needed ? + 1.3 How are cgroups implemented ? + 1.4 What does notify_on_release do ? + 1.5 What does clone_children do ? + 1.6 How do I use cgroups ? + 2. Usage Examples and Syntax + 2.1 Basic Usage + 2.2 Attaching processes + 2.3 Mounting hierarchies by name + 3. Kernel API + 3.1 Overview + 3.2 Synchronization + 3.3 Subsystem API + 4. Extended attributes usage + 5. Questions 1. Control Groups ================= @@ -72,7 +76,7 @@ On their own, the only use for cgroups is for simple job tracking. The intention is that other subsystems hook into the generic cgroup support to provide new attributes for cgroups, such as accounting/limiting the resources which processes in a cgroup can -access. For example, cpusets (see Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt) allow +access. For example, cpusets (see Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst) allow you to associate a set of CPUs and a set of memory nodes with the tasks in each cgroup. @@ -108,7 +112,7 @@ As an example of a scenario (originally proposed by vatsa@in.ibm.com) that can benefit from multiple hierarchies, consider a large university server with various users - students, professors, system tasks etc. The resource planning for this server could be along the -following lines: +following lines:: CPU : "Top cpuset" / \ @@ -136,7 +140,7 @@ depending on who launched it (prof/student). With the ability to classify tasks differently for different resources (by putting those resource subsystems in different hierarchies), the admin can easily set up a script which receives exec notifications -and depending on who is launching the browser he can +and depending on who is launching the browser he can:: # echo browser_pid > /sys/fs/cgroup/<restype>/<userclass>/tasks @@ -151,7 +155,7 @@ wants to do online gaming :)) OR give one of the student's simulation apps enhanced CPU power. With ability to write PIDs directly to resource classes, it's just a -matter of: +matter of:: # echo pid > /sys/fs/cgroup/network/<new_class>/tasks (after some time) @@ -306,7 +310,7 @@ configuration from the parent during initialization. -------------------------- To start a new job that is to be contained within a cgroup, using -the "cpuset" cgroup subsystem, the steps are something like: +the "cpuset" cgroup subsystem, the steps are something like:: 1) mount -t tmpfs cgroup_root /sys/fs/cgroup 2) mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset @@ -320,7 +324,7 @@ the "cpuset" cgroup subsystem, the steps are something like: For example, the following sequence of commands will setup a cgroup named "Charlie", containing just CPUs 2 and 3, and Memory Node 1, -and then start a subshell 'sh' in that cgroup: +and then start a subshell 'sh' in that cgroup:: mount -t tmpfs cgroup_root /sys/fs/cgroup mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset @@ -345,8 +349,9 @@ and then start a subshell 'sh' in that cgroup: Creating, modifying, using cgroups can be done through the cgroup virtual filesystem. -To mount a cgroup hierarchy with all available subsystems, type: -# mount -t cgroup xxx /sys/fs/cgroup +To mount a cgroup hierarchy with all available subsystems, type:: + + # mount -t cgroup xxx /sys/fs/cgroup The "xxx" is not interpreted by the cgroup code, but will appear in /proc/mounts so may be any useful identifying string that you like. @@ -355,18 +360,19 @@ Note: Some subsystems do not work without some user input first. For instance, if cpusets are enabled the user will have to populate the cpus and mems files for each new cgroup created before that group can be used. -As explained in section `1.2 Why are cgroups needed?' you should create +As explained in section `1.2 Why are cgroups needed?` you should create different hierarchies of cgroups for each single resource or group of resources you want to control. Therefore, you should mount a tmpfs on /sys/fs/cgroup and create directories for each cgroup resource or resource -group. +group:: -# mount -t tmpfs cgroup_root /sys/fs/cgroup -# mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 + # mount -t tmpfs cgroup_root /sys/fs/cgroup + # mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 To mount a cgroup hierarchy with just the cpuset and memory -subsystems, type: -# mount -t cgroup -o cpuset,memory hier1 /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 +subsystems, type:: + + # mount -t cgroup -o cpuset,memory hier1 /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 While remounting cgroups is currently supported, it is not recommend to use it. Remounting allows changing bound subsystems and @@ -375,9 +381,10 @@ hierarchy is empty and release_agent itself should be replaced with conventional fsnotify. The support for remounting will be removed in the future. -To Specify a hierarchy's release_agent: -# mount -t cgroup -o cpuset,release_agent="/sbin/cpuset_release_agent" \ - xxx /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 +To Specify a hierarchy's release_agent:: + + # mount -t cgroup -o cpuset,release_agent="/sbin/cpuset_release_agent" \ + xxx /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 Note that specifying 'release_agent' more than once will return failure. @@ -390,32 +397,39 @@ Then under /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 you can find a tree that corresponds to the tree of the cgroups in the system. For instance, /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 is the cgroup that holds the whole system. -If you want to change the value of release_agent: -# echo "/sbin/new_release_agent" > /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1/release_agent +If you want to change the value of release_agent:: + + # echo "/sbin/new_release_agent" > /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1/release_agent It can also be changed via remount. -If you want to create a new cgroup under /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1: -# cd /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 -# mkdir my_cgroup +If you want to create a new cgroup under /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1:: + + # cd /sys/fs/cgroup/rg1 + # mkdir my_cgroup + +Now you want to do something with this cgroup: + + # cd my_cgroup -Now you want to do something with this cgroup. -# cd my_cgroup +In this directory you can find several files:: -In this directory you can find several files: -# ls -cgroup.procs notify_on_release tasks -(plus whatever files added by the attached subsystems) + # ls + cgroup.procs notify_on_release tasks + (plus whatever files added by the attached subsystems) -Now attach your shell to this cgroup: -# /bin/echo $$ > tasks +Now attach your shell to this cgroup:: + + # /bin/echo $$ > tasks You can also create cgroups inside your cgroup by using mkdir in this -directory. -# mkdir my_sub_cs +directory:: + + # mkdir my_sub_cs + +To remove a cgroup, just use rmdir:: -To remove a cgroup, just use rmdir: -# rmdir my_sub_cs + # rmdir my_sub_cs This will fail if the cgroup is in use (has cgroups inside, or has processes attached, or is held alive by other subsystem-specific @@ -424,19 +438,21 @@ reference). 2.2 Attaching processes ----------------------- -# /bin/echo PID > tasks +:: + + # /bin/echo PID > tasks Note that it is PID, not PIDs. You can only attach ONE task at a time. -If you have several tasks to attach, you have to do it one after another: +If you have several tasks to attach, you have to do it one after another:: -# /bin/echo PID1 > tasks -# /bin/echo PID2 > tasks - ... -# /bin/echo PIDn > tasks + # /bin/echo PID1 > tasks + # /bin/echo PID2 > tasks + ... + # /bin/echo PIDn > tasks -You can attach the current shell task by echoing 0: +You can attach the current shell task by echoing 0:: -# echo 0 > tasks + # echo 0 > tasks You can use the cgroup.procs file instead of the tasks file to move all threads in a threadgroup at once. Echoing the PID of any task in a @@ -529,7 +545,7 @@ Each subsystem may export the following methods. The only mandatory methods are css_alloc/free. Any others that are null are presumed to be successful no-ops. -struct cgroup_subsys_state *css_alloc(struct cgroup *cgrp) +``struct cgroup_subsys_state *css_alloc(struct cgroup *cgrp)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) Called to allocate a subsystem state object for a cgroup. The @@ -544,7 +560,7 @@ identified by the passed cgroup object having a NULL parent (since it's the root of the hierarchy) and may be an appropriate place for initialization code. -int css_online(struct cgroup *cgrp) +``int css_online(struct cgroup *cgrp)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) Called after @cgrp successfully completed all allocations and made @@ -554,7 +570,7 @@ callback can be used to implement reliable state sharing and propagation along the hierarchy. See the comment on cgroup_for_each_descendant_pre() for details. -void css_offline(struct cgroup *cgrp); +``void css_offline(struct cgroup *cgrp);`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) This is the counterpart of css_online() and called iff css_online() @@ -564,7 +580,7 @@ all references it's holding on @cgrp. When all references are dropped, cgroup removal will proceed to the next step - css_free(). After this callback, @cgrp should be considered dead to the subsystem. -void css_free(struct cgroup *cgrp) +``void css_free(struct cgroup *cgrp)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) The cgroup system is about to free @cgrp; the subsystem should free @@ -573,7 +589,7 @@ is completely unused; @cgrp->parent is still valid. (Note - can also be called for a newly-created cgroup if an error occurs after this subsystem's create() method has been called for the new cgroup). -int can_attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset) +``int can_attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) Called prior to moving one or more tasks into a cgroup; if the @@ -594,7 +610,7 @@ fork. If this method returns 0 (success) then this should remain valid while the caller holds cgroup_mutex and it is ensured that either attach() or cancel_attach() will be called in future. -void css_reset(struct cgroup_subsys_state *css) +``void css_reset(struct cgroup_subsys_state *css)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) An optional operation which should restore @css's configuration to the @@ -608,7 +624,7 @@ This prevents unexpected resource control from a hidden css and ensures that the configuration is in the initial state when it is made visible again later. -void cancel_attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset) +``void cancel_attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) Called when a task attach operation has failed after can_attach() has succeeded. @@ -617,26 +633,26 @@ function, so that the subsystem can implement a rollback. If not, not necessary. This will be called only about subsystems whose can_attach() operation have succeeded. The parameters are identical to can_attach(). -void attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset) +``void attach(struct cgroup *cgrp, struct cgroup_taskset *tset)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) Called after the task has been attached to the cgroup, to allow any post-attachment activity that requires memory allocations or blocking. The parameters are identical to can_attach(). -void fork(struct task_struct *task) +``void fork(struct task_struct *task)`` Called when a task is forked into a cgroup. -void exit(struct task_struct *task) +``void exit(struct task_struct *task)`` Called during task exit. -void free(struct task_struct *task) +``void free(struct task_struct *task)`` Called when the task_struct is freed. -void bind(struct cgroup *root) +``void bind(struct cgroup *root)`` (cgroup_mutex held by caller) Called when a cgroup subsystem is rebound to a different hierarchy @@ -649,6 +665,7 @@ that is being created/destroyed (and hence has no sub-cgroups). cgroup filesystem supports certain types of extended attributes in its directories and files. The current supported types are: + - Trusted (XATTR_TRUSTED) - Security (XATTR_SECURITY) @@ -666,12 +683,13 @@ in containers and systemd for assorted meta data like main PID in a cgroup 5. Questions ============ -Q: what's up with this '/bin/echo' ? -A: bash's builtin 'echo' command does not check calls to write() against - errors. If you use it in the cgroup file system, you won't be - able to tell whether a command succeeded or failed. +:: -Q: When I attach processes, only the first of the line gets really attached ! -A: We can only return one error code per call to write(). So you should also - put only ONE PID. + Q: what's up with this '/bin/echo' ? + A: bash's builtin 'echo' command does not check calls to write() against + errors. If you use it in the cgroup file system, you won't be + able to tell whether a command succeeded or failed. + Q: When I attach processes, only the first of the line gets really attached ! + A: We can only return one error code per call to write(). So you should also + put only ONE PID. diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpuacct.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpuacct.rst index 9d73cc0cadb9..d30ed81d2ad7 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpuacct.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpuacct.rst @@ -1,5 +1,6 @@ +========================= CPU Accounting Controller -------------------------- +========================= The CPU accounting controller is used to group tasks using cgroups and account the CPU usage of these groups of tasks. @@ -8,9 +9,9 @@ The CPU accounting controller supports multi-hierarchy groups. An accounting group accumulates the CPU usage of all of its child groups and the tasks directly present in its group. -Accounting groups can be created by first mounting the cgroup filesystem. +Accounting groups can be created by first mounting the cgroup filesystem:: -# mount -t cgroup -ocpuacct none /sys/fs/cgroup + # mount -t cgroup -ocpuacct none /sys/fs/cgroup With the above step, the initial or the parent accounting group becomes visible at /sys/fs/cgroup. At bootup, this group includes all the tasks in @@ -19,11 +20,11 @@ the system. /sys/fs/cgroup/tasks lists the tasks in this cgroup. by this group which is essentially the CPU time obtained by all the tasks in the system. -New accounting groups can be created under the parent group /sys/fs/cgroup. +New accounting groups can be created under the parent group /sys/fs/cgroup:: -# cd /sys/fs/cgroup -# mkdir g1 -# echo $$ > g1/tasks + # cd /sys/fs/cgroup + # mkdir g1 + # echo $$ > g1/tasks The above steps create a new group g1 and move the current shell process (bash) into it. CPU time consumed by this bash and its children diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst index 8402dd6de8df..b6a42cdea72b 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst @@ -1,35 +1,36 @@ - CPUSETS - ------- +======= +CPUSETS +======= Copyright (C) 2004 BULL SA. -Written by Simon.Derr@bull.net - -Portions Copyright (c) 2004-2006 Silicon Graphics, Inc. -Modified by Paul Jackson <pj@sgi.com> -Modified by Christoph Lameter <cl@linux.com> -Modified by Paul Menage <menage@google.com> -Modified by Hidetoshi Seto <seto.hidetoshi@jp.fujitsu.com> -CONTENTS: -========= +Written by Simon.Derr@bull.net -1. Cpusets - 1.1 What are cpusets ? - 1.2 Why are cpusets needed ? - 1.3 How are cpusets implemented ? - 1.4 What are exclusive cpusets ? - 1.5 What is memory_pressure ? - 1.6 What is memory spread ? - 1.7 What is sched_load_balance ? - 1.8 What is sched_relax_domain_level ? - 1.9 How do I use cpusets ? -2. Usage Examples and Syntax - 2.1 Basic Usage - 2.2 Adding/removing cpus - 2.3 Setting flags - 2.4 Attaching processes -3. Questions -4. Contact +- Portions Copyright (c) 2004-2006 Silicon Graphics, Inc. +- Modified by Paul Jackson <pj@sgi.com> +- Modified by Christoph Lameter <cl@linux.com> +- Modified by Paul Menage <menage@google.com> +- Modified by Hidetoshi Seto <seto.hidetoshi@jp.fujitsu.com> + +.. CONTENTS: + + 1. Cpusets + 1.1 What are cpusets ? + 1.2 Why are cpusets needed ? + 1.3 How are cpusets implemented ? + 1.4 What are exclusive cpusets ? + 1.5 What is memory_pressure ? + 1.6 What is memory spread ? + 1.7 What is sched_load_balance ? + 1.8 What is sched_relax_domain_level ? + 1.9 How do I use cpusets ? + 2. Usage Examples and Syntax + 2.1 Basic Usage + 2.2 Adding/removing cpus + 2.3 Setting flags + 2.4 Attaching processes + 3. Questions + 4. Contact 1. Cpusets ========== @@ -48,7 +49,7 @@ hooks, beyond what is already present, required to manage dynamic job placement on large systems. Cpusets use the generic cgroup subsystem described in -Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.txt. +Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.rst. Requests by a task, using the sched_setaffinity(2) system call to include CPUs in its CPU affinity mask, and using the mbind(2) and @@ -157,7 +158,7 @@ modifying cpusets is via this cpuset file system. The /proc/<pid>/status file for each task has four added lines, displaying the task's cpus_allowed (on which CPUs it may be scheduled) and mems_allowed (on which Memory Nodes it may obtain memory), -in the two formats seen in the following example: +in the two formats seen in the following example:: Cpus_allowed: ffffffff,ffffffff,ffffffff,ffffffff Cpus_allowed_list: 0-127 @@ -181,6 +182,7 @@ files describing that cpuset: - cpuset.sched_relax_domain_level: the searching range when migrating tasks In addition, only the root cpuset has the following file: + - cpuset.memory_pressure_enabled flag: compute memory_pressure? New cpusets are created using the mkdir system call or shell @@ -266,7 +268,8 @@ to monitor a cpuset for signs of memory pressure. It's up to the batch manager or other user code to decide what to do about it and take action. -==> Unless this feature is enabled by writing "1" to the special file +==> + Unless this feature is enabled by writing "1" to the special file /dev/cpuset/memory_pressure_enabled, the hook in the rebalance code of __alloc_pages() for this metric reduces to simply noticing that the cpuset_memory_pressure_enabled flag is zero. So only @@ -399,6 +402,7 @@ have tasks running on them unless explicitly assigned. This default load balancing across all CPUs is not well suited for the following two situations: + 1) On large systems, load balancing across many CPUs is expensive. If the system is managed using cpusets to place independent jobs on separate sets of CPUs, full load balancing is unnecessary. @@ -501,6 +505,7 @@ all the CPUs that must be load balanced. The cpuset code builds a new such partition and passes it to the scheduler sched domain setup code, to have the sched domains rebuilt as necessary, whenever: + - the 'cpuset.sched_load_balance' flag of a cpuset with non-empty CPUs changes, - or CPUs come or go from a cpuset with this flag enabled, - or 'cpuset.sched_relax_domain_level' value of a cpuset with non-empty CPUs @@ -553,13 +558,15 @@ this searching range as you like. This file takes int value which indicates size of searching range in levels ideally as follows, otherwise initial value -1 that indicates the cpuset has no request. - -1 : no request. use system default or follow request of others. - 0 : no search. - 1 : search siblings (hyperthreads in a core). - 2 : search cores in a package. - 3 : search cpus in a node [= system wide on non-NUMA system] - 4 : search nodes in a chunk of node [on NUMA system] - 5 : search system wide [on NUMA system] +====== =========================================================== + -1 no request. use system default or follow request of others. + 0 no search. + 1 search siblings (hyperthreads in a core). + 2 search cores in a package. + 3 search cpus in a node [= system wide on non-NUMA system] + 4 search nodes in a chunk of node [on NUMA system] + 5 search system wide [on NUMA system] +====== =========================================================== The system default is architecture dependent. The system default can be changed using the relax_domain_level= boot parameter. @@ -578,13 +585,14 @@ and whether it is acceptable or not depends on your situation. Don't modify this file if you are not sure. If your situation is: + - The migration costs between each cpu can be assumed considerably small(for you) due to your special application's behavior or special hardware support for CPU cache etc. - The searching cost doesn't have impact(for you) or you can make the searching cost enough small by managing cpuset to compact etc. - The latency is required even it sacrifices cache hit rate etc. -then increasing 'sched_relax_domain_level' would benefit you. + then increasing 'sched_relax_domain_level' would benefit you. 1.9 How do I use cpusets ? @@ -678,7 +686,7 @@ To start a new job that is to be contained within a cpuset, the steps are: For example, the following sequence of commands will setup a cpuset named "Charlie", containing just CPUs 2 and 3, and Memory Node 1, -and then start a subshell 'sh' in that cpuset: +and then start a subshell 'sh' in that cpuset:: mount -t cgroup -ocpuset cpuset /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset cd /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset @@ -693,6 +701,7 @@ and then start a subshell 'sh' in that cpuset: cat /proc/self/cpuset There are ways to query or modify cpusets: + - via the cpuset file system directly, using the various cd, mkdir, echo, cat, rmdir commands from the shell, or their equivalent from C. - via the C library libcpuset. @@ -722,115 +731,133 @@ Then under /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset you can find a tree that corresponds to the tree of the cpusets in the system. For instance, /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset is the cpuset that holds the whole system. -If you want to create a new cpuset under /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset: -# cd /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset -# mkdir my_cpuset +If you want to create a new cpuset under /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset:: + + # cd /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset + # mkdir my_cpuset -Now you want to do something with this cpuset. -# cd my_cpuset +Now you want to do something with this cpuset:: -In this directory you can find several files: -# ls -cgroup.clone_children cpuset.memory_pressure -cgroup.event_control cpuset.memory_spread_page -cgroup.procs cpuset.memory_spread_slab -cpuset.cpu_exclusive cpuset.mems -cpuset.cpus cpuset.sched_load_balance -cpuset.mem_exclusive cpuset.sched_relax_domain_level -cpuset.mem_hardwall notify_on_release -cpuset.memory_migrate tasks + # cd my_cpuset + +In this directory you can find several files:: + + # ls + cgroup.clone_children cpuset.memory_pressure + cgroup.event_control cpuset.memory_spread_page + cgroup.procs cpuset.memory_spread_slab + cpuset.cpu_exclusive cpuset.mems + cpuset.cpus cpuset.sched_load_balance + cpuset.mem_exclusive cpuset.sched_relax_domain_level + cpuset.mem_hardwall notify_on_release + cpuset.memory_migrate tasks Reading them will give you information about the state of this cpuset: the CPUs and Memory Nodes it can use, the processes that are using it, its properties. By writing to these files you can manipulate the cpuset. -Set some flags: -# /bin/echo 1 > cpuset.cpu_exclusive +Set some flags:: + + # /bin/echo 1 > cpuset.cpu_exclusive + +Add some cpus:: + + # /bin/echo 0-7 > cpuset.cpus + +Add some mems:: -Add some cpus: -# /bin/echo 0-7 > cpuset.cpus + # /bin/echo 0-7 > cpuset.mems -Add some mems: -# /bin/echo 0-7 > cpuset.mems +Now attach your shell to this cpuset:: -Now attach your shell to this cpuset: -# /bin/echo $$ > tasks + # /bin/echo $$ > tasks You can also create cpusets inside your cpuset by using mkdir in this -directory. -# mkdir my_sub_cs +directory:: + + # mkdir my_sub_cs + +To remove a cpuset, just use rmdir:: + + # rmdir my_sub_cs -To remove a cpuset, just use rmdir: -# rmdir my_sub_cs This will fail if the cpuset is in use (has cpusets inside, or has processes attached). Note that for legacy reasons, the "cpuset" filesystem exists as a wrapper around the cgroup filesystem. -The command +The command:: -mount -t cpuset X /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset + mount -t cpuset X /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset -is equivalent to +is equivalent to:: -mount -t cgroup -ocpuset,noprefix X /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset -echo "/sbin/cpuset_release_agent" > /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset/release_agent + mount -t cgroup -ocpuset,noprefix X /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset + echo "/sbin/cpuset_release_agent" > /sys/fs/cgroup/cpuset/release_agent 2.2 Adding/removing cpus ------------------------ This is the syntax to use when writing in the cpus or mems files -in cpuset directories: +in cpuset directories:: -# /bin/echo 1-4 > cpuset.cpus -> set cpus list to cpus 1,2,3,4 -# /bin/echo 1,2,3,4 > cpuset.cpus -> set cpus list to cpus 1,2,3,4 + # /bin/echo 1-4 > cpuset.cpus -> set cpus list to cpus 1,2,3,4 + # /bin/echo 1,2,3,4 > cpuset.cpus -> set cpus list to cpus 1,2,3,4 To add a CPU to a cpuset, write the new list of CPUs including the -CPU to be added. To add 6 to the above cpuset: +CPU to be added. To add 6 to the above cpuset:: -# /bin/echo 1-4,6 > cpuset.cpus -> set cpus list to cpus 1,2,3,4,6 + # /bin/echo 1-4,6 > cpuset.cpus -> set cpus list to cpus 1,2,3,4,6 Similarly to remove a CPU from a cpuset, write the new list of CPUs without the CPU to be removed. -To remove all the CPUs: +To remove all the CPUs:: -# /bin/echo "" > cpuset.cpus -> clear cpus list + # /bin/echo "" > cpuset.cpus -> clear cpus list 2.3 Setting flags ----------------- -The syntax is very simple: +The syntax is very simple:: -# /bin/echo 1 > cpuset.cpu_exclusive -> set flag 'cpuset.cpu_exclusive' -# /bin/echo 0 > cpuset.cpu_exclusive -> unset flag 'cpuset.cpu_exclusive' + # /bin/echo 1 > cpuset.cpu_exclusive -> set flag 'cpuset.cpu_exclusive' + # /bin/echo 0 > cpuset.cpu_exclusive -> unset flag 'cpuset.cpu_exclusive' 2.4 Attaching processes ----------------------- -# /bin/echo PID > tasks +:: + + # /bin/echo PID > tasks Note that it is PID, not PIDs. You can only attach ONE task at a time. -If you have several tasks to attach, you have to do it one after another: +If you have several tasks to attach, you have to do it one after another:: -# /bin/echo PID1 > tasks -# /bin/echo PID2 > tasks + # /bin/echo PID1 > tasks + # /bin/echo PID2 > tasks ... -# /bin/echo PIDn > tasks + # /bin/echo PIDn > tasks 3. Questions ============ -Q: what's up with this '/bin/echo' ? -A: bash's builtin 'echo' command does not check calls to write() against +Q: + what's up with this '/bin/echo' ? + +A: + bash's builtin 'echo' command does not check calls to write() against errors. If you use it in the cpuset file system, you won't be able to tell whether a command succeeded or failed. -Q: When I attach processes, only the first of the line gets really attached ! -A: We can only return one error code per call to write(). So you should also +Q: + When I attach processes, only the first of the line gets really attached ! + +A: + We can only return one error code per call to write(). So you should also put only ONE pid. 4. Contact diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/devices.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/devices.rst index 3c1095ca02ea..e1886783961e 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/devices.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/devices.rst @@ -1,6 +1,9 @@ +=========================== Device Whitelist Controller +=========================== -1. Description: +1. Description +============== Implement a cgroup to track and enforce open and mknod restrictions on device files. A device cgroup associates a device access @@ -16,24 +19,26 @@ devices from the whitelist or add new entries. A child cgroup can never receive a device access which is denied by its parent. 2. User Interface +================= An entry is added using devices.allow, and removed using -devices.deny. For instance +devices.deny. For instance:: echo 'c 1:3 mr' > /sys/fs/cgroup/1/devices.allow allows cgroup 1 to read and mknod the device usually known as -/dev/null. Doing +/dev/null. Doing:: echo a > /sys/fs/cgroup/1/devices.deny -will remove the default 'a *:* rwm' entry. Doing +will remove the default 'a *:* rwm' entry. Doing:: echo a > /sys/fs/cgroup/1/devices.allow will add the 'a *:* rwm' entry to the whitelist. 3. Security +=========== Any task can move itself between cgroups. This clearly won't suffice, but we can decide the best way to adequately restrict @@ -50,6 +55,7 @@ A cgroup may not be granted more permissions than the cgroup's parent has. 4. Hierarchy +============ device cgroups maintain hierarchy by making sure a cgroup never has more access permissions than its parent. Every time an entry is written to @@ -58,7 +64,8 @@ from their whitelist and all the locally set whitelist entries will be re-evaluated. In case one of the locally set whitelist entries would provide more access than the cgroup's parent, it'll be removed from the whitelist. -Example: +Example:: + A / \ B @@ -67,10 +74,12 @@ Example: A allow "b 8:* rwm", "c 116:1 rw" B deny "c 1:3 rwm", "c 116:2 rwm", "b 3:* rwm" -If a device is denied in group A: +If a device is denied in group A:: + # echo "c 116:* r" > A/devices.deny + it'll propagate down and after revalidating B's entries, the whitelist entry -"c 116:2 rwm" will be removed: +"c 116:2 rwm" will be removed:: group whitelist entries denied devices A all "b 8:* rwm", "c 116:* rw" @@ -79,7 +88,8 @@ it'll propagate down and after revalidating B's entries, the whitelist entry In case parent's exceptions change and local exceptions are not allowed anymore, they'll be deleted. -Notice that new whitelist entries will not be propagated: +Notice that new whitelist entries will not be propagated:: + A / \ B @@ -88,24 +98,30 @@ Notice that new whitelist entries will not be propagated: A "c 1:3 rwm", "c 1:5 r" all the rest B "c 1:3 rwm", "c 1:5 r" all the rest -when adding "c *:3 rwm": +when adding ``c *:3 rwm``:: + # echo "c *:3 rwm" >A/devices.allow -the result: +the result:: + group whitelist entries denied devices A "c *:3 rwm", "c 1:5 r" all the rest B "c 1:3 rwm", "c 1:5 r" all the rest -but now it'll be possible to add new entries to B: +but now it'll be possible to add new entries to B:: + # echo "c 2:3 rwm" >B/devices.allow # echo "c 50:3 r" >B/devices.allow -or even + +or even:: + # echo "c *:3 rwm" >B/devices.allow Allowing or denying all by writing 'a' to devices.allow or devices.deny will not be possible once the device cgroups has children. 4.1 Hierarchy (internal implementation) +--------------------------------------- device cgroups is implemented internally using a behavior (ALLOW, DENY) and a list of exceptions. The internal state is controlled using the same user diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/freezer-subsystem.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/freezer-subsystem.rst index e831cb2b8394..582d3427de3f 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/freezer-subsystem.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/freezer-subsystem.rst @@ -1,3 +1,7 @@ +============== +Cgroup Freezer +============== + The cgroup freezer is useful to batch job management system which start and stop sets of tasks in order to schedule the resources of a machine according to the desires of a system administrator. This sort of program @@ -23,7 +27,7 @@ blocked, or ignored it can be seen by waiting or ptracing parent tasks. SIGCONT is especially unsuitable since it can be caught by the task. Any programs designed to watch for SIGSTOP and SIGCONT could be broken by attempting to use SIGSTOP and SIGCONT to stop and resume tasks. We can -demonstrate this problem using nested bash shells: +demonstrate this problem using nested bash shells:: $ echo $$ 16644 @@ -93,19 +97,19 @@ The following cgroupfs files are created by cgroup freezer. The root cgroup is non-freezable and the above interface files don't exist. -* Examples of usage : +* Examples of usage:: # mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer # mount -t cgroup -ofreezer freezer /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer # mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0 # echo $some_pid > /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0/tasks -to get status of the freezer subsystem : +to get status of the freezer subsystem:: # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0/freezer.state THAWED -to freeze all tasks in the container : +to freeze all tasks in the container:: # echo FROZEN > /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0/freezer.state # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0/freezer.state @@ -113,7 +117,7 @@ to freeze all tasks in the container : # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0/freezer.state FROZEN -to unfreeze all tasks in the container : +to unfreeze all tasks in the container:: # echo THAWED > /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0/freezer.state # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/freezer/0/freezer.state diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/hugetlb.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/hugetlb.rst index 1260e5369b9b..a3902aa253a9 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/hugetlb.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/hugetlb.rst @@ -1,5 +1,6 @@ +================== HugeTLB Controller -------------------- +================== The HugeTLB controller allows to limit the HugeTLB usage per control group and enforces the controller limit during page fault. Since HugeTLB doesn't @@ -16,16 +17,16 @@ With the above step, the initial or the parent HugeTLB group becomes visible at /sys/fs/cgroup. At bootup, this group includes all the tasks in the system. /sys/fs/cgroup/tasks lists the tasks in this cgroup. -New groups can be created under the parent group /sys/fs/cgroup. +New groups can be created under the parent group /sys/fs/cgroup:: -# cd /sys/fs/cgroup -# mkdir g1 -# echo $$ > g1/tasks + # cd /sys/fs/cgroup + # mkdir g1 + # echo $$ > g1/tasks The above steps create a new group g1 and move the current shell process (bash) into it. -Brief summary of control files +Brief summary of control files:: hugetlb.<hugepagesize>.limit_in_bytes # set/show limit of "hugepagesize" hugetlb usage hugetlb.<hugepagesize>.max_usage_in_bytes # show max "hugepagesize" hugetlb usage recorded @@ -33,17 +34,17 @@ Brief summary of control files hugetlb.<hugepagesize>.failcnt # show the number of allocation failure due to HugeTLB limit For a system supporting three hugepage sizes (64k, 32M and 1G), the control -files include: - -hugetlb.1GB.limit_in_bytes -hugetlb.1GB.max_usage_in_bytes -hugetlb.1GB.usage_in_bytes -hugetlb.1GB.failcnt -hugetlb.64KB.limit_in_bytes -hugetlb.64KB.max_usage_in_bytes -hugetlb.64KB.usage_in_bytes -hugetlb.64KB.failcnt -hugetlb.32MB.limit_in_bytes -hugetlb.32MB.max_usage_in_bytes -hugetlb.32MB.usage_in_bytes -hugetlb.32MB.failcnt +files include:: + + hugetlb.1GB.limit_in_bytes + hugetlb.1GB.max_usage_in_bytes + hugetlb.1GB.usage_in_bytes + hugetlb.1GB.failcnt + hugetlb.64KB.limit_in_bytes + hugetlb.64KB.max_usage_in_bytes + hugetlb.64KB.usage_in_bytes + hugetlb.64KB.failcnt + hugetlb.32MB.limit_in_bytes + hugetlb.32MB.max_usage_in_bytes + hugetlb.32MB.usage_in_bytes + hugetlb.32MB.failcnt diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/index.rst b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/index.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..fe76d42edc11 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/index.rst @@ -0,0 +1,30 @@ +:orphan: + +======================== +Control Groups version 1 +======================== + +.. toctree:: + :maxdepth: 1 + + cgroups + + blkio-controller + cpuacct + cpusets + devices + freezer-subsystem + hugetlb + memcg_test + memory + net_cls + net_prio + pids + rdma + +.. only:: subproject and html + + Indices + ======= + + * :ref:`genindex` diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memcg_test.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memcg_test.rst index 621e29ffb358..91bd18c6a514 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memcg_test.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memcg_test.rst @@ -1,32 +1,43 @@ -Memory Resource Controller(Memcg) Implementation Memo. +===================================================== +Memory Resource Controller(Memcg) Implementation Memo +===================================================== + Last Updated: 2010/2 + Base Kernel Version: based on 2.6.33-rc7-mm(candidate for 34). Because VM is getting complex (one of reasons is memcg...), memcg's behavior is complex. This is a document for memcg's internal behavior. Please note that implementation details can be changed. -(*) Topics on API should be in Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.txt) +(*) Topics on API should be in Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.rst) 0. How to record usage ? +======================== + 2 objects are used. page_cgroup ....an object per page. + Allocated at boot or memory hotplug. Freed at memory hot removal. swap_cgroup ... an entry per swp_entry. + Allocated at swapon(). Freed at swapoff(). The page_cgroup has USED bit and double count against a page_cgroup never occurs. swap_cgroup is used only when a charged page is swapped-out. 1. Charge +========= a page/swp_entry may be charged (usage += PAGE_SIZE) at mem_cgroup_try_charge() 2. Uncharge +=========== + a page/swp_entry may be uncharged (usage -= PAGE_SIZE) by mem_cgroup_uncharge() @@ -37,9 +48,12 @@ Please note that implementation details can be changed. disappears. 3. charge-commit-cancel +======================= + Memcg pages are charged in two steps: - mem_cgroup_try_charge() - mem_cgroup_commit_charge() or mem_cgroup_cancel_charge() + + - mem_cgroup_try_charge() + - mem_cgroup_commit_charge() or mem_cgroup_cancel_charge() At try_charge(), there are no flags to say "this page is charged". at this point, usage += PAGE_SIZE. @@ -51,6 +65,8 @@ Please note that implementation details can be changed. Under below explanation, we assume CONFIG_MEM_RES_CTRL_SWAP=y. 4. Anonymous +============ + Anonymous page is newly allocated at - page fault into MAP_ANONYMOUS mapping. - Copy-On-Write. @@ -78,34 +94,45 @@ Under below explanation, we assume CONFIG_MEM_RES_CTRL_SWAP=y. (e) zap_pte() is called and swp_entry's refcnt -=1 -> 0. 5. Page Cache - Page Cache is charged at +============= + + Page Cache is charged at - add_to_page_cache_locked(). The logic is very clear. (About migration, see below) - Note: __remove_from_page_cache() is called by remove_from_page_cache() - and __remove_mapping(). + + Note: + __remove_from_page_cache() is called by remove_from_page_cache() + and __remove_mapping(). 6. Shmem(tmpfs) Page Cache +=========================== + The best way to understand shmem's page state transition is to read mm/shmem.c. + But brief explanation of the behavior of memcg around shmem will be helpful to understand the logic. Shmem's page (just leaf page, not direct/indirect block) can be on + - radix-tree of shmem's inode. - SwapCache. - Both on radix-tree and SwapCache. This happens at swap-in and swap-out, It's charged when... + - A new page is added to shmem's radix-tree. - A swp page is read. (move a charge from swap_cgroup to page_cgroup) 7. Page Migration +================= mem_cgroup_migrate() 8. LRU +====== Each memcg has its own private LRU. Now, its handling is under global VM's control (means that it's handled under global pgdat->lru_lock). Almost all routines around memcg's LRU is called by global LRU's @@ -114,163 +141,211 @@ Under below explanation, we assume CONFIG_MEM_RES_CTRL_SWAP=y. A special function is mem_cgroup_isolate_pages(). This scans memcg's private LRU and call __isolate_lru_page() to extract a page from LRU. + (By __isolate_lru_page(), the page is removed from both of global and - private LRU.) + private LRU.) 9. Typical Tests. +================= Tests for racy cases. - 9.1 Small limit to memcg. +9.1 Small limit to memcg. +------------------------- + When you do test to do racy case, it's good test to set memcg's limit to be very small rather than GB. Many races found in the test under xKB or xxMB limits. + (Memory behavior under GB and Memory behavior under MB shows very - different situation.) + different situation.) + +9.2 Shmem +--------- - 9.2 Shmem Historically, memcg's shmem handling was poor and we saw some amount of troubles here. This is because shmem is page-cache but can be SwapCache. Test with shmem/tmpfs is always good test. - 9.3 Migration +9.3 Migration +------------- + For NUMA, migration is an another special case. To do easy test, cpuset - is useful. Following is a sample script to do migration. + is useful. Following is a sample script to do migration:: - mount -t cgroup -o cpuset none /opt/cpuset + mount -t cgroup -o cpuset none /opt/cpuset - mkdir /opt/cpuset/01 - echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/01/cpuset.cpus - echo 0 > /opt/cpuset/01/cpuset.mems - echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/01/cpuset.memory_migrate - mkdir /opt/cpuset/02 - echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/02/cpuset.cpus - echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/02/cpuset.mems - echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/02/cpuset.memory_migrate + mkdir /opt/cpuset/01 + echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/01/cpuset.cpus + echo 0 > /opt/cpuset/01/cpuset.mems + echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/01/cpuset.memory_migrate + mkdir /opt/cpuset/02 + echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/02/cpuset.cpus + echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/02/cpuset.mems + echo 1 > /opt/cpuset/02/cpuset.memory_migrate In above set, when you moves a task from 01 to 02, page migration to node 0 to node 1 will occur. Following is a script to migrate all - under cpuset. - -- - move_task() - { - for pid in $1 - do - /bin/echo $pid >$2/tasks 2>/dev/null - echo -n $pid - echo -n " " - done - echo END - } - - G1_TASK=`cat ${G1}/tasks` - G2_TASK=`cat ${G2}/tasks` - move_task "${G1_TASK}" ${G2} & - -- - 9.4 Memory hotplug. + under cpuset.:: + + -- + move_task() + { + for pid in $1 + do + /bin/echo $pid >$2/tasks 2>/dev/null + echo -n $pid + echo -n " " + done + echo END + } + + G1_TASK=`cat ${G1}/tasks` + G2_TASK=`cat ${G2}/tasks` + move_task "${G1_TASK}" ${G2} & + -- + +9.4 Memory hotplug +------------------ + memory hotplug test is one of good test. - to offline memory, do following. - # echo offline > /sys/devices/system/memory/memoryXXX/state + + to offline memory, do following:: + + # echo offline > /sys/devices/system/memory/memoryXXX/state + (XXX is the place of memory) + This is an easy way to test page migration, too. - 9.5 mkdir/rmdir +9.5 mkdir/rmdir +--------------- + When using hierarchy, mkdir/rmdir test should be done. - Use tests like the following. + Use tests like the following:: + + echo 1 >/opt/cgroup/01/memory/use_hierarchy + mkdir /opt/cgroup/01/child_a + mkdir /opt/cgroup/01/child_b - echo 1 >/opt/cgroup/01/memory/use_hierarchy - mkdir /opt/cgroup/01/child_a - mkdir /opt/cgroup/01/child_b + set limit to 01. + add limit to 01/child_b + run jobs under child_a and child_b - set limit to 01. - add limit to 01/child_b - run jobs under child_a and child_b + create/delete following groups at random while jobs are running:: - create/delete following groups at random while jobs are running. - /opt/cgroup/01/child_a/child_aa - /opt/cgroup/01/child_b/child_bb - /opt/cgroup/01/child_c + /opt/cgroup/01/child_a/child_aa + /opt/cgroup/01/child_b/child_bb + /opt/cgroup/01/child_c running new jobs in new group is also good. - 9.6 Mount with other subsystems. +9.6 Mount with other subsystems +------------------------------- + Mounting with other subsystems is a good test because there is a race and lock dependency with other cgroup subsystems. - example) - # mount -t cgroup none /cgroup -o cpuset,memory,cpu,devices + example:: + + # mount -t cgroup none /cgroup -o cpuset,memory,cpu,devices and do task move, mkdir, rmdir etc...under this. - 9.7 swapoff. +9.7 swapoff +----------- + Besides management of swap is one of complicated parts of memcg, call path of swap-in at swapoff is not same as usual swap-in path.. It's worth to be tested explicitly. - For example, test like following is good. - (Shell-A) - # mount -t cgroup none /cgroup -o memory - # mkdir /cgroup/test - # echo 40M > /cgroup/test/memory.limit_in_bytes - # echo 0 > /cgroup/test/tasks + For example, test like following is good: + + (Shell-A):: + + # mount -t cgroup none /cgroup -o memory + # mkdir /cgroup/test + # echo 40M > /cgroup/test/memory.limit_in_bytes + # echo 0 > /cgroup/test/tasks + Run malloc(100M) program under this. You'll see 60M of swaps. - (Shell-B) - # move all tasks in /cgroup/test to /cgroup - # /sbin/swapoff -a - # rmdir /cgroup/test - # kill malloc task. + + (Shell-B):: + + # move all tasks in /cgroup/test to /cgroup + # /sbin/swapoff -a + # rmdir /cgroup/test + # kill malloc task. Of course, tmpfs v.s. swapoff test should be tested, too. - 9.8 OOM-Killer +9.8 OOM-Killer +-------------- + Out-of-memory caused by memcg's limit will kill tasks under the memcg. When hierarchy is used, a task under hierarchy will be killed by the kernel. + In this case, panic_on_oom shouldn't be invoked and tasks in other groups shouldn't be killed. It's not difficult to cause OOM under memcg as following. - Case A) when you can swapoff - #swapoff -a - #echo 50M > /memory.limit_in_bytes + + Case A) when you can swapoff:: + + #swapoff -a + #echo 50M > /memory.limit_in_bytes + run 51M of malloc - Case B) when you use mem+swap limitation. - #echo 50M > memory.limit_in_bytes - #echo 50M > memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes + Case B) when you use mem+swap limitation:: + + #echo 50M > memory.limit_in_bytes + #echo 50M > memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes + run 51M of malloc - 9.9 Move charges at task migration +9.9 Move charges at task migration +---------------------------------- + Charges associated with a task can be moved along with task migration. - (Shell-A) - #mkdir /cgroup/A - #echo $$ >/cgroup/A/tasks + (Shell-A):: + + #mkdir /cgroup/A + #echo $$ >/cgroup/A/tasks + run some programs which uses some amount of memory in /cgroup/A. - (Shell-B) - #mkdir /cgroup/B - #echo 1 >/cgroup/B/memory.move_charge_at_immigrate - #echo "pid of the program running in group A" >/cgroup/B/tasks + (Shell-B):: + + #mkdir /cgroup/B + #echo 1 >/cgroup/B/memory.move_charge_at_immigrate + #echo "pid of the program running in group A" >/cgroup/B/tasks - You can see charges have been moved by reading *.usage_in_bytes or + You can see charges have been moved by reading ``*.usage_in_bytes`` or memory.stat of both A and B. - See 8.2 of Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.txt to see what value should be - written to move_charge_at_immigrate. - 9.10 Memory thresholds + See 8.2 of Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.rst to see what value should + be written to move_charge_at_immigrate. + +9.10 Memory thresholds +---------------------- + Memory controller implements memory thresholds using cgroups notification API. You can use tools/cgroup/cgroup_event_listener.c to test it. - (Shell-A) Create cgroup and run event listener - # mkdir /cgroup/A - # ./cgroup_event_listener /cgroup/A/memory.usage_in_bytes 5M + (Shell-A) Create cgroup and run event listener:: + + # mkdir /cgroup/A + # ./cgroup_event_listener /cgroup/A/memory.usage_in_bytes 5M + + (Shell-B) Add task to cgroup and try to allocate and free memory:: - (Shell-B) Add task to cgroup and try to allocate and free memory - # echo $$ >/cgroup/A/tasks - # a="$(dd if=/dev/zero bs=1M count=10)" - # a= + # echo $$ >/cgroup/A/tasks + # a="$(dd if=/dev/zero bs=1M count=10)" + # a= You will see message from cgroup_event_listener every time you cross the thresholds. diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.rst index a33cedf85427..41bdc038dad9 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.rst @@ -1,22 +1,26 @@ +========================== Memory Resource Controller +========================== -NOTE: This document is hopelessly outdated and it asks for a complete +NOTE: + This document is hopelessly outdated and it asks for a complete rewrite. It still contains a useful information so we are keeping it here but make sure to check the current code if you need a deeper understanding. -NOTE: The Memory Resource Controller has generically been referred to as the +NOTE: + The Memory Resource Controller has generically been referred to as the memory controller in this document. Do not confuse memory controller used here with the memory controller that is used in hardware. -(For editors) -In this document: +(For editors) In this document: When we mention a cgroup (cgroupfs's directory) with memory controller, we call it "memory cgroup". When you see git-log and source code, you'll see patch's title and function names tend to use "memcg". In this document, we avoid using it. Benefits and Purpose of the memory controller +============================================= The memory controller isolates the memory behaviour of a group of tasks from the rest of the system. The article on LWN [12] mentions some probable @@ -38,6 +42,7 @@ e. There are several other use cases; find one or use the controller just Current Status: linux-2.6.34-mmotm(development version of 2010/April) Features: + - accounting anonymous pages, file caches, swap caches usage and limiting them. - pages are linked to per-memcg LRU exclusively, and there is no global LRU. - optionally, memory+swap usage can be accounted and limited. @@ -54,41 +59,48 @@ Features: Brief summary of control files. - tasks # attach a task(thread) and show list of threads - cgroup.procs # show list of processes - cgroup.event_control # an interface for event_fd() - memory.usage_in_bytes # show current usage for memory - (See 5.5 for details) - memory.memsw.usage_in_bytes # show current usage for memory+Swap - (See 5.5 for details) - memory.limit_in_bytes # set/show limit of memory usage - memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes # set/show limit of memory+Swap usage - memory.failcnt # show the number of memory usage hits limits - memory.memsw.failcnt # show the number of memory+Swap hits limits - memory.max_usage_in_bytes # show max memory usage recorded - memory.memsw.max_usage_in_bytes # show max memory+Swap usage recorded - memory.soft_limit_in_bytes # set/show soft limit of memory usage - memory.stat # show various statistics - memory.use_hierarchy # set/show hierarchical account enabled - memory.force_empty # trigger forced page reclaim - memory.pressure_level # set memory pressure notifications - memory.swappiness # set/show swappiness parameter of vmscan - (See sysctl's vm.swappiness) - memory.move_charge_at_immigrate # set/show controls of moving charges - memory.oom_control # set/show oom controls. - memory.numa_stat # show the number of memory usage per numa node - - memory.kmem.limit_in_bytes # set/show hard limit for kernel memory - memory.kmem.usage_in_bytes # show current kernel memory allocation - memory.kmem.failcnt # show the number of kernel memory usage hits limits - memory.kmem.max_usage_in_bytes # show max kernel memory usage recorded - - memory.kmem.tcp.limit_in_bytes # set/show hard limit for tcp buf memory - memory.kmem.tcp.usage_in_bytes # show current tcp buf memory allocation - memory.kmem.tcp.failcnt # show the number of tcp buf memory usage hits limits - memory.kmem.tcp.max_usage_in_bytes # show max tcp buf memory usage recorded +==================================== ========================================== + tasks attach a task(thread) and show list of + threads + cgroup.procs show list of processes + cgroup.event_control an interface for event_fd() + memory.usage_in_bytes show current usage for memory + (See 5.5 for details) + memory.memsw.usage_in_bytes show current usage for memory+Swap + (See 5.5 for details) + memory.limit_in_bytes set/show limit of memory usage + memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes set/show limit of memory+Swap usage + memory.failcnt show the number of memory usage hits limits + memory.memsw.failcnt show the number of memory+Swap hits limits + memory.max_usage_in_bytes show max memory usage recorded + memory.memsw.max_usage_in_bytes show max memory+Swap usage recorded + memory.soft_limit_in_bytes set/show soft limit of memory usage + memory.stat show various statistics + memory.use_hierarchy set/show hierarchical account enabled + memory.force_empty trigger forced page reclaim + memory.pressure_level set memory pressure notifications + memory.swappiness set/show swappiness parameter of vmscan + (See sysctl's vm.swappiness) + memory.move_charge_at_immigrate set/show controls of moving charges + memory.oom_control set/show oom controls. + memory.numa_stat show the number of memory usage per numa + node + + memory.kmem.limit_in_bytes set/show hard limit for kernel memory + memory.kmem.usage_in_bytes show current kernel memory allocation + memory.kmem.failcnt show the number of kernel memory usage + hits limits + memory.kmem.max_usage_in_bytes show max kernel memory usage recorded + + memory.kmem.tcp.limit_in_bytes set/show hard limit for tcp buf memory + memory.kmem.tcp.usage_in_bytes show current tcp buf memory allocation + memory.kmem.tcp.failcnt show the number of tcp buf memory usage + hits limits + memory.kmem.tcp.max_usage_in_bytes show max tcp buf memory usage recorded +==================================== ========================================== 1. History +========== The memory controller has a long history. A request for comments for the memory controller was posted by Balbir Singh [1]. At the time the RFC was posted @@ -103,6 +115,7 @@ at version 6; it combines both mapped (RSS) and unmapped Page Cache Control [11]. 2. Memory Control +================= Memory is a unique resource in the sense that it is present in a limited amount. If a task requires a lot of CPU processing, the task can spread @@ -120,6 +133,7 @@ are: The memory controller is the first controller developed. 2.1. Design +----------- The core of the design is a counter called the page_counter. The page_counter tracks the current memory usage and limit of the group of @@ -127,6 +141,9 @@ processes associated with the controller. Each cgroup has a memory controller specific data structure (mem_cgroup) associated with it. 2.2. Accounting +--------------- + +:: +--------------------+ | mem_cgroup | @@ -165,6 +182,7 @@ updated. page_cgroup has its own LRU on cgroup. (*) page_cgroup structure is allocated at boot/memory-hotplug time. 2.2.1 Accounting details +------------------------ All mapped anon pages (RSS) and cache pages (Page Cache) are accounted. Some pages which are never reclaimable and will not be on the LRU @@ -191,6 +209,7 @@ Note: we just account pages-on-LRU because our purpose is to control amount of used pages; not-on-LRU pages tend to be out-of-control from VM view. 2.3 Shared Page Accounting +-------------------------- Shared pages are accounted on the basis of the first touch approach. The cgroup that first touches a page is accounted for the page. The principle @@ -207,11 +226,13 @@ be backed into memory in force, charges for pages are accounted against the caller of swapoff rather than the users of shmem. 2.4 Swap Extension (CONFIG_MEMCG_SWAP) +-------------------------------------- Swap Extension allows you to record charge for swap. A swapped-in page is charged back to original page allocator if possible. When swap is accounted, following files are added. + - memory.memsw.usage_in_bytes. - memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes. @@ -224,14 +245,16 @@ In this case, setting memsw.limit_in_bytes=3G will prevent bad use of swap. By using the memsw limit, you can avoid system OOM which can be caused by swap shortage. -* why 'memory+swap' rather than swap. +**why 'memory+swap' rather than swap** + The global LRU(kswapd) can swap out arbitrary pages. Swap-out means to move account from memory to swap...there is no change in usage of memory+swap. In other words, when we want to limit the usage of swap without affecting global LRU, memory+swap limit is better than just limiting swap from an OS point of view. -* What happens when a cgroup hits memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes +**What happens when a cgroup hits memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes** + When a cgroup hits memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes, it's useless to do swap-out in this cgroup. Then, swap-out will not be done by cgroup routine and file caches are dropped. But as mentioned above, global LRU can do swapout memory @@ -239,6 +262,7 @@ from it for sanity of the system's memory management state. You can't forbid it by cgroup. 2.5 Reclaim +----------- Each cgroup maintains a per cgroup LRU which has the same structure as global VM. When a cgroup goes over its limit, we first try @@ -251,29 +275,36 @@ The reclaim algorithm has not been modified for cgroups, except that pages that are selected for reclaiming come from the per-cgroup LRU list. -NOTE: Reclaim does not work for the root cgroup, since we cannot set any -limits on the root cgroup. +NOTE: + Reclaim does not work for the root cgroup, since we cannot set any + limits on the root cgroup. -Note2: When panic_on_oom is set to "2", the whole system will panic. +Note2: + When panic_on_oom is set to "2", the whole system will panic. When oom event notifier is registered, event will be delivered. (See oom_control section) 2.6 Locking +----------- lock_page_cgroup()/unlock_page_cgroup() should not be called under the i_pages lock. Other lock order is following: + PG_locked. - mm->page_table_lock - pgdat->lru_lock - lock_page_cgroup. + mm->page_table_lock + pgdat->lru_lock + lock_page_cgroup. + In many cases, just lock_page_cgroup() is called. + per-zone-per-cgroup LRU (cgroup's private LRU) is just guarded by pgdat->lru_lock, it has no lock of its own. 2.7 Kernel Memory Extension (CONFIG_MEMCG_KMEM) +----------------------------------------------- With the Kernel memory extension, the Memory Controller is able to limit the amount of kernel memory used by the system. Kernel memory is fundamentally @@ -288,6 +319,7 @@ Kernel memory limits are not imposed for the root cgroup. Usage for the root cgroup may or may not be accounted. The memory used is accumulated into memory.kmem.usage_in_bytes, or in a separate counter when it makes sense. (currently only for tcp). + The main "kmem" counter is fed into the main counter, so kmem charges will also be visible from the user counter. @@ -295,36 +327,42 @@ Currently no soft limit is implemented for kernel memory. It is future work to trigger slab reclaim when those limits are reached. 2.7.1 Current Kernel Memory resources accounted +----------------------------------------------- -* stack pages: every process consumes some stack pages. By accounting into -kernel memory, we prevent new processes from being created when the kernel -memory usage is too high. +stack pages: + every process consumes some stack pages. By accounting into + kernel memory, we prevent new processes from being created when the kernel + memory usage is too high. -* slab pages: pages allocated by the SLAB or SLUB allocator are tracked. A copy -of each kmem_cache is created every time the cache is touched by the first time -from inside the memcg. The creation is done lazily, so some objects can still be -skipped while the cache is being created. All objects in a slab page should -belong to the same memcg. This only fails to hold when a task is migrated to a -different memcg during the page allocation by the cache. +slab pages: + pages allocated by the SLAB or SLUB allocator are tracked. A copy + of each kmem_cache is created every time the cache is touched by the first time + from inside the memcg. The creation is done lazily, so some objects can still be + skipped while the cache is being created. All objects in a slab page should + belong to the same memcg. This only fails to hold when a task is migrated to a + different memcg during the page allocation by the cache. -* sockets memory pressure: some sockets protocols have memory pressure -thresholds. The Memory Controller allows them to be controlled individually -per cgroup, instead of globally. +sockets memory pressure: + some sockets protocols have memory pressure + thresholds. The Memory Controller allows them to be controlled individually + per cgroup, instead of globally. -* tcp memory pressure: sockets memory pressure for the tcp protocol. +tcp memory pressure: + sockets memory pressure for the tcp protocol. 2.7.2 Common use cases +---------------------- Because the "kmem" counter is fed to the main user counter, kernel memory can never be limited completely independently of user memory. Say "U" is the user limit, and "K" the kernel limit. There are three possible ways limits can be set: - U != 0, K = unlimited: +U != 0, K = unlimited: This is the standard memcg limitation mechanism already present before kmem accounting. Kernel memory is completely ignored. - U != 0, K < U: +U != 0, K < U: Kernel memory is a subset of the user memory. This setup is useful in deployments where the total amount of memory per-cgroup is overcommited. Overcommiting kernel memory limits is definitely not recommended, since the @@ -332,19 +370,23 @@ set: In this case, the admin could set up K so that the sum of all groups is never greater than the total memory, and freely set U at the cost of his QoS. - WARNING: In the current implementation, memory reclaim will NOT be + +WARNING: + In the current implementation, memory reclaim will NOT be triggered for a cgroup when it hits K while staying below U, which makes this setup impractical. - U != 0, K >= U: +U != 0, K >= U: Since kmem charges will also be fed to the user counter and reclaim will be triggered for the cgroup for both kinds of memory. This setup gives the admin a unified view of memory, and it is also useful for people who just want to track kernel memory usage. 3. User Interface +================= 3.0. Configuration +------------------ a. Enable CONFIG_CGROUPS b. Enable CONFIG_MEMCG @@ -352,39 +394,53 @@ c. Enable CONFIG_MEMCG_SWAP (to use swap extension) d. Enable CONFIG_MEMCG_KMEM (to use kmem extension) 3.1. Prepare the cgroups (see cgroups.txt, Why are cgroups needed?) -# mount -t tmpfs none /sys/fs/cgroup -# mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/memory -# mount -t cgroup none /sys/fs/cgroup/memory -o memory +------------------------------------------------------------------- + +:: + + # mount -t tmpfs none /sys/fs/cgroup + # mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/memory + # mount -t cgroup none /sys/fs/cgroup/memory -o memory + +3.2. Make the new group and move bash into it:: + + # mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0 + # echo $$ > /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/tasks -3.2. Make the new group and move bash into it -# mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0 -# echo $$ > /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/tasks +Since now we're in the 0 cgroup, we can alter the memory limit:: -Since now we're in the 0 cgroup, we can alter the memory limit: -# echo 4M > /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/memory.limit_in_bytes + # echo 4M > /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/memory.limit_in_bytes -NOTE: We can use a suffix (k, K, m, M, g or G) to indicate values in kilo, -mega or gigabytes. (Here, Kilo, Mega, Giga are Kibibytes, Mebibytes, Gibibytes.) +NOTE: + We can use a suffix (k, K, m, M, g or G) to indicate values in kilo, + mega or gigabytes. (Here, Kilo, Mega, Giga are Kibibytes, Mebibytes, + Gibibytes.) -NOTE: We can write "-1" to reset the *.limit_in_bytes(unlimited). -NOTE: We cannot set limits on the root cgroup any more. +NOTE: + We can write "-1" to reset the ``*.limit_in_bytes(unlimited)``. -# cat /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/memory.limit_in_bytes -4194304 +NOTE: + We cannot set limits on the root cgroup any more. -We can check the usage: -# cat /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/memory.usage_in_bytes -1216512 +:: + + # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/memory.limit_in_bytes + 4194304 + +We can check the usage:: + + # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/0/memory.usage_in_bytes + 1216512 A successful write to this file does not guarantee a successful setting of this limit to the value written into the file. This can be due to a number of factors, such as rounding up to page boundaries or the total availability of memory on the system. The user is required to re-read -this file after a write to guarantee the value committed by the kernel. +this file after a write to guarantee the value committed by the kernel:: -# echo 1 > memory.limit_in_bytes -# cat memory.limit_in_bytes -4096 + # echo 1 > memory.limit_in_bytes + # cat memory.limit_in_bytes + 4096 The memory.failcnt field gives the number of times that the cgroup limit was exceeded. @@ -393,6 +449,7 @@ The memory.stat file gives accounting information. Now, the number of caches, RSS and Active pages/Inactive pages are shown. 4. Testing +========== For testing features and implementation, see memcg_test.txt. @@ -408,6 +465,7 @@ But the above two are testing extreme situations. Trying usual test under memory controller is always helpful. 4.1 Troubleshooting +------------------- Sometimes a user might find that the application under a cgroup is terminated by the OOM killer. There are several causes for this: @@ -422,6 +480,7 @@ To know what happens, disabling OOM_Kill as per "10. OOM Control" (below) and seeing what happens will be helpful. 4.2 Task migration +------------------ When a task migrates from one cgroup to another, its charge is not carried forward by default. The pages allocated from the original cgroup still @@ -432,6 +491,7 @@ You can move charges of a task along with task migration. See 8. "Move charges at task migration" 4.3 Removing a cgroup +--------------------- A cgroup can be removed by rmdir, but as discussed in sections 4.1 and 4.2, a cgroup might have some charge associated with it, even though all @@ -448,13 +508,15 @@ will be charged as a new owner of it. About use_hierarchy, see Section 6. -5. Misc. interfaces. +5. Misc. interfaces +=================== 5.1 force_empty +--------------- memory.force_empty interface is provided to make cgroup's memory usage empty. - When writing anything to this + When writing anything to this:: - # echo 0 > memory.force_empty + # echo 0 > memory.force_empty the cgroup will be reclaimed and as many pages reclaimed as possible. @@ -471,50 +533,61 @@ About use_hierarchy, see Section 6. About use_hierarchy, see Section 6. 5.2 stat file +------------- memory.stat file includes following statistics -# per-memory cgroup local status -cache - # of bytes of page cache memory. -rss - # of bytes of anonymous and swap cache memory (includes +per-memory cgroup local status +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +=============== =============================================================== +cache # of bytes of page cache memory. +rss # of bytes of anonymous and swap cache memory (includes transparent hugepages). -rss_huge - # of bytes of anonymous transparent hugepages. -mapped_file - # of bytes of mapped file (includes tmpfs/shmem) -pgpgin - # of charging events to the memory cgroup. The charging +rss_huge # of bytes of anonymous transparent hugepages. +mapped_file # of bytes of mapped file (includes tmpfs/shmem) +pgpgin # of charging events to the memory cgroup. The charging event happens each time a page is accounted as either mapped anon page(RSS) or cache page(Page Cache) to the cgroup. -pgpgout - # of uncharging events to the memory cgroup. The uncharging +pgpgout # of uncharging events to the memory cgroup. The uncharging event happens each time a page is unaccounted from the cgroup. -swap - # of bytes of swap usage -dirty - # of bytes that are waiting to get written back to the disk. -writeback - # of bytes of file/anon cache that are queued for syncing to +swap # of bytes of swap usage +dirty # of bytes that are waiting to get written back to the disk. +writeback # of bytes of file/anon cache that are queued for syncing to disk. -inactive_anon - # of bytes of anonymous and swap cache memory on inactive +inactive_anon # of bytes of anonymous and swap cache memory on inactive LRU list. -active_anon - # of bytes of anonymous and swap cache memory on active +active_anon # of bytes of anonymous and swap cache memory on active LRU list. -inactive_file - # of bytes of file-backed memory on inactive LRU list. -active_file - # of bytes of file-backed memory on active LRU list. -unevictable - # of bytes of memory that cannot be reclaimed (mlocked etc). - -# status considering hierarchy (see memory.use_hierarchy settings) - -hierarchical_memory_limit - # of bytes of memory limit with regard to hierarchy - under which the memory cgroup is -hierarchical_memsw_limit - # of bytes of memory+swap limit with regard to - hierarchy under which memory cgroup is. - -total_<counter> - # hierarchical version of <counter>, which in - addition to the cgroup's own value includes the - sum of all hierarchical children's values of - <counter>, i.e. total_cache - -# The following additional stats are dependent on CONFIG_DEBUG_VM. - -recent_rotated_anon - VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) -recent_rotated_file - VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) -recent_scanned_anon - VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) -recent_scanned_file - VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) +inactive_file # of bytes of file-backed memory on inactive LRU list. +active_file # of bytes of file-backed memory on active LRU list. +unevictable # of bytes of memory that cannot be reclaimed (mlocked etc). +=============== =============================================================== + +status considering hierarchy (see memory.use_hierarchy settings) +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +========================= =================================================== +hierarchical_memory_limit # of bytes of memory limit with regard to hierarchy + under which the memory cgroup is +hierarchical_memsw_limit # of bytes of memory+swap limit with regard to + hierarchy under which memory cgroup is. + +total_<counter> # hierarchical version of <counter>, which in + addition to the cgroup's own value includes the + sum of all hierarchical children's values of + <counter>, i.e. total_cache +========================= =================================================== + +The following additional stats are dependent on CONFIG_DEBUG_VM +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +========================= ======================================== +recent_rotated_anon VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) +recent_rotated_file VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) +recent_scanned_anon VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) +recent_scanned_file VM internal parameter. (see mm/vmscan.c) +========================= ======================================== Memo: recent_rotated means recent frequency of LRU rotation. @@ -525,12 +598,15 @@ Note: Only anonymous and swap cache memory is listed as part of 'rss' stat. This should not be confused with the true 'resident set size' or the amount of physical memory used by the cgroup. + 'rss + mapped_file" will give you resident set size of cgroup. + (Note: file and shmem may be shared among other cgroups. In that case, - mapped_file is accounted only when the memory cgroup is owner of page - cache.) + mapped_file is accounted only when the memory cgroup is owner of page + cache.) 5.3 swappiness +-------------- Overrides /proc/sys/vm/swappiness for the particular group. The tunable in the root cgroup corresponds to the global swappiness setting. @@ -541,16 +617,19 @@ there is a swap storage available. This might lead to memcg OOM killer if there are no file pages to reclaim. 5.4 failcnt +----------- A memory cgroup provides memory.failcnt and memory.memsw.failcnt files. This failcnt(== failure count) shows the number of times that a usage counter hit its limit. When a memory cgroup hits a limit, failcnt increases and memory under it will be reclaimed. -You can reset failcnt by writing 0 to failcnt file. -# echo 0 > .../memory.failcnt +You can reset failcnt by writing 0 to failcnt file:: + + # echo 0 > .../memory.failcnt 5.5 usage_in_bytes +------------------ For efficiency, as other kernel components, memory cgroup uses some optimization to avoid unnecessary cacheline false sharing. usage_in_bytes is affected by the @@ -560,6 +639,7 @@ If you want to know more exact memory usage, you should use RSS+CACHE(+SWAP) value in memory.stat(see 5.2). 5.6 numa_stat +------------- This is similar to numa_maps but operates on a per-memcg basis. This is useful for providing visibility into the numa locality information within @@ -571,22 +651,23 @@ Each memcg's numa_stat file includes "total", "file", "anon" and "unevictable" per-node page counts including "hierarchical_<counter>" which sums up all hierarchical children's values in addition to the memcg's own value. -The output format of memory.numa_stat is: +The output format of memory.numa_stat is:: -total=<total pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... -file=<total file pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... -anon=<total anon pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... -unevictable=<total anon pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... -hierarchical_<counter>=<counter pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... + total=<total pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... + file=<total file pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... + anon=<total anon pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... + unevictable=<total anon pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... + hierarchical_<counter>=<counter pages> N0=<node 0 pages> N1=<node 1 pages> ... The "total" count is sum of file + anon + unevictable. 6. Hierarchy support +==================== The memory controller supports a deep hierarchy and hierarchical accounting. The hierarchy is created by creating the appropriate cgroups in the cgroup filesystem. Consider for example, the following cgroup filesystem -hierarchy +hierarchy:: root / | \ @@ -603,24 +684,28 @@ limit, the reclaim algorithm reclaims from the tasks in the ancestor and the children of the ancestor. 6.1 Enabling hierarchical accounting and reclaim +------------------------------------------------ A memory cgroup by default disables the hierarchy feature. Support -can be enabled by writing 1 to memory.use_hierarchy file of the root cgroup +can be enabled by writing 1 to memory.use_hierarchy file of the root cgroup:: -# echo 1 > memory.use_hierarchy + # echo 1 > memory.use_hierarchy -The feature can be disabled by +The feature can be disabled by:: -# echo 0 > memory.use_hierarchy + # echo 0 > memory.use_hierarchy -NOTE1: Enabling/disabling will fail if either the cgroup already has other +NOTE1: + Enabling/disabling will fail if either the cgroup already has other cgroups created below it, or if the parent cgroup has use_hierarchy enabled. -NOTE2: When panic_on_oom is set to "2", the whole system will panic in +NOTE2: + When panic_on_oom is set to "2", the whole system will panic in case of an OOM event in any cgroup. 7. Soft limits +============== Soft limits allow for greater sharing of memory. The idea behind soft limits is to allow control groups to use as much of the memory as needed, provided @@ -640,22 +725,26 @@ hints/setup. Currently soft limit based reclaim is set up such that it gets invoked from balance_pgdat (kswapd). 7.1 Interface +------------- Soft limits can be setup by using the following commands (in this example we -assume a soft limit of 256 MiB) +assume a soft limit of 256 MiB):: -# echo 256M > memory.soft_limit_in_bytes + # echo 256M > memory.soft_limit_in_bytes -If we want to change this to 1G, we can at any time use +If we want to change this to 1G, we can at any time use:: -# echo 1G > memory.soft_limit_in_bytes + # echo 1G > memory.soft_limit_in_bytes -NOTE1: Soft limits take effect over a long period of time, since they involve +NOTE1: + Soft limits take effect over a long period of time, since they involve reclaiming memory for balancing between memory cgroups -NOTE2: It is recommended to set the soft limit always below the hard limit, +NOTE2: + It is recommended to set the soft limit always below the hard limit, otherwise the hard limit will take precedence. 8. Move charges at task migration +================================= Users can move charges associated with a task along with task migration, that is, uncharge task's pages from the old cgroup and charge them to the new cgroup. @@ -663,60 +752,71 @@ This feature is not supported in !CONFIG_MMU environments because of lack of page tables. 8.1 Interface +------------- This feature is disabled by default. It can be enabled (and disabled again) by writing to memory.move_charge_at_immigrate of the destination cgroup. -If you want to enable it: +If you want to enable it:: -# echo (some positive value) > memory.move_charge_at_immigrate + # echo (some positive value) > memory.move_charge_at_immigrate -Note: Each bits of move_charge_at_immigrate has its own meaning about what type +Note: + Each bits of move_charge_at_immigrate has its own meaning about what type of charges should be moved. See 8.2 for details. -Note: Charges are moved only when you move mm->owner, in other words, +Note: + Charges are moved only when you move mm->owner, in other words, a leader of a thread group. -Note: If we cannot find enough space for the task in the destination cgroup, we +Note: + If we cannot find enough space for the task in the destination cgroup, we try to make space by reclaiming memory. Task migration may fail if we cannot make enough space. -Note: It can take several seconds if you move charges much. +Note: + It can take several seconds if you move charges much. -And if you want disable it again: +And if you want disable it again:: -# echo 0 > memory.move_charge_at_immigrate + # echo 0 > memory.move_charge_at_immigrate 8.2 Type of charges which can be moved +-------------------------------------- Each bit in move_charge_at_immigrate has its own meaning about what type of charges should be moved. But in any case, it must be noted that an account of a page or a swap can be moved only when it is charged to the task's current (old) memory cgroup. - bit | what type of charges would be moved ? - -----+------------------------------------------------------------------------ - 0 | A charge of an anonymous page (or swap of it) used by the target task. - | You must enable Swap Extension (see 2.4) to enable move of swap charges. - -----+------------------------------------------------------------------------ - 1 | A charge of file pages (normal file, tmpfs file (e.g. ipc shared memory) - | and swaps of tmpfs file) mmapped by the target task. Unlike the case of - | anonymous pages, file pages (and swaps) in the range mmapped by the task - | will be moved even if the task hasn't done page fault, i.e. they might - | not be the task's "RSS", but other task's "RSS" that maps the same file. - | And mapcount of the page is ignored (the page can be moved even if - | page_mapcount(page) > 1). You must enable Swap Extension (see 2.4) to - | enable move of swap charges. ++---+--------------------------------------------------------------------------+ +|bit| what type of charges would be moved ? | ++===+==========================================================================+ +| 0 | A charge of an anonymous page (or swap of it) used by the target task. | +| | You must enable Swap Extension (see 2.4) to enable move of swap charges. | ++---+--------------------------------------------------------------------------+ +| 1 | A charge of file pages (normal file, tmpfs file (e.g. ipc shared memory) | +| | and swaps of tmpfs file) mmapped by the target task. Unlike the case of | +| | anonymous pages, file pages (and swaps) in the range mmapped by the task | +| | will be moved even if the task hasn't done page fault, i.e. they might | +| | not be the task's "RSS", but other task's "RSS" that maps the same file. | +| | And mapcount of the page is ignored (the page can be moved even if | +| | page_mapcount(page) > 1). You must enable Swap Extension (see 2.4) to | +| | enable move of swap charges. | ++---+--------------------------------------------------------------------------+ 8.3 TODO +-------- - All of moving charge operations are done under cgroup_mutex. It's not good behavior to hold the mutex too long, so we may need some trick. 9. Memory thresholds +==================== Memory cgroup implements memory thresholds using the cgroups notification API (see cgroups.txt). It allows to register multiple memory and memsw thresholds and gets notifications when it crosses. To register a threshold, an application must: + - create an eventfd using eventfd(2); - open memory.usage_in_bytes or memory.memsw.usage_in_bytes; - write string like "<event_fd> <fd of memory.usage_in_bytes> <threshold>" to @@ -728,6 +828,7 @@ threshold in any direction. It's applicable for root and non-root cgroup. 10. OOM Control +=============== memory.oom_control file is for OOM notification and other controls. @@ -736,6 +837,7 @@ API (See cgroups.txt). It allows to register multiple OOM notification delivery and gets notification when OOM happens. To register a notifier, an application must: + - create an eventfd using eventfd(2) - open memory.oom_control file - write string like "<event_fd> <fd of memory.oom_control>" to @@ -752,8 +854,11 @@ If OOM-killer is disabled, tasks under cgroup will hang/sleep in memory cgroup's OOM-waitqueue when they request accountable memory. For running them, you have to relax the memory cgroup's OOM status by + * enlarge limit or reduce usage. + To reduce usage, + * kill some tasks. * move some tasks to other group with account migration. * remove some files (on tmpfs?) @@ -761,11 +866,14 @@ To reduce usage, Then, stopped tasks will work again. At reading, current status of OOM is shown. - oom_kill_disable 0 or 1 (if 1, oom-killer is disabled) - under_oom 0 or 1 (if 1, the memory cgroup is under OOM, tasks may - be stopped.) + + - oom_kill_disable 0 or 1 + (if 1, oom-killer is disabled) + - under_oom 0 or 1 + (if 1, the memory cgroup is under OOM, tasks may be stopped.) 11. Memory Pressure +=================== The pressure level notifications can be used to monitor the memory allocation cost; based on the pressure, applications can implement @@ -840,21 +948,22 @@ Test: Here is a small script example that makes a new cgroup, sets up a memory limit, sets up a notification in the cgroup and then makes child - cgroup experience a critical pressure: + cgroup experience a critical pressure:: - # cd /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/ - # mkdir foo - # cd foo - # cgroup_event_listener memory.pressure_level low,hierarchy & - # echo 8000000 > memory.limit_in_bytes - # echo 8000000 > memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes - # echo $$ > tasks - # dd if=/dev/zero | read x + # cd /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/ + # mkdir foo + # cd foo + # cgroup_event_listener memory.pressure_level low,hierarchy & + # echo 8000000 > memory.limit_in_bytes + # echo 8000000 > memory.memsw.limit_in_bytes + # echo $$ > tasks + # dd if=/dev/zero | read x (Expect a bunch of notifications, and eventually, the oom-killer will trigger.) 12. TODO +======== 1. Make per-cgroup scanner reclaim not-shared pages first 2. Teach controller to account for shared-pages @@ -862,11 +971,13 @@ Test: not yet hit but the usage is getting closer Summary +======= Overall, the memory controller has been a stable controller and has been commented and discussed quite extensively in the community. References +========== 1. Singh, Balbir. RFC: Memory Controller, http://lwn.net/Articles/206697/ 2. Singh, Balbir. Memory Controller (RSS Control), diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_cls.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_cls.rst index ec182346dea2..a2cf272af7a0 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_cls.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_cls.rst @@ -1,5 +1,6 @@ +========================= Network classifier cgroup -------------------------- +========================= The Network classifier cgroup provides an interface to tag network packets with a class identifier (classid). @@ -17,23 +18,27 @@ values is 0xAAAABBBB; AAAA is the major handle number and BBBB is the minor handle number. Reading net_cls.classid yields a decimal result. -Example: -mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls -mount -t cgroup -onet_cls net_cls /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls -mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls/0 -echo 0x100001 > /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls/0/net_cls.classid - - setting a 10:1 handle. +Example:: -cat /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls/0/net_cls.classid -1048577 + mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls + mount -t cgroup -onet_cls net_cls /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls + mkdir /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls/0 + echo 0x100001 > /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls/0/net_cls.classid -configuring tc: -tc qdisc add dev eth0 root handle 10: htb +- setting a 10:1 handle:: -tc class add dev eth0 parent 10: classid 10:1 htb rate 40mbit - - creating traffic class 10:1 + cat /sys/fs/cgroup/net_cls/0/net_cls.classid + 1048577 -tc filter add dev eth0 parent 10: protocol ip prio 10 handle 1: cgroup +- configuring tc:: -configuring iptables, basic example: -iptables -A OUTPUT -m cgroup ! --cgroup 0x100001 -j DROP + tc qdisc add dev eth0 root handle 10: htb + tc class add dev eth0 parent 10: classid 10:1 htb rate 40mbit + +- creating traffic class 10:1:: + + tc filter add dev eth0 parent 10: protocol ip prio 10 handle 1: cgroup + +configuring iptables, basic example:: + + iptables -A OUTPUT -m cgroup ! --cgroup 0x100001 -j DROP diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_prio.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_prio.rst index a82cbd28ea8a..b40905871c64 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_prio.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/net_prio.rst @@ -1,5 +1,6 @@ +======================= Network priority cgroup -------------------------- +======================= The Network priority cgroup provides an interface to allow an administrator to dynamically set the priority of network traffic generated by various @@ -14,9 +15,9 @@ SO_PRIORITY socket option. This however, is not always possible because: This cgroup allows an administrator to assign a process to a group which defines the priority of egress traffic on a given interface. Network priority groups can -be created by first mounting the cgroup filesystem. +be created by first mounting the cgroup filesystem:: -# mount -t cgroup -onet_prio none /sys/fs/cgroup/net_prio + # mount -t cgroup -onet_prio none /sys/fs/cgroup/net_prio With the above step, the initial group acting as the parent accounting group becomes visible at '/sys/fs/cgroup/net_prio'. This group includes all tasks in @@ -25,17 +26,18 @@ the system. '/sys/fs/cgroup/net_prio/tasks' lists the tasks in this cgroup. Each net_prio cgroup contains two files that are subsystem specific net_prio.prioidx -This file is read-only, and is simply informative. It contains a unique integer -value that the kernel uses as an internal representation of this cgroup. + This file is read-only, and is simply informative. It contains a unique + integer value that the kernel uses as an internal representation of this + cgroup. net_prio.ifpriomap -This file contains a map of the priorities assigned to traffic originating from -processes in this group and egressing the system on various interfaces. It -contains a list of tuples in the form <ifname priority>. Contents of this file -can be modified by echoing a string into the file using the same tuple format. -for example: + This file contains a map of the priorities assigned to traffic originating + from processes in this group and egressing the system on various interfaces. + It contains a list of tuples in the form <ifname priority>. Contents of this + file can be modified by echoing a string into the file using the same tuple + format. For example:: -echo "eth0 5" > /sys/fs/cgroups/net_prio/iscsi/net_prio.ifpriomap + echo "eth0 5" > /sys/fs/cgroups/net_prio/iscsi/net_prio.ifpriomap This command would force any traffic originating from processes belonging to the iscsi net_prio cgroup and egressing on interface eth0 to have the priority of diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/pids.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/pids.rst index e105d708ccde..6acebd9e72c8 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/pids.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/pids.rst @@ -1,5 +1,6 @@ - Process Number Controller - ========================= +========================= +Process Number Controller +========================= Abstract -------- @@ -34,55 +35,58 @@ pids.current tracks all child cgroup hierarchies, so parent/pids.current is a superset of parent/child/pids.current. The pids.events file contains event counters: + - max: Number of times fork failed because limit was hit. Example ------- -First, we mount the pids controller: -# mkdir -p /sys/fs/cgroup/pids -# mount -t cgroup -o pids none /sys/fs/cgroup/pids +First, we mount the pids controller:: + + # mkdir -p /sys/fs/cgroup/pids + # mount -t cgroup -o pids none /sys/fs/cgroup/pids + +Then we create a hierarchy, set limits and attach processes to it:: -Then we create a hierarchy, set limits and attach processes to it: -# mkdir -p /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child -# echo 2 > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.max -# echo $$ > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/cgroup.procs -# cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.current -2 -# + # mkdir -p /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child + # echo 2 > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.max + # echo $$ > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/cgroup.procs + # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.current + 2 + # It should be noted that attempts to overcome the set limit (2 in this case) will -fail: +fail:: -# cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.current -2 -# ( /bin/echo "Here's some processes for you." | cat ) -sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable -# + # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.current + 2 + # ( /bin/echo "Here's some processes for you." | cat ) + sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable + # Even if we migrate to a child cgroup (which doesn't have a set limit), we will not be able to overcome the most stringent limit in the hierarchy (in this case, -parent's): - -# echo $$ > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child/cgroup.procs -# cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.current -2 -# cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child/pids.current -2 -# cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child/pids.max -max -# ( /bin/echo "Here's some processes for you." | cat ) -sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable -# +parent's):: + + # echo $$ > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child/cgroup.procs + # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.current + 2 + # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child/pids.current + 2 + # cat /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/child/pids.max + max + # ( /bin/echo "Here's some processes for you." | cat ) + sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable + # We can set a limit that is smaller than pids.current, which will stop any new processes from being forked at all (note that the shell itself counts towards -pids.current): - -# echo 1 > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.max -# /bin/echo "We can't even spawn a single process now." -sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable -# echo 0 > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.max -# /bin/echo "We can't even spawn a single process now." -sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable -# +pids.current):: + + # echo 1 > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.max + # /bin/echo "We can't even spawn a single process now." + sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable + # echo 0 > /sys/fs/cgroup/pids/parent/pids.max + # /bin/echo "We can't even spawn a single process now." + sh: fork: Resource temporary unavailable + # diff --git a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/rdma.txt b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/rdma.rst index 9bdb7fd03f83..2fcb0a9bf790 100644 --- a/Documentation/cgroup-v1/rdma.txt +++ b/Documentation/cgroup-v1/rdma.rst @@ -1,16 +1,17 @@ - RDMA Controller - ---------------- +=============== +RDMA Controller +=============== -Contents --------- +.. Contents -1. Overview - 1-1. What is RDMA controller? - 1-2. Why RDMA controller needed? - 1-3. How is RDMA controller implemented? -2. Usage Examples + 1. Overview + 1-1. What is RDMA controller? + 1-2. Why RDMA controller needed? + 1-3. How is RDMA controller implemented? + 2. Usage Examples 1. Overview +=========== 1-1. What is RDMA controller? ----------------------------- @@ -83,27 +84,34 @@ what is configured by user for a given cgroup and what is supported by IB device. Following resources can be accounted by rdma controller. + + ========== ============================= hca_handle Maximum number of HCA Handles hca_object Maximum number of HCA Objects + ========== ============================= 2. Usage Examples ------------------ - -(a) Configure resource limit: -echo mlx4_0 hca_handle=2 hca_object=2000 > /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/1/rdma.max -echo ocrdma1 hca_handle=3 > /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/2/rdma.max - -(b) Query resource limit: -cat /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/2/rdma.max -#Output: -mlx4_0 hca_handle=2 hca_object=2000 -ocrdma1 hca_handle=3 hca_object=max - -(c) Query current usage: -cat /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/2/rdma.current -#Output: -mlx4_0 hca_handle=1 hca_object=20 -ocrdma1 hca_handle=1 hca_object=23 - -(d) Delete resource limit: -echo echo mlx4_0 hca_handle=max hca_object=max > /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/1/rdma.max +================= + +(a) Configure resource limit:: + + echo mlx4_0 hca_handle=2 hca_object=2000 > /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/1/rdma.max + echo ocrdma1 hca_handle=3 > /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/2/rdma.max + +(b) Query resource limit:: + + cat /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/2/rdma.max + #Output: + mlx4_0 hca_handle=2 hca_object=2000 + ocrdma1 hca_handle=3 hca_object=max + +(c) Query current usage:: + + cat /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/2/rdma.current + #Output: + mlx4_0 hca_handle=1 hca_object=20 + ocrdma1 hca_handle=1 hca_object=23 + +(d) Delete resource limit:: + + echo echo mlx4_0 hca_handle=max hca_object=max > /sys/fs/cgroup/rdma/1/rdma.max diff --git a/Documentation/core-api/circular-buffers.rst b/Documentation/core-api/circular-buffers.rst index 53e51caa3347..50966f66e398 100644 --- a/Documentation/core-api/circular-buffers.rst +++ b/Documentation/core-api/circular-buffers.rst @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ Circular Buffers ================ :Author: David Howells <dhowells@redhat.com> -:Author: Paul E. McKenney <paulmck@linux.vnet.ibm.com> +:Author: Paul E. McKenney <paulmck@linux.ibm.com> Linux provides a number of features that can be used to implement circular diff --git a/Documentation/core-api/timekeeping.rst b/Documentation/core-api/timekeeping.rst index 93cbeb9daec0..20ee447a50f3 100644 --- a/Documentation/core-api/timekeeping.rst +++ b/Documentation/core-api/timekeeping.rst @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ different format depending on what is required by the user: .. c:function:: u64 ktime_get_ns( void ) u64 ktime_get_boottime_ns( void ) u64 ktime_get_real_ns( void ) - u64 ktime_get_tai_ns( void ) + u64 ktime_get_clocktai_ns( void ) u64 ktime_get_raw_ns( void ) Same as the plain ktime_get functions, but returning a u64 number @@ -99,16 +99,20 @@ Coarse and fast_ns access Some additional variants exist for more specialized cases: -.. c:function:: ktime_t ktime_get_coarse_boottime( void ) +.. c:function:: ktime_t ktime_get_coarse( void ) + ktime_t ktime_get_coarse_boottime( void ) ktime_t ktime_get_coarse_real( void ) ktime_t ktime_get_coarse_clocktai( void ) - ktime_t ktime_get_coarse_raw( void ) + +.. c:function:: u64 ktime_get_coarse_ns( void ) + u64 ktime_get_coarse_boottime_ns( void ) + u64 ktime_get_coarse_real_ns( void ) + u64 ktime_get_coarse_clocktai_ns( void ) .. c:function:: void ktime_get_coarse_ts64( struct timespec64 * ) void ktime_get_coarse_boottime_ts64( struct timespec64 * ) void ktime_get_coarse_real_ts64( struct timespec64 * ) void ktime_get_coarse_clocktai_ts64( struct timespec64 * ) - void ktime_get_coarse_raw_ts64( struct timespec64 * ) These are quicker than the non-coarse versions, but less accurate, corresponding to CLOCK_MONONOTNIC_COARSE and CLOCK_REALTIME_COARSE diff --git a/Documentation/cputopology.txt b/Documentation/cputopology.txt index cb61277e2308..b90dafcc8237 100644 --- a/Documentation/cputopology.txt +++ b/Documentation/cputopology.txt @@ -12,6 +12,12 @@ physical_package_id: socket number, but the actual value is architecture and platform dependent. +die_id: + + the CPU die ID of cpuX. Typically it is the hardware platform's + identifier (rather than the kernel's). The actual value is + architecture and platform dependent. + core_id: the CPU core ID of cpuX. Typically it is the hardware platform's @@ -30,25 +36,33 @@ drawer_id: identifier (rather than the kernel's). The actual value is architecture and platform dependent. -thread_siblings: +core_cpus: - internal kernel map of cpuX's hardware threads within the same - core as cpuX. + internal kernel map of CPUs within the same core. + (deprecated name: "thread_siblings") -thread_siblings_list: +core_cpus_list: - human-readable list of cpuX's hardware threads within the same - core as cpuX. + human-readable list of CPUs within the same core. + (deprecated name: "thread_siblings_list"); -core_siblings: +package_cpus: - internal kernel map of cpuX's hardware threads within the same - physical_package_id. + internal kernel map of the CPUs sharing the same physical_package_id. + (deprecated name: "core_siblings") -core_siblings_list: +package_cpus_list: - human-readable list of cpuX's hardware threads within the same - physical_package_id. + human-readable list of CPUs sharing the same physical_package_id. + (deprecated name: "core_siblings_list") + +die_cpus: + + internal kernel map of CPUs within the same die. + +die_cpus_list: + + human-readable list of CPUs within the same die. book_siblings: @@ -81,11 +95,13 @@ For an architecture to support this feature, it must define some of these macros in include/asm-XXX/topology.h:: #define topology_physical_package_id(cpu) + #define topology_die_id(cpu) #define topology_core_id(cpu) #define topology_book_id(cpu) #define topology_drawer_id(cpu) #define topology_sibling_cpumask(cpu) #define topology_core_cpumask(cpu) + #define topology_die_cpumask(cpu) #define topology_book_cpumask(cpu) #define topology_drawer_cpumask(cpu) @@ -99,9 +115,11 @@ provides default definitions for any of the above macros that are not defined by include/asm-XXX/topology.h: 1) topology_physical_package_id: -1 -2) topology_core_id: 0 -3) topology_sibling_cpumask: just the given CPU -4) topology_core_cpumask: just the given CPU +2) topology_die_id: -1 +3) topology_core_id: 0 +4) topology_sibling_cpumask: just the given CPU +5) topology_core_cpumask: just the given CPU +6) topology_die_cpumask: just the given CPU For architectures that don't support books (CONFIG_SCHED_BOOK) there are no default definitions for topology_book_id() and topology_book_cpumask(). diff --git a/Documentation/crypto/api-samples.rst b/Documentation/crypto/api-samples.rst index f14afaaf2f32..e923f17bc2bd 100644 --- a/Documentation/crypto/api-samples.rst +++ b/Documentation/crypto/api-samples.rst @@ -4,111 +4,89 @@ Code Examples Code Example For Symmetric Key Cipher Operation ----------------------------------------------- -:: - - - /* tie all data structures together */ - struct skcipher_def { - struct scatterlist sg; - struct crypto_skcipher *tfm; - struct skcipher_request *req; - struct crypto_wait wait; - }; - - /* Perform cipher operation */ - static unsigned int test_skcipher_encdec(struct skcipher_def *sk, - int enc) - { - int rc; - - if (enc) - rc = crypto_wait_req(crypto_skcipher_encrypt(sk->req), &sk->wait); - else - rc = crypto_wait_req(crypto_skcipher_decrypt(sk->req), &sk->wait); - - if (rc) - pr_info("skcipher encrypt returned with result %d\n", rc); +This code encrypts some data with AES-256-XTS. For sake of example, +all inputs are random bytes, the encryption is done in-place, and it's +assumed the code is running in a context where it can sleep. - return rc; - } +:: - /* Initialize and trigger cipher operation */ static int test_skcipher(void) { - struct skcipher_def sk; - struct crypto_skcipher *skcipher = NULL; - struct skcipher_request *req = NULL; - char *scratchpad = NULL; - char *ivdata = NULL; - unsigned char key[32]; - int ret = -EFAULT; - - skcipher = crypto_alloc_skcipher("cbc-aes-aesni", 0, 0); - if (IS_ERR(skcipher)) { - pr_info("could not allocate skcipher handle\n"); - return PTR_ERR(skcipher); - } - - req = skcipher_request_alloc(skcipher, GFP_KERNEL); - if (!req) { - pr_info("could not allocate skcipher request\n"); - ret = -ENOMEM; - goto out; - } - - skcipher_request_set_callback(req, CRYPTO_TFM_REQ_MAY_BACKLOG, - crypto_req_done, - &sk.wait); - - /* AES 256 with random key */ - get_random_bytes(&key, 32); - if (crypto_skcipher_setkey(skcipher, key, 32)) { - pr_info("key could not be set\n"); - ret = -EAGAIN; - goto out; - } - - /* IV will be random */ - ivdata = kmalloc(16, GFP_KERNEL); - if (!ivdata) { - pr_info("could not allocate ivdata\n"); - goto out; - } - get_random_bytes(ivdata, 16); - - /* Input data will be random */ - scratchpad = kmalloc(16, GFP_KERNEL); - if (!scratchpad) { - pr_info("could not allocate scratchpad\n"); - goto out; - } - get_random_bytes(scratchpad, 16); - - sk.tfm = skcipher; - sk.req = req; - - /* We encrypt one block */ - sg_init_one(&sk.sg, scratchpad, 16); - skcipher_request_set_crypt(req, &sk.sg, &sk.sg, 16, ivdata); - crypto_init_wait(&sk.wait); - - /* encrypt data */ - ret = test_skcipher_encdec(&sk, 1); - if (ret) - goto out; - - pr_info("Encryption triggered successfully\n"); - + struct crypto_skcipher *tfm = NULL; + struct skcipher_request *req = NULL; + u8 *data = NULL; + const size_t datasize = 512; /* data size in bytes */ + struct scatterlist sg; + DECLARE_CRYPTO_WAIT(wait); + u8 iv[16]; /* AES-256-XTS takes a 16-byte IV */ + u8 key[64]; /* AES-256-XTS takes a 64-byte key */ + int err; + + /* + * Allocate a tfm (a transformation object) and set the key. + * + * In real-world use, a tfm and key are typically used for many + * encryption/decryption operations. But in this example, we'll just do a + * single encryption operation with it (which is not very efficient). + */ + + tfm = crypto_alloc_skcipher("xts(aes)", 0, 0); + if (IS_ERR(tfm)) { + pr_err("Error allocating xts(aes) handle: %ld\n", PTR_ERR(tfm)); + return PTR_ERR(tfm); + } + + get_random_bytes(key, sizeof(key)); + err = crypto_skcipher_setkey(tfm, key, sizeof(key)); + if (err) { + pr_err("Error setting key: %d\n", err); + goto out; + } + + /* Allocate a request object */ + req = skcipher_request_alloc(tfm, GFP_KERNEL); + if (!req) { + err = -ENOMEM; + goto out; + } + + /* Prepare the input data */ + data = kmalloc(datasize, GFP_KERNEL); + if (!data) { + err = -ENOMEM; + goto out; + } + get_random_bytes(data, datasize); + + /* Initialize the IV */ + get_random_bytes(iv, sizeof(iv)); + + /* + * Encrypt the data in-place. + * + * For simplicity, in this example we wait for the request to complete + * before proceeding, even if the underlying implementation is asynchronous. + * + * To decrypt instead of encrypt, just change crypto_skcipher_encrypt() to + * crypto_skcipher_decrypt(). + */ + sg_init_one(&sg, data, datasize); + skcipher_request_set_callback(req, CRYPTO_TFM_REQ_MAY_BACKLOG | + CRYPTO_TFM_REQ_MAY_SLEEP, + crypto_req_done, &wait); + skcipher_request_set_crypt(req, &sg, &sg, datasize, iv); + err = crypto_wait_req(crypto_skcipher_encrypt(req), &wait); + if (err) { + pr_err("Error encrypting data: %d\n", err); + goto out; + } + + pr_debug("Encryption was successful\n"); out: - if (skcipher) - crypto_free_skcipher(skcipher); - if (req) + crypto_free_skcipher(tfm); skcipher_request_free(req); - if (ivdata) - kfree(ivdata); - if (scratchpad) - kfree(scratchpad); - return ret; + kfree(data); + return err; } diff --git a/Documentation/crypto/api-skcipher.rst b/Documentation/crypto/api-skcipher.rst index 4eec4a93f7e3..20ba08dddf2e 100644 --- a/Documentation/crypto/api-skcipher.rst +++ b/Documentation/crypto/api-skcipher.rst @@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ Block Cipher Algorithm Definitions :doc: Block Cipher Algorithm Definitions .. kernel-doc:: include/linux/crypto.h - :functions: crypto_alg ablkcipher_alg blkcipher_alg cipher_alg + :functions: crypto_alg ablkcipher_alg blkcipher_alg cipher_alg compress_alg Symmetric Key Cipher API ------------------------ diff --git a/Documentation/crypto/architecture.rst b/Documentation/crypto/architecture.rst index ee8ff0762d7f..3eae1ae7f798 100644 --- a/Documentation/crypto/architecture.rst +++ b/Documentation/crypto/architecture.rst @@ -208,9 +208,7 @@ the aforementioned cipher types: - CRYPTO_ALG_TYPE_KPP Key-agreement Protocol Primitive (KPP) such as an ECDH or DH implementation -- CRYPTO_ALG_TYPE_DIGEST Raw message digest - -- CRYPTO_ALG_TYPE_HASH Alias for CRYPTO_ALG_TYPE_DIGEST +- CRYPTO_ALG_TYPE_HASH Raw message digest - CRYPTO_ALG_TYPE_SHASH Synchronous multi-block hash diff --git a/Documentation/crypto/crypto_engine.rst b/Documentation/crypto/crypto_engine.rst index 1d56221dfe35..236c674d6897 100644 --- a/Documentation/crypto/crypto_engine.rst +++ b/Documentation/crypto/crypto_engine.rst @@ -1,50 +1,85 @@ -============= -CRYPTO ENGINE +.. SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +Crypto Engine ============= Overview -------- -The crypto engine API (CE), is a crypto queue manager. +The crypto engine (CE) API is a crypto queue manager. Requirement ----------- -You have to put at start of your tfm_ctx the struct crypto_engine_ctx:: +You must put, at the start of your transform context your_tfm_ctx, the structure +crypto_engine: + +:: - struct your_tfm_ctx { - struct crypto_engine_ctx enginectx; - ... - }; + struct your_tfm_ctx { + struct crypto_engine engine; + ... + }; -Why: Since CE manage only crypto_async_request, it cannot know the underlying -request_type and so have access only on the TFM. -So using container_of for accessing __ctx is impossible. -Furthermore, the crypto engine cannot know the "struct your_tfm_ctx", -so it must assume that crypto_engine_ctx is at start of it. +The crypto engine only manages asynchronous requests in the form of +crypto_async_request. It cannot know the underlying request type and thus only +has access to the transform structure. It is not possible to access the context +using container_of. In addition, the engine knows nothing about your +structure "``struct your_tfm_ctx``". The engine assumes (requires) the placement +of the known member ``struct crypto_engine`` at the beginning. Order of operations ------------------- -You have to obtain a struct crypto_engine via crypto_engine_alloc_init(). -And start it via crypto_engine_start(). - -Before transferring any request, you have to fill the enginectx. -- prepare_request: (taking a function pointer) If you need to do some processing before doing the request -- unprepare_request: (taking a function pointer) Undoing what's done in prepare_request -- do_one_request: (taking a function pointer) Do encryption for current request - -Note: that those three functions get the crypto_async_request associated with the received request. -So your need to get the original request via container_of(areq, struct yourrequesttype_request, base); - -When your driver receive a crypto_request, you have to transfer it to -the cryptoengine via one of: -- crypto_transfer_ablkcipher_request_to_engine() -- crypto_transfer_aead_request_to_engine() -- crypto_transfer_akcipher_request_to_engine() -- crypto_transfer_hash_request_to_engine() -- crypto_transfer_skcipher_request_to_engine() - -At the end of the request process, a call to one of the following function is needed: -- crypto_finalize_ablkcipher_request -- crypto_finalize_aead_request -- crypto_finalize_akcipher_request -- crypto_finalize_hash_request -- crypto_finalize_skcipher_request +You are required to obtain a struct crypto_engine via ``crypto_engine_alloc_init()``. +Start it via ``crypto_engine_start()``. When finished with your work, shut down the +engine using ``crypto_engine_stop()`` and destroy the engine with +``crypto_engine_exit()``. + +Before transferring any request, you have to fill the context enginectx by +providing functions for the following: + +* ``prepare_crypt_hardware``: Called once before any prepare functions are + called. + +* ``unprepare_crypt_hardware``: Called once after all unprepare functions have + been called. + +* ``prepare_cipher_request``/``prepare_hash_request``: Called before each + corresponding request is performed. If some processing or other preparatory + work is required, do it here. + +* ``unprepare_cipher_request``/``unprepare_hash_request``: Called after each + request is handled. Clean up / undo what was done in the prepare function. + +* ``cipher_one_request``/``hash_one_request``: Handle the current request by + performing the operation. + +Note that these functions access the crypto_async_request structure +associated with the received request. You are able to retrieve the original +request by using: + +:: + + container_of(areq, struct yourrequesttype_request, base); + +When your driver receives a crypto_request, you must to transfer it to +the crypto engine via one of: + +* crypto_transfer_ablkcipher_request_to_engine() + +* crypto_transfer_aead_request_to_engine() + +* crypto_transfer_akcipher_request_to_engine() + +* crypto_transfer_hash_request_to_engine() + +* crypto_transfer_skcipher_request_to_engine() + +At the end of the request process, a call to one of the following functions is needed: + +* crypto_finalize_ablkcipher_request() + +* crypto_finalize_aead_request() + +* crypto_finalize_akcipher_request() + +* crypto_finalize_hash_request() + +* crypto_finalize_skcipher_request() diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/cpufreq/imx-cpufreq-dt.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/cpufreq/imx-cpufreq-dt.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..87bff5add3f9 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/cpufreq/imx-cpufreq-dt.txt @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +i.MX CPUFreq-DT OPP bindings +================================ + +Certain i.MX SoCs support different OPPs depending on the "market segment" and +"speed grading" value which are written in fuses. These bits are combined with +the opp-supported-hw values for each OPP to check if the OPP is allowed. + +Required properties: +-------------------- + +For each opp entry in 'operating-points-v2' table: +- opp-supported-hw: Two bitmaps indicating: + - Supported speed grade mask + - Supported market segment mask + 0: Consumer + 1: Extended Consumer + 2: Industrial + 3: Automotive + +Example: +-------- + +opp_table { + compatible = "operating-points-v2"; + opp-1000000000 { + opp-hz = /bits/ 64 <1000000000>; + /* grade >= 0, consumer only */ + opp-supported-hw = <0xf>, <0x3>; + }; + + opp-1300000000 { + opp-hz = /bits/ 64 <1300000000>; + opp-microvolt = <1000000>; + /* grade >= 1, all segments */ + opp-supported-hw = <0xe>, <0x7>; + }; +} diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/crypto/atmel-crypto.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/crypto/atmel-crypto.txt index 6b458bb2440d..f2aab3dc2b52 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/crypto/atmel-crypto.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/crypto/atmel-crypto.txt @@ -66,16 +66,3 @@ sha@f8034000 { dmas = <&dma1 2 17>; dma-names = "tx"; }; - -* Eliptic Curve Cryptography (I2C) - -Required properties: -- compatible : must be "atmel,atecc508a". -- reg: I2C bus address of the device. -- clock-frequency: must be present in the i2c controller node. - -Example: -atecc508a@c0 { - compatible = "atmel,atecc508a"; - reg = <0xC0>; -}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio-davinci.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio-davinci.txt index 553b92a7e87b..bc6b4b62df83 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio-davinci.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/gpio-davinci.txt @@ -5,6 +5,7 @@ Required Properties: "ti,keystone-gpio": for Keystone 2 66AK2H/K, 66AK2L, 66AK2E SoCs "ti,k2g-gpio", "ti,keystone-gpio": for 66AK2G + "ti,am654-gpio", "ti,keystone-gpio": for TI K3 AM654 - reg: Physical base address of the controller and the size of memory mapped registers. @@ -145,3 +146,20 @@ gpio0: gpio@260bf00 { ti,ngpio = <32>; ti,davinci-gpio-unbanked = <32>; }; + +Example for K3 AM654: + +wkup_gpio0: wkup_gpio0@42110000 { + compatible = "ti,am654-gpio", "ti,keystone-gpio"; + reg = <0x42110000 0x100>; + gpio-controller; + #gpio-cells = <2>; + interrupt-parent = <&intr_wkup_gpio>; + interrupts = <59 128>, <59 129>, <59 130>, <59 131>; + interrupt-controller; + #interrupt-cells = <2>; + ti,ngpio = <56>; + ti,davinci-gpio-unbanked = <0>; + clocks = <&k3_clks 59 0>; + clock-names = "gpio"; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/pl061-gpio.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/pl061-gpio.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 89058d375b7c..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/pl061-gpio.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,10 +0,0 @@ -ARM PL061 GPIO controller - -Required properties: -- compatible : "arm,pl061", "arm,primecell" -- #gpio-cells : Should be two. The first cell is the pin number and the - second cell is used to specify optional parameters: - - bit 0 specifies polarity (0 for normal, 1 for inverted) -- gpio-controller : Marks the device node as a GPIO controller. -- interrupts : Interrupt mapping for GPIO IRQ. -- gpio-ranges : Interaction with the PINCTRL subsystem. diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/pl061-gpio.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/pl061-gpio.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..313b17229247 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/gpio/pl061-gpio.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: (GPL-2.0 OR BSD-2-Clause) +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/gpio/pl061-gpio.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: ARM PL061 GPIO controller + +maintainers: + - Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org> + - Rob Herring <robh@kernel.org> + +# We need a select here so we don't match all nodes with 'arm,primecell' +select: + properties: + compatible: + contains: + const: arm,pl061 + required: + - compatible + +properties: + $nodename: + pattern: "^gpio@[0-9a-f]+$" + + compatible: + items: + - const: arm,pl061 + - const: arm,primecell + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + + interrupts: + oneOf: + - maxItems: 1 + - maxItems: 8 + + interrupt-controller: true + + "#interrupt-cells": + const: 2 + + clocks: + maxItems: 1 + + clock-names: true + + "#gpio-cells": + const: 2 + + gpio-controller: true + + gpio-ranges: + maxItems: 8 + +required: + - compatible + - reg + - interrupts + - interrupt-controller + - "#interrupt-cells" + - clocks + - "#gpio-cells" + - gpio-controller + +additionalProperties: false + +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/cdns,i3c-master.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/cdns,i3c-master.txt index 69da2115abdc..1cf6182f888c 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/cdns,i3c-master.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/cdns,i3c-master.txt @@ -38,6 +38,6 @@ Example: nunchuk: nunchuk@52 { compatible = "nintendo,nunchuk"; - reg = <0x52 0x80000010 0>; + reg = <0x52 0x0 0x10>; }; }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/i3c.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/i3c.txt index ab729a0a86ae..4ffe059f0fec 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/i3c.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/i3c/i3c.txt @@ -39,7 +39,9 @@ valid here, but several new properties have been added. New constraint on existing properties: -------------------------------------- - reg: contains 3 cells - + first cell : still encoding the I2C address + + first cell : still encoding the I2C address. 10 bit addressing is not + supported. Devices with 10 bit address can't be properly passed through + DEFSLVS command. + second cell: shall be 0 diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/amazon,al-fic.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/amazon,al-fic.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..4e82fd575cec --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/amazon,al-fic.txt @@ -0,0 +1,29 @@ +Amazon's Annapurna Labs Fabric Interrupt Controller + +Required properties: + +- compatible: should be "amazon,al-fic" +- reg: physical base address and size of the registers +- interrupt-controller: identifies the node as an interrupt controller +- #interrupt-cells: must be 2. + First cell defines the index of the interrupt within the controller. + Second cell is used to specify the trigger type and must be one of the + following: + - bits[3:0] trigger type and level flags + 1 = low-to-high edge triggered + 4 = active high level-sensitive +- interrupt-parent: specifies the parent interrupt controller. +- interrupts: describes which input line in the interrupt parent, this + fic's output is connected to. This field property depends on the parent's + binding + +Example: + +amazon_fic: interrupt-controller@0xfd8a8500 { + compatible = "amazon,al-fic"; + interrupt-controller; + #interrupt-cells = <2>; + reg = <0x0 0xfd8a8500 0x0 0x1000>; + interrupt-parent = <&gic>; + interrupts = <GIC_SPI 0x0 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/amlogic,meson-gpio-intc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/amlogic,meson-gpio-intc.txt index 1502a51548bb..7d531d5fff29 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/amlogic,meson-gpio-intc.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/amlogic,meson-gpio-intc.txt @@ -15,6 +15,7 @@ Required properties: "amlogic,meson-gxbb-gpio-intc" for GXBB SoCs (S905) or "amlogic,meson-gxl-gpio-intc" for GXL SoCs (S905X, S912) "amlogic,meson-axg-gpio-intc" for AXG SoCs (A113D, A113X) + "amlogic,meson-g12a-gpio-intc" for G12A SoCs (S905D2, S905X2, S905Y2) - reg : Specifies base physical address and size of the registers. - interrupt-controller : Identifies the node as an interrupt controller. - #interrupt-cells : Specifies the number of cells needed to encode an diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/csky,mpintc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/csky,mpintc.txt index ab921f1698fb..e13405355166 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/csky,mpintc.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/csky,mpintc.txt @@ -6,11 +6,16 @@ C-SKY Multi-processors Interrupt Controller is designed for ck807/ck810/ck860 SMP soc, and it also could be used in non-SMP system. Interrupt number definition: - 0-15 : software irq, and we use 15 as our IPI_IRQ. 16-31 : private irq, and we use 16 as the co-processor timer. 31-1024: common irq for soc ip. +Interrupt triger mode: (Defined in dt-bindings/interrupt-controller/irq.h) + IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH (default) + IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_LOW + IRQ_TYPE_EDGE_RISING + IRQ_TYPE_EDGE_FALLING + ============================= intc node bindings definition ============================= @@ -26,15 +31,22 @@ intc node bindings definition - #interrupt-cells Usage: required Value type: <u32> - Definition: must be <1> + Definition: <2> - interrupt-controller: Usage: required -Examples: +Examples: ("interrupts = <irq_num IRQ_TYPE_XXX>") --------- +#include <dt-bindings/interrupt-controller/irq.h> intc: interrupt-controller { compatible = "csky,mpintc"; - #interrupt-cells = <1>; + #interrupt-cells = <2>; interrupt-controller; }; + + device: device-example { + ... + interrupts = <34 IRQ_TYPE_EDGE_RISING>; + interrupt-parent = <&intc>; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/renesas,rza1-irqc.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/renesas,rza1-irqc.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..727b7e4cd6e0 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/interrupt-controller/renesas,rza1-irqc.txt @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +DT bindings for the Renesas RZ/A1 Interrupt Controller + +The RZ/A1 Interrupt Controller is a front-end for the GIC found on Renesas +RZ/A1 and RZ/A2 SoCs: + - IRQ sense select for 8 external interrupts, 1:1-mapped to 8 GIC SPI + interrupts, + - NMI edge select. + +Required properties: + - compatible: Must be "renesas,<soctype>-irqc", and "renesas,rza1-irqc" as + fallback. + Examples with soctypes are: + - "renesas,r7s72100-irqc" (RZ/A1H) + - "renesas,r7s9210-irqc" (RZ/A2M) + - #interrupt-cells: Must be 2 (an interrupt index and flags, as defined + in interrupts.txt in this directory) + - #address-cells: Must be zero + - interrupt-controller: Marks the device as an interrupt controller + - reg: Base address and length of the memory resource used by the interrupt + controller + - interrupt-map: Specifies the mapping from external interrupts to GIC + interrupts + - interrupt-map-mask: Must be <7 0> + +Example: + + irqc: interrupt-controller@fcfef800 { + compatible = "renesas,r7s72100-irqc", "renesas,rza1-irqc"; + #interrupt-cells = <2>; + #address-cells = <0>; + interrupt-controller; + reg = <0xfcfef800 0x6>; + interrupt-map = + <0 0 &gic GIC_SPI 0 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <1 0 &gic GIC_SPI 1 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <2 0 &gic GIC_SPI 2 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <3 0 &gic GIC_SPI 3 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <4 0 &gic GIC_SPI 4 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <5 0 &gic GIC_SPI 5 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <6 0 &gic GIC_SPI 6 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <7 0 &gic GIC_SPI 7 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; + interrupt-map-mask = <7 0>; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-lm36274.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-lm36274.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..39c230d59a4d --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-lm36274.txt @@ -0,0 +1,85 @@ +* Texas Instruments LM36274 4-Channel LCD Backlight Driver w/Integrated Bias + +The LM36274 is an integrated four-channel WLED driver and LCD bias supply. +The backlight boost provides the power to bias four parallel LED strings with +up to 29V total output voltage. The 11-bit LED current is programmable via +the I2C bus and/or controlled via a logic level PWM input from 60 uA to 30 mA. + +Parent device properties are documented in +Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt + +Regulator properties are documented in +Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/lm363x-regulator.txt + +Required backlight properties: + - compatible: + "ti,lm36274-backlight" + - reg : 0 + - #address-cells : 1 + - #size-cells : 0 + - led-sources : Indicates which LED strings will be enabled. + Values from 0-3, sources is 0 based so strings will be + source value + 1. + +Optional backlight properties: + - label : see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/common.txt + - linux,default-trigger : + see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/common.txt + +Example: + +HVLED string 1 and 3 are controlled by control bank A and HVLED 2 string is +controlled by control bank B. + +lm36274@11 { + compatible = "ti,lm36274"; + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + reg = <0x11>; + + enable-gpios = <&gpio1 28 GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH>; + + regulators { + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + compatible = "ti,lm363x-regulator"; + + enable-gpios = <&pioC 0 GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH>, + <&pioC 1 GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH>; + + vboost { + regulator-name = "lcd_boost"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <4000000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <7150000>; + regulator-always-on; + }; + + vpos { + regulator-name = "lcd_vpos"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <4000000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <6500000>; + }; + + vneg { + regulator-name = "lcd_vneg"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <4000000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <6500000>; + }; + }; + + backlight { + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + compatible = "ti,lm36274-backlight"; + + led@0 { + reg = <0>; + led-sources = <0 2>; + label = "white:backlight_cluster"; + linux,default-trigger = "backlight"; + }; + }; +}; + +For more product information please see the link below: +http://www.ti.com/lit/ds/symlink/lm36274.pdf diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-lm3697.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-lm3697.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..63992d732959 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-lm3697.txt @@ -0,0 +1,73 @@ +* Texas Instruments - LM3697 Highly Efficient White LED Driver + +The LM3697 11-bit LED driver provides high- +performance backlight dimming for 1, 2, or 3 series +LED strings while delivering up to 90% efficiency. + +This device is suitable for display and keypad lighting + +Required properties: + - compatible: + "ti,lm3697" + - reg : I2C slave address + - #address-cells : 1 + - #size-cells : 0 + +Optional properties: + - enable-gpios : GPIO pin to enable/disable the device + - vled-supply : LED supply + +Required child properties: + - reg : 0 - LED is Controlled by bank A + 1 - LED is Controlled by bank B + - led-sources : Indicates which HVLED string is associated to which + control bank. This is a zero based property so + HVLED1 = 0, HVLED2 = 1, HVLED3 = 2. + Additional information is contained + in Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/common.txt + +Optional child properties: + - ti,brightness-resolution - see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt + - ramp-up-us: see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt + - ramp-down-us: see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt + - label : see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/common.txt + - linux,default-trigger : + see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/common.txt + +Example: + +HVLED string 1 and 3 are controlled by control bank A and HVLED 2 string is +controlled by control bank B. + +led-controller@36 { + compatible = "ti,lm3697"; + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + reg = <0x36>; + + enable-gpios = <&gpio1 28 GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH>; + vled-supply = <&vbatt>; + + led@0 { + reg = <0>; + led-sources = <0 2>; + ti,brightness-resolution = <2047>; + ramp-up-us = <5000>; + ramp-down-us = <1000>; + label = "white:first_backlight_cluster"; + linux,default-trigger = "backlight"; + }; + + led@1 { + reg = <1>; + led-sources = <1>; + ti,brightness-resolution = <255>; + ramp-up-us = <500>; + ramp-down-us = <1000>; + label = "white:second_backlight_cluster"; + linux,default-trigger = "backlight"; + }; +} + +For more product information please see the link below: +http://www.ti.com/lit/ds/symlink/lm3697.pdf diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-spi-byte.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-spi-byte.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..28b6b2d9091e --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/leds-spi-byte.txt @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +* Single Byte SPI LED Device Driver. + +The driver can be used for controllers with a very simple SPI protocol: +- one LED is controlled by a single byte on MOSI +- the value of the byte gives the brightness between two values (lowest to + highest) +- no return value is necessary (no MISO signal) + +The value for lowest and highest brightness is dependent on the device and +therefore on the compatible string. + +Depending on the compatible string some special functions (like hardware +accelerated blinking) might can be supported too. + +The driver currently only supports one LED. The properties of the LED are +configured in a sub-node in the device node. + +Required properties: +- compatible: should be one of + * "ubnt,acb-spi-led" microcontroller (SONiX 8F26E611LA) based device + used for example in Ubiquiti airCube ISP + +Property rules described in Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-bus.txt +apply. + +LED sub-node properties: +- label: + see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/common.txt +- default-state: + see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/leds/common.txt + Only "on" and "off" are supported. + +Example: + +led-controller@0 { + compatible = "ubnt,acb-spi-led"; + reg = <0>; + spi-max-frequency = <100000>; + + led { + label = "white:status"; + default-state = "on"; + }; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/allegro.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/allegro.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..a92e2fbf26c9 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/allegro.txt @@ -0,0 +1,43 @@ +Device-tree bindings for the Allegro DVT video IP codecs present in the Xilinx +ZynqMP SoC. The IP core may either be a H.264/H.265 encoder or H.264/H.265 +decoder ip core. + +Each actual codec engines is controlled by a microcontroller (MCU). Host +software uses a provided mailbox interface to communicate with the MCU. The +MCU share an interrupt. + +Required properties: + - compatible: value should be one of the following + "allegro,al5e-1.1", "allegro,al5e": encoder IP core + "allegro,al5d-1.1", "allegro,al5d": decoder IP core + - reg: base and length of the memory mapped register region and base and + length of the memory mapped sram + - reg-names: must include "regs" and "sram" + - interrupts: shared interrupt from the MCUs to the processing system + - clocks: must contain an entry for each entry in clock-names + - clock-names: must include "core_clk", "mcu_clk", "m_axi_core_aclk", + "m_axi_mcu_aclk", "s_axi_lite_aclk" + +Example: + al5e: video-codec@a0009000 { + compatible = "allegro,al5e-1.1", "allegro,al5e"; + reg = <0 0xa0009000 0 0x1000>, + <0 0xa0000000 0 0x8000>; + reg-names = "regs", "sram"; + interrupts = <0 96 4>; + clocks = <&xlnx_vcu 0>, <&xlnx_vcu 1>, + <&clkc 71>, <&clkc 71>, <&clkc 71>; + clock-names = "core_clk", "mcu_clk", "m_axi_core_aclk", + "m_axi_mcu_aclk", "s_axi_lite_aclk" + }; + al5d: video-codec@a0029000 { + compatible = "allegro,al5d-1.1", "allegro,al5d"; + reg = <0 0xa0029000 0 0x1000>, + <0 0xa0020000 0 0x8000>; + reg-names = "regs", "sram"; + interrupts = <0 96 4>; + clocks = <&xlnx_vcu 2>, <&xlnx_vcu 3>, + <&clkc 71>, <&clkc 71>, <&clkc 71>; + clock-names = "core_clk", "mcu_clk", "m_axi_core_aclk", + "m_axi_mcu_aclk", "s_axi_lite_aclk" + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/amlogic,vdec.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/amlogic,vdec.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..aabdd01bcf32 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/amlogic,vdec.txt @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +Amlogic Video Decoder +================================ + +The video decoding IP lies within the DOS memory region, +except for the hardware bitstream parser that makes use of an undocumented +region. + +It makes use of the following blocks: + +- ESPARSER is a bitstream parser that outputs to a VIFIFO. Further VDEC blocks +then feed from this VIFIFO. +- VDEC_1 can decode MPEG-1, MPEG-2, MPEG-4 part 2, MJPEG, H.263, H.264, VC-1. +- VDEC_HEVC can decode HEVC and VP9. + +Both VDEC_1 and VDEC_HEVC share the "vdec" IRQ and as such cannot run +concurrently. + +Device Tree Bindings: +--------------------- + +VDEC: Video Decoder +-------------------------- + +Required properties: +- compatible: value should be different for each SoC family as : + - GXBB (S905) : "amlogic,gxbb-vdec" + - GXL (S905X, S905D) : "amlogic,gxl-vdec" + - GXM (S912) : "amlogic,gxm-vdec" +- reg: base address and size of he following memory-mapped regions : + - dos + - esparser +- reg-names: should contain the names of the previous memory regions +- interrupts: should contain the following IRQs: + - vdec + - esparser +- interrupt-names: should contain the names of the previous interrupts +- amlogic,ao-sysctrl: should point to the AOBUS sysctrl node +- amlogic,canvas: should point to a canvas provider node +- clocks: should contain the following clocks : + - dos_parser + - dos + - vdec_1 + - vdec_hevc +- clock-names: should contain the names of the previous clocks +- resets: should contain the parser reset +- reset-names: should be "esparser" + +Example: + +vdec: video-decoder@c8820000 { + compatible = "amlogic,gxbb-vdec"; + reg = <0x0 0xc8820000 0x0 0x10000>, + <0x0 0xc110a580 0x0 0xe4>; + reg-names = "dos", "esparser"; + + interrupts = <GIC_SPI 44 IRQ_TYPE_EDGE_RISING>, + <GIC_SPI 32 IRQ_TYPE_EDGE_RISING>; + interrupt-names = "vdec", "esparser"; + + amlogic,ao-sysctrl = <&sysctrl_AO>; + amlogic,canvas = <&canvas>; + + clocks = <&clkc CLKID_DOS_PARSER>, + <&clkc CLKID_DOS>, + <&clkc CLKID_VDEC_1>, + <&clkc CLKID_VDEC_HEVC>; + clock-names = "dos_parser", "dos", "vdec_1", "vdec_hevc"; + + resets = <&reset RESET_PARSER>; + reset-names = "esparser"; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/imx7-csi.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/imx7-csi.txt index 3c07bc676bc3..443aef07356e 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/imx7-csi.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/imx7-csi.txt @@ -14,8 +14,7 @@ Required properties: - interrupts : should contain CSI interrupt; - clocks : list of clock specifiers, see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/clock/clock-bindings.txt for details; -- clock-names : must contain "axi", "mclk" and "dcic" entries, matching - entries in the clock property; +- clock-names : must contain "mclk"; The device node shall contain one 'port' child node with one child 'endpoint' node, according to the bindings defined in: @@ -32,10 +31,8 @@ example: compatible = "fsl,imx7-csi"; reg = <0x30710000 0x10000>; interrupts = <GIC_SPI 7 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; - clocks = <&clks IMX7D_CLK_DUMMY>, - <&clks IMX7D_CSI_MCLK_ROOT_CLK>, - <&clks IMX7D_CLK_DUMMY>; - clock-names = "axi", "mclk", "dcic"; + clocks = <&clks IMX7D_CSI_MCLK_ROOT_CLK>; + clock-names = "mclk"; port { csi_from_csi_mux: endpoint { diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/marvell,mmp2-ccic.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/marvell,mmp2-ccic.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..7ec2c8c8a3b9 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/marvell,mmp2-ccic.txt @@ -0,0 +1,50 @@ +Marvell MMP2 camera host interface + +Required properties: + - compatible: Should be "marvell,mmp2-ccic". + - reg: Register base and size. + - interrupts: The interrupt number. + - #clock-cells: Must be 0. + +Optional properties: + - clocks: Reference to the input clock as specified by + Documentation/devicetree/bindings/clock/clock-bindings.txt. + - clock-names: Names of the clocks used; "axi" for the AXI bus interface, + "func" for the peripheral clock and "phy" for the parallel + video bus interface. + - clock-output-names: Optional clock source for sensors. Shall be "mclk". + +Required subnodes: + - port: The parallel bus interface port with a single endpoint linked to + the sensor's endpoint as described in + Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/video-interfaces.txt. + +Required endpoint properties: + - bus-type: data bus type, <5> or <6> for Parallel or Bt.656 respectively + - pclk-sample: pixel clock polarity + - hsync-active: horizontal synchronization polarity (only required for + parallel bus) + - vsync-active: vertical synchronization polarity (only required for + parallel bus) + +Example: + + camera0: camera@d420a000 { + compatible = "marvell,mmp2-ccic"; + reg = <0xd420a000 0x800>; + interrupts = <42>; + clocks = <&soc_clocks MMP2_CLK_CCIC0>; + clock-names = "axi"; + #clock-cells = <0>; + clock-output-names = "mclk"; + + port { + camera0_0: endpoint { + remote-endpoint = <&ov7670_0>; + bus-type = <5>; /* Parallel */ + hsync-active = <1>; /* Active high */ + vsync-active = <1>; /* Active high */ + pclk-sample = <0>; /* Falling */ + }; + }; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/st,stm32-dcmi.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/st,stm32-dcmi.txt index 249790a93017..3122ded82eb4 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/st,stm32-dcmi.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/st,stm32-dcmi.txt @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ Required properties: - clock-names: must contain "mclk", which is the DCMI peripherial clock - pinctrl: the pincontrol settings to configure muxing properly for pins that connect to DCMI device. - See Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pinctrl/st,stm32-pinctrl.txt. + See Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pinctrl/st,stm32-pinctrl.yaml. - dmas: phandle to DMA controller node, see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/stm32-dma.txt - dma-names: must contain "tx", which is the transmit channel from DCMI to DMA diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/sun6i-csi.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/sun6i-csi.txt index 0dd540bb03db..a2e3e56f0257 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/sun6i-csi.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/media/sun6i-csi.txt @@ -6,6 +6,7 @@ Allwinner V3s SoC features a CSI module(CSI1) with parallel interface. Required properties: - compatible: value must be one of: * "allwinner,sun6i-a31-csi" + * "allwinner,sun8i-a83t-csi" * "allwinner,sun8i-h3-csi" * "allwinner,sun8i-v3s-csi" * "allwinner,sun50i-a64-csi" diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/atmel-usart.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/atmel-usart.txt index 7f0cd72f47d2..699fd3c9ace8 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/atmel-usart.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/atmel-usart.txt @@ -17,17 +17,24 @@ Required properties for USART in SPI mode: - cs-gpios: chipselects (internal cs not supported) - atmel,usart-mode : Must be <AT91_USART_MODE_SPI> (found in dt-bindings/mfd/at91-usart.h) +Optional properties in serial and SPI mode: +- dma bindings for dma transfer: + - dmas: DMA specifier, consisting of a phandle to DMA controller node, + memory peripheral interface and USART DMA channel ID, FIFO configuration. + The order of DMA channels is fixed. The first DMA channel must be TX + associated channel and the second one must be RX associated channel. + Refer to dma.txt and atmel-dma.txt for details. + - dma-names: "tx" for TX channel. + "rx" for RX channel. + The order of dma-names is also fixed. The first name must be "tx" + and the second one must be "rx" as in the examples below. + Optional properties in serial mode: - atmel,use-dma-rx: use of PDC or DMA for receiving data - atmel,use-dma-tx: use of PDC or DMA for transmitting data - {rts,cts,dtr,dsr,rng,dcd}-gpios: specify a GPIO for RTS/CTS/DTR/DSR/RI/DCD line respectively. It will use specified PIO instead of the peripheral function pin for the USART feature. If unsure, don't specify this property. -- add dma bindings for dma transfer: - - dmas: DMA specifier, consisting of a phandle to DMA controller node, - memory peripheral interface and USART DMA channel ID, FIFO configuration. - Refer to dma.txt and atmel-dma.txt for details. - - dma-names: "rx" for RX channel, "tx" for TX channel. - atmel,fifo-size: maximum number of data the RX and TX FIFOs can store for FIFO capable USARTs. - rs485-rts-delay, rs485-rx-during-tx, linux,rs485-enabled-at-boot-time: see rs485.txt @@ -81,5 +88,8 @@ Example: interrupts = <12 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH 5>; clocks = <&usart0_clk>; clock-names = "usart"; + dmas = <&dma0 2 AT91_DMA_CFG_PER_ID(3)>, + <&dma0 2 (AT91_DMA_CFG_PER_ID(4) | AT91_DMA_CFG_FIFOCFG_ASAP)>; + dma-names = "tx", "rx"; cs-gpios = <&pioB 3 0>; }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt index 86ca786d54fc..2296b8f24de4 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/ti-lmu.txt @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ TI LMU driver supports lighting devices below. LM3632 Backlight and regulator LM3633 Backlight, LED and fault monitor LM3695 Backlight - LM3697 Backlight and fault monitor + LM36274 Backlight and regulator Required properties: - compatible: Should be one of: @@ -16,15 +16,32 @@ Required properties: "ti,lm3632" "ti,lm3633" "ti,lm3695" - "ti,lm3697" + "ti,lm36274" - reg: I2C slave address. 0x11 for LM3632 0x29 for LM3631 - 0x36 for LM3633, LM3697 + 0x36 for LM3633 0x63 for LM3695 + 0x11 for LM36274 -Optional property: +Optional properties: - enable-gpios: A GPIO specifier for hardware enable pin. + - ramp-up-us: Current ramping from one brightness level to + the a higher brightness level. + Range from 2048 us - 117.44 s + - ramp-down-us: Current ramping from one brightness level to + the a lower brightness level. + Range from 2048 us - 117.44 s + - ti,brightness-resolution - This determines whether to use 8 bit brightness + mode or 11 bit brightness mode. If this value is + not set the device is defaulted to the preferred + 8bit brightness mode per 7.3.4.1 of the data + sheet. This setting can either be in the parent + node or as part of the LED child nodes. This + is determined by the part itself if the strings + have a common brightness register or individual + brightness registers. + The values are 255 (8bit) or 2047 (11bit). Required node: - backlight: All LMU devices have backlight child nodes. @@ -35,14 +52,15 @@ Optional nodes: Required properties: - compatible: Should be one of: "ti,lm3633-fault-monitor" - "ti,lm3697-fault-monitor" - leds: LED properties for LM3633. Please refer to [2]. + LED properties for LM36274. Please refer to [4]. - regulators: Regulator properties for LM3631 and LM3632. Please refer to [3]. [1] ../leds/backlight/ti-lmu-backlight.txt [2] ../leds/leds-lm3633.txt [3] ../regulator/lm363x-regulator.txt +[4] ../leds/leds-lm36274.txt lm3631@29 { compatible = "ti,lm3631"; @@ -90,7 +108,7 @@ lm3631@29 { lcd_bl { led-sources = <0 1>; - ramp-up-msec = <300>; + ramp-up-us = <300000>; }; }; }; @@ -152,15 +170,15 @@ lm3633@36 { main { label = "main_lcd"; led-sources = <1 2>; - ramp-up-msec = <500>; - ramp-down-msec = <500>; + ramp-up-us = <500000>; + ramp-down-us = <500000>; }; front { label = "front_lcd"; led-sources = <0>; - ramp-up-msec = <1000>; - ramp-down-msec = <0>; + ramp-up-us = <1000000>; + ramp-down-us = <0>; }; }; @@ -201,23 +219,51 @@ lm3695@63 { }; }; -lm3697@36 { - compatible = "ti,lm3697"; - reg = <0x36>; +lm36274@11 { + compatible = "ti,lm36274"; + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + reg = <0x11>; enable-gpios = <&pioC 2 GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH>; + regulators { + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + compatible = "ti,lm363x-regulator"; - backlight { - compatible = "ti,lm3697-backlight"; + enable-gpios = <&pioC 0 GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH>, + <&pioC 1 GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH>; - lcd { - led-sources = <0 1 2>; - ramp-up-msec = <200>; - ramp-down-msec = <200>; + vboost { + regulator-name = "lcd_boost"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <4000000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <7150000>; + regulator-always-on; + }; + + vpos { + regulator-name = "lcd_vpos"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <4000000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <6500000>; + }; + + vneg { + regulator-name = "lcd_vneg"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <4000000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <6500000>; }; }; - fault-monitor { - compatible = "ti,lm3697-fault-monitor"; + backlight { + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + compatible = "ti,lm36274-backlight"; + + led@0 { + reg = <0>; + led-sources = <0 2>; + label = "white:backlight_cluster"; + linux,default-trigger = "backlight"; + }; }; }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/perf/fsl-imx-ddr.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/perf/fsl-imx-ddr.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..d77e3f26f9e6 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/perf/fsl-imx-ddr.txt @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +* Freescale(NXP) IMX8 DDR performance monitor + +Required properties: + +- compatible: should be one of: + "fsl,imx8-ddr-pmu" + "fsl,imx8m-ddr-pmu" + +- reg: physical address and size + +- interrupts: single interrupt + generated by the control block + +Example: + + ddr-pmu@5c020000 { + compatible = "fsl,imx8-ddr-pmu"; + reg = <0x5c020000 0x10000>; + interrupt-parent = <&gic>; + interrupts = <GIC_SPI 131 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/ingenic,jz47xx-pwm.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/ingenic,jz47xx-pwm.txt index 7d9d3f90641b..493bec80d59b 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/ingenic,jz47xx-pwm.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/ingenic,jz47xx-pwm.txt @@ -2,10 +2,7 @@ Ingenic JZ47xx PWM Controller ============================= Required properties: -- compatible: One of: - * "ingenic,jz4740-pwm" - * "ingenic,jz4770-pwm" - * "ingenic,jz4780-pwm" +- compatible: Should be "ingenic,jz4740-pwm" - #pwm-cells: Should be 3. See pwm.txt in this directory for a description of the cells format. - clocks : phandle to the external clock. diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-sifive.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-sifive.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..36447e3c9378 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-sifive.txt @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +SiFive PWM controller + +Unlike most other PWM controllers, the SiFive PWM controller currently only +supports one period for all channels in the PWM. All PWMs need to run at +the same period. The period also has significant restrictions on the values +it can achieve, which the driver rounds to the nearest achievable period. +PWM RTL that corresponds to the IP block version numbers can be found +here: + +https://github.com/sifive/sifive-blocks/tree/master/src/main/scala/devices/pwm + +Required properties: +- compatible: Should be "sifive,<chip>-pwm" and "sifive,pwm<version>". + Supported compatible strings are: "sifive,fu540-c000-pwm" for the SiFive + PWM v0 as integrated onto the SiFive FU540 chip, and "sifive,pwm0" for the + SiFive PWM v0 IP block with no chip integration tweaks. + Please refer to sifive-blocks-ip-versioning.txt for details. +- reg: physical base address and length of the controller's registers +- clocks: Should contain a clock identifier for the PWM's parent clock. +- #pwm-cells: Should be 3. See pwm.txt in this directory + for a description of the cell format. +- interrupts: one interrupt per PWM channel + +Examples: + +pwm: pwm@10020000 { + compatible = "sifive,fu540-c000-pwm", "sifive,pwm0"; + reg = <0x0 0x10020000 0x0 0x1000>; + clocks = <&tlclk>; + interrupt-parent = <&plic>; + interrupts = <42 43 44 45>; + #pwm-cells = <3>; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32-lp.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32-lp.txt index bd23302e84be..6521bc44a74e 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32-lp.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32-lp.txt @@ -11,8 +11,10 @@ Required parameters: bindings defined in pwm.txt. Optional properties: -- pinctrl-names: Set to "default". -- pinctrl-0: Phandle pointing to pin configuration node for PWM. +- pinctrl-names: Set to "default". An additional "sleep" state can be + defined to set pins in sleep state when in low power. +- pinctrl-n: Phandle(s) pointing to pin configuration node for PWM, + respectively for "default" and "sleep" states. Example: timer@40002400 { @@ -21,7 +23,8 @@ Example: pwm { compatible = "st,stm32-pwm-lp"; #pwm-cells = <3>; - pinctrl-names = "default"; + pinctrl-names = "default", "sleep"; pinctrl-0 = <&lppwm1_pins>; + pinctrl-1 = <&lppwm1_sleep_pins>; }; }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32.txt index 3e6d55018d7a..a8690bfa5e1f 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-stm32.txt @@ -8,6 +8,8 @@ Required parameters: - pinctrl-names: Set to "default". - pinctrl-0: List of phandles pointing to pin configuration nodes for PWM module. For Pinctrl properties see ../pinctrl/pinctrl-bindings.txt +- #pwm-cells: Should be set to 3. This PWM chip uses the default 3 cells + bindings defined in pwm.txt. Optional parameters: - st,breakinput: One or two <index level filter> to describe break input configurations. @@ -28,6 +30,7 @@ Example: pwm { compatible = "st,stm32-pwm"; + #pwm-cells = <3>; pinctrl-0 = <&pwm1_pins>; pinctrl-names = "default"; st,breakinput = <0 1 5>; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/arizona-regulator.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/arizona-regulator.txt index 443564d7784f..69bf41949b01 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/arizona-regulator.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/arizona-regulator.txt @@ -5,7 +5,8 @@ of analogue I/O. This document lists regulator specific bindings, see the primary binding document: - ../mfd/arizona.txt + For Wolfson Microelectronic Arizona codecs: ../mfd/arizona.txt + For Cirrus Logic Madera codecs: ../mfd/madera.txt Optional properties: - wlf,ldoena : GPIO specifier for the GPIO controlling LDOENA diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/fixed-regulator.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/fixed-regulator.yaml index d289c2f7455a..a650b457085d 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/fixed-regulator.yaml +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/fixed-regulator.yaml @@ -12,10 +12,13 @@ maintainers: description: Any property defined as part of the core regulator binding, defined in - regulator.txt, can also be used. However a fixed voltage regulator is + regulator.yaml, can also be used. However a fixed voltage regulator is expected to have the regulator-min-microvolt and regulator-max-microvolt to be the same. +allOf: + - $ref: "regulator.yaml#" + properties: compatible: const: regulator-fixed diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/gpio-regulator.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/gpio-regulator.txt deleted file mode 100644 index dd25e73b5d79..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/gpio-regulator.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,57 +0,0 @@ -GPIO controlled regulators - -Required properties: -- compatible : Must be "regulator-gpio". -- regulator-name : Defined in regulator.txt as optional, but required - here. -- gpios : Array of one or more GPIO pins used to select the - regulator voltage/current listed in "states". -- states : Selection of available voltages/currents provided by - this regulator and matching GPIO configurations to - achieve them. If there are no states in the "states" - array, use a fixed regulator instead. - -Optional properties: -- enable-gpios : GPIO used to enable/disable the regulator. - Warning, the GPIO phandle flags are ignored and the - GPIO polarity is controlled solely by the presence - of "enable-active-high" DT property. This is due to - compatibility with old DTs. -- enable-active-high : Polarity of "enable-gpio" GPIO is active HIGH. - Default is active LOW. -- gpios-states : On operating systems, that don't support reading back - gpio values in output mode (most notably linux), this - array provides the state of GPIO pins set when - requesting them from the gpio controller. Systems, - that are capable of preserving state when requesting - the lines, are free to ignore this property. - 0: LOW, 1: HIGH. Default is LOW if nothing else - is specified. -- startup-delay-us : Startup time in microseconds. -- regulator-type : Specifies what is being regulated, must be either - "voltage" or "current", defaults to voltage. - -Any property defined as part of the core regulator binding defined in -regulator.txt can also be used. - -Example: - - mmciv: gpio-regulator { - compatible = "regulator-gpio"; - - regulator-name = "mmci-gpio-supply"; - regulator-min-microvolt = <1800000>; - regulator-max-microvolt = <2600000>; - regulator-boot-on; - - enable-gpios = <&gpio0 23 0x4>; - gpios = <&gpio0 24 0x4 - &gpio0 25 0x4>; - states = <1800000 0x3 - 2200000 0x2 - 2600000 0x1 - 2900000 0x0>; - - startup-delay-us = <100000>; - enable-active-high; - }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/gpio-regulator.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/gpio-regulator.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..9d3b28417fb6 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/gpio-regulator.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,118 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/regulator/gpio-regulator.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: GPIO controlled regulators + +maintainers: + - Liam Girdwood <lgirdwood@gmail.com> + - Mark Brown <broonie@kernel.org> + +description: + Any property defined as part of the core regulator binding, defined in + regulator.txt, can also be used. + +allOf: + - $ref: "regulator.yaml#" + +properties: + compatible: + const: regulator-gpio + + regulator-name: true + + enable-gpios: + description: GPIO to use to enable/disable the regulator. + Warning, the GPIO phandle flags are ignored and the GPIO polarity is + controlled solely by the presence of "enable-active-high" DT property. + This is due to compatibility with old DTs. + maxItems: 1 + + gpios: + description: Array of one or more GPIO pins used to select the regulator + voltage/current listed in "states". + minItems: 1 + maxItems: 8 # Should be enough... + + gpios-states: + description: | + On operating systems, that don't support reading back gpio values in + output mode (most notably linux), this array provides the state of GPIO + pins set when requesting them from the gpio controller. Systems, that are + capable of preserving state when requesting the lines, are free to ignore + this property. + 0: LOW + 1: HIGH + Default is LOW if nothing else is specified. + allOf: + - $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32-array + - maxItems: 8 + items: + enum: [ 0, 1 ] + default: 0 + + states: + description: Selection of available voltages/currents provided by this + regulator and matching GPIO configurations to achieve them. If there are + no states in the "states" array, use a fixed regulator instead. + allOf: + - $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32-matrix + - maxItems: 8 + items: + items: + - description: Voltage in microvolts + - description: GPIO group state value + + startup-delay-us: + description: startup time in microseconds + + enable-active-high: + description: Polarity of "enable-gpio" GPIO is active HIGH. Default is + active LOW. + type: boolean + + gpio-open-drain: + description: + GPIO is open drain type. If this property is missing then default + assumption is false. + type: boolean + + regulator-type: + description: Specifies what is being regulated. + allOf: + - $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/string + - enum: + - voltage + - current + default: voltage + +required: + - compatible + - regulator-name + - gpios + - states + +examples: + - | + gpio-regulator { + compatible = "regulator-gpio"; + + regulator-name = "mmci-gpio-supply"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <1800000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <2600000>; + regulator-boot-on; + + enable-gpios = <&gpio0 23 0x4>; + gpios = <&gpio0 24 0x4 + &gpio0 25 0x4>; + states = <1800000 0x3>, + <2200000 0x2>, + <2600000 0x1>, + <2900000 0x0>; + + startup-delay-us = <100000>; + enable-active-high; + }; +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/max8660.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/max8660.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 8ba994d8a142..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/max8660.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,47 +0,0 @@ -Maxim MAX8660 voltage regulator - -Required properties: -- compatible: must be one of "maxim,max8660", "maxim,max8661" -- reg: I2C slave address, usually 0x34 -- any required generic properties defined in regulator.txt - -Example: - - i2c_master { - max8660@34 { - compatible = "maxim,max8660"; - reg = <0x34>; - - regulators { - regulator@0 { - regulator-compatible= "V3(DCDC)"; - regulator-min-microvolt = <725000>; - regulator-max-microvolt = <1800000>; - }; - - regulator@1 { - regulator-compatible= "V4(DCDC)"; - regulator-min-microvolt = <725000>; - regulator-max-microvolt = <1800000>; - }; - - regulator@2 { - regulator-compatible= "V5(LDO)"; - regulator-min-microvolt = <1700000>; - regulator-max-microvolt = <2000000>; - }; - - regulator@3 { - regulator-compatible= "V6(LDO)"; - regulator-min-microvolt = <1800000>; - regulator-max-microvolt = <3300000>; - }; - - regulator@4 { - regulator-compatible= "V7(LDO)"; - regulator-min-microvolt = <1800000>; - regulator-max-microvolt = <3300000>; - }; - }; - }; - }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/max8660.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/max8660.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..9c038698f880 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/max8660.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/regulator/max8660.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: Maxim MAX8660 voltage regulator + +maintainers: + - Daniel Mack <zonque@gmail.com> + +properties: + $nodename: + pattern: "pmic@[0-9a-f]{1,2}" + compatible: + enum: + - maxim,max8660 + - maxim,max8661 + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + + regulators: + type: object + + patternProperties: + "regulator-.+": + $ref: "regulator.yaml#" + + additionalProperties: false + +additionalProperties: false + +examples: + - | + i2c { + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + + pmic@34 { + compatible = "maxim,max8660"; + reg = <0x34>; + + regulators { + regulator-V3 { + regulator-compatible= "V3(DCDC)"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <725000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <1800000>; + }; + + regulator-V4 { + regulator-compatible= "V4(DCDC)"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <725000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <1800000>; + }; + + regulator-V5 { + regulator-compatible= "V5(LDO)"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <1700000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <2000000>; + }; + + regulator-V6 { + regulator-compatible= "V6(LDO)"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <1800000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <3300000>; + }; + + regulator-V7 { + regulator-compatible= "V7(LDO)"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <1800000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <3300000>; + }; + }; + }; + }; +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/qcom,spmi-regulator.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/qcom,spmi-regulator.txt index 406f2e570c50..430b8622bda1 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/qcom,spmi-regulator.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/qcom,spmi-regulator.txt @@ -4,11 +4,13 @@ Qualcomm SPMI Regulators Usage: required Value type: <string> Definition: must be one of: + "qcom,pm8005-regulators" "qcom,pm8841-regulators" "qcom,pm8916-regulators" "qcom,pm8941-regulators" "qcom,pm8994-regulators" "qcom,pmi8994-regulators" + "qcom,pms405-regulators" - interrupts: Usage: optional @@ -110,6 +112,23 @@ Qualcomm SPMI Regulators Definition: Reference to regulator supplying the input pin, as described in the data sheet. +- vdd_l1_l2-supply: +- vdd_l3_l8-supply: +- vdd_l4-supply: +- vdd_l5_l6-supply: +- vdd_l10_l11_l12_l13-supply: +- vdd_l7-supply: +- vdd_l9-supply: +- vdd_s1-supply: +- vdd_s2-supply: +- vdd_s3-supply: +- vdd_s4-supply: +- vdd_s5-supply + Usage: optional (pms405 only) + Value type: <phandle> + Definition: Reference to regulator supplying the input pin, as + described in the data sheet. + - qcom,saw-reg: Usage: optional Value type: <phandle> @@ -120,6 +139,9 @@ The regulator node houses sub-nodes for each regulator within the device. Each sub-node is identified using the node's name, with valid values listed for each of the PMICs below. +pm8005: + s1, s2, s3, s4 + pm8841: s1, s2, s3, s4, s5, s6, s7, s8 diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.txt index 0a3f087d5844..487ccd8370b3 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.txt @@ -1,139 +1 @@ -Voltage/Current Regulators - -Optional properties: -- regulator-name: A string used as a descriptive name for regulator outputs -- regulator-min-microvolt: smallest voltage consumers may set -- regulator-max-microvolt: largest voltage consumers may set -- regulator-microvolt-offset: Offset applied to voltages to compensate for voltage drops -- regulator-min-microamp: smallest current consumers may set -- regulator-max-microamp: largest current consumers may set -- regulator-input-current-limit-microamp: maximum input current regulator allows -- regulator-always-on: boolean, regulator should never be disabled -- regulator-boot-on: bootloader/firmware enabled regulator -- regulator-allow-bypass: allow the regulator to go into bypass mode -- regulator-allow-set-load: allow the regulator performance level to be configured -- <name>-supply: phandle to the parent supply/regulator node -- regulator-ramp-delay: ramp delay for regulator(in uV/us) - For hardware which supports disabling ramp rate, it should be explicitly - initialised to zero (regulator-ramp-delay = <0>) for disabling ramp delay. -- regulator-enable-ramp-delay: The time taken, in microseconds, for the supply - rail to reach the target voltage, plus/minus whatever tolerance the board - design requires. This property describes the total system ramp time - required due to the combination of internal ramping of the regulator itself, - and board design issues such as trace capacitance and load on the supply. -- regulator-settling-time-us: Settling time, in microseconds, for voltage - change if regulator have the constant time for any level voltage change. - This is useful when regulator have exponential voltage change. -- regulator-settling-time-up-us: Settling time, in microseconds, for voltage - increase if the regulator needs a constant time to settle after voltage - increases of any level. This is useful for regulators with exponential - voltage changes. -- regulator-settling-time-down-us: Settling time, in microseconds, for voltage - decrease if the regulator needs a constant time to settle after voltage - decreases of any level. This is useful for regulators with exponential - voltage changes. -- regulator-soft-start: Enable soft start so that voltage ramps slowly -- regulator-state-standby sub-root node for Standby mode - : equivalent with standby Linux sleep state, which provides energy savings - with a relatively quick transition back time. -- regulator-state-mem sub-root node for Suspend-to-RAM mode - : suspend to memory, the device goes to sleep, but all data stored in memory, - only some external interrupt can wake the device. -- regulator-state-disk sub-root node for Suspend-to-DISK mode - : suspend to disk, this state operates similarly to Suspend-to-RAM, - but includes a final step of writing memory contents to disk. -- regulator-state-[mem/disk/standby] node has following common properties: - - regulator-on-in-suspend: regulator should be on in suspend state. - - regulator-off-in-suspend: regulator should be off in suspend state. - - regulator-suspend-min-microvolt: minimum voltage may be set in - suspend state. - - regulator-suspend-max-microvolt: maximum voltage may be set in - suspend state. - - regulator-suspend-microvolt: the default voltage which regulator - would be set in suspend. This property is now deprecated, instead - setting voltage for suspend mode via the API which regulator - driver provides is recommended. - - regulator-changeable-in-suspend: whether the default voltage and - the regulator on/off in suspend can be changed in runtime. - - regulator-mode: operating mode in the given suspend state. - The set of possible operating modes depends on the capabilities of - every hardware so the valid modes are documented on each regulator - device tree binding document. -- regulator-initial-mode: initial operating mode. The set of possible operating - modes depends on the capabilities of every hardware so each device binding - documentation explains which values the regulator supports. -- regulator-allowed-modes: list of operating modes that software is allowed to - configure for the regulator at run-time. Elements may be specified in any - order. The set of possible operating modes depends on the capabilities of - every hardware so each device binding document explains which values the - regulator supports. -- regulator-system-load: Load in uA present on regulator that is not captured by - any consumer request. -- regulator-pull-down: Enable pull down resistor when the regulator is disabled. -- regulator-over-current-protection: Enable over current protection. -- regulator-active-discharge: tristate, enable/disable active discharge of - regulators. The values are: - 0: Disable active discharge. - 1: Enable active discharge. - Absence of this property will leave configuration to default. -- regulator-coupled-with: Regulators with which the regulator - is coupled. The linkage is 2-way - all coupled regulators should be linked - with each other. A regulator should not be coupled with its supplier. -- regulator-coupled-max-spread: Array of maximum spread between voltages of - coupled regulators in microvolts, each value in the array relates to the - corresponding couple specified by the regulator-coupled-with property. -- regulator-max-step-microvolt: Maximum difference between current and target - voltages that can be changed safely in a single step. - -Deprecated properties: -- regulator-compatible: If a regulator chip contains multiple - regulators, and if the chip's binding contains a child node that - describes each regulator, then this property indicates which regulator - this child node is intended to configure. If this property is missing, - the node's name will be used instead. - -Example: - - xyzreg: regulator@0 { - regulator-min-microvolt = <1000000>; - regulator-max-microvolt = <2500000>; - regulator-always-on; - vin-supply = <&vin>; - - regulator-state-mem { - regulator-on-in-suspend; - }; - }; - -Regulator Consumers: -Consumer nodes can reference one or more of its supplies/ -regulators using the below bindings. - -- <name>-supply: phandle to the regulator node - -These are the same bindings that a regulator in the above -example used to reference its own supply, in which case -its just seen as a special case of a regulator being a -consumer itself. - -Example of a consumer device node (mmc) referencing two -regulators (twl_reg1 and twl_reg2), - - twl_reg1: regulator@0 { - ... - ... - ... - }; - - twl_reg2: regulator@1 { - ... - ... - ... - }; - - mmc: mmc@0 { - ... - ... - vmmc-supply = <&twl_reg1>; - vmmcaux-supply = <&twl_reg2>; - }; +This file has moved to regulator.yaml. diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..02c3043ce419 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,200 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/regulator/regulator.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: Voltage/Current Regulators + +maintainers: + - Liam Girdwood <lgirdwood@gmail.com> + - Mark Brown <broonie@kernel.org> + +properties: + regulator-name: + description: A string used as a descriptive name for regulator outputs + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/string" + + regulator-min-microvolt: + description: smallest voltage consumers may set + + regulator-max-microvolt: + description: largest voltage consumers may set + + regulator-microvolt-offset: + description: Offset applied to voltages to compensate for voltage drops + + regulator-min-microamp: + description: smallest current consumers may set + + regulator-max-microamp: + description: largest current consumers may set + + regulator-input-current-limit-microamp: + description: maximum input current regulator allows + + regulator-always-on: + description: boolean, regulator should never be disabled + type: boolean + + regulator-boot-on: + description: bootloader/firmware enabled regulator + type: boolean + + regulator-allow-bypass: + description: allow the regulator to go into bypass mode + type: boolean + + regulator-allow-set-load: + description: allow the regulator performance level to be configured + type: boolean + + regulator-ramp-delay: + description: ramp delay for regulator(in uV/us) For hardware which supports + disabling ramp rate, it should be explicitly initialised to zero (regulator-ramp-delay + = <0>) for disabling ramp delay. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + regulator-enable-ramp-delay: + description: The time taken, in microseconds, for the supply rail to + reach the target voltage, plus/minus whatever tolerance the board + design requires. This property describes the total system ramp time + required due to the combination of internal ramping of the regulator + itself, and board design issues such as trace capacitance and load + on the supply. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + regulator-settling-time-us: + description: Settling time, in microseconds, for voltage change if regulator + have the constant time for any level voltage change. This is useful + when regulator have exponential voltage change. + + regulator-settling-time-up-us: + description: Settling time, in microseconds, for voltage increase if + the regulator needs a constant time to settle after voltage increases + of any level. This is useful for regulators with exponential voltage + changes. + + regulator-settling-time-down-us: + description: Settling time, in microseconds, for voltage decrease if + the regulator needs a constant time to settle after voltage decreases + of any level. This is useful for regulators with exponential voltage + changes. + + regulator-soft-start: + description: Enable soft start so that voltage ramps slowly + type: boolean + + regulator-initial-mode: + description: initial operating mode. The set of possible operating modes + depends on the capabilities of every hardware so each device binding + documentation explains which values the regulator supports. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + regulator-allowed-modes: + description: list of operating modes that software is allowed to configure + for the regulator at run-time. Elements may be specified in any order. + The set of possible operating modes depends on the capabilities of + every hardware so each device binding document explains which values + the regulator supports. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32-array" + + regulator-system-load: + description: Load in uA present on regulator that is not captured by + any consumer request. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + regulator-pull-down: + description: Enable pull down resistor when the regulator is disabled. + type: boolean + + regulator-over-current-protection: + description: Enable over current protection. + type: boolean + + regulator-active-discharge: + description: | + tristate, enable/disable active discharge of regulators. The values are: + 0: Disable active discharge. + 1: Enable active discharge. + Absence of this property will leave configuration to default. + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - enum: [ 0, 1 ] + + regulator-coupled-with: + description: Regulators with which the regulator is coupled. The linkage + is 2-way - all coupled regulators should be linked with each other. + A regulator should not be coupled with its supplier. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/phandle-array" + + regulator-coupled-max-spread: + description: Array of maximum spread between voltages of coupled regulators + in microvolts, each value in the array relates to the corresponding + couple specified by the regulator-coupled-with property. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + regulator-max-step-microvolt: + description: Maximum difference between current and target voltages + that can be changed safely in a single step. + +patternProperties: + ".*-supply$": + description: Input supply phandle(s) for this node + + regulator-state-(standby|mem|disk): + type: object + description: + sub-nodes for regulator state in Standby, Suspend-to-RAM, and + Suspend-to-DISK modes. Equivalent with standby, mem, and disk Linux + sleep states. + + properties: + regulator-on-in-suspend: + description: regulator should be on in suspend state. + type: boolean + + regulator-off-in-suspend: + description: regulator should be off in suspend state. + type: boolean + + regulator-suspend-min-microvolt: + description: minimum voltage may be set in suspend state. + + regulator-suspend-max-microvolt: + description: maximum voltage may be set in suspend state. + + regulator-suspend-microvolt: + description: the default voltage which regulator would be set in + suspend. This property is now deprecated, instead setting voltage + for suspend mode via the API which regulator driver provides is + recommended. + + regulator-changeable-in-suspend: + description: whether the default voltage and the regulator on/off + in suspend can be changed in runtime. + type: boolean + + regulator-mode: + description: operating mode in the given suspend state. The set + of possible operating modes depends on the capabilities of every + hardware so the valid modes are documented on each regulator device + tree binding document. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + additionalProperties: false + +examples: + - | + xyzreg: regulator@0 { + regulator-min-microvolt = <1000000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <2500000>; + regulator-always-on; + vin-supply = <&vin>; + + regulator-state-mem { + regulator-on-in-suspend; + }; + }; + +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/slg51000.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/slg51000.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..aa0733e49b90 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/slg51000.txt @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +* Dialog Semiconductor SLG51000 Voltage Regulator + +Required properties: +- compatible : Should be "dlg,slg51000" for SLG51000 +- reg : Specifies the I2C slave address. +- xxx-supply: Input voltage supply regulator for ldo3 to ldo7. + These entries are required if regulators are enabled for a device. + An absence of these properties can cause the regulator registration to fail. + If some of input supply is powered through battery or always-on supply then + also it is required to have these parameters with proper node handle of always + on power supply. + vin3-supply: Input supply for ldo3 + vin4-supply: Input supply for ldo4 + vin5-supply: Input supply for ldo5 + vin6-supply: Input supply for ldo6 + vin7-supply: Input supply for ldo7 + +Optional properties: +- interrupt-parent : Specifies the reference to the interrupt controller. +- interrupts : IRQ line information. +- dlg,cs-gpios : Specify a valid GPIO for chip select + +Sub-nodes: +- regulators : This node defines the settings for the regulators. + The content of the sub-node is defined by the standard binding + for regulators; see regulator.txt. + + The SLG51000 regulators are bound using their names listed below: + ldo1 + ldo2 + ldo3 + ldo4 + ldo5 + ldo6 + ldo7 + +Optional properties for regulators: +- enable-gpios : Specify a valid GPIO for platform control of the regulator. + +Example: + pmic: slg51000@75 { + compatible = "dlg,slg51000"; + reg = <0x75>; + + regulators { + ldo1 { + regulator-name = "ldo1"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <2400000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <3300000>; + }; + + ldo2 { + regulator-name = "ldo2"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <2400000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <3300000>; + }; + + ldo3 { + regulator-name = "ldo3"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <1200000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <3750000>; + }; + + ldo4 { + regulator-name = "ldo4"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <1200000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <3750000>; + }; + + ldo5 { + regulator-name = "ldo5"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <500000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <1200000>; + }; + + ldo6 { + regulator-name = "ldo6"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <500000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <1200000>; + }; + + ldo7 { + regulator-name = "ldo7"; + regulator-min-microvolt = <1200000>; + regulator-max-microvolt = <3750000>; + }; + }; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/st,stm32-booster.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/st,stm32-booster.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..479ad4c8758e --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/st,stm32-booster.txt @@ -0,0 +1,18 @@ +STM32 BOOSTER - Booster for ADC analog input switches + +Some STM32 devices embed a 3.3V booster supplied by Vdda, that can be used +to supply ADC analog input switches. + +Required properties: +- compatible: Should be one of: + "st,stm32h7-booster" + "st,stm32mp1-booster" +- st,syscfg: Phandle to system configuration controller. +- vdda-supply: Phandle to the vdda input analog voltage. + +Example: + booster: regulator-booster { + compatible = "st,stm32mp1-booster"; + st,syscfg = <&syscfg>; + vdda-supply = <&vdda>; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rng/brcm,iproc-rng200.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rng/brcm,iproc-rng200.txt index 0014da9145af..c223e54452da 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rng/brcm,iproc-rng200.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/rng/brcm,iproc-rng200.txt @@ -2,6 +2,7 @@ HWRNG support for the iproc-rng200 driver Required properties: - compatible : Must be one of: + "brcm,bcm7211-rng200" "brcm,bcm7278-rng200" "brcm,iproc-rng200" - reg : base address and size of control register block diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..eb3992138eec --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,132 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: (GPL-2.0+ OR BSD-2-Clause) +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: Allwinner A10 I2S Controller Device Tree Bindings + +maintainers: + - Chen-Yu Tsai <wens@csie.org> + - Maxime Ripard <maxime.ripard@bootlin.com> + +properties: + "#sound-dai-cells": + const: 0 + + compatible: + oneOf: + - const: allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s + - const: allwinner,sun6i-a31-i2s + - const: allwinner,sun8i-a83t-i2s + - const: allwinner,sun8i-h3-i2s + - const: allwinner,sun50i-a64-codec-i2s + - items: + - const: allwinner,sun50i-a64-i2s + - const: allwinner,sun8i-h3-i2s + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + + interrupts: + maxItems: 1 + + clocks: + items: + - description: Bus Clock + - description: Module Clock + + clock-names: + items: + - const: apb + - const: mod + + # Even though it only applies to subschemas under the conditionals, + # not listing them here will trigger a warning because of the + # additionalsProperties set to false. + dmas: true + dma-names: true + resets: + maxItems: 1 + +allOf: + - if: + properties: + compatible: + contains: + enum: + - allwinner,sun6i-a31-i2s + - allwinner,sun8i-a83t-i2s + - allwinner,sun8i-h3-i2s + - allwinner,sun50i-a64-codec-i2s + + then: + required: + - resets + + - if: + properties: + compatible: + contains: + const: allwinner,sun8i-a83t-i2s + + then: + properties: + dmas: + minItems: 1 + maxItems: 2 + items: + - description: RX DMA Channel + - description: TX DMA Channel + description: + Some controllers cannot receive but can only transmit + data. In such a case, the RX DMA channel is to be omitted. + + dma-names: + oneOf: + - items: + - const: rx + - const: tx + - const: tx + description: + Some controllers cannot receive but can only transmit + data. In such a case, the RX name is to be omitted. + + else: + properties: + dmas: + items: + - description: RX DMA Channel + - description: TX DMA Channel + + dma-names: + items: + - const: rx + - const: tx + +required: + - "#sound-dai-cells" + - compatible + - reg + - interrupts + - clocks + - clock-names + - dmas + - dma-names + +additionalProperties: false + +examples: + - | + i2s0: i2s@1c22400 { + #sound-dai-cells = <0>; + compatible = "allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s"; + reg = <0x01c22400 0x400>; + interrupts = <0 16 4>; + clocks = <&apb0_gates 3>, <&i2s0_clk>; + clock-names = "apb", "mod"; + dmas = <&dma 0 3>, <&dma 0 3>; + dma-names = "rx", "tx"; + }; + +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..e0284d8c3b63 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,120 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/sound/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: Allwinner A10 S/PDIF Controller Device Tree Bindings + +maintainers: + - Chen-Yu Tsai <wens@csie.org> + - Liam Girdwood <lgirdwood@gmail.com> + - Mark Brown <broonie@kernel.org> + - Maxime Ripard <maxime.ripard@bootlin.com> + +properties: + "#sound-dai-cells": + const: 0 + + compatible: + oneOf: + - const: allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif + - const: allwinner,sun6i-a31-spdif + - const: allwinner,sun8i-h3-spdif + - const: allwinner,sun50i-h6-spdif + - items: + - const: allwinner,sun8i-a83t-spdif + - const: allwinner,sun8i-h3-spdif + - items: + - const: allwinner,sun50i-a64-spdif + - const: allwinner,sun8i-h3-spdif + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + + interrupts: + maxItems: 1 + + clocks: + items: + - description: Bus Clock + - description: Module Clock + + clock-names: + items: + - const: apb + - const: spdif + + # Even though it only applies to subschemas under the conditionals, + # not listing them here will trigger a warning because of the + # additionalsProperties set to false. + dmas: true + dma-names: true + resets: + maxItems: 1 + +allOf: + - if: + properties: + compatible: + contains: + enum: + - allwinner,sun6i-a31-spdif + - allwinner,sun8i-h3-spdif + + then: + required: + - resets + + - if: + properties: + compatible: + contains: + const: allwinner,sun8i-h3-spdif + + then: + properties: + dmas: + description: TX DMA Channel + + dma-names: + const: tx + + else: + properties: + dmas: + items: + - description: RX DMA Channel + - description: TX DMA Channel + + dma-names: + items: + - const: rx + - const: tx + +required: + - "#sound-dai-cells" + - compatible + - reg + - interrupts + - clocks + - clock-names + - dmas + - dma-names + +additionalProperties: false + +examples: + - | + spdif: spdif@1c21000 { + #sound-dai-cells = <0>; + compatible = "allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif"; + reg = <0x01c21000 0x40>; + interrupts = <13>; + clocks = <&apb0_gates 1>, <&spdif_clk>; + clock-names = "apb", "spdif"; + dmas = <&dma 0 2>, <&dma 0 2>; + dma-names = "rx", "tx"; + }; + +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/amlogic,axg-tdm-formatters.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/amlogic,axg-tdm-formatters.txt index 3b94a715a0b9..8835a43edfbb 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/amlogic,axg-tdm-formatters.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/amlogic,axg-tdm-formatters.txt @@ -15,11 +15,15 @@ Required properties: * "lrclk" : sample clock * "lrclk_sel": sample clock input multiplexer -Example of TDMOUT_A on the A113 SoC: +Optional property: +- resets: phandle to the dedicated reset line of the tdm formatter. + +Example of TDMOUT_A on the S905X2 SoC: tdmout_a: audio-controller@500 { compatible = "amlogic,axg-tdmout"; reg = <0x0 0x500 0x0 0x40>; + resets = <&clkc_audio AUD_RESET_TDMOUT_A>; clocks = <&clkc_audio AUD_CLKID_TDMOUT_A>, <&clkc_audio AUD_CLKID_TDMOUT_A_SCLK>, <&clkc_audio AUD_CLKID_TDMOUT_A_SCLK_SEL>, diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/amlogic,g12a-tohdmitx.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/amlogic,g12a-tohdmitx.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..aa6c35570d31 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/amlogic,g12a-tohdmitx.txt @@ -0,0 +1,55 @@ +* Amlogic HDMI Tx control glue + +Required properties: +- compatible: "amlogic,g12a-tohdmitx" +- reg: physical base address of the controller and length of memory + mapped region. +- #sound-dai-cells: should be 1. + +Example on the S905X2 SoC: + +tohdmitx: audio-controller@744 { + compatible = "amlogic,g12a-tohdmitx"; + reg = <0x0 0x744 0x0 0x4>; + #sound-dai-cells = <1>; +}; + +Example of an 'amlogic,axg-sound-card': + +sound { + compatible = "amlogic,axg-sound-card"; + +[...] + + dai-link-x { + sound-dai = <&tdmif_a>; + dai-format = "i2s"; + dai-tdm-slot-tx-mask-0 = <1 1>; + + codec-0 { + sound-dai = <&tohdmitx TOHDMITX_I2S_IN_A>; + }; + + codec-1 { + sound-dai = <&external_dac>; + }; + }; + + dai-link-y { + sound-dai = <&tdmif_c>; + dai-format = "i2s"; + dai-tdm-slot-tx-mask-0 = <1 1>; + + codec { + sound-dai = <&tohdmitx TOHDMITX_I2S_IN_C>; + }; + }; + + dai-link-z { + sound-dai = <&tohdmitx TOHDMITX_I2S_OUT>; + + codec { + sound-dai = <&hdmi_tx>; + }; + }; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/cs42xx8.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/cs42xx8.txt index 8619a156d038..bbfe39347c20 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/cs42xx8.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/cs42xx8.txt @@ -14,6 +14,11 @@ Required properties: - VA-supply, VD-supply, VLS-supply, VLC-supply: power supplies for the device, as covered in Documentation/devicetree/bindings/regulator/regulator.txt +Optional properties: + + - reset-gpios : a GPIO spec to define which pin is connected to the chip's + !RESET pin + Example: cs42888: codec@48 { @@ -25,4 +30,5 @@ cs42888: codec@48 { VD-supply = <®_audio>; VLS-supply = <®_audio>; VLC-supply = <®_audio>; + reset-gpios = <&pca9557_b 1 GPIO_ACTIVE_LOW>; }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/davinci-mcasp-audio.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/davinci-mcasp-audio.txt index a58f79f5345c..c483dcec01f8 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/davinci-mcasp-audio.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/davinci-mcasp-audio.txt @@ -44,6 +44,9 @@ Optional properties: please refer to pinctrl-bindings.txt - fck_parent : Should contain a valid clock name which will be used as parent for the McASP fck +- auxclk-fs-ratio: When McASP is bus master indicates the ratio between AUCLK + and FS rate if applicable: + AUCLK rate = auxclk-fs-ratio * FS rate Optional GPIO support: If any McASP pin need to be used as GPIO then the McASP node must have: diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/madera.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/madera.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..5e669ce552f4 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/madera.txt @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +Cirrus Logic Madera class audio codecs + +This describes audio configuration bindings for these codecs. + +See also the core bindings for the parent MFD driver: +See Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mfd/madera.txt + +and defines for values used in these bindings: +include/dt-bindings/sound/madera.h + +These properties are all contained in the parent MFD node. + +Optional properties: + - cirrus,dmic-ref : Indicates how the MICBIAS pins have been externally + connected to DMICs on each input, one cell per input. + <IN1 IN2 IN3 ...> + A value of 0 indicates MICVDD and is the default, other values depend on the + codec: + For CS47L35 one of the CS47L35_DMIC_REF_xxx values + For all other codecs one of the MADERA_DMIC_REF_xxx values + Also see the datasheet for a description of the INn_DMIC_SUP field. + + - cirrus,inmode : A list of input mode settings for each input. A maximum of + 16 cells, with four cells per input in the order INnAL, INnAR INnBL INnBR. + For non-muxed inputs the first two cells for that input set the mode for + the left and right channel and the second two cells must be 0. + For muxed inputs the first two cells for that input set the mode of the + left and right A inputs and the second two cells set the mode of the left + and right B inputs. + Valid mode values are one of the MADERA_INMODE_xxx. If the array is shorter + than the number of inputs the unspecified inputs default to + MADERA_INMODE_DIFF. + + - cirrus,out-mono : Mono bit for each output, maximum of six cells if the + array is shorter outputs will be set to stereo. + + - cirrus,max-channels-clocked : Maximum number of channels that I2S clocks + will be generated for. Useful when clock master for systems where the I2S + bus has multiple data lines. + One cell for each AIF, use a value of zero for AIFs that should be handled + normally. + + - cirrus,pdm-fmt : PDM speaker data format, must contain 2 cells + (OUT5 and OUT6). See the PDM_SPKn_FMT field in the datasheet for a + description of this value. + The second cell is ignored for codecs that do not have OUT6. + + - cirrus,pdm-mute : PDM mute format, must contain 2 cells + (OUT5 and OUT6). See the PDM_SPKn_CTRL_1 register in the datasheet for a + description of this value. + The second cell is ignored for codecs that do not have OUT6. + +Example: + +cs47l35@0 { + compatible = "cirrus,cs47l35"; + + cirrus,dmic-ref = <0 0 CS47L35_DMIC_REF_MICBIAS1B 0>; + cirrus,inmode = < + MADERA_INMODE_DMIC MADERA_INMODE_DMIC /* IN1A digital */ + MADERA_INMODE_SE MADERA_INMODE_SE /* IN1B single-ended */ + MADERA_INMODE_DIFF MADERA_INMODE_DIFF /* IN2 differential */ + 0 0 /* not used on this codec */ + >; + cirrus,out-mono = <0 0 0 0 0 0>; + cirrus,max-channels-clocked = <2 0 0>; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/max98357a.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/max98357a.txt index 28645a2ff885..4bce14ce806f 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/max98357a.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/max98357a.txt @@ -9,6 +9,10 @@ Optional properties: - sdmode-gpios : GPIO specifier for the chip's SD_MODE pin. If this option is not specified then driver does not manage the pin state (e.g. chip is always on). +- sdmode-delay : specify delay time for SD_MODE pin. + If this option is specified, which means it's required i2s clocks + ready before SD_MODE is unmuted in order to avoid the speaker pop noise. + It's observed that 5ms is sufficient. Example: diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/rt1011.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/rt1011.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..35a23e60d679 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/rt1011.txt @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +RT1011 Mono Class D Audio Amplifier + +This device supports I2C only. + +Required properties: + +- compatible : "realtek,rt1011". + +- reg : The I2C address of the device. This I2C address decide by + two input pins (ASEL1 and ASEL2). + ------------------------------------- + | ASEL2 | ASEL1 | Address | + ------------------------------------- + | 0 | 0 | 0x38 | + ------------------------------------- + | 0 | 1 | 0x39 | + ------------------------------------- + | 1 | 0 | 0x3a | + ------------------------------------- + | 1 | 1 | 0x3b | + ------------------------------------- + +Pins on the device (for linking into audio routes) for RT1011: + + * SPO + +Example: + +rt1011: codec@38 { + compatible = "realtek,rt1011"; + reg = <0x38>; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/rt1308.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/rt1308.txt new file mode 100755 index 000000000000..2d46084afce4 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/rt1308.txt @@ -0,0 +1,17 @@ +RT1308 audio Amplifier + +This device supports I2C only. + +Required properties: + +- compatible : "realtek,rt1308". + +- reg : The I2C address of the device. + + +Example: + +rt1308: rt1308@10 { + compatible = "realtek,rt1308"; + reg = <0x10>; +}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-i2s.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-i2s.txt index 58c341300552..cbf24bcd1b8d 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-i2s.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-i2s.txt @@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ Required properties: See Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/stm32-dma.txt. - dma-names: Identifier for each DMA request line. Must be "tx" and "rx". - pinctrl-names: should contain only value "default" - - pinctrl-0: see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pinctrl/st,stm32-pinctrl.txt + - pinctrl-0: see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pinctrl/st,stm32-pinctrl.yaml Optional properties: - resets: Reference to a reset controller asserting the reset controller diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-sai.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-sai.txt index 3f4467ff0aa2..944743dd9212 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-sai.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/st,stm32-sai.txt @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ SAI subnodes required properties: "tx": if sai sub-block is configured as playback DAI "rx": if sai sub-block is configured as capture DAI - pinctrl-names: should contain only value "default" - - pinctrl-0: see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pinctrl/st,stm32-pinctrl.txt + - pinctrl-0: see Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pinctrl/st,stm32-pinctrl.yaml SAI subnodes Optional properties: - st,sync: specify synchronization mode. diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sun4i-i2s.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sun4i-i2s.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 61e71c1729e0..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sun4i-i2s.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,45 +0,0 @@ -* Allwinner A10 I2S controller - -The I2S bus (Inter-IC sound bus) is a serial link for digital -audio data transfer between devices in the system. - -Required properties: - -- compatible: should be one of the following: - - "allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s" - - "allwinner,sun6i-a31-i2s" - - "allwinner,sun8i-a83t-i2s" - - "allwinner,sun8i-h3-i2s" - - "allwinner,sun50i-a64-codec-i2s" -- reg: physical base address of the controller and length of memory mapped - region. -- interrupts: should contain the I2S interrupt. -- dmas: DMA specifiers for tx and rx dma. See the DMA client binding, - Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/dma.txt -- dma-names: should include "tx" and "rx". -- clocks: a list of phandle + clock-specifer pairs, one for each entry in clock-names. -- clock-names: should contain the following: - - "apb" : clock for the I2S bus interface - - "mod" : module clock for the I2S controller -- #sound-dai-cells : Must be equal to 0 - -Required properties for the following compatibles: - - "allwinner,sun6i-a31-i2s" - - "allwinner,sun8i-a83t-i2s" - - "allwinner,sun8i-h3-i2s" - - "allwinner,sun50i-a64-codec-i2s" -- resets: phandle to the reset line for this codec - -Example: - -i2s0: i2s@1c22400 { - #sound-dai-cells = <0>; - compatible = "allwinner,sun4i-a10-i2s"; - reg = <0x01c22400 0x400>; - interrupts = <GIC_SPI 16 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; - clocks = <&apb0_gates 3>, <&i2s0_clk>; - clock-names = "apb", "mod"; - dmas = <&dma SUN4I_DMA_NORMAL 3>, - <&dma SUN4I_DMA_NORMAL 3>; - dma-names = "rx", "tx"; -}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sunxi,sun4i-spdif.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sunxi,sun4i-spdif.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 0c64a209c2e9..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sound/sunxi,sun4i-spdif.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,42 +0,0 @@ -Allwinner Sony/Philips Digital Interface Format (S/PDIF) Controller - -The Allwinner S/PDIF audio block is a transceiver that allows the -processor to receive and transmit digital audio via an coaxial cable or -a fibre cable. -For now only playback is supported. - -Required properties: - - - compatible : should be one of the following: - - "allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif": for the Allwinner A10 SoC - - "allwinner,sun6i-a31-spdif": for the Allwinner A31 SoC - - "allwinner,sun8i-h3-spdif": for the Allwinner H3 SoC - - - reg : Offset and length of the register set for the device. - - - interrupts : Contains the spdif interrupt. - - - dmas : Generic dma devicetree binding as described in - Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/dma.txt. - - - dma-names : Two dmas have to be defined, "tx" and "rx". - - - clocks : Contains an entry for each entry in clock-names. - - - clock-names : Includes the following entries: - "apb" clock for the spdif bus. - "spdif" clock for spdif controller. - - - resets : reset specifier for the ahb reset (A31 and newer only) - -Example: - -spdif: spdif@1c21000 { - compatible = "allwinner,sun4i-a10-spdif"; - reg = <0x01c21000 0x40>; - interrupts = <13>; - clocks = <&apb0_gates 1>, <&spdif_clk>; - clock-names = "apb", "spdif"; - dmas = <&dma 0 2>, <&dma 0 2>; - dma-names = "rx", "tx"; -}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spi.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spi.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..c374fd4923a6 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spi.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,86 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/spi/allwinner,sun4i-a10-spi.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: Allwinner A10 SPI Controller Device Tree Bindings + +allOf: + - $ref: "spi-controller.yaml" + +maintainers: + - Chen-Yu Tsai <wens@csie.org> + - Maxime Ripard <maxime.ripard@bootlin.com> + +properties: + "#address-cells": true + "#size-cells": true + + compatible: + const: allwinner,sun4i-a10-spi + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + + interrupts: + maxItems: 1 + + clocks: + items: + - description: Bus Clock + - description: Module Clock + + clock-names: + items: + - const: ahb + - const: mod + + dmas: + items: + - description: RX DMA Channel + - description: TX DMA Channel + + dma-names: + items: + - const: rx + - const: tx + + num-cs: true + +patternProperties: + "^.*@[0-9a-f]+": + properties: + reg: + items: + minimum: 0 + maximum: 4 + + spi-rx-bus-width: + const: 1 + + spi-tx-bus-width: + const: 1 + +required: + - compatible + - reg + - interrupts + - clocks + - clock-names + +additionalProperties: false + +examples: + - | + spi1: spi@1c06000 { + compatible = "allwinner,sun4i-a10-spi"; + reg = <0x01c06000 0x1000>; + interrupts = <11>; + clocks = <&ahb_gates 21>, <&spi1_clk>; + clock-names = "ahb", "mod"; + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + }; + +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..bda7a5befd8b --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,106 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/spi/allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: Allwinner A31 SPI Controller Device Tree Bindings + +allOf: + - $ref: "spi-controller.yaml" + +maintainers: + - Chen-Yu Tsai <wens@csie.org> + - Maxime Ripard <maxime.ripard@bootlin.com> + +properties: + "#address-cells": true + "#size-cells": true + + compatible: + enum: + - allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi + - allwinner,sun8i-h3-spi + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + + interrupts: + maxItems: 1 + + clocks: + items: + - description: Bus Clock + - description: Module Clock + + clock-names: + items: + - const: ahb + - const: mod + + resets: + maxItems: 1 + + dmas: + items: + - description: RX DMA Channel + - description: TX DMA Channel + + dma-names: + items: + - const: rx + - const: tx + + num-cs: true + +patternProperties: + "^.*@[0-9a-f]+": + properties: + reg: + items: + minimum: 0 + maximum: 4 + + spi-rx-bus-width: + const: 1 + + spi-tx-bus-width: + const: 1 + +required: + - compatible + - reg + - interrupts + - clocks + - clock-names + +additionalProperties: false + +examples: + - | + spi1: spi@1c69000 { + compatible = "allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi"; + reg = <0x01c69000 0x1000>; + interrupts = <0 66 4>; + clocks = <&ahb1_gates 21>, <&spi1_clk>; + clock-names = "ahb", "mod"; + resets = <&ahb1_rst 21>; + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + }; + + - | + spi0: spi@1c68000 { + compatible = "allwinner,sun8i-h3-spi"; + reg = <0x01c68000 0x1000>; + interrupts = <0 65 4>; + clocks = <&ccu 30>, <&ccu 82>; + clock-names = "ahb", "mod"; + dmas = <&dma 23>, <&dma 23>; + dma-names = "rx", "tx"; + resets = <&ccu 15>; + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + }; + +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-bus.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-bus.txt index 1f6e86f787ef..e07783505498 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-bus.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-bus.txt @@ -1,111 +1 @@ -SPI (Serial Peripheral Interface) busses - -SPI busses can be described with a node for the SPI controller device -and a set of child nodes for each SPI slave on the bus. The system's SPI -controller may be described for use in SPI master mode or in SPI slave mode, -but not for both at the same time. - -The SPI controller node requires the following properties: -- compatible - Name of SPI bus controller following generic names - recommended practice. - -In master mode, the SPI controller node requires the following additional -properties: -- #address-cells - number of cells required to define a chip select - address on the SPI bus. -- #size-cells - should be zero. - -In slave mode, the SPI controller node requires one additional property: -- spi-slave - Empty property. - -No other properties are required in the SPI bus node. It is assumed -that a driver for an SPI bus device will understand that it is an SPI bus. -However, the binding does not attempt to define the specific method for -assigning chip select numbers. Since SPI chip select configuration is -flexible and non-standardized, it is left out of this binding with the -assumption that board specific platform code will be used to manage -chip selects. Individual drivers can define additional properties to -support describing the chip select layout. - -Optional properties (master mode only): -- cs-gpios - gpios chip select. -- num-cs - total number of chipselects. - -If cs-gpios is used the number of chip selects will be increased automatically -with max(cs-gpios > hw cs). - -So if for example the controller has 2 CS lines, and the cs-gpios -property looks like this: - -cs-gpios = <&gpio1 0 0>, <0>, <&gpio1 1 0>, <&gpio1 2 0>; - -Then it should be configured so that num_chipselect = 4 with the -following mapping: - -cs0 : &gpio1 0 0 -cs1 : native -cs2 : &gpio1 1 0 -cs3 : &gpio1 2 0 - - -SPI slave nodes must be children of the SPI controller node. - -In master mode, one or more slave nodes (up to the number of chip selects) can -be present. Required properties are: -- compatible - Name of SPI device following generic names recommended - practice. -- reg - Chip select address of device. -- spi-max-frequency - Maximum SPI clocking speed of device in Hz. - -In slave mode, the (single) slave node is optional. -If present, it must be called "slave". Required properties are: -- compatible - Name of SPI device following generic names recommended - practice. - -All slave nodes can contain the following optional properties: -- spi-cpol - Empty property indicating device requires inverse clock - polarity (CPOL) mode. -- spi-cpha - Empty property indicating device requires shifted clock - phase (CPHA) mode. -- spi-cs-high - Empty property indicating device requires chip select - active high. -- spi-3wire - Empty property indicating device requires 3-wire mode. -- spi-lsb-first - Empty property indicating device requires LSB first mode. -- spi-tx-bus-width - The bus width (number of data wires) that is used for MOSI. - Defaults to 1 if not present. -- spi-rx-bus-width - The bus width (number of data wires) that is used for MISO. - Defaults to 1 if not present. -- spi-rx-delay-us - Microsecond delay after a read transfer. -- spi-tx-delay-us - Microsecond delay after a write transfer. - -Some SPI controllers and devices support Dual and Quad SPI transfer mode. -It allows data in the SPI system to be transferred using 2 wires (DUAL) or 4 -wires (QUAD). -Now the value that spi-tx-bus-width and spi-rx-bus-width can receive is -only 1 (SINGLE), 2 (DUAL) and 4 (QUAD). -Dual/Quad mode is not allowed when 3-wire mode is used. - -If a gpio chipselect is used for the SPI slave the gpio number will be passed -via the SPI master node cs-gpios property. - -SPI example for an MPC5200 SPI bus: - spi@f00 { - #address-cells = <1>; - #size-cells = <0>; - compatible = "fsl,mpc5200b-spi","fsl,mpc5200-spi"; - reg = <0xf00 0x20>; - interrupts = <2 13 0 2 14 0>; - interrupt-parent = <&mpc5200_pic>; - - ethernet-switch@0 { - compatible = "micrel,ks8995m"; - spi-max-frequency = <1000000>; - reg = <0>; - }; - - codec@1 { - compatible = "ti,tlv320aic26"; - spi-max-frequency = <100000>; - reg = <1>; - }; - }; +This file has moved to spi-controller.yaml. diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-controller.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-controller.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..876c0623f322 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-controller.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,161 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/spi/spi-controller.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: SPI Controller Generic Binding + +maintainers: + - Mark Brown <broonie@kernel.org> + +description: | + SPI busses can be described with a node for the SPI controller device + and a set of child nodes for each SPI slave on the bus. The system SPI + controller may be described for use in SPI master mode or in SPI slave mode, + but not for both at the same time. + +properties: + $nodename: + pattern: "^spi(@.*|-[0-9a-f])*$" + + "#address-cells": + const: 1 + + "#size-cells": + const: 0 + + cs-gpios: + description: | + GPIOs used as chip selects. + If that property is used, the number of chip selects will be + increased automatically with max(cs-gpios, hardware chip selects). + + So if, for example, the controller has 2 CS lines, and the + cs-gpios looks like this + cs-gpios = <&gpio1 0 0>, <0>, <&gpio1 1 0>, <&gpio1 2 0>; + + Then it should be configured so that num_chipselect = 4, with + the following mapping + cs0 : &gpio1 0 0 + cs1 : native + cs2 : &gpio1 1 0 + cs3 : &gpio1 2 0 + + num-cs: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32 + description: + Total number of chip selects. + + spi-slave: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/flag + description: + The SPI controller acts as a slave, instead of a master. + +patternProperties: + "^slave$": + type: object + + properties: + compatible: + description: + Compatible of the SPI device. + + required: + - compatible + + "^.*@[0-9a-f]+$": + type: object + + properties: + compatible: + description: + Compatible of the SPI device. + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + minimum: 0 + maximum: 256 + description: + Chip select used by the device. + + spi-3wire: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/flag + description: + The device requires 3-wire mode. + + spi-cpha: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/flag + description: + The device requires shifted clock phase (CPHA) mode. + + spi-cpol: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/flag + description: + The device requires inverse clock polarity (CPOL) mode. + + spi-cs-high: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/flag + description: + The device requires the chip select active high. + + spi-lsb-first: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/flag + description: + The device requires the LSB first mode. + + spi-max-frequency: + $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32 + description: + Maximum SPI clocking speed of the device in Hz. + + spi-rx-bus-width: + allOf: + - $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32 + - enum: [ 1, 2, 4 ] + - default: 1 + description: + Bus width to the SPI bus used for MISO. + + spi-rx-delay-us: + description: + Delay, in microseconds, after a read transfer. + + spi-tx-bus-width: + allOf: + - $ref: /schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32 + - enum: [ 1, 2, 4 ] + - default: 1 + description: + Bus width to the SPI bus used for MOSI. + + spi-tx-delay-us: + description: + Delay, in microseconds, after a write transfer. + + required: + - compatible + - reg + +examples: + - | + spi@f00 { + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + compatible = "fsl,mpc5200b-spi","fsl,mpc5200-spi"; + reg = <0xf00 0x20>; + interrupts = <2 13 0 2 14 0>; + interrupt-parent = <&mpc5200_pic>; + + ethernet-switch@0 { + compatible = "micrel,ks8995m"; + spi-max-frequency = <1000000>; + reg = <0>; + }; + + codec@1 { + compatible = "ti,tlv320aic26"; + spi-max-frequency = <100000>; + reg = <1>; + }; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-gpio.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-gpio.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 52db562f17a4..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-gpio.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,43 +0,0 @@ -SPI-GPIO devicetree bindings - -This represents a group of 3-n GPIO lines used for bit-banged SPI on dedicated -GPIO lines. - -Required properties: - - - compatible: should be set to "spi-gpio" - - #address-cells: should be set to <0x1> - - ranges - - sck-gpios: GPIO spec for the SCK line to use - - miso-gpios: GPIO spec for the MISO line to use - - mosi-gpios: GPIO spec for the MOSI line to use - - cs-gpios: GPIOs to use for chipselect lines. - Not needed if num-chipselects = <0>. - - num-chipselects: Number of chipselect lines. Should be <0> if a single device - with no chip select is connected. - -Deprecated bindings: - -These legacy GPIO line bindings can alternatively be used to define the -GPIO lines used, they should not be used in new device trees. - - - gpio-sck: GPIO spec for the SCK line to use - - gpio-miso: GPIO spec for the MISO line to use - - gpio-mosi: GPIO spec for the MOSI line to use - -Example: - - spi { - compatible = "spi-gpio"; - #address-cells = <0x1>; - ranges; - - sck-gpios = <&gpio 95 0>; - miso-gpios = <&gpio 98 0>; - mosi-gpios = <&gpio 97 0>; - cs-gpios = <&gpio 125 0>; - num-chipselects = <1>; - - /* clients */ - }; - diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-gpio.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-gpio.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..55c4f1705f07 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-gpio.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,72 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/spi/spi-gpio.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: SPI-GPIO devicetree bindings + +maintainers: + - Rob Herring <robh@kernel.org> + +description: + This represents a group of 3-n GPIO lines used for bit-banged SPI on + dedicated GPIO lines. + +allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/spi/spi-controller.yaml#" + +properties: + compatible: + const: spi-gpio + + sck-gpios: + description: GPIO spec for the SCK line to use + maxItems: 1 + + miso-gpios: + description: GPIO spec for the MISO line to use + maxItems: 1 + + mosi-gpios: + description: GPIO spec for the MOSI line to use + maxItems: 1 + + cs-gpios: + description: GPIOs to use for chipselect lines. + Not needed if num-chipselects = <0>. + minItems: 1 + maxItems: 1024 + + num-chipselects: + description: Number of chipselect lines. Should be <0> if a single device + with no chip select is connected. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + # Deprecated properties + gpio-sck: false + gpio-miso: false + gpio-mosi: false + +required: + - compatible + - num-chipselects + - sck-gpios + +examples: + - | + spi { + compatible = "spi-gpio"; + #address-cells = <0x1>; + #size-cells = <0x0>; + + sck-gpios = <&gpio 95 0>; + miso-gpios = <&gpio 98 0>; + mosi-gpios = <&gpio 97 0>; + cs-gpios = <&gpio 125 0>; + num-chipselects = <1>; + + /* clients */ + }; + +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-pl022.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-pl022.yaml new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..dfb697c69341 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-pl022.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,165 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 +%YAML 1.2 +--- +$id: http://devicetree.org/schemas/spi/spi-pl022.yaml# +$schema: http://devicetree.org/meta-schemas/core.yaml# + +title: ARM PL022 SPI controller + +maintainers: + - Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org> + +allOf: + - $ref: "spi-controller.yaml#" + +# We need a select here so we don't match all nodes with 'arm,primecell' +select: + properties: + compatible: + contains: + const: arm,pl022 + required: + - compatible + +properties: + compatible: + items: + - const: arm,pl022 + - const: arm,primecell + + reg: + maxItems: 1 + + interrupts: + maxItems: 1 + + clocks: + maxItems: 2 + + clock-names: + items: + - enum: + - SSPCLK + - sspclk + - const: apb_pclk + + pl022,autosuspend-delay: + description: delay in ms following transfer completion before the + runtime power management system suspends the device. A setting of 0 + indicates no delay and the device will be suspended immediately. + $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + + pl022,rt: + description: indicates the controller should run the message pump with realtime + priority to minimise the transfer latency on the bus (boolean) + type: boolean + + dmas: + description: + Two or more DMA channel specifiers following the convention outlined + in bindings/dma/dma.txt + minItems: 2 + maxItems: 32 + + dma-names: + description: + There must be at least one channel named "tx" for transmit and named "rx" + for receive. + minItems: 2 + maxItems: 32 + additionalItems: true + items: + - const: rx + - const: tx + +patternProperties: + "^[a-zA-Z][a-zA-Z0-9,+\\-._]{0,63}@[0-9a-f]+$": + type: object + # SPI slave nodes must be children of the SPI master node and can + # contain the following properties. + properties: + pl022,interface: + description: SPI interface type + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - enum: + - 0 # SPI + - 1 # Texas Instruments Synchronous Serial Frame Format + - 2 # Microwire (Half Duplex) + + pl022,com-mode: + description: Specifies the transfer mode + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - enum: + - 0 # interrupt mode + - 1 # polling mode + - 2 # DMA mode + default: 1 + + pl022,rx-level-trig: + description: Rx FIFO watermark level + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - minimum: 0 + maximum: 4 + + pl022,tx-level-trig: + description: Tx FIFO watermark level + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - minimum: 0 + maximum: 4 + + pl022,ctrl-len: + description: Microwire interface - Control length + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - minimum: 0x03 + maximum: 0x1f + + pl022,wait-state: + description: Microwire interface - Wait state + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - enum: [ 0, 1 ] + + pl022,duplex: + description: Microwire interface - Full/Half duplex + allOf: + - $ref: "/schemas/types.yaml#/definitions/uint32" + - enum: [ 0, 1 ] + +required: + - compatible + - reg + - interrupts + +examples: + - | + spi@e0100000 { + compatible = "arm,pl022", "arm,primecell"; + reg = <0xe0100000 0x1000>; + #address-cells = <1>; + #size-cells = <0>; + interrupts = <0 31 0x4>; + dmas = <&dma_controller 23 1>, + <&dma_controller 24 0>; + dma-names = "rx", "tx"; + + m25p80@1 { + compatible = "st,m25p80"; + reg = <1>; + spi-max-frequency = <12000000>; + spi-cpol; + spi-cpha; + pl022,interface = <0>; + pl022,com-mode = <0x2>; + pl022,rx-level-trig = <0>; + pl022,tx-level-trig = <0>; + pl022,ctrl-len = <0x11>; + pl022,wait-state = <0>; + pl022,duplex = <0>; + }; + }; +... diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-stm32-qspi.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-stm32-qspi.txt index adeeb63e84b9..bfc038b9478d 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-stm32-qspi.txt +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-stm32-qspi.txt @@ -19,8 +19,11 @@ Required properties: - reg: chip-Select number (QSPI controller may connect 2 flashes) - spi-max-frequency: max frequency of spi bus -Optional property: +Optional properties: - spi-rx-bus-width: see ./spi-bus.txt for the description +- dmas: DMA specifiers for tx and rx dma. See the DMA client binding, +Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/dma.txt. +- dma-names: DMA request names should include "tx" and "rx" if present. Example: diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-sun4i.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-sun4i.txt deleted file mode 100644 index c75d604a8290..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-sun4i.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,23 +0,0 @@ -Allwinner A10 SPI controller - -Required properties: -- compatible: Should be "allwinner,sun4-a10-spi". -- reg: Should contain register location and length. -- interrupts: Should contain interrupt. -- clocks: phandle to the clocks feeding the SPI controller. Two are - needed: - - "ahb": the gated AHB parent clock - - "mod": the parent module clock -- clock-names: Must contain the clock names described just above - -Example: - -spi1: spi@1c06000 { - compatible = "allwinner,sun4i-a10-spi"; - reg = <0x01c06000 0x1000>; - interrupts = <11>; - clocks = <&ahb_gates 21>, <&spi1_clk>; - clock-names = "ahb", "mod"; - #address-cells = <1>; - #size-cells = <0>; -}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-sun6i.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-sun6i.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 435a8e0731ac..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-sun6i.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,44 +0,0 @@ -Allwinner A31/H3 SPI controller - -Required properties: -- compatible: Should be "allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi" or "allwinner,sun8i-h3-spi". -- reg: Should contain register location and length. -- interrupts: Should contain interrupt. -- clocks: phandle to the clocks feeding the SPI controller. Two are - needed: - - "ahb": the gated AHB parent clock - - "mod": the parent module clock -- clock-names: Must contain the clock names described just above -- resets: phandle to the reset controller asserting this device in - reset - -Optional properties: -- dmas: DMA specifiers for rx and tx dma. See the DMA client binding, - Documentation/devicetree/bindings/dma/dma.txt -- dma-names: DMA request names should include "rx" and "tx" if present. - -Example: - -spi1: spi@1c69000 { - compatible = "allwinner,sun6i-a31-spi"; - reg = <0x01c69000 0x1000>; - interrupts = <0 66 4>; - clocks = <&ahb1_gates 21>, <&spi1_clk>; - clock-names = "ahb", "mod"; - resets = <&ahb1_rst 21>; -}; - -spi0: spi@1c68000 { - compatible = "allwinner,sun8i-h3-spi"; - reg = <0x01c68000 0x1000>; - interrupts = <GIC_SPI 65 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; - clocks = <&ccu CLK_BUS_SPI0>, <&ccu CLK_SPI0>; - clock-names = "ahb", "mod"; - dmas = <&dma 23>, <&dma 23>; - dma-names = "rx", "tx"; - pinctrl-names = "default"; - pinctrl-0 = <&spi0_pins>; - resets = <&ccu RST_BUS_SPI0>; - #address-cells = <1>; - #size-cells = <0>; -}; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-synquacer.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-synquacer.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..291dfa692d0a --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi-synquacer.txt @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ +* Socionext Synquacer HS-SPI bindings + +Required Properties: +- compatible: should be "socionext,synquacer-spi" +- reg: physical base address of the controller and length of memory mapped + region. +- interrupts: should contain the "spi_rx", "spi_tx" and "spi_fault" interrupts. +- clocks: core clock iHCLK. Optional rate clock iPCLK (default is iHCLK) +- clock-names: Shall be "iHCLK" and "iPCLK" respectively + +Optional Properties: +- socionext,use-rtm: boolean, if required to use "retimed clock" for RX +- socionext,set-aces: boolean, if same active clock edges field to be set. + +Example: + + spi0: spi@ff110000 { + compatible = "socionext,synquacer-spi"; + reg = <0xff110000 0x1000>; + interrupts = <GIC_SPI 160 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <GIC_SPI 161 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>, + <GIC_SPI 162 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; + clocks = <&clk_hsspi>; + clock-names = "iHCLK"; + socionext,use-rtm; + socionext,set-aces; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi_pl022.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi_pl022.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 7638b4968ddb..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/spi/spi_pl022.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,70 +0,0 @@ -ARM PL022 SPI controller - -Required properties: -- compatible : "arm,pl022", "arm,primecell" -- reg : Offset and length of the register set for the device -- interrupts : Should contain SPI controller interrupt -- num-cs : total number of chipselects - -Optional properties: -- cs-gpios : should specify GPIOs used for chipselects. - The gpios will be referred to as reg = <index> in the SPI child nodes. - If unspecified, a single SPI device without a chip select can be used. -- pl022,autosuspend-delay : delay in ms following transfer completion before - the runtime power management system suspends the - device. A setting of 0 indicates no delay and the - device will be suspended immediately -- pl022,rt : indicates the controller should run the message pump with realtime - priority to minimise the transfer latency on the bus (boolean) -- dmas : Two or more DMA channel specifiers following the convention outlined - in bindings/dma/dma.txt -- dma-names: Names for the dma channels, if present. There must be at - least one channel named "tx" for transmit and named "rx" for - receive. - - -SPI slave nodes must be children of the SPI master node and can -contain the following properties. - -- pl022,interface : interface type: - 0: SPI - 1: Texas Instruments Synchronous Serial Frame Format - 2: Microwire (Half Duplex) -- pl022,com-mode : specifies the transfer mode: - 0: interrupt mode - 1: polling mode (default mode if property not present) - 2: DMA mode -- pl022,rx-level-trig : Rx FIFO watermark level -- pl022,tx-level-trig : Tx FIFO watermark level -- pl022,ctrl-len : Microwire interface: Control length -- pl022,wait-state : Microwire interface: Wait state -- pl022,duplex : Microwire interface: Full/Half duplex - - -Example: - - spi@e0100000 { - compatible = "arm,pl022", "arm,primecell"; - reg = <0xe0100000 0x1000>; - #address-cells = <1>; - #size-cells = <0>; - interrupts = <0 31 0x4>; - dmas = <&dma-controller 23 1>, - <&dma-controller 24 0>; - dma-names = "rx", "tx"; - - m25p80@1 { - compatible = "st,m25p80"; - reg = <1>; - spi-max-frequency = <12000000>; - spi-cpol; - spi-cpha; - pl022,interface = <0>; - pl022,com-mode = <0x2>; - pl022,rx-level-trig = <0>; - pl022,tx-level-trig = <0>; - pl022,ctrl-len = <0x11>; - pl022,wait-state = <0>; - pl022,duplex = <0>; - }; - }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/timer/nxp,sysctr-timer.txt b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/timer/nxp,sysctr-timer.txt new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..d57659996d62 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/timer/nxp,sysctr-timer.txt @@ -0,0 +1,25 @@ +NXP System Counter Module(sys_ctr) + +The system counter(sys_ctr) is a programmable system counter which provides +a shared time base to Cortex A15, A7, A53, A73, etc. it is intended for use in +applications where the counter is always powered and support multiple, +unrelated clocks. The compare frame inside can be used for timer purpose. + +Required properties: + +- compatible : should be "nxp,sysctr-timer" +- reg : Specifies the base physical address and size of the comapre + frame and the counter control, read & compare. +- interrupts : should be the first compare frames' interrupt +- clocks : Specifies the counter clock. +- clock-names: Specifies the clock's name of this module + +Example: + + system_counter: timer@306a0000 { + compatible = "nxp,sysctr-timer"; + reg = <0x306a0000 0x20000>;/* system-counter-rd & compare */ + clocks = <&clk_8m>; + clock-names = "per"; + interrupts = <GIC_SPI 47 IRQ_TYPE_LEVEL_HIGH>; + }; diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/trivial-devices.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/trivial-devices.yaml index 747fd3f689dc..2e742d399e87 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/trivial-devices.yaml +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/trivial-devices.yaml @@ -52,6 +52,10 @@ properties: - at,24c08 # i2c trusted platform module (TPM) - atmel,at97sc3204t + # i2c h/w symmetric crypto module + - atmel,atsha204a + # i2c h/w elliptic curve crypto module + - atmel,atecc508a # CM32181: Ambient Light Sensor - capella,cm32181 # CM3232: Ambient Light Sensor diff --git a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.yaml b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.yaml index 33a65a45e319..1acf806b62bf 100644 --- a/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.yaml +++ b/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/vendor-prefixes.yaml @@ -49,6 +49,8 @@ patternProperties: description: Aeroflex Gaisler AB "^al,.*": description: Annapurna Labs + "^allegro,.*": + description: Allegro DVT "^allo,.*": description: Allo.com "^allwinner,.*": diff --git a/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/consumer.rst b/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/consumer.rst index 5e4d8aa68913..9559aa3cbcef 100644 --- a/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/consumer.rst +++ b/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/consumer.rst @@ -283,8 +283,6 @@ To summarize:: gpiod_set_value(desc, 1); default (active high) high gpiod_set_value(desc, 0); active low high gpiod_set_value(desc, 1); active low low - gpiod_set_value(desc, 0); default (active high) low - gpiod_set_value(desc, 1); default (active high) high gpiod_set_value(desc, 0); open drain low gpiod_set_value(desc, 1); open drain high impedance gpiod_set_value(desc, 0); open source high impedance @@ -366,7 +364,7 @@ accessed sequentially. The functions take three arguments: * array_size - the number of array elements * desc_array - an array of GPIO descriptors - * array_info - optional information obtained from gpiod_array_get() + * array_info - optional information obtained from gpiod_get_array() * value_bitmap - a bitmap to store the GPIOs' values (get) or a bitmap of values to assign to the GPIOs (set) diff --git a/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/driver.rst b/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/driver.rst index 1ce7fcd0f989..4af9aae724f0 100644 --- a/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/driver.rst +++ b/Documentation/driver-api/gpio/driver.rst @@ -235,7 +235,7 @@ means that a pull up or pull-down resistor is available on the output of the GPIO line, and this resistor is software controlled. In discrete designs, a pull-up or pull-down resistor is simply soldered on -the circuit board. This is not something we deal or model in software. The +the circuit board. This is not something we deal with or model in software. The most you will think about these lines is that they will very likely be configured as open drain or open source (see the section above). @@ -292,18 +292,18 @@ We can divide GPIO irqchips in two broad categories: - HIERARCHICAL INTERRUPT CHIPS: this means that each GPIO line has a dedicated irq line to a parent interrupt controller one level up. There is no need - to inquire the GPIO hardware to figure out which line has figured, but it - may still be necessary to acknowledge the interrupt and set up the - configuration such as edge sensitivity. + to inquire the GPIO hardware to figure out which line has fired, but it + may still be necessary to acknowledge the interrupt and set up configuration + such as edge sensitivity. Realtime considerations: a realtime compliant GPIO driver should not use spinlock_t or any sleepable APIs (like PM runtime) as part of its irqchip implementation. -- spinlock_t should be replaced with raw_spinlock_t [1]. +- spinlock_t should be replaced with raw_spinlock_t.[1] - If sleepable APIs have to be used, these can be done from the .irq_bus_lock() and .irq_bus_unlock() callbacks, as these are the only slowpath callbacks - on an irqchip. Create the callbacks if needed [2]. + on an irqchip. Create the callbacks if needed.[2] Cascaded GPIO irqchips @@ -361,7 +361,7 @@ Cascaded GPIO irqchips usually fall in one of three categories: Realtime considerations: this kind of handlers will be forced threaded on -RT, and as result the IRQ core will complain that generic_handle_irq() is called - with IRQ enabled and the same work around as for "CHAINED GPIO irqchips" can + with IRQ enabled and the same work-around as for "CHAINED GPIO irqchips" can be applied. - NESTED THREADED GPIO IRQCHIPS: these are off-chip GPIO expanders and any @@ -418,7 +418,7 @@ symbol: If there is a need to exclude certain GPIO lines from the IRQ domain handled by these helpers, we can set .irq.need_valid_mask of the gpiochip before -[devm_]gpiochip_add_data() is called. This allocates an .irq.valid_mask with as +``[devm_]gpiochip_add_data()`` is called. This allocates an .irq.valid_mask with as many bits set as there are GPIO lines in the chip, each bit representing line 0..n-1. Drivers can exclude GPIO lines by clearing bits from this mask. The mask must be filled in before gpiochip_irqchip_add() or gpiochip_irqchip_add_nested() diff --git a/Documentation/driver-api/s390-drivers.rst b/Documentation/driver-api/s390-drivers.rst index 30e6aa7e160b..5158577bc29b 100644 --- a/Documentation/driver-api/s390-drivers.rst +++ b/Documentation/driver-api/s390-drivers.rst @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ not strictly considered I/O devices. They are considered here as well, although they are not the focus of this document. Some additional information can also be found in the kernel source under -Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt. +Documentation/s390/driver-model.rst. The css bus =========== @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ into several categories: * Standard I/O subchannels, for use by the system. They have a child device on the ccw bus and are described below. * I/O subchannels bound to the vfio-ccw driver. See - Documentation/s390/vfio-ccw.txt. + Documentation/s390/vfio-ccw.rst. * Message subchannels. No Linux driver currently exists. * CHSC subchannels (at most one). The chsc subchannel driver can be used to send asynchronous chsc commands. diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt index 66cad5c86171..a226061fa109 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt @@ -45,6 +45,7 @@ Table of Contents 3.9 /proc/<pid>/map_files - Information about memory mapped files 3.10 /proc/<pid>/timerslack_ns - Task timerslack value 3.11 /proc/<pid>/patch_state - Livepatch patch operation state + 3.12 /proc/<pid>/arch_status - Task architecture specific information 4 Configuring procfs 4.1 Mount options @@ -1948,6 +1949,45 @@ patched. If the patch is being enabled, then the task has already been patched. If the patch is being disabled, then the task hasn't been unpatched yet. +3.12 /proc/<pid>/arch_status - task architecture specific status +------------------------------------------------------------------- +When CONFIG_PROC_PID_ARCH_STATUS is enabled, this file displays the +architecture specific status of the task. + +Example +------- + $ cat /proc/6753/arch_status + AVX512_elapsed_ms: 8 + +Description +----------- + +x86 specific entries: +--------------------- + AVX512_elapsed_ms: + ------------------ + If AVX512 is supported on the machine, this entry shows the milliseconds + elapsed since the last time AVX512 usage was recorded. The recording + happens on a best effort basis when a task is scheduled out. This means + that the value depends on two factors: + + 1) The time which the task spent on the CPU without being scheduled + out. With CPU isolation and a single runnable task this can take + several seconds. + + 2) The time since the task was scheduled out last. Depending on the + reason for being scheduled out (time slice exhausted, syscall ...) + this can be arbitrary long time. + + As a consequence the value cannot be considered precise and authoritative + information. The application which uses this information has to be aware + of the overall scenario on the system in order to determine whether a + task is a real AVX512 user or not. Precise information can be obtained + with performance counters. + + A special value of '-1' indicates that no AVX512 usage was recorded, thus + the task is unlikely an AVX512 user, but depends on the workload and the + scheduling scenario, it also could be a false negative mentioned above. ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ Configuring procfs diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt index d06e9a59a9f4..cad797a8a39e 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt @@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ A memory policy with a valid NodeList will be saved, as specified, for use at file creation time. When a task allocates a file in the file system, the mount option memory policy will be applied with a NodeList, if any, modified by the calling task's cpuset constraints -[See Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt] and any optional flags, listed +[See Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst] and any optional flags, listed below. If the resulting NodeLists is the empty set, the effective memory policy for the file will revert to "default" policy. diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/API.txt b/Documentation/fmc/API.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 06b06b92c794..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/API.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,47 +0,0 @@ -Functions Exported by fmc.ko -**************************** - -The FMC core exports the usual 4 functions that are needed for a bus to -work, and a few more: - - int fmc_driver_register(struct fmc_driver *drv); - void fmc_driver_unregister(struct fmc_driver *drv); - int fmc_device_register(struct fmc_device *fmc); - void fmc_device_unregister(struct fmc_device *fmc); - - int fmc_device_register_n(struct fmc_device **fmc, int n); - void fmc_device_unregister_n(struct fmc_device **fmc, int n); - - uint32_t fmc_readl(struct fmc_device *fmc, int offset); - void fmc_writel(struct fmc_device *fmc, uint32_t val, int off); - void *fmc_get_drvdata(struct fmc_device *fmc); - void fmc_set_drvdata(struct fmc_device *fmc, void *data); - - int fmc_reprogram(struct fmc_device *f, struct fmc_driver *d, char *gw, - int sdb_entry); - -The data structure that describe a device is detailed in *note FMC -Device::, the one that describes a driver is detailed in *note FMC -Driver::. Please note that structures of type fmc_device must be -allocated by the caller, but must not be released after unregistering. -The fmc-bus itself takes care of releasing the structure when their use -count reaches zero - actually, the device model does that in lieu of us. - -The functions to register and unregister n devices are meant to be used -by carriers that host more than one mezzanine. The devices must all be -registered at the same time because if the FPGA is reprogrammed, all -devices in the array are affected. Usually, the driver matching the -first device will reprogram the FPGA, so other devices must know they -are already driven by a reprogrammed FPGA. - -If a carrier hosts slots that are driven by different FPGA devices, it -should register as a group only mezzanines that are driven by the same -FPGA, for the reason outlined above. - -Finally, the fmc_reprogram function calls the reprogram method (see -*note The API Offered by Carriers:: and also scans the memory area for -an SDB tree. You can pass -1 as sdb_entry to disable such scan. -Otherwise, the function fails if no tree is found at the specified -entry point. The function is meant to factorize common code, and by -the time you read this it is already used by the spec-sw and fine-delay -modules. diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/FMC-and-SDB.txt b/Documentation/fmc/FMC-and-SDB.txt deleted file mode 100644 index fa14e0b24521..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/FMC-and-SDB.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,88 +0,0 @@ - -FMC (FPGA Mezzanine Card) is the standard we use for our I/O devices, -in the context of White Rabbit and related hardware. - -In our I/O environments we need to write drivers for each mezzanine -card, and such drivers must work regardless of the carrier being used. -To achieve this, we abstract the FMC interface. - -We have a carrier for PCI-E called SPEC and one for VME called SVEC, -but more are planned. Also, we support stand-alone devices (usually -plugged on a SPEC card), controlled through Etherbone, developed by GSI. - -Code and documentation for the FMC bus was born as part of the spec-sw -project, but now it lives in its own project. Other projects, i.e. -software support for the various carriers, should include this as a -submodule. - -The most up to date version of code and documentation is always -available from the repository you can clone from: - - git://ohwr.org/fmc-projects/fmc-bus.git (read-only) - git@ohwr.org:fmc-projects/fmc-bus.git (read-write for developers) - -Selected versions of the documentation, as well as complete tar -archives for selected revisions are placed to the Files section of the -project: `http://www.ohwr.org/projects/fmc-bus/files' - - -What is FMC -*********** - -FMC, as said, stands for "FPGA Mezzanine Card". It is a standard -developed by the VME consortium called VITA (VMEbus International Trade -Association and ratified by ANSI, the American National Standard -Institute. The official documentation is called "ANSI-VITA 57.1". - -The FMC card is an almost square PCB, around 70x75 millimeters, that is -called mezzanine in this document. It usually lives plugged into -another PCB for power supply and control; such bigger circuit board is -called carrier from now on, and a single carrier may host more than one -mezzanine. - -In the typical application the mezzanine is mostly analog while the -carrier is mostly digital, and hosts an FPGA that must be configured to -match the specific mezzanine and the desired application. Thus, you may -need to load different FPGA images to drive different instances of the -same mezzanine. - -FMC, as such, is not a bus in the usual meaning of the term, because -most carriers have only one connector, and carriers with several -connectors have completely separate electrical connections to them. -This package, however, implements a bus as a software abstraction. - - -What is SDB -*********** - -SDB (Self Describing Bus) is a set of data structures that we use for -enumerating the internal structure of an FPGA image. We also use it as -a filesystem inside the FMC EEPROM. - -SDB is not mandatory for use of this FMC kernel bus, but if you have SDB -this package can make good use of it. SDB itself is developed in the -fpga-config-space OHWR project. The link to the repository is -`git://ohwr.org/hdl-core-lib/fpga-config-space.git' and what is used in -this project lives in the sdbfs subdirectory in there. - -SDB support for FMC is described in *note FMC Identification:: and -*note SDB Support:: - - -SDB Support -*********** - -The fmc.ko bus driver exports a few functions to help drivers taking -advantage of the SDB information that may be present in your own FPGA -memory image. - -The module exports the following functions, in the special header -<linux/fmc-sdb.h>. The linux/ prefix in the name is there because we -plan to submit it upstream in the future, and don't want to force -changes on our drivers if that happens. - - int fmc_scan_sdb_tree(struct fmc_device *fmc, unsigned long address); - void fmc_show_sdb_tree(struct fmc_device *fmc); - signed long fmc_find_sdb_device(struct sdb_array *tree, uint64_t vendor, - uint32_t device, unsigned long *sz); - int fmc_free_sdb_tree(struct fmc_device *fmc); diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/carrier.txt b/Documentation/fmc/carrier.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 5e4f1dd3e98b..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/carrier.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,311 +0,0 @@ -FMC Device -********** - -Within the Linux bus framework, the FMC device is created and -registered by the carrier driver. For example, the PCI driver for the -SPEC card fills a data structure for each SPEC that it drives, and -registers an associated FMC device for each card. The SVEC driver can -do exactly the same for the VME carrier (actually, it should do it -twice, because the SVEC carries two FMC mezzanines). Similarly, an -Etherbone driver will be able to register its own FMC devices, offering -communication primitives through frame exchange. - -The contents of the EEPROM within the FMC are used for identification -purposes, i.e. for matching the device with its own driver. For this -reason the device structure includes a complete copy of the EEPROM -(actually, the carrier driver may choose whether or not to return it - -for example we most likely won't have the whole EEPROM available for -Etherbone devices. - -The following listing shows the current structure defining a device. -Please note that all the machinery is in place but some details may -still change in the future. For this reason, there is a version field -at the beginning of the structure. As usual, the minor number will -change for compatible changes (like a new flag) and the major number -will increase when an incompatible change happens (for example, a -change in layout of some fmc data structures). Device writers should -just set it to the value FMC_VERSION, and be ready to get back -EINVAL -at registration time. - - struct fmc_device { - unsigned long version; - unsigned long flags; - struct module *owner; /* char device must pin it */ - struct fmc_fru_id id; /* for EEPROM-based match */ - struct fmc_operations *op; /* carrier-provided */ - int irq; /* according to host bus. 0 == none */ - int eeprom_len; /* Usually 8kB, may be less */ - int eeprom_addr; /* 0x50, 0x52 etc */ - uint8_t *eeprom; /* Full contents or leading part */ - char *carrier_name; /* "SPEC" or similar, for special use */ - void *carrier_data; /* "struct spec *" or equivalent */ - __iomem void *fpga_base; /* May be NULL (Etherbone) */ - __iomem void *slot_base; /* Set by the driver */ - struct fmc_device **devarray; /* Allocated by the bus */ - int slot_id; /* Index in the slot array */ - int nr_slots; /* Number of slots in this carrier */ - unsigned long memlen; /* Used for the char device */ - struct device dev; /* For Linux use */ - struct device *hwdev; /* The underlying hardware device */ - unsigned long sdbfs_entry; - struct sdb_array *sdb; - uint32_t device_id; /* Filled by the device */ - char *mezzanine_name; /* Defaults to ``fmc'' */ - void *mezzanine_data; - }; - -The meaning of most fields is summarized in the code comment above. - -The following fields must be filled by the carrier driver before -registration: - - * version: must be set to FMC_VERSION. - - * owner: set to MODULE_OWNER. - - * op: the operations to act on the device. - - * irq: number for the mezzanine; may be zero. - - * eeprom_len: length of the following array. - - * eeprom_addr: 0x50 for first mezzanine and so on. - - * eeprom: the full content of the I2C EEPROM. - - * carrier_name. - - * carrier_data: a unique pointer for the carrier. - - * fpga_base: the I/O memory address (may be NULL). - - * slot_id: the index of this slot (starting from zero). - - * memlen: if fpga_base is valid, the length of I/O memory. - - * hwdev: to be used in some dev_err() calls. - - * device_id: a slot-specific unique integer number. - - -Please note that the carrier should read its own EEPROM memory before -registering the device, as well as fill all other fields listed above. - -The following fields should not be assigned, because they are filled -later by either the bus or the device driver: - - * flags. - - * fru_id: filled by the bus, parsing the eeprom. - - * slot_base: filled and used by the driver, if useful to it. - - * devarray: an array og all mezzanines driven by a singe FPGA. - - * nr_slots: set by the core at registration time. - - * dev: used by Linux. - - * sdb: FPGA contents, scanned according to driver's directions. - - * sdbfs_entry: SDB entry point in EEPROM: autodetected. - - * mezzanine_data: available for the driver. - - * mezzanine_name: filled by fmc-bus during identification. - - -Note: mezzanine_data may be redundant, because Linux offers the drvdata -approach, so the field may be removed in later versions of this bus -implementation. - -As I write this, she SPEC carrier is already completely functional in -the fmc-bus environment, and is a good reference to look at. - - -The API Offered by Carriers -=========================== - -The carrier provides a number of methods by means of the -`fmc_operations' structure, which currently is defined like this -(again, it is a moving target, please refer to the header rather than -this document): - - struct fmc_operations { - uint32_t (*readl)(struct fmc_device *fmc, int offset); - void (*writel)(struct fmc_device *fmc, uint32_t value, int offset); - int (*reprogram)(struct fmc_device *f, struct fmc_driver *d, char *gw); - int (*validate)(struct fmc_device *fmc, struct fmc_driver *drv); - int (*irq_request)(struct fmc_device *fmc, irq_handler_t h, - char *name, int flags); - void (*irq_ack)(struct fmc_device *fmc); - int (*irq_free)(struct fmc_device *fmc); - int (*gpio_config)(struct fmc_device *fmc, struct fmc_gpio *gpio, - int ngpio); - int (*read_ee)(struct fmc_device *fmc, int pos, void *d, int l); - int (*write_ee)(struct fmc_device *fmc, int pos, const void *d, int l); - }; - -The individual methods perform the following tasks: - -`readl' -`writel' - These functions access FPGA registers by whatever means the - carrier offers. They are not expected to fail, and most of the time - they will just make a memory access to the host bus. If the - carrier provides a fpga_base pointer, the driver may use direct - access through that pointer. For this reason the header offers the - inline functions fmc_readl and fmc_writel that access fpga_base if - the respective method is NULL. A driver that wants to be portable - and efficient should use fmc_readl and fmc_writel. For Etherbone, - or other non-local carriers, error-management is still to be - defined. - -`validate' - Module parameters are used to manage different applications for - two or more boards of the same kind. Validation is based on the - busid module parameter, if provided, and returns the matching - index in the associated array. See *note Module Parameters:: in in - doubt. If no match is found, `-ENOENT' is returned; if the user - didn't pass `busid=', all devices will pass validation. The value - returned by the validate method can be used as index into other - parameters (for example, some drivers use the `lm32=' parameter in - this way). Such "generic parameters" are documented in *note - Module Parameters::, below. The validate method is used by - `fmc-trivial.ko', described in *note fmc-trivial::. - -`reprogram' - The carrier enumerates FMC devices by loading a standard (or - golden) FPGA binary that allows EEPROM access. Each driver, then, - will need to reprogram the FPGA by calling this function. If the - name argument is NULL, the carrier should reprogram the golden - binary. If the gateware name has been overridden through module - parameters (in a carrier-specific way) the file loaded will match - the parameters. Per-device gateware names can be specified using - the `gateware=' parameter, see *note Module Parameters::. Note: - Clients should call rhe new helper, fmc_reprogram, which both - calls this method and parse the SDB tree of the FPGA. - -`irq_request' -`irq_ack' -`irq_free' - Interrupt management is carrier-specific, so it is abstracted as - operations. The interrupt number is listed in the device - structure, and for the mezzanine driver the number is only - informative. The handler will receive the fmc pointer as dev_id; - the flags argument is passed to the Linux request_irq function, - but fmc-specific flags may be added in the future. You'll most - likely want to pass the `IRQF_SHARED' flag. - -`gpio_config' - The method allows to configure a GPIO pin in the carrier, and read - its current value if it is configured as input. See *note The GPIO - Abstraction:: for details. - -`read_ee' -`write_ee' - Read or write the EEPROM. The functions are expected to be only - called before reprogramming and the carrier should refuse them - with `ENODEV' after reprogramming. The offset is expected to be - within 8kB (the current size), but addresses up to 1MB are - reserved to fit bigger I2C devices in the future. Carriers may - offer access to other internal flash memories using these same - methods: for example the SPEC driver may define that its carrier - I2C memory is seen at offset 1M and the internal SPI flash is seen - at offset 16M. This multiplexing of several flash memories in the - same address space is carrier-specific and should only be used - by a driver that has verified the `carrier_name' field. - - - -The GPIO Abstraction -==================== - -Support for GPIO pins in the fmc-bus environment is not very -straightforward and deserves special discussion. - -While the general idea of a carrier-independent driver seems to fly, -configuration of specific signals within the carrier needs at least -some knowledge of the carrier itself. For this reason, the specific -driver can request to configure carrier-specific GPIO pins, numbered -from 0 to at most 4095. Configuration is performed by passing a -pointer to an array of struct fmc_gpio items, as well as the length of -the array. This is the data structure: - - struct fmc_gpio { - char *carrier_name; - int gpio; - int _gpio; /* internal use by the carrier */ - int mode; /* GPIOF_DIR_OUT etc, from <linux/gpio.h> */ - int irqmode; /* IRQF_TRIGGER_LOW and so on */ - }; - -By specifying a carrier_name for each pin, the driver may access -different pins in different carriers. The gpio_config method is -expected to return the number of pins successfully configured, ignoring -requests for other carriers. However, if no pin is configured (because -no structure at all refers to the current carrier_name), the operation -returns an error so the caller will know that it is running under a -yet-unsupported carrier. - -So, for example, a driver that has been developed and tested on both -the SPEC and the SVEC may request configuration of two different GPIO -pins, and expect one such configuration to succeed - if none succeeds -it most likely means that the current carrier is a still-unknown one. - -If, however, your GPIO pin has a specific known role, you can pass a -special number in the gpio field, using one of the following macros: - - #define FMC_GPIO_RAW(x) (x) /* 4096 of them */ - #define FMC_GPIO_IRQ(x) ((x) + 0x1000) /* 256 of them */ - #define FMC_GPIO_LED(x) ((x) + 0x1100) /* 256 of them */ - #define FMC_GPIO_KEY(x) ((x) + 0x1200) /* 256 of them */ - #define FMC_GPIO_TP(x) ((x) + 0x1300) /* 256 of them */ - #define FMC_GPIO_USER(x) ((x) + 0x1400) /* 256 of them */ - -Use of virtual GPIO numbers (anything but FMC_GPIO_RAW) is allowed -provided the carrier_name field in the data structure is left -unspecified (NULL). Each carrier is responsible for providing a mapping -between virtual and physical GPIO numbers. The carrier may then use the -_gpio field to cache the result of this mapping. - -All carriers must map their I/O lines to the sets above starting from -zero. The SPEC, for example, maps interrupt pins 0 and 1, and test -points 0 through 3 (even if the test points on the PCB are called -5,6,7,8). - -If, for example, a driver requires a free LED and a test point (for a -scope probe to be plugged at some point during development) it may ask -for FMC_GPIO_LED(0) and FMC_GPIO_TP(0). Each carrier will provide -suitable GPIO pins. Clearly, the person running the drivers will know -the order used by the specific carrier driver in assigning leds and -testpoints, so to make a carrier-dependent use of the diagnostic tools. - -In theory, some form of autodetection should be possible: a driver like -the wr-nic (which uses IRQ(1) on the SPEC card) should configure -IRQ(0), make a test with software-generated interrupts and configure -IRQ(1) if the test fails. This probing step should be used because even -if the wr-nic gateware is known to use IRQ1 on the SPEC, the driver -should be carrier-independent and thus use IRQ(0) as a first bet - -actually, the knowledge that IRQ0 may fail is carrier-dependent -information, but using it doesn't make the driver unsuitable for other -carriers. - -The return value of gpio_config is defined as follows: - - * If no pin in the array can be used by the carrier, `-ENODEV'. - - * If at least one virtual GPIO number cannot be mapped, `-ENOENT'. - - * On success, 0 or positive. The value returned is the number of - high input bits (if no input is configured, the value for success - is 0). - -While I admit the procedure is not completely straightforward, it -allows configuration, input and output with a single carrier operation. -Given the typical use case of FMC devices, GPIO operations are not -expected to ever by in hot paths, and GPIO access so fare has only been -used to configure the interrupt pin, mode and polarity. Especially -reading inputs is not expected to be common. If your device has GPIO -capabilities in the hot path, you should consider using the kernel's -GPIO mechanisms. diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-chardev.txt b/Documentation/fmc/fmc-chardev.txt deleted file mode 100644 index d9ccb278e597..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-chardev.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,64 +0,0 @@ -fmc-chardev -=========== - -This is a simple generic driver, that allows user access by means of a -character device (actually, one for each mezzanine it takes hold of). - -The char device is created as a misc device. Its name in /dev (as -created by udev) is the same name as the underlying FMC device. Thus, -the name can be a silly fmc-0000 look-alike if the device has no -identifiers nor bus_id, a more specific fmc-0400 if the device has a -bus-specific address but no associated name, or something like -fdelay-0400 if the FMC core can rely on both a mezzanine name and a bus -address. - -Currently the driver only supports read and write: you can lseek to the -desired address and read or write a register. - -The driver assumes all registers are 32-bit in size, and only accepts a -single read or write per system call. However, as a result of Unix read -and write semantics, users can simply fread or fwrite bigger areas in -order to dump or store bigger memory areas. - -There is currently no support for mmap, user-space interrupt management -and DMA buffers. They may be added in later versions, if the need -arises. - -The example below shows raw access to a SPEC card programmed with its -golden FPGA file, that features an SDB structure at offset 256 - i.e. -64 words. The mezzanine's EEPROM in this case is not programmed, so the -default name is fmc-<bus><devfn>, and there are two cards in the system: - - spusa.root# insmod fmc-chardev.ko - [ 1073.339332] spec 0000:02:00.0: Driver has no ID: matches all - [ 1073.345051] spec 0000:02:00.0: Created misc device "fmc-0200" - [ 1073.350821] spec 0000:04:00.0: Driver has no ID: matches all - [ 1073.356525] spec 0000:04:00.0: Created misc device "fmc-0400" - spusa.root# ls -l /dev/fmc* - crw------- 1 root root 10, 58 Nov 20 19:23 /dev/fmc-0200 - crw------- 1 root root 10, 57 Nov 20 19:23 /dev/fmc-0400 - spusa.root# dd bs=4 skip=64 count=1 if=/dev/fmc-0200 2> /dev/null | od -t x1z - 0000000 2d 42 44 53 >-BDS< - 0000004 - -The simple program tools/fmc-mem in this package can access an FMC char -device and read or write a word or a whole area. Actually, the program -is not specific to FMC at all, it just uses lseek, read and write. - -Its first argument is the device name, the second the offset, the third -(if any) the value to write and the optional last argument that must -begin with "+" is the number of bytes to read or write. In case of -repeated reading data is written to stdout; repeated writes read from -stdin and the value argument is ignored. - -The following examples show reading the SDB magic number and the first -SDB record from a SPEC device programmed with its golden image: - - spusa.root# ./fmc-mem /dev/fmc-0200 100 - 5344422d - spusa.root# ./fmc-mem /dev/fmc-0200 100 +40 | od -Ax -t x1z - 000000 2d 42 44 53 00 01 02 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 >-BDS............< - 000010 00 00 00 00 ff 01 00 00 00 00 00 00 51 06 00 00 >............Q...< - 000020 c9 42 a5 e6 02 00 00 00 11 05 12 20 2d 34 42 57 >.B......... -4BW< - 000030 73 6f 72 43 72 61 62 73 49 53 47 2d 00 20 20 20 >sorCrabsISG-. < - 000040 diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-fakedev.txt b/Documentation/fmc/fmc-fakedev.txt deleted file mode 100644 index e85b74a4ae30..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-fakedev.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,36 +0,0 @@ -fmc-fakedev -=========== - -This package includes a software-only device, called fmc-fakedev, which -is able to register up to 4 mezzanines (by default it registers one). -Unlike the SPEC driver, which creates an FMC device for each PCI cards -it manages, this module creates a single instance of its set of -mezzanines. - -It is meant as the simplest possible example of how a driver should be -written, and it includes a fake EEPROM image (built using the tools -described in *note FMC Identification::),, which by default is -replicated for each fake mezzanine. - -You can also use this device to verify the match algorithms, by asking -it to test your own EEPROM image. You can provide the image by means of -the eeprom= module parameter: the new EEPROM image is loaded, as usual, -by means of the firmware loader. This example shows the defaults and a -custom EEPROM image: - - spusa.root# insmod fmc-fakedev.ko - [ 99.971247] fake-fmc-carrier: mezzanine 0 - [ 99.975393] Manufacturer: fake-vendor - [ 99.979624] Product name: fake-design-for-testing - spusa.root# rmmod fmc-fakedev - spusa.root# insmod fmc-fakedev.ko eeprom=fdelay-eeprom.bin - [ 121.447464] fake-fmc-carrier: Mezzanine 0: eeprom "fdelay-eeprom.bin" - [ 121.462725] fake-fmc-carrier: mezzanine 0 - [ 121.466858] Manufacturer: CERN - [ 121.470477] Product name: FmcDelay1ns4cha - spusa.root# rmmod fmc-fakedev - -After loading the device, you can use the write_ee method do modify its -own internal fake EEPROM: whenever the image is overwritten starting at -offset 0, the module will unregister and register again the FMC device. -This is shown in fmc-write-eeprom.txt diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-trivial.txt b/Documentation/fmc/fmc-trivial.txt deleted file mode 100644 index d1910bc67159..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-trivial.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,17 +0,0 @@ -fmc-trivial -=========== - -The simple module fmc-trivial is just a simple client that registers an -interrupt handler. I used it to verify the basic mechanism of the FMC -bus and how interrupts worked. - -The module implements the generic FMC parameters, so it can program a -different gateware file in each card. The whole list of parameters it -accepts are: - -`busid=' -`gateware=' - Generic parameters. See mezzanine.txt - - -This driver is worth reading, in my opinion. diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-write-eeprom.txt b/Documentation/fmc/fmc-write-eeprom.txt deleted file mode 100644 index e0a9712156aa..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/fmc-write-eeprom.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,98 +0,0 @@ -fmc-write-eeprom -================ - -This module is designed to load a binary file from /lib/firmware and to -write it to the internal EEPROM of the mezzanine card. This driver uses -the `busid' generic parameter. - -Overwriting the EEPROM is not something you should do daily, and it is -expected to only happen during manufacturing. For this reason, the -module makes it unlikely for the random user to change a working EEPROM. - -However, since the EEPROM may include application-specific information -other than the identification, later versions of this packages added -write-support through sysfs. See *note Accessing the EEPROM::. - -To avoid damaging the EEPROM content, the module takes the following -measures: - - * It accepts a `file=' argument (within /lib/firmware) and if no - such argument is received, it doesn't write anything to EEPROM - (i.e. there is no default file name). - - * If the file name ends with `.bin' it is written verbatim starting - at offset 0. - - * If the file name ends with `.tlv' it is interpreted as - type-length-value (i.e., it allows writev(2)-like operation). - - * If the file name doesn't match any of the patterns above, it is - ignored and no write is performed. - - * Only cards listed with `busid=' are written to. If no busid is - specified, no programming is done (and the probe function of the - driver will fail). - - -Each TLV tuple is formatted in this way: the header is 5 bytes, -followed by data. The first byte is `w' for write, the next two bytes -represent the address, in little-endian byte order, and the next two -represent the data length, in little-endian order. The length does not -include the header (it is the actual number of bytes to be written). - -This is a real example: that writes 5 bytes at position 0x110: - - spusa.root# od -t x1 -Ax /lib/firmware/try.tlv - 000000 77 10 01 05 00 30 31 32 33 34 - 00000a - spusa.root# insmod /tmp/fmc-write-eeprom.ko busid=0x0200 file=try.tlv - [19983.391498] spec 0000:03:00.0: write 5 bytes at 0x0110 - [19983.414615] spec 0000:03:00.0: write_eeprom: success - -Please note that you'll most likely want to use SDBFS to build your -EEPROM image, at least if your mezzanines are being used in the White -Rabbit environment. For this reason the TLV format is not expected to -be used much and is not expected to be developed further. - -If you want to try reflashing fake EEPROM devices, you can use the -fmc-fakedev.ko module (see *note fmc-fakedev::). Whenever you change -the image starting at offset 0, it will deregister and register again -after two seconds. Please note, however, that if fmc-write-eeprom is -still loaded, the system will associate it to the new device, which -will be reprogrammed and thus will be unloaded after two seconds. The -following example removes the module after it reflashed fakedev the -first time. - - spusa.root# insmod fmc-fakedev.ko - [ 72.984733] fake-fmc: Manufacturer: fake-vendor - [ 72.989434] fake-fmc: Product name: fake-design-for-testing - spusa.root# insmod fmc-write-eeprom.ko busid=0 file=fdelay-eeprom.bin; \ - rmmod fmc-write-eeprom - [ 130.874098] fake-fmc: Matching a generic driver (no ID) - [ 130.887845] fake-fmc: programming 6155 bytes - [ 130.894567] fake-fmc: write_eeprom: success - [ 132.895794] fake-fmc: Manufacturer: CERN - [ 132.899872] fake-fmc: Product name: FmcDelay1ns4cha - - -Accessing the EEPROM -===================== - -The bus creates a sysfs binary file called eeprom for each mezzanine it -knows about: - - spusa.root# cd /sys/bus/fmc/devices; ls -l */eeprom - -r--r--r-- 1 root root 8192 Feb 21 12:30 FmcAdc100m14b4cha-0800/eeprom - -r--r--r-- 1 root root 8192 Feb 21 12:30 FmcDelay1ns4cha-0200/eeprom - -r--r--r-- 1 root root 8192 Feb 21 12:30 FmcDio5cha-0400/eeprom - -Everybody can read the files and the superuser can also modify it, but -the operation may on the carrier driver, if the carrier is unable to -access the I2C bus. For example, the spec driver can access the bus -only with its golden gateware: after a mezzanine driver reprogrammed -the FPGA with a custom circuit, the carrier is unable to access the -EEPROM and returns ENOTSUPP. - -An alternative way to write the EEPROM is the mezzanine driver -fmc-write-eeprom (See *note fmc-write-eeprom::), but the procedure is -more complex. diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/identifiers.txt b/Documentation/fmc/identifiers.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 3bb577ff0d52..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/identifiers.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,168 +0,0 @@ -FMC Identification -****************** - -The FMC standard requires every compliant mezzanine to carry -identification information in an I2C EEPROM. The information must be -laid out according to the "IPMI Platform Management FRU Information", -where IPMI is a lie I'd better not expand, and FRU means "Field -Replaceable Unit". - -The FRU information is an intricate unreadable binary blob that must -live at offset 0 of the EEPROM, and typically extends for a few hundred -bytes. The standard allows the application to use all the remaining -storage area of the EEPROM as it wants. - -This chapter explains how to create your own EEPROM image and how to -write it in your mezzanine, as well as how devices and drivers are -paired at run time. EEPROM programming uses tools that are part of this -package and SDB (part of the fpga-config-space package). - -The first sections are only interesting for manufacturers who need to -write the EEPROM. If you are just a software developer writing an FMC -device or driver, you may jump straight to *note SDB Support::. - - -Building the FRU Structure -========================== - -If you want to know the internals of the FRU structure and despair, you -can retrieve the document from -`http://download.intel.com/design/servers/ipmi/FRU1011.pdf' . The -standard is awful and difficult without reason, so we only support the -minimum mandatory subset - we create a simple structure and parse it -back at run time, but we are not able to either generate or parse more -arcane features like non-english languages and 6-bit text. If you need -more items of the FRU standard for your boards, please submit patches. - -This package includes the Python script that Matthieu Cattin wrote to -generate the FRU binary blob, based on an helper libipmi by Manohar -Vanga and Matthieu himself. I changed the test script to receive -parameters from the command line or from the environment (the command -line takes precedence) - -To make a long story short, in order to build a standard-compliant -binary file to be burned in your EEPROM, you need the following items: - - Environment Opt Official Name Default ---------------------------------------------------------------------- - FRU_VENDOR -v "Board Manufacturer" fmc-example - FRU_NAME -n "Board Product Name" mezzanine - FRU_SERIAL -s `Board Serial Number" 0001 - FRU_PART -p "Board Part Number" sample-part - FRU_OUTPUT -o not applicable /dev/stdout - -The "Official Name" above is what you find in the FRU official -documentation, chapter 11, page 7 ("Board Info Area Format"). The -output option is used to save the generated binary to a specific file -name instead of stdout. - -You can pass the items to the FRU generator either in the environment -or on the command line. This package has currently no support for -specifying power consumption or such stuff, but I plan to add it as -soon as I find some time for that. - -FIXME: consumption etc for FRU are here or in PTS? - -The following example creates a binary image for a specific board: - - ./tools/fru-generator -v CERN -n FmcAdc100m14b4cha \ - -s HCCFFIA___-CR000003 -p EDA-02063-V5-0 > eeprom.bin - -The following example shows a script that builds several binary EEPROM -images for a series of boards, changing the serial number for each of -them. The script uses a mix of environment variables and command line -options, and uses the same string patterns shown above. - - #!/bin/sh - - export FRU_VENDOR="CERN" - export FRU_NAME="FmcAdc100m14b4cha" - export FRU_PART="EDA-02063-V5-0" - - serial="HCCFFIA___-CR" - - for number in $(seq 1 50); do - # build number-string "ns" - ns="$(printf %06d $number)" - ./fru-generator -s "${serial}${ns}" > eeprom-${ns}.bin - done - - -Using SDB-FS in the EEPROM -========================== - -If you want to use SDB as a filesystem in the EEPROM device within the -mezzanine, you should create one such filesystem using gensdbfs, from -the fpga-config-space package on OHWR. - -By using an SBD filesystem you can cluster several files in a single -EEPROM, so both the host system and a soft-core running in the FPGA (if -any) can access extra production-time information. - -We chose to use SDB as a storage filesystem because the format is very -simple, and both the host system and the soft-core will likely already -include support code for such format. The SDB library offered by the -fpga-config-space is less than 1kB under LM32, so it proves quite up to -the task. - -The SDB entry point (which acts as a directory listing) cannot live at -offset zero in the flash device, because the FRU information must live -there. To avoid wasting precious storage space while still allowing -for more-than-minimal FRU structures, the fmc.ko will look for the SDB -record at address 256, 512 and 1024. - -In order to generate the complete EEPROM image you'll need a -configuration file for gensdbfs: you tell the program where to place -the sdb entry point, and you must force the FRU data file to be placed -at the beginning of the storage device. If needed, you can also place -other files at a special offset (we sometimes do it for backward -compatibility with drivers we wrote before implementing SDB for flash -memory). - -The directory tools/sdbfs of this package includes a well-commented -example that you may want to use as a starting point (the comments are -in the file called -SDB-CONFIG-). Reading documentation for gensdbfs -is a suggested first step anyways. - -This package (generic FMC bus support) only accesses two files in the -EEPROM: the FRU information, at offset zero, with a suggested filename -of IPMI-FRU and the short name for the mezzanine, in a file called -name. The IPMI-FRU name is not mandatory, but a strongly suggested -choice; the name filename is mandatory, because this is the preferred -short name used by the FMC core. For example, a name of "fdelay" may -supplement a Product Name like "FmcDelay1ns4cha" - exactly as -demonstrated in `tools/sdbfs'. - -Note: SDB access to flash memory is not yet supported, so the short -name currently in use is just the "Product Name" FRU string. - -The example in tools/sdbfs includes an extra file, that is needed by -the fine-delay driver, and must live at a known address of 0x1800. By -running gensdbfs on that directory you can output your binary EEPROM -image (here below spusa$ is the shell prompt): - - spusa$ ../fru-generator -v CERN -n FmcDelay1ns4cha -s proto-0 \ - -p EDA-02267-V3 > IPMI-FRU - spusa$ ls -l - total 16 - -rw-rw-r-- 1 rubini staff 975 Nov 19 18:08 --SDB-CONFIG-- - -rw-rw-r-- 1 rubini staff 216 Nov 19 18:13 IPMI-FRU - -rw-rw-r-- 1 rubini staff 11 Nov 19 18:04 fd-calib - -rw-rw-r-- 1 rubini staff 7 Nov 19 18:04 name - spusa$ sudo gensdbfs . /lib/firmware/fdelay-eeprom.bin - spusa$ sdb-read -l -e 0x100 /lib/firmware/fdelay-eeprom.bin - /home/rubini/wip/sdbfs/userspace/sdb-read: listing format is to be defined - 46696c6544617461:2e202020 00000100-000018ff . - 46696c6544617461:6e616d65 00000200-00000206 name - 46696c6544617461:66642d63 00001800-000018ff fd-calib - 46696c6544617461:49504d49 00000000-000000d7 IPMI-FRU - spusa$ ../fru-dump /lib/firmware/fdelay-eeprom.bin - /lib/firmware/fdelay-eeprom.bin: manufacturer: CERN - /lib/firmware/fdelay-eeprom.bin: product-name: FmcDelay1ns4cha - /lib/firmware/fdelay-eeprom.bin: serial-number: proto-0 - /lib/firmware/fdelay-eeprom.bin: part-number: EDA-02267-V3 - -As expected, the output file is both a proper sdbfs object and an IPMI -FRU information blob. The fd-calib file lives at offset 0x1800 and is -over-allocated to 256 bytes, according to the configuration file for -gensdbfs. diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/mezzanine.txt b/Documentation/fmc/mezzanine.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 87910dbfc91e..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/mezzanine.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,123 +0,0 @@ -FMC Driver -********** - -An FMC driver is concerned with the specific mezzanine and associated -gateware. As such, it is expected to be independent of the carrier -being used: it will perform I/O accesses only by means of -carrier-provided functions. - -The matching between device and driver is based on the content of the -EEPROM (as mandated by the FMC standard) or by the actual cores -configured in the FPGA; the latter technique is used when the FPGA is -already programmed when the device is registered to the bus core. - -In some special cases it is possible for a driver to directly access -FPGA registers, by means of the `fpga_base' field of the device -structure. This may be needed for high-bandwidth peripherals like fast -ADC cards. If the device module registered a remote device (for example -by means of Etherbone), the `fpga_base' pointer will be NULL. -Therefore, drivers must be ready to deal with NULL base pointers, and -fail gracefully. Most driver, however, are not expected to access the -pointer directly but run fmc_readl and fmc_writel instead, which will -work in any case. - -In even more special cases, the driver may access carrier-specific -functionality: the `carrier_name' string allows the driver to check -which is the current carrier and make use of the `carrier_data' -pointer. We chose to use carrier names rather than numeric identifiers -for greater flexibility, but also to avoid a central registry within -the `fmc.h' file - we hope other users will exploit our framework with -their own carriers. An example use of carrier names is in GPIO setup -(see *note The GPIO Abstraction::), although the name match is not -expected to be performed by the driver. If you depend on specific -carriers, please check the carrier name and fail gracefully if your -driver finds it is running in a yet-unknown-to-it environment. - - -ID Table -======== - -Like most other Linux drivers, and FMC driver must list all the devices -which it is able to drive. This is usually done by means of a device -table, but in FMC we can match hardware based either on the contents of -their EEPROM or on the actual FPGA cores that can be enumerated. -Therefore, we have two tables of identifiers. - -Matching of FRU information depends on two names, the manufacturer (or -vendor) and the device (see *note FMC Identification::); for -flexibility during production (i.e. before writing to the EEPROM) the -bus supports a catch-all driver that specifies NULL strings. For this -reason, the table is specified as pointer-and-length, not a a -null-terminated array - the entry with NULL names can be a valid entry. - -Matching on FPGA cores depends on two numeric fields: the 64-bit vendor -number and the 32-bit device number. Support for matching based on -class is not yet implemented. Each device is expected to be uniquely -identified by an array of cores (it matches if all of the cores are -instantiated), and for consistency the list is passed as -pointer-and-length. Several similar devices can be driven by the same -driver, and thus the driver specifies and array of such arrays. - -The complete set of involved data structures is thus the following: - - struct fmc_fru_id { char *manufacturer; char *product_name; }; - struct fmc_sdb_one_id { uint64_t vendor; uint32_t device; }; - struct fmc_sdb_id { struct fmc_sdb_one_id *cores; int cores_nr; }; - - struct fmc_device_id { - struct fmc_fru_id *fru_id; int fru_id_nr; - struct fmc_sdb_id *sdb_id; int sdb_id_nr; - }; - -A better reference, with full explanation, is the <linux/fmc.h> header. - - -Module Parameters -================= - -Most of the FMC drivers need the same set of kernel parameters. This -package includes support to implement common parameters by means of -fields in the `fmc_driver' structure and simple macro definitions. - -The parameters are carrier-specific, in that they rely on the busid -concept, that varies among carriers. For the SPEC, the identifier is a -PCI bus and devfn number, 16 bits wide in total; drivers for other -carriers will most likely offer something similar but not identical, -and some code duplication is unavoidable. - -This is the list of parameters that are common to several modules to -see how they are actually used, please look at spec-trivial.c. - -`busid=' - This is an array of integers, listing carrier-specific - identification numbers. For PIC, for example, `0x0400' represents - bus 4, slot 0. If any such ID is specified, the driver will only - accept to drive cards that appear in the list (even if the FMC ID - matches). This is accomplished by the validate carrier method. - -`gateware=' - The argument is an array of strings. If no busid= is specified, - the first string of gateware= is used for all cards; otherwise the - identifiers and gateware names are paired one by one, in the order - specified. - -`show_sdb=' - For modules supporting it, this parameter asks to show the SDB - internal structure by means of kernel messages. It is disabled by - default because those lines tend to hide more important messages, - if you look at the system console while loading the drivers. - Note: the parameter is being obsoleted, because fmc.ko itself now - supports dump_sdb= that applies to every client driver. - - -For example, if you are using the trivial driver to load two different -gateware files to two different cards, you can use the following -parameters to load different binaries to the cards, after looking up -the PCI identifiers. This has been tested with a SPEC carrier. - - insmod fmc-trivial.ko \ - busid=0x0200,0x0400 \ - gateware=fmc/fine-delay.bin,fmc/simple-dio.bin - -Please note that not all sub-modules support all of those parameters. -You can use modinfo to check what is supported by each module. diff --git a/Documentation/fmc/parameters.txt b/Documentation/fmc/parameters.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 59edf088e3a4..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/fmc/parameters.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,56 +0,0 @@ -Module Parameters in fmc.ko -*************************** - -The core driver receives two module parameters, meant to help debugging -client modules. Both parameters can be modified by writing to -/sys/module/fmc/parameters/, because they are used when client drivers -are devices are registered, not when fmc.ko is loaded. - -`dump_eeprom=' - If not zero, the parameter asks the bus controller to dump the - EEPROM of any device that is registered, using printk. - -`dump_sdb=' - If not zero, the parameter prints the SDB tree of every FPGA it is - loaded by fmc_reprogram(). If greater than one, it asks to dump - the binary content of SDB records. This currently only dumps the - top-level SDB array, though. - - -EEPROM dumping avoids repeating lines, since most of the contents is -usually empty and all bits are one or zero. This is an example of the -output: - - [ 6625.850480] spec 0000:02:00.0: FPGA programming successful - [ 6626.139949] spec 0000:02:00.0: Manufacturer: CERN - [ 6626.144666] spec 0000:02:00.0: Product name: FmcDelay1ns4cha - [ 6626.150370] FMC: mezzanine 0: 0000:02:00.0 on SPEC - [ 6626.155179] FMC: dumping eeprom 0x2000 (8192) bytes - [ 6626.160087] 0000: 01 00 00 01 00 0b 00 f3 01 0a 00 a5 85 87 c4 43 - [ 6626.167069] 0010: 45 52 4e cf 46 6d 63 44 65 6c 61 79 31 6e 73 34 - [ 6626.174019] 0020: 63 68 61 c7 70 72 6f 74 6f 2d 30 cc 45 44 41 2d - [ 6626.180975] 0030: 30 32 32 36 37 2d 56 33 da 32 30 31 32 2d 31 31 - [...] - [ 6626.371366] 0200: 66 64 65 6c 61 79 0a 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 - [ 6626.378359] 0210: 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 - [ 6626.385361] [...] - [ 6626.387308] 1800: 70 6c 61 63 65 68 6f 6c 64 65 72 ff ff ff ff ff - [ 6626.394259] 1810: ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff ff - [ 6626.401250] [...] - -The dump of SDB looks like the following; the example shows the simple -golden gateware for the SPEC card, removing the leading timestamps to -fit the page: - - spec 0000:02:00.0: SDB: 00000651:e6a542c9 WB4-Crossbar-GSI - spec 0000:02:00.0: SDB: 0000ce42:ff07fc47 WR-Periph-Syscon (00000000-000000ff) - FMC: mezzanine 0: 0000:02:00.0 on SPEC - FMC: poor dump of sdb first level: - 0000: 53 44 42 2d 00 02 01 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 - 0010: 00 00 00 00 00 00 01 ff 00 00 00 00 00 00 06 51 - 0020: e6 a5 42 c9 00 00 00 02 20 12 05 11 57 42 34 2d - 0030: 43 72 6f 73 73 62 61 72 2d 47 53 49 20 20 20 00 - 0040: 00 00 01 01 00 00 00 07 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 - 0050: 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 ff 00 00 00 00 00 00 ce 42 - 0060: ff 07 fc 47 00 00 00 01 20 12 03 05 57 52 2d 50 - 0070: 65 72 69 70 68 2d 53 79 73 63 6f 6e 20 20 20 01 diff --git a/Documentation/laptops/thinkpad-acpi.txt b/Documentation/laptops/thinkpad-acpi.txt index 6cced88de6da..75ef063622d2 100644 --- a/Documentation/laptops/thinkpad-acpi.txt +++ b/Documentation/laptops/thinkpad-acpi.txt @@ -679,7 +679,7 @@ status as "unknown". The available commands are: sysfs notes: The ThinkLight sysfs interface is documented by the LED class -documentation, in Documentation/leds/leds-class.txt. The ThinkLight LED name +documentation, in Documentation/leds/leds-class.rst. The ThinkLight LED name is "tpacpi::thinklight". Due to limitations in the sysfs LED class, if the status of the ThinkLight @@ -779,7 +779,7 @@ All of the above can be turned on and off and can be made to blink. sysfs notes: The ThinkPad LED sysfs interface is described in detail by the LED class -documentation, in Documentation/leds/leds-class.txt. +documentation, in Documentation/leds/leds-class.rst. The LEDs are named (in LED ID order, from 0 to 12): "tpacpi::power", "tpacpi:orange:batt", "tpacpi:green:batt", diff --git a/Documentation/leds/index.rst b/Documentation/leds/index.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..9885f7c1b75d --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/leds/index.rst @@ -0,0 +1,25 @@ +:orphan: + +==== +LEDs +==== + +.. toctree:: + :maxdepth: 1 + + leds-class + leds-class-flash + ledtrig-oneshot + ledtrig-transient + ledtrig-usbport + + uleds + + leds-blinkm + leds-lm3556 + leds-lp3944 + leds-lp5521 + leds-lp5523 + leds-lp5562 + leds-lp55xx + leds-mlxcpld diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-blinkm.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-blinkm.rst index 9dd92f4cf4e1..c74b5bc877b1 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-blinkm.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-blinkm.rst @@ -1,3 +1,7 @@ +================== +Leds BlinkM driver +================== + The leds-blinkm driver supports the devices of the BlinkM family. They are RGB-LED modules driven by a (AT)tiny microcontroller and @@ -14,35 +18,36 @@ The interface this driver provides is 2-fold: a) LED class interface for use with triggers ############################################ -The registration follows the scheme: -blinkm-<i2c-bus-nr>-<i2c-device-nr>-<color> +The registration follows the scheme:: + + blinkm-<i2c-bus-nr>-<i2c-device-nr>-<color> -$ ls -h /sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-* -/sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-9-blue: -brightness device max_brightness power subsystem trigger uevent + $ ls -h /sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-* + /sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-9-blue: + brightness device max_brightness power subsystem trigger uevent -/sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-9-green: -brightness device max_brightness power subsystem trigger uevent + /sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-9-green: + brightness device max_brightness power subsystem trigger uevent -/sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-9-red: -brightness device max_brightness power subsystem trigger uevent + /sys/class/leds/blinkm-6-9-red: + brightness device max_brightness power subsystem trigger uevent (same is /sys/bus/i2c/devices/6-0009/leds) We can control the colors separated into red, green and blue and assign triggers on each color. -E.g.: +E.g.:: -$ cat blinkm-6-9-blue/brightness -05 + $ cat blinkm-6-9-blue/brightness + 05 -$ echo 200 > blinkm-6-9-blue/brightness -$ + $ echo 200 > blinkm-6-9-blue/brightness + $ -$ modprobe ledtrig-heartbeat -$ echo heartbeat > blinkm-6-9-green/trigger -$ + $ modprobe ledtrig-heartbeat + $ echo heartbeat > blinkm-6-9-green/trigger + $ b) Sysfs group to control rgb, fade, hsb, scripts ... @@ -52,29 +57,28 @@ This extended interface is available as folder blinkm in the sysfs folder of the I2C device. E.g. below /sys/bus/i2c/devices/6-0009/blinkm -$ ls -h /sys/bus/i2c/devices/6-0009/blinkm/ -blue green red test + $ ls -h /sys/bus/i2c/devices/6-0009/blinkm/ + blue green red test Currently supported is just setting red, green, blue and a test sequence. -E.g.: +E.g.:: -$ cat * -00 -00 -00 -#Write into test to start test sequence!# + $ cat * + 00 + 00 + 00 + #Write into test to start test sequence!# -$ echo 1 > test -$ + $ echo 1 > test + $ -$ echo 255 > red -$ + $ echo 255 > red + $ as of 6/2012 dl9pf <at> gmx <dot> de - diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-class-flash.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-class-flash.rst index 8da3c6f4b60b..6ec12c5a1a0e 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-class-flash.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-class-flash.rst @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ - +============================== Flash LED handling under Linux ============================== Some LED devices provide two modes - torch and flash. In the LED subsystem -those modes are supported by LED class (see Documentation/leds/leds-class.txt) +those modes are supported by LED class (see Documentation/leds/leds-class.rst) and LED Flash class respectively. The torch mode related features are enabled by default and the flash ones only if a driver declares it by setting LED_DEV_CAP_FLASH flag. @@ -14,6 +14,7 @@ registered in the LED subsystem with led_classdev_flash_register function. Following sysfs attributes are exposed for controlling flash LED devices: (see Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-led-flash) + - flash_brightness - max_flash_brightness - flash_timeout @@ -31,30 +32,46 @@ be defined in the kernel config. The driver must call the v4l2_flash_init function to get registered in the V4L2 subsystem. The function takes six arguments: -- dev : flash device, e.g. an I2C device -- of_node : of_node of the LED, may be NULL if the same as device's -- fled_cdev : LED flash class device to wrap -- iled_cdev : LED flash class device representing indicator LED associated with - fled_cdev, may be NULL -- ops : V4L2 specific ops - * external_strobe_set - defines the source of the flash LED strobe - + +- dev: + flash device, e.g. an I2C device +- of_node: + of_node of the LED, may be NULL if the same as device's +- fled_cdev: + LED flash class device to wrap +- iled_cdev: + LED flash class device representing indicator LED associated with + fled_cdev, may be NULL +- ops: + V4L2 specific ops + + * external_strobe_set + defines the source of the flash LED strobe - V4L2_CID_FLASH_STROBE control or external source, typically a sensor, which makes it possible to synchronise the flash strobe start with exposure start, - * intensity_to_led_brightness and led_brightness_to_intensity - perform + * intensity_to_led_brightness and led_brightness_to_intensity + perform enum led_brightness <-> V4L2 intensity conversion in a device specific manner - they can be used for devices with non-linear LED current scale. -- config : configuration for V4L2 Flash sub-device - * dev_name - the name of the media entity, unique in the system, - * flash_faults - bitmask of flash faults that the LED flash class +- config: + configuration for V4L2 Flash sub-device + + * dev_name + the name of the media entity, unique in the system, + * flash_faults + bitmask of flash faults that the LED flash class device can report; corresponding LED_FAULT* bit definitions are available in <linux/led-class-flash.h>, - * torch_intensity - constraints for the LED in TORCH mode + * torch_intensity + constraints for the LED in TORCH mode in microamperes, - * indicator_intensity - constraints for the indicator LED + * indicator_intensity + constraints for the indicator LED in microamperes, - * has_external_strobe - determines whether the flash strobe source + * has_external_strobe + determines whether the flash strobe source can be switched to external, On remove the v4l2_flash_release function has to be called, which takes one diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-class.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-class.rst index 8b39cc6b03ee..df0120a1ee3c 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-class.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-class.rst @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ - +======================== LED handling under Linux ======================== @@ -43,7 +43,7 @@ LED Device Naming Is currently of the form: -"devicename:colour:function" + "devicename:colour:function" There have been calls for LED properties such as colour to be exported as individual led class attributes. As a solution which doesn't incur as much @@ -57,9 +57,12 @@ Brightness setting API LED subsystem core exposes following API for setting brightness: - - led_set_brightness : it is guaranteed not to sleep, passing LED_OFF stops + - led_set_brightness: + it is guaranteed not to sleep, passing LED_OFF stops blinking, - - led_set_brightness_sync : for use cases when immediate effect is desired - + + - led_set_brightness_sync: + for use cases when immediate effect is desired - it can block the caller for the time required for accessing device registers and can sleep, passing LED_OFF stops hardware blinking, returns -EBUSY if software blink fallback is enabled. @@ -70,7 +73,7 @@ LED registration API A driver wanting to register a LED classdev for use by other drivers / userspace needs to allocate and fill a led_classdev struct and then call -[devm_]led_classdev_register. If the non devm version is used the driver +`[devm_]led_classdev_register`. If the non devm version is used the driver must call led_classdev_unregister from its remove function before free-ing the led_classdev struct. @@ -94,7 +97,7 @@ with brightness value LED_OFF, which should stop any software timers that may have been required for blinking. The blink_set() function should choose a user friendly blinking value -if it is called with *delay_on==0 && *delay_off==0 parameters. In this +if it is called with `*delay_on==0` && `*delay_off==0` parameters. In this case the driver should give back the chosen value through delay_on and delay_off parameters to the leds subsystem. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lm3556.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-lm3556.rst index 62278e871b50..1ef17d7d800e 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-lm3556.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-lm3556.rst @@ -1,68 +1,118 @@ +======================== Kernel driver for lm3556 ======================== -*Texas Instrument: - 1.5 A Synchronous Boost LED Flash Driver w/ High-Side Current Source +* Texas Instrument: + 1.5 A Synchronous Boost LED Flash Driver w/ High-Side Current Source * Datasheet: http://www.national.com/ds/LM/LM3556.pdf Authors: - Daniel Jeong + - Daniel Jeong + Contact:Daniel Jeong(daniel.jeong-at-ti.com, gshark.jeong-at-gmail.com) Description ----------- There are 3 functions in LM3556, Flash, Torch and Indicator. -FLASH MODE +Flash Mode +^^^^^^^^^^ + In Flash Mode, the LED current source(LED) provides 16 target current levels from 93.75 mA to 1500 mA.The Flash currents are adjusted via the CURRENT CONTROL REGISTER(0x09).Flash mode is activated by the ENABLE REGISTER(0x0A), or by pulling the STROBE pin HIGH. + LM3556 Flash can be controlled through sys/class/leds/flash/brightness file + * if STROBE pin is enabled, below example control brightness only, and -ON / OFF will be controlled by STROBE pin. + ON / OFF will be controlled by STROBE pin. Flash Example: -OFF : #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/flash/brightness -93.75 mA: #echo 1 > sys/class/leds/flash/brightness -... ..... -1500 mA: #echo 16 > sys/class/leds/flash/brightness -TORCH MODE +OFF:: + + #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/flash/brightness + +93.75 mA:: + + #echo 1 > sys/class/leds/flash/brightness + +... + +1500 mA:: + + #echo 16 > sys/class/leds/flash/brightness + +Torch Mode +^^^^^^^^^^ + In Torch Mode, the current source(LED) is programmed via the CURRENT CONTROL REGISTER(0x09).Torch Mode is activated by the ENABLE REGISTER(0x0A) or by the hardware TORCH input. + LM3556 torch can be controlled through sys/class/leds/torch/brightness file. * if TORCH pin is enabled, below example control brightness only, and ON / OFF will be controlled by TORCH pin. Torch Example: -OFF : #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/torch/brightness -46.88 mA: #echo 1 > sys/class/leds/torch/brightness -... ..... -375 mA : #echo 8 > sys/class/leds/torch/brightness -INDICATOR MODE +OFF:: + + #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/torch/brightness + +46.88 mA:: + + #echo 1 > sys/class/leds/torch/brightness + +... + +375 mA:: + + #echo 8 > sys/class/leds/torch/brightness + +Indicator Mode +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + Indicator pattern can be set through sys/class/leds/indicator/pattern file, and 4 patterns are pre-defined in indicator_pattern array. + According to N-lank, Pulse time and N Period values, different pattern wiill be generated.If you want new patterns for your own device, change indicator_pattern array with your own values and INDIC_PATTERN_SIZE. + Please refer datasheet for more detail about N-Blank, Pulse time and N Period. Indicator pattern example: -pattern 0: #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/indicator/pattern -.... -pattern 3: #echo 3 > sys/class/leds/indicator/pattern + +pattern 0:: + + #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/indicator/pattern + +... + +pattern 3:: + + #echo 3 > sys/class/leds/indicator/pattern Indicator brightness can be controlled through sys/class/leds/indicator/brightness file. Example: -OFF : #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/indicator/brightness -5.86 mA : #echo 1 > sys/class/leds/indicator/brightness -........ -46.875mA : #echo 8 > sys/class/leds/indicator/brightness + +OFF:: + + #echo 0 > sys/class/leds/indicator/brightness + +5.86 mA:: + + #echo 1 > sys/class/leds/indicator/brightness + +... + +46.875mA:: + + #echo 8 > sys/class/leds/indicator/brightness Notes ----- @@ -70,7 +120,8 @@ Driver expects it is registered using the i2c_board_info mechanism. To register the chip at address 0x63 on specific adapter, set the platform data according to include/linux/platform_data/leds-lm3556.h, set the i2c board info -Example: +Example:: + static struct i2c_board_info board_i2c_ch4[] __initdata = { { I2C_BOARD_INFO(LM3556_NAME, 0x63), @@ -80,6 +131,7 @@ Example: and register it in the platform init function -Example: +Example:: + board_register_i2c_bus(4, 400, board_i2c_ch4, ARRAY_SIZE(board_i2c_ch4)); diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp3944.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp3944.rst index e88ac3b60c08..c2f87dc1a3a9 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp3944.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp3944.rst @@ -1,14 +1,20 @@ +==================== Kernel driver lp3944 ==================== * National Semiconductor LP3944 Fun-light Chip + Prefix: 'lp3944' + Addresses scanned: None (see the Notes section below) - Datasheet: Publicly available at the National Semiconductor website - http://www.national.com/pf/LP/LP3944.html + + Datasheet: + + Publicly available at the National Semiconductor website + http://www.national.com/pf/LP/LP3944.html Authors: - Antonio Ospite <ospite@studenti.unina.it> + Antonio Ospite <ospite@studenti.unina.it> Description @@ -19,8 +25,11 @@ is used as a led controller. The DIM modes are used to set _blink_ patterns for leds, the pattern is specified supplying two parameters: - - period: from 0s to 1.6s - - duty cycle: percentage of the period the led is on, from 0 to 100 + + - period: + from 0s to 1.6s + - duty cycle: + percentage of the period the led is on, from 0 to 100 Setting a led in DIM0 or DIM1 mode makes it blink according to the pattern. See the datasheet for details. @@ -35,7 +44,7 @@ The chip is used mainly in embedded contexts, so this driver expects it is registered using the i2c_board_info mechanism. To register the chip at address 0x60 on adapter 0, set the platform data -according to include/linux/leds-lp3944.h, set the i2c board info: +according to include/linux/leds-lp3944.h, set the i2c board info:: static struct i2c_board_info a910_i2c_board_info[] __initdata = { { @@ -44,7 +53,7 @@ according to include/linux/leds-lp3944.h, set the i2c board info: }, }; -and register it in the platform init function +and register it in the platform init function:: i2c_register_board_info(0, a910_i2c_board_info, ARRAY_SIZE(a910_i2c_board_info)); diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.rst b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..0432615b083d --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.rst @@ -0,0 +1,115 @@ +======================== +Kernel driver for lp5521 +======================== + +* National Semiconductor LP5521 led driver chip +* Datasheet: http://www.national.com/pf/LP/LP5521.html + +Authors: Mathias Nyman, Yuri Zaporozhets, Samu Onkalo + +Contact: Samu Onkalo (samu.p.onkalo-at-nokia.com) + +Description +----------- + +LP5521 can drive up to 3 channels. Leds can be controlled directly via +the led class control interface. Channels have generic names: +lp5521:channelx, where x is 0 .. 2 + +All three channels can be also controlled using the engine micro programs. +More details of the instructions can be found from the public data sheet. + +LP5521 has the internal program memory for running various LED patterns. +There are two ways to run LED patterns. + +1) Legacy interface - enginex_mode and enginex_load + Control interface for the engines: + + x is 1 .. 3 + + enginex_mode: + disabled, load, run + enginex_load: + store program (visible only in engine load mode) + + Example (start to blink the channel 2 led):: + + cd /sys/class/leds/lp5521:channel2/device + echo "load" > engine3_mode + echo "037f4d0003ff6000" > engine3_load + echo "run" > engine3_mode + + To stop the engine:: + + echo "disabled" > engine3_mode + +2) Firmware interface - LP55xx common interface + +For the details, please refer to 'firmware' section in leds-lp55xx.txt + +sysfs contains a selftest entry. + +The test communicates with the chip and checks that +the clock mode is automatically set to the requested one. + +Each channel has its own led current settings. + +- /sys/class/leds/lp5521:channel0/led_current - RW +- /sys/class/leds/lp5521:channel0/max_current - RO + +Format: 10x mA i.e 10 means 1.0 mA + +example platform data:: + + static struct lp55xx_led_config lp5521_led_config[] = { + { + .name = "red", + .chan_nr = 0, + .led_current = 50, + .max_current = 130, + }, { + .name = "green", + .chan_nr = 1, + .led_current = 0, + .max_current = 130, + }, { + .name = "blue", + .chan_nr = 2, + .led_current = 0, + .max_current = 130, + } + }; + + static int lp5521_setup(void) + { + /* setup HW resources */ + } + + static void lp5521_release(void) + { + /* Release HW resources */ + } + + static void lp5521_enable(bool state) + { + /* Control of chip enable signal */ + } + + static struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5521_platform_data = { + .led_config = lp5521_led_config, + .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5521_led_config), + .clock_mode = LP55XX_CLOCK_EXT, + .setup_resources = lp5521_setup, + .release_resources = lp5521_release, + .enable = lp5521_enable, + }; + +Note: + chan_nr can have values between 0 and 2. + The name of each channel can be configurable. + If the name field is not defined, the default name will be set to 'xxxx:channelN' + (XXXX : pdata->label or i2c client name, N : channel number) + + +If the current is set to 0 in the platform data, that channel is +disabled and it is not visible in the sysfs. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt deleted file mode 100644 index d08d8c179f85..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5521.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,101 +0,0 @@ -Kernel driver for lp5521 -======================== - -* National Semiconductor LP5521 led driver chip -* Datasheet: http://www.national.com/pf/LP/LP5521.html - -Authors: Mathias Nyman, Yuri Zaporozhets, Samu Onkalo -Contact: Samu Onkalo (samu.p.onkalo-at-nokia.com) - -Description ------------ - -LP5521 can drive up to 3 channels. Leds can be controlled directly via -the led class control interface. Channels have generic names: -lp5521:channelx, where x is 0 .. 2 - -All three channels can be also controlled using the engine micro programs. -More details of the instructions can be found from the public data sheet. - -LP5521 has the internal program memory for running various LED patterns. -There are two ways to run LED patterns. - -1) Legacy interface - enginex_mode and enginex_load - Control interface for the engines: - x is 1 .. 3 - enginex_mode : disabled, load, run - enginex_load : store program (visible only in engine load mode) - - Example (start to blink the channel 2 led): - cd /sys/class/leds/lp5521:channel2/device - echo "load" > engine3_mode - echo "037f4d0003ff6000" > engine3_load - echo "run" > engine3_mode - - To stop the engine: - echo "disabled" > engine3_mode - -2) Firmware interface - LP55xx common interface - For the details, please refer to 'firmware' section in leds-lp55xx.txt - -sysfs contains a selftest entry. -The test communicates with the chip and checks that -the clock mode is automatically set to the requested one. - -Each channel has its own led current settings. -/sys/class/leds/lp5521:channel0/led_current - RW -/sys/class/leds/lp5521:channel0/max_current - RO -Format: 10x mA i.e 10 means 1.0 mA - -example platform data: - -Note: chan_nr can have values between 0 and 2. -The name of each channel can be configurable. -If the name field is not defined, the default name will be set to 'xxxx:channelN' -(XXXX : pdata->label or i2c client name, N : channel number) - -static struct lp55xx_led_config lp5521_led_config[] = { - { - .name = "red", - .chan_nr = 0, - .led_current = 50, - .max_current = 130, - }, { - .name = "green", - .chan_nr = 1, - .led_current = 0, - .max_current = 130, - }, { - .name = "blue", - .chan_nr = 2, - .led_current = 0, - .max_current = 130, - } -}; - -static int lp5521_setup(void) -{ - /* setup HW resources */ -} - -static void lp5521_release(void) -{ - /* Release HW resources */ -} - -static void lp5521_enable(bool state) -{ - /* Control of chip enable signal */ -} - -static struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5521_platform_data = { - .led_config = lp5521_led_config, - .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5521_led_config), - .clock_mode = LP55XX_CLOCK_EXT, - .setup_resources = lp5521_setup, - .release_resources = lp5521_release, - .enable = lp5521_enable, -}; - -If the current is set to 0 in the platform data, that channel is -disabled and it is not visible in the sysfs. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5523.rst b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5523.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..7d7362a1dd57 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5523.rst @@ -0,0 +1,147 @@ +======================== +Kernel driver for lp5523 +======================== + +* National Semiconductor LP5523 led driver chip +* Datasheet: http://www.national.com/pf/LP/LP5523.html + +Authors: Mathias Nyman, Yuri Zaporozhets, Samu Onkalo +Contact: Samu Onkalo (samu.p.onkalo-at-nokia.com) + +Description +----------- +LP5523 can drive up to 9 channels. Leds can be controlled directly via +the led class control interface. +The name of each channel is configurable in the platform data - name and label. +There are three options to make the channel name. + +a) Define the 'name' in the platform data + +To make specific channel name, then use 'name' platform data. + +- /sys/class/leds/R1 (name: 'R1') +- /sys/class/leds/B1 (name: 'B1') + +b) Use the 'label' with no 'name' field + +For one device name with channel number, then use 'label'. +- /sys/class/leds/RGB:channelN (label: 'RGB', N: 0 ~ 8) + +c) Default + +If both fields are NULL, 'lp5523' is used by default. +- /sys/class/leds/lp5523:channelN (N: 0 ~ 8) + +LP5523 has the internal program memory for running various LED patterns. +There are two ways to run LED patterns. + +1) Legacy interface - enginex_mode, enginex_load and enginex_leds + + Control interface for the engines: + + x is 1 .. 3 + + enginex_mode: + disabled, load, run + enginex_load: + microcode load + enginex_leds: + led mux control + + :: + + cd /sys/class/leds/lp5523:channel2/device + echo "load" > engine3_mode + echo "9d80400004ff05ff437f0000" > engine3_load + echo "111111111" > engine3_leds + echo "run" > engine3_mode + + To stop the engine:: + + echo "disabled" > engine3_mode + +2) Firmware interface - LP55xx common interface + +For the details, please refer to 'firmware' section in leds-lp55xx.txt + +LP5523 has three master faders. If a channel is mapped to one of +the master faders, its output is dimmed based on the value of the master +fader. + +For example:: + + echo "123000123" > master_fader_leds + +creates the following channel-fader mappings:: + + channel 0,6 to master_fader1 + channel 1,7 to master_fader2 + channel 2,8 to master_fader3 + +Then, to have 25% of the original output on channel 0,6:: + + echo 64 > master_fader1 + +To have 0% of the original output (i.e. no output) channel 1,7:: + + echo 0 > master_fader2 + +To have 100% of the original output (i.e. no dimming) on channel 2,8:: + + echo 255 > master_fader3 + +To clear all master fader controls:: + + echo "000000000" > master_fader_leds + +Selftest uses always the current from the platform data. + +Each channel contains led current settings. +- /sys/class/leds/lp5523:channel2/led_current - RW +- /sys/class/leds/lp5523:channel2/max_current - RO + +Format: 10x mA i.e 10 means 1.0 mA + +Example platform data:: + + static struct lp55xx_led_config lp5523_led_config[] = { + { + .name = "D1", + .chan_nr = 0, + .led_current = 50, + .max_current = 130, + }, + ... + { + .chan_nr = 8, + .led_current = 50, + .max_current = 130, + } + }; + + static int lp5523_setup(void) + { + /* Setup HW resources */ + } + + static void lp5523_release(void) + { + /* Release HW resources */ + } + + static void lp5523_enable(bool state) + { + /* Control chip enable signal */ + } + + static struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5523_platform_data = { + .led_config = lp5523_led_config, + .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5523_led_config), + .clock_mode = LP55XX_CLOCK_EXT, + .setup_resources = lp5523_setup, + .release_resources = lp5523_release, + .enable = lp5523_enable, + }; + +Note + chan_nr can have values between 0 and 8. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5523.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5523.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 0961a060fc4d..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5523.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,130 +0,0 @@ -Kernel driver for lp5523 -======================== - -* National Semiconductor LP5523 led driver chip -* Datasheet: http://www.national.com/pf/LP/LP5523.html - -Authors: Mathias Nyman, Yuri Zaporozhets, Samu Onkalo -Contact: Samu Onkalo (samu.p.onkalo-at-nokia.com) - -Description ------------ -LP5523 can drive up to 9 channels. Leds can be controlled directly via -the led class control interface. -The name of each channel is configurable in the platform data - name and label. -There are three options to make the channel name. - -a) Define the 'name' in the platform data -To make specific channel name, then use 'name' platform data. -/sys/class/leds/R1 (name: 'R1') -/sys/class/leds/B1 (name: 'B1') - -b) Use the 'label' with no 'name' field -For one device name with channel number, then use 'label'. -/sys/class/leds/RGB:channelN (label: 'RGB', N: 0 ~ 8) - -c) Default -If both fields are NULL, 'lp5523' is used by default. -/sys/class/leds/lp5523:channelN (N: 0 ~ 8) - -LP5523 has the internal program memory for running various LED patterns. -There are two ways to run LED patterns. - -1) Legacy interface - enginex_mode, enginex_load and enginex_leds - Control interface for the engines: - x is 1 .. 3 - enginex_mode : disabled, load, run - enginex_load : microcode load - enginex_leds : led mux control - - cd /sys/class/leds/lp5523:channel2/device - echo "load" > engine3_mode - echo "9d80400004ff05ff437f0000" > engine3_load - echo "111111111" > engine3_leds - echo "run" > engine3_mode - - To stop the engine: - echo "disabled" > engine3_mode - -2) Firmware interface - LP55xx common interface - For the details, please refer to 'firmware' section in leds-lp55xx.txt - -LP5523 has three master faders. If a channel is mapped to one of -the master faders, its output is dimmed based on the value of the master -fader. - -For example, - - echo "123000123" > master_fader_leds - -creates the following channel-fader mappings: - - channel 0,6 to master_fader1 - channel 1,7 to master_fader2 - channel 2,8 to master_fader3 - -Then, to have 25% of the original output on channel 0,6: - - echo 64 > master_fader1 - -To have 0% of the original output (i.e. no output) channel 1,7: - - echo 0 > master_fader2 - -To have 100% of the original output (i.e. no dimming) on channel 2,8: - - echo 255 > master_fader3 - -To clear all master fader controls: - - echo "000000000" > master_fader_leds - -Selftest uses always the current from the platform data. - -Each channel contains led current settings. -/sys/class/leds/lp5523:channel2/led_current - RW -/sys/class/leds/lp5523:channel2/max_current - RO -Format: 10x mA i.e 10 means 1.0 mA - -Example platform data: - -Note - chan_nr can have values between 0 and 8. - -static struct lp55xx_led_config lp5523_led_config[] = { - { - .name = "D1", - .chan_nr = 0, - .led_current = 50, - .max_current = 130, - }, -... - { - .chan_nr = 8, - .led_current = 50, - .max_current = 130, - } -}; - -static int lp5523_setup(void) -{ - /* Setup HW resources */ -} - -static void lp5523_release(void) -{ - /* Release HW resources */ -} - -static void lp5523_enable(bool state) -{ - /* Control chip enable signal */ -} - -static struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5523_platform_data = { - .led_config = lp5523_led_config, - .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5523_led_config), - .clock_mode = LP55XX_CLOCK_EXT, - .setup_resources = lp5523_setup, - .release_resources = lp5523_release, - .enable = lp5523_enable, -}; diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5562.rst b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5562.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..79bbb2487ff6 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5562.rst @@ -0,0 +1,137 @@ +======================== +Kernel driver for lp5562 +======================== + +* TI LP5562 LED Driver + +Author: Milo(Woogyom) Kim <milo.kim@ti.com> + +Description +=========== + + LP5562 can drive up to 4 channels. R/G/B and White. + LEDs can be controlled directly via the led class control interface. + + All four channels can be also controlled using the engine micro programs. + LP5562 has the internal program memory for running various LED patterns. + For the details, please refer to 'firmware' section in leds-lp55xx.txt + +Device attribute +================ + +engine_mux + 3 Engines are allocated in LP5562, but the number of channel is 4. + Therefore each channel should be mapped to the engine number. + + Value: RGB or W + + This attribute is used for programming LED data with the firmware interface. + Unlike the LP5521/LP5523/55231, LP5562 has unique feature for the engine mux, + so additional sysfs is required + + LED Map + + ===== === =============================== + Red ... Engine 1 (fixed) + Green ... Engine 2 (fixed) + Blue ... Engine 3 (fixed) + White ... Engine 1 or 2 or 3 (selective) + ===== === =============================== + +How to load the program data using engine_mux +============================================= + + Before loading the LP5562 program data, engine_mux should be written between + the engine selection and loading the firmware. + Engine mux has two different mode, RGB and W. + RGB is used for loading RGB program data, W is used for W program data. + + For example, run blinking green channel pattern:: + + echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine # 2 is for green channel + echo "RGB" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine_mux # engine mux for RGB + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading + echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine + + To run a blinking white pattern:: + + echo 1 or 2 or 3 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine + echo "W" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine_mux + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading + echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine + +How to load the predefined patterns +=================================== + + Please refer to 'leds-lp55xx.txt" + +Setting Current of Each Channel +=============================== + + Like LP5521 and LP5523/55231, LP5562 provides LED current settings. + The 'led_current' and 'max_current' are used. + +Example of Platform data +======================== + +:: + + static struct lp55xx_led_config lp5562_led_config[] = { + { + .name = "R", + .chan_nr = 0, + .led_current = 20, + .max_current = 40, + }, + { + .name = "G", + .chan_nr = 1, + .led_current = 20, + .max_current = 40, + }, + { + .name = "B", + .chan_nr = 2, + .led_current = 20, + .max_current = 40, + }, + { + .name = "W", + .chan_nr = 3, + .led_current = 20, + .max_current = 40, + }, + }; + + static int lp5562_setup(void) + { + /* setup HW resources */ + } + + static void lp5562_release(void) + { + /* Release HW resources */ + } + + static void lp5562_enable(bool state) + { + /* Control of chip enable signal */ + } + + static struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5562_platform_data = { + .led_config = lp5562_led_config, + .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5562_led_config), + .setup_resources = lp5562_setup, + .release_resources = lp5562_release, + .enable = lp5562_enable, + }; + +To configure the platform specific data, lp55xx_platform_data structure is used + + +If the current is set to 0 in the platform data, that channel is +disabled and it is not visible in the sysfs. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5562.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5562.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 5a823ff6b393..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp5562.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,120 +0,0 @@ -Kernel driver for LP5562 -======================== - -* TI LP5562 LED Driver - -Author: Milo(Woogyom) Kim <milo.kim@ti.com> - -Description - - LP5562 can drive up to 4 channels. R/G/B and White. - LEDs can be controlled directly via the led class control interface. - - All four channels can be also controlled using the engine micro programs. - LP5562 has the internal program memory for running various LED patterns. - For the details, please refer to 'firmware' section in leds-lp55xx.txt - -Device attribute: engine_mux - - 3 Engines are allocated in LP5562, but the number of channel is 4. - Therefore each channel should be mapped to the engine number. - Value : RGB or W - - This attribute is used for programming LED data with the firmware interface. - Unlike the LP5521/LP5523/55231, LP5562 has unique feature for the engine mux, - so additional sysfs is required. - - LED Map - Red ... Engine 1 (fixed) - Green ... Engine 2 (fixed) - Blue ... Engine 3 (fixed) - White ... Engine 1 or 2 or 3 (selective) - -How to load the program data using engine_mux - - Before loading the LP5562 program data, engine_mux should be written between - the engine selection and loading the firmware. - Engine mux has two different mode, RGB and W. - RGB is used for loading RGB program data, W is used for W program data. - - For example, run blinking green channel pattern, - echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine # 2 is for green channel - echo "RGB" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine_mux # engine mux for RGB - echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading - echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/data - echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading - echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine - - To run a blinking white pattern, - echo 1 or 2 or 3 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine - echo "W" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine_mux - echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading - echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/data - echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5562/loading - echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine - -How to load the predefined patterns - - Please refer to 'leds-lp55xx.txt" - -Setting Current of Each Channel - - Like LP5521 and LP5523/55231, LP5562 provides LED current settings. - The 'led_current' and 'max_current' are used. - -(Example of Platform data) - -To configure the platform specific data, lp55xx_platform_data structure is used. - -static struct lp55xx_led_config lp5562_led_config[] = { - { - .name = "R", - .chan_nr = 0, - .led_current = 20, - .max_current = 40, - }, - { - .name = "G", - .chan_nr = 1, - .led_current = 20, - .max_current = 40, - }, - { - .name = "B", - .chan_nr = 2, - .led_current = 20, - .max_current = 40, - }, - { - .name = "W", - .chan_nr = 3, - .led_current = 20, - .max_current = 40, - }, -}; - -static int lp5562_setup(void) -{ - /* setup HW resources */ -} - -static void lp5562_release(void) -{ - /* Release HW resources */ -} - -static void lp5562_enable(bool state) -{ - /* Control of chip enable signal */ -} - -static struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5562_platform_data = { - .led_config = lp5562_led_config, - .num_channels = ARRAY_SIZE(lp5562_led_config), - .setup_resources = lp5562_setup, - .release_resources = lp5562_release, - .enable = lp5562_enable, -}; - -If the current is set to 0 in the platform data, that channel is -disabled and it is not visible in the sysfs. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp55xx.rst b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp55xx.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..632e41cec0b5 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp55xx.rst @@ -0,0 +1,224 @@ +================================================= +LP5521/LP5523/LP55231/LP5562/LP8501 Common Driver +================================================= + +Authors: Milo(Woogyom) Kim <milo.kim@ti.com> + +Description +----------- +LP5521, LP5523/55231, LP5562 and LP8501 have common features as below. + + Register access via the I2C + Device initialization/deinitialization + Create LED class devices for multiple output channels + Device attributes for user-space interface + Program memory for running LED patterns + +The LP55xx common driver provides these features using exported functions. + + lp55xx_init_device() / lp55xx_deinit_device() + lp55xx_register_leds() / lp55xx_unregister_leds() + lp55xx_regsister_sysfs() / lp55xx_unregister_sysfs() + +( Driver Structure Data ) + +In lp55xx common driver, two different data structure is used. + +* lp55xx_led + control multi output LED channels such as led current, channel index. +* lp55xx_chip + general chip control such like the I2C and platform data. + +For example, LP5521 has maximum 3 LED channels. +LP5523/55231 has 9 output channels:: + + lp55xx_chip for LP5521 ... lp55xx_led #1 + lp55xx_led #2 + lp55xx_led #3 + + lp55xx_chip for LP5523 ... lp55xx_led #1 + lp55xx_led #2 + . + . + lp55xx_led #9 + +( Chip Dependent Code ) + +To support device specific configurations, special structure +'lpxx_device_config' is used. + + - Maximum number of channels + - Reset command, chip enable command + - Chip specific initialization + - Brightness control register access + - Setting LED output current + - Program memory address access for running patterns + - Additional device specific attributes + +( Firmware Interface ) + +LP55xx family devices have the internal program memory for running +various LED patterns. + +This pattern data is saved as a file in the user-land or +hex byte string is written into the memory through the I2C. + +LP55xx common driver supports the firmware interface. + +LP55xx chips have three program engines. + +To load and run the pattern, the programming sequence is following. + + (1) Select an engine number (1/2/3) + (2) Mode change to load + (3) Write pattern data into selected area + (4) Mode change to run + +The LP55xx common driver provides simple interfaces as below. + +select_engine: + Select which engine is used for running program +run_engine: + Start program which is loaded via the firmware interface +firmware: + Load program data + +In case of LP5523, one more command is required, 'enginex_leds'. +It is used for selecting LED output(s) at each engine number. +In more details, please refer to 'leds-lp5523.txt'. + +For example, run blinking pattern in engine #1 of LP5521:: + + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading + echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine + +For example, run blinking pattern in engine #3 of LP55231 + +Two LEDs are configured as pattern output channels:: + + echo 3 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp55231/loading + echo "9d0740ff7e0040007e00a0010000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp55231/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp55231/loading + echo "000001100" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine3_leds + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine + +To start blinking patterns in engine #2 and #3 simultaneously:: + + for idx in 2 3 + do + echo $idx > /sys/class/leds/red/device/select_engine + sleep 0.1 + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading + echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading + done + echo 1 > /sys/class/leds/red/device/run_engine + +Here is another example for LP5523. + +Full LED strings are selected by 'engine2_leds':: + + echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5523/loading + echo "9d80400004ff05ff437f0000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5523/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5523/loading + echo "111111111" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine2_leds + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine + +As soon as 'loading' is set to 0, registered callback is called. +Inside the callback, the selected engine is loaded and memory is updated. +To run programmed pattern, 'run_engine' attribute should be enabled. + +The pattern sequence of LP8501 is similar to LP5523. + +However pattern data is specific. + +Ex 1) Engine 1 is used:: + + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading + echo "9d0140ff7e0040007e00a001c000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine + +Ex 2) Engine 2 and 3 are used at the same time:: + + echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine + sleep 1 + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading + echo "9d0140ff7e0040007e00a001c000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading + sleep 1 + echo 3 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine + sleep 1 + echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading + echo "9d0340ff7e0040007e00a001c000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/data + echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading + sleep 1 + echo 1 > /sys/class/leds/d1/device/run_engine + +( 'run_engine' and 'firmware_cb' ) + +The sequence of running the program data is common. + +But each device has own specific register addresses for commands. + +To support this, 'run_engine' and 'firmware_cb' are configurable in each driver. + +run_engine: + Control the selected engine +firmware_cb: + The callback function after loading the firmware is done. + + Chip specific commands for loading and updating program memory. + +( Predefined pattern data ) + +Without the firmware interface, LP55xx driver provides another method for +loading a LED pattern. That is 'predefined' pattern. + +A predefined pattern is defined in the platform data and load it(or them) +via the sysfs if needed. + +To use the predefined pattern concept, 'patterns' and 'num_patterns' should be +configured. + +Example of predefined pattern data:: + + /* mode_1: blinking data */ + static const u8 mode_1[] = { + 0x40, 0x00, 0x60, 0x00, 0x40, 0xFF, 0x60, 0x00, + }; + + /* mode_2: always on */ + static const u8 mode_2[] = { 0x40, 0xFF, }; + + struct lp55xx_predef_pattern board_led_patterns[] = { + { + .r = mode_1, + .size_r = ARRAY_SIZE(mode_1), + }, + { + .b = mode_2, + .size_b = ARRAY_SIZE(mode_2), + }, + } + + struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5562_pdata = { + ... + .patterns = board_led_patterns, + .num_patterns = ARRAY_SIZE(board_led_patterns), + }; + +Then, mode_1 and mode_2 can be run via through the sysfs:: + + echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern # red blinking LED pattern + echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern # blue LED always on + +To stop running pattern:: + + echo 0 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp55xx.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-lp55xx.txt deleted file mode 100644 index e23fa91ea722..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-lp55xx.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,194 +0,0 @@ -LP5521/LP5523/LP55231/LP5562/LP8501 Common Driver -================================================= - -Authors: Milo(Woogyom) Kim <milo.kim@ti.com> - -Description ------------ -LP5521, LP5523/55231, LP5562 and LP8501 have common features as below. - - Register access via the I2C - Device initialization/deinitialization - Create LED class devices for multiple output channels - Device attributes for user-space interface - Program memory for running LED patterns - -The LP55xx common driver provides these features using exported functions. - lp55xx_init_device() / lp55xx_deinit_device() - lp55xx_register_leds() / lp55xx_unregister_leds() - lp55xx_regsister_sysfs() / lp55xx_unregister_sysfs() - -( Driver Structure Data ) - -In lp55xx common driver, two different data structure is used. - -o lp55xx_led - control multi output LED channels such as led current, channel index. -o lp55xx_chip - general chip control such like the I2C and platform data. - -For example, LP5521 has maximum 3 LED channels. -LP5523/55231 has 9 output channels. - -lp55xx_chip for LP5521 ... lp55xx_led #1 - lp55xx_led #2 - lp55xx_led #3 - -lp55xx_chip for LP5523 ... lp55xx_led #1 - lp55xx_led #2 - . - . - lp55xx_led #9 - -( Chip Dependent Code ) - -To support device specific configurations, special structure -'lpxx_device_config' is used. - - Maximum number of channels - Reset command, chip enable command - Chip specific initialization - Brightness control register access - Setting LED output current - Program memory address access for running patterns - Additional device specific attributes - -( Firmware Interface ) - -LP55xx family devices have the internal program memory for running -various LED patterns. -This pattern data is saved as a file in the user-land or -hex byte string is written into the memory through the I2C. -LP55xx common driver supports the firmware interface. - -LP55xx chips have three program engines. -To load and run the pattern, the programming sequence is following. - (1) Select an engine number (1/2/3) - (2) Mode change to load - (3) Write pattern data into selected area - (4) Mode change to run - -The LP55xx common driver provides simple interfaces as below. -select_engine : Select which engine is used for running program -run_engine : Start program which is loaded via the firmware interface -firmware : Load program data - -In case of LP5523, one more command is required, 'enginex_leds'. -It is used for selecting LED output(s) at each engine number. -In more details, please refer to 'leds-lp5523.txt'. - -For example, run blinking pattern in engine #1 of LP5521 -echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine -echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading -echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/data -echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading -echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine - -For example, run blinking pattern in engine #3 of LP55231 -Two LEDs are configured as pattern output channels. -echo 3 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine -echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp55231/loading -echo "9d0740ff7e0040007e00a0010000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp55231/data -echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp55231/loading -echo "000001100" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine3_leds -echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine - -To start blinking patterns in engine #2 and #3 simultaneously, -for idx in 2 3 -do - echo $idx > /sys/class/leds/red/device/select_engine - sleep 0.1 - echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading - echo "4000600040FF6000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/data - echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5521/loading -done -echo 1 > /sys/class/leds/red/device/run_engine - -Here is another example for LP5523. -Full LED strings are selected by 'engine2_leds'. -echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine -echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5523/loading -echo "9d80400004ff05ff437f0000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp5523/data -echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp5523/loading -echo "111111111" > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/engine2_leds -echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine - -As soon as 'loading' is set to 0, registered callback is called. -Inside the callback, the selected engine is loaded and memory is updated. -To run programmed pattern, 'run_engine' attribute should be enabled. - -The pattern sequence of LP8501 is similar to LP5523. -However pattern data is specific. -Ex 1) Engine 1 is used -echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine -echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading -echo "9d0140ff7e0040007e00a001c000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/data -echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading -echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/run_engine - -Ex 2) Engine 2 and 3 are used at the same time -echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine -sleep 1 -echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading -echo "9d0140ff7e0040007e00a001c000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/data -echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading -sleep 1 -echo 3 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/select_engine -sleep 1 -echo 1 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading -echo "9d0340ff7e0040007e00a001c000" > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/data -echo 0 > /sys/class/firmware/lp8501/loading -sleep 1 -echo 1 > /sys/class/leds/d1/device/run_engine - -( 'run_engine' and 'firmware_cb' ) -The sequence of running the program data is common. -But each device has own specific register addresses for commands. -To support this, 'run_engine' and 'firmware_cb' are configurable in each driver. -run_engine : Control the selected engine -firmware_cb : The callback function after loading the firmware is done. - Chip specific commands for loading and updating program memory. - -( Predefined pattern data ) - -Without the firmware interface, LP55xx driver provides another method for -loading a LED pattern. That is 'predefined' pattern. -A predefined pattern is defined in the platform data and load it(or them) -via the sysfs if needed. -To use the predefined pattern concept, 'patterns' and 'num_patterns' should be -configured. - - Example of predefined pattern data: - - /* mode_1: blinking data */ - static const u8 mode_1[] = { - 0x40, 0x00, 0x60, 0x00, 0x40, 0xFF, 0x60, 0x00, - }; - - /* mode_2: always on */ - static const u8 mode_2[] = { 0x40, 0xFF, }; - - struct lp55xx_predef_pattern board_led_patterns[] = { - { - .r = mode_1, - .size_r = ARRAY_SIZE(mode_1), - }, - { - .b = mode_2, - .size_b = ARRAY_SIZE(mode_2), - }, - } - - struct lp55xx_platform_data lp5562_pdata = { - ... - .patterns = board_led_patterns, - .num_patterns = ARRAY_SIZE(board_led_patterns), - }; - -Then, mode_1 and mode_2 can be run via through the sysfs. - - echo 1 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern # red blinking LED pattern - echo 2 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern # blue LED always on - -To stop running pattern, - echo 0 > /sys/bus/i2c/devices/xxxx/led_pattern diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-mlxcpld.rst b/Documentation/leds/leds-mlxcpld.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..528582429e0b --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/leds/leds-mlxcpld.rst @@ -0,0 +1,118 @@ +======================================= +Kernel driver for Mellanox systems LEDs +======================================= + +Provide system LED support for the nex Mellanox systems: +"msx6710", "msx6720", "msb7700", "msn2700", "msx1410", +"msn2410", "msb7800", "msn2740", "msn2100". + +Description +----------- +Driver provides the following LEDs for the systems "msx6710", "msx6720", +"msb7700", "msn2700", "msx1410", "msn2410", "msb7800", "msn2740": + + - mlxcpld:fan1:green + - mlxcpld:fan1:red + - mlxcpld:fan2:green + - mlxcpld:fan2:red + - mlxcpld:fan3:green + - mlxcpld:fan3:red + - mlxcpld:fan4:green + - mlxcpld:fan4:red + - mlxcpld:psu:green + - mlxcpld:psu:red + - mlxcpld:status:green + - mlxcpld:status:red + + "status" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x20 + - Bits [3:0] + + "psu" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x20 + - Bits [7:4] + + "fan1" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x21 + - Bits [3:0] + + "fan2" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x21 + - Bits [7:4] + + "fan3" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x22 + - Bits [3:0] + + "fan4" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x22 + - Bits [7:4] + + Color mask for all the above LEDs: + + [bit3,bit2,bit1,bit0] or + [bit7,bit6,bit5,bit4]: + + - [0,0,0,0] = LED OFF + - [0,1,0,1] = Red static ON + - [1,1,0,1] = Green static ON + - [0,1,1,0] = Red blink 3Hz + - [1,1,1,0] = Green blink 3Hz + - [0,1,1,1] = Red blink 6Hz + - [1,1,1,1] = Green blink 6Hz + +Driver provides the following LEDs for the system "msn2100": + + - mlxcpld:fan:green + - mlxcpld:fan:red + - mlxcpld:psu1:green + - mlxcpld:psu1:red + - mlxcpld:psu2:green + - mlxcpld:psu2:red + - mlxcpld:status:green + - mlxcpld:status:red + - mlxcpld:uid:blue + + "status" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x20 + - Bits [3:0] + + "fan" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x21 + - Bits [3:0] + + "psu1" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x23 + - Bits [3:0] + + "psu2" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x23 + - Bits [7:4] + + "uid" + - CPLD reg offset: 0x24 + - Bits [3:0] + + Color mask for all the above LEDs, excepted uid: + + [bit3,bit2,bit1,bit0] or + [bit7,bit6,bit5,bit4]: + + - [0,0,0,0] = LED OFF + - [0,1,0,1] = Red static ON + - [1,1,0,1] = Green static ON + - [0,1,1,0] = Red blink 3Hz + - [1,1,1,0] = Green blink 3Hz + - [0,1,1,1] = Red blink 6Hz + - [1,1,1,1] = Green blink 6Hz + + Color mask for uid LED: + [bit3,bit2,bit1,bit0]: + + - [0,0,0,0] = LED OFF + - [1,1,0,1] = Blue static ON + - [1,1,1,0] = Blue blink 3Hz + - [1,1,1,1] = Blue blink 6Hz + +Driver supports HW blinking at 3Hz and 6Hz frequency (50% duty cycle). +For 3Hz duty cylce is about 167 msec, for 6Hz is about 83 msec. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/leds-mlxcpld.txt b/Documentation/leds/leds-mlxcpld.txt deleted file mode 100644 index a0e8fd457117..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/leds/leds-mlxcpld.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,110 +0,0 @@ -Kernel driver for Mellanox systems LEDs -======================================= - -Provide system LED support for the nex Mellanox systems: -"msx6710", "msx6720", "msb7700", "msn2700", "msx1410", -"msn2410", "msb7800", "msn2740", "msn2100". - -Description ------------ -Driver provides the following LEDs for the systems "msx6710", "msx6720", -"msb7700", "msn2700", "msx1410", "msn2410", "msb7800", "msn2740": - mlxcpld:fan1:green - mlxcpld:fan1:red - mlxcpld:fan2:green - mlxcpld:fan2:red - mlxcpld:fan3:green - mlxcpld:fan3:red - mlxcpld:fan4:green - mlxcpld:fan4:red - mlxcpld:psu:green - mlxcpld:psu:red - mlxcpld:status:green - mlxcpld:status:red - - "status" - CPLD reg offset: 0x20 - Bits [3:0] - - "psu" - CPLD reg offset: 0x20 - Bits [7:4] - - "fan1" - CPLD reg offset: 0x21 - Bits [3:0] - - "fan2" - CPLD reg offset: 0x21 - Bits [7:4] - - "fan3" - CPLD reg offset: 0x22 - Bits [3:0] - - "fan4" - CPLD reg offset: 0x22 - Bits [7:4] - - Color mask for all the above LEDs: - [bit3,bit2,bit1,bit0] or - [bit7,bit6,bit5,bit4]: - [0,0,0,0] = LED OFF - [0,1,0,1] = Red static ON - [1,1,0,1] = Green static ON - [0,1,1,0] = Red blink 3Hz - [1,1,1,0] = Green blink 3Hz - [0,1,1,1] = Red blink 6Hz - [1,1,1,1] = Green blink 6Hz - -Driver provides the following LEDs for the system "msn2100": - mlxcpld:fan:green - mlxcpld:fan:red - mlxcpld:psu1:green - mlxcpld:psu1:red - mlxcpld:psu2:green - mlxcpld:psu2:red - mlxcpld:status:green - mlxcpld:status:red - mlxcpld:uid:blue - - "status" - CPLD reg offset: 0x20 - Bits [3:0] - - "fan" - CPLD reg offset: 0x21 - Bits [3:0] - - "psu1" - CPLD reg offset: 0x23 - Bits [3:0] - - "psu2" - CPLD reg offset: 0x23 - Bits [7:4] - - "uid" - CPLD reg offset: 0x24 - Bits [3:0] - - Color mask for all the above LEDs, excepted uid: - [bit3,bit2,bit1,bit0] or - [bit7,bit6,bit5,bit4]: - [0,0,0,0] = LED OFF - [0,1,0,1] = Red static ON - [1,1,0,1] = Green static ON - [0,1,1,0] = Red blink 3Hz - [1,1,1,0] = Green blink 3Hz - [0,1,1,1] = Red blink 6Hz - [1,1,1,1] = Green blink 6Hz - - Color mask for uid LED: - [bit3,bit2,bit1,bit0]: - [0,0,0,0] = LED OFF - [1,1,0,1] = Blue static ON - [1,1,1,0] = Blue blink 3Hz - [1,1,1,1] = Blue blink 6Hz - -Driver supports HW blinking at 3Hz and 6Hz frequency (50% duty cycle). -For 3Hz duty cylce is about 167 msec, for 6Hz is about 83 msec. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-oneshot.txt b/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-oneshot.rst index fe57474a12e2..69fa3ea1d554 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-oneshot.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-oneshot.rst @@ -1,3 +1,4 @@ +==================== One-shot LED Trigger ==================== @@ -17,27 +18,27 @@ additional "invert" property specifies if the LED has to stay off (normal) or on (inverted) when not rearmed. The trigger can be activated from user space on led class devices as shown -below: +below:: echo oneshot > trigger This adds sysfs attributes to the LED that are documented in: Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-led-trigger-oneshot -Example use-case: network devices, initialization: +Example use-case: network devices, initialization:: echo oneshot > trigger # set trigger for this led echo 33 > delay_on # blink at 1 / (33 + 33) Hz on continuous traffic echo 33 > delay_off -interface goes up: +interface goes up:: echo 1 > invert # set led as normally-on, turn the led on -packet received/transmitted: +packet received/transmitted:: echo 1 > shot # led starts blinking, ignored if already blinking -interface goes down +interface goes down:: echo 0 > invert # set led as normally-off, turn the led off diff --git a/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-transient.txt b/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-transient.rst index 3bd38b487df1..d921dc830cd0 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-transient.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-transient.rst @@ -1,3 +1,4 @@ +===================== LED Transient Trigger ===================== @@ -62,12 +63,13 @@ non-transient state. When driver gets suspended, irrespective of the transient state, the LED state changes to LED_OFF. Transient trigger can be enabled and disabled from user space on led class -devices, that support this trigger as shown below: +devices, that support this trigger as shown below:: -echo transient > trigger -echo none > trigger + echo transient > trigger + echo none > trigger -NOTE: Add a new property trigger state to control the state. +NOTE: + Add a new property trigger state to control the state. This trigger exports three properties, activate, state, and duration. When transient trigger is activated these properties are set to default values. @@ -79,7 +81,8 @@ transient trigger is activated these properties are set to default values. - state allows user to specify a transient state to be held for the specified duration. - activate - one shot timer activate mechanism. + activate + - one shot timer activate mechanism. 1 when activated, 0 when deactivated. default value is zero when transient trigger is enabled, to allow duration to be set. @@ -89,12 +92,14 @@ transient trigger is activated these properties are set to default values. deactivated state indicates that there is no active timer running. - duration - one shot timer value. When activate is set, duration value + duration + - one shot timer value. When activate is set, duration value is used to start a timer that runs once. This value doesn't get changed by the trigger unless user does a set via echo new_value > duration - state - transient state to be held. It has two values 0 or 1. 0 maps + state + - transient state to be held. It has two values 0 or 1. 0 maps to LED_OFF and 1 maps to LED_FULL. The specified state is held for the duration of the one shot timer and then the state gets changed to the non-transient state which is the @@ -114,39 +119,49 @@ When timer expires activate goes back to deactivated state, duration is left at the set value to be used when activate is set at a future time. This will allow user app to set the time once and activate it to run it once for the specified value as needed. When timer expires, state is restored to the -non-transient state which is the inverse of the transient state. - - echo 1 > activate - starts timer = duration when duration is not 0. - echo 0 > activate - cancels currently running timer. - echo n > duration - stores timer value to be used upon next - activate. Currently active timer if - any, continues to run for the specified time. - echo 0 > duration - stores timer value to be used upon next - activate. Currently active timer if any, - continues to run for the specified time. - echo 1 > state - stores desired transient state LED_FULL to be +non-transient state which is the inverse of the transient state: + + ================= =============================================== + echo 1 > activate starts timer = duration when duration is not 0. + echo 0 > activate cancels currently running timer. + echo n > duration stores timer value to be used upon next + activate. Currently active timer if + any, continues to run for the specified time. + echo 0 > duration stores timer value to be used upon next + activate. Currently active timer if any, + continues to run for the specified time. + echo 1 > state stores desired transient state LED_FULL to be held for the specified duration. - echo 0 > state - stores desired transient state LED_OFF to be + echo 0 > state stores desired transient state LED_OFF to be held for the specified duration. + ================= =============================================== + +What is not supported +===================== -What is not supported: -====================== - Timer activation is one shot and extending and/or shortening the timer is not supported. -Example use-case 1: +Examples +======== + +use-case 1:: + echo transient > trigger echo n > duration echo 1 > state -repeat the following step as needed: + +repeat the following step as needed:: + echo 1 > activate - start timer = duration to run once echo 1 > activate - start timer = duration to run once echo none > trigger This trigger is intended to be used for for the following example use cases: + - Control of vibrate (phones, tablets etc.) hardware by user space app. - Use of LED by user space app as activity indicator. - Use of LED by user space app as a kind of watchdog indicator -- as - long as the app is alive, it can keep the LED illuminated, if it dies - the LED will be extinguished automatically. + long as the app is alive, it can keep the LED illuminated, if it dies + the LED will be extinguished automatically. - Use by any user space app that needs a transient GPIO output. diff --git a/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-usbport.txt b/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-usbport.rst index 69f54bfb4789..37c2505bfd57 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-usbport.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/ledtrig-usbport.rst @@ -1,3 +1,4 @@ +==================== USB port LED trigger ==================== @@ -10,14 +11,18 @@ listed as separated entries in a "ports" subdirectory. Selecting is handled by echoing "1" to a chosen port. Please note that this trigger allows selecting multiple USB ports for a single -LED. This can be useful in two cases: +LED. + +This can be useful in two cases: 1) Device with single USB LED and few physical ports +==================================================== In such a case LED will be turned on as long as there is at least one connected USB device. 2) Device with a physical port handled by few controllers +========================================================= Some devices may have one controller per PHY standard. E.g. USB 3.0 physical port may be handled by ohci-platform, ehci-platform and xhci-hcd. If there is @@ -25,14 +30,14 @@ only one LED user will most likely want to assign ports from all 3 hubs. This trigger can be activated from user space on led class devices as shown -below: +below:: echo usbport > trigger This adds sysfs attributes to the LED that are documented in: Documentation/ABI/testing/sysfs-class-led-trigger-usbport -Example use-case: +Example use-case:: echo usbport > trigger echo 1 > ports/usb1-port1 diff --git a/Documentation/leds/uleds.txt b/Documentation/leds/uleds.rst index 13e375a580f9..83221098009c 100644 --- a/Documentation/leds/uleds.txt +++ b/Documentation/leds/uleds.rst @@ -1,3 +1,4 @@ +============== Userspace LEDs ============== @@ -10,12 +11,12 @@ Usage When the driver is loaded, a character device is created at /dev/uleds. To create a new LED class device, open /dev/uleds and write a uleds_user_dev -structure to it (found in kernel public header file linux/uleds.h). +structure to it (found in kernel public header file linux/uleds.h):: #define LED_MAX_NAME_SIZE 64 struct uleds_user_dev { - char name[LED_MAX_NAME_SIZE]; + char name[LED_MAX_NAME_SIZE]; }; A new LED class device will be created with the name given. The name can be diff --git a/Documentation/locking/lockdep-design.txt b/Documentation/locking/lockdep-design.txt index 39fae143c9cb..f189d130e543 100644 --- a/Documentation/locking/lockdep-design.txt +++ b/Documentation/locking/lockdep-design.txt @@ -15,34 +15,48 @@ tens of thousands of) instantiations. For example a lock in the inode struct is one class, while each inode has its own instantiation of that lock class. -The validator tracks the 'state' of lock-classes, and it tracks -dependencies between different lock-classes. The validator maintains a -rolling proof that the state and the dependencies are correct. - -Unlike an lock instantiation, the lock-class itself never goes away: when -a lock-class is used for the first time after bootup it gets registered, -and all subsequent uses of that lock-class will be attached to this -lock-class. +The validator tracks the 'usage state' of lock-classes, and it tracks +the dependencies between different lock-classes. Lock usage indicates +how a lock is used with regard to its IRQ contexts, while lock +dependency can be understood as lock order, where L1 -> L2 suggests that +a task is attempting to acquire L2 while holding L1. From lockdep's +perspective, the two locks (L1 and L2) are not necessarily related; that +dependency just means the order ever happened. The validator maintains a +continuing effort to prove lock usages and dependencies are correct or +the validator will shoot a splat if incorrect. + +A lock-class's behavior is constructed by its instances collectively: +when the first instance of a lock-class is used after bootup the class +gets registered, then all (subsequent) instances will be mapped to the +class and hence their usages and dependecies will contribute to those of +the class. A lock-class does not go away when a lock instance does, but +it can be removed if the memory space of the lock class (static or +dynamic) is reclaimed, this happens for example when a module is +unloaded or a workqueue is destroyed. State ----- -The validator tracks lock-class usage history into 4 * nSTATEs + 1 separate -state bits: +The validator tracks lock-class usage history and divides the usage into +(4 usages * n STATEs + 1) categories: +where the 4 usages can be: - 'ever held in STATE context' - 'ever held as readlock in STATE context' - 'ever held with STATE enabled' - 'ever held as readlock with STATE enabled' -Where STATE can be either one of (kernel/locking/lockdep_states.h) - - hardirq - - softirq +where the n STATEs are coded in kernel/locking/lockdep_states.h and as of +now they include: +- hardirq +- softirq +where the last 1 category is: - 'ever used' [ == !unused ] -When locking rules are violated, these state bits are presented in the -locking error messages, inside curlies. A contrived example: +When locking rules are violated, these usage bits are presented in the +locking error messages, inside curlies, with a total of 2 * n STATEs bits. +A contrived example: modprobe/2287 is trying to acquire lock: (&sio_locks[i].lock){-.-.}, at: [<c02867fd>] mutex_lock+0x21/0x24 @@ -51,28 +65,67 @@ locking error messages, inside curlies. A contrived example: (&sio_locks[i].lock){-.-.}, at: [<c02867fd>] mutex_lock+0x21/0x24 -The bit position indicates STATE, STATE-read, for each of the states listed -above, and the character displayed in each indicates: +For a given lock, the bit positions from left to right indicate the usage +of the lock and readlock (if exists), for each of the n STATEs listed +above respectively, and the character displayed at each bit position +indicates: '.' acquired while irqs disabled and not in irq context '-' acquired in irq context '+' acquired with irqs enabled '?' acquired in irq context with irqs enabled. -Unused mutexes cannot be part of the cause of an error. +The bits are illustrated with an example: + + (&sio_locks[i].lock){-.-.}, at: [<c02867fd>] mutex_lock+0x21/0x24 + |||| + ||| \-> softirq disabled and not in softirq context + || \--> acquired in softirq context + | \---> hardirq disabled and not in hardirq context + \----> acquired in hardirq context + + +For a given STATE, whether the lock is ever acquired in that STATE +context and whether that STATE is enabled yields four possible cases as +shown in the table below. The bit character is able to indicate which +exact case is for the lock as of the reporting time. + + ------------------------------------------- + | | irq enabled | irq disabled | + |-------------------------------------------| + | ever in irq | ? | - | + |-------------------------------------------| + | never in irq | + | . | + ------------------------------------------- + +The character '-' suggests irq is disabled because if otherwise the +charactor '?' would have been shown instead. Similar deduction can be +applied for '+' too. + +Unused locks (e.g., mutexes) cannot be part of the cause of an error. Single-lock state rules: ------------------------ +A lock is irq-safe means it was ever used in an irq context, while a lock +is irq-unsafe means it was ever acquired with irq enabled. + A softirq-unsafe lock-class is automatically hardirq-unsafe as well. The -following states are exclusive, and only one of them is allowed to be -set for any lock-class: +following states must be exclusive: only one of them is allowed to be set +for any lock-class based on its usage: + + <hardirq-safe> or <hardirq-unsafe> + <softirq-safe> or <softirq-unsafe> - <hardirq-safe> and <hardirq-unsafe> - <softirq-safe> and <softirq-unsafe> +This is because if a lock can be used in irq context (irq-safe) then it +cannot be ever acquired with irq enabled (irq-unsafe). Otherwise, a +deadlock may happen. For example, in the scenario that after this lock +was acquired but before released, if the context is interrupted this +lock will be attempted to acquire twice, which creates a deadlock, +referred to as lock recursion deadlock. -The validator detects and reports lock usage that violate these +The validator detects and reports lock usage that violates these single-lock state rules. Multi-lock dependency rules: @@ -81,15 +134,18 @@ Multi-lock dependency rules: The same lock-class must not be acquired twice, because this could lead to lock recursion deadlocks. -Furthermore, two locks may not be taken in different order: +Furthermore, two locks can not be taken in inverse order: <L1> -> <L2> <L2> -> <L1> -because this could lead to lock inversion deadlocks. (The validator -finds such dependencies in arbitrary complexity, i.e. there can be any -other locking sequence between the acquire-lock operations, the -validator will still track all dependencies between locks.) +because this could lead to a deadlock - referred to as lock inversion +deadlock - as attempts to acquire the two locks form a circle which +could lead to the two contexts waiting for each other permanently. The +validator will find such dependency circle in arbitrary complexity, +i.e., there can be any other locking sequence between the acquire-lock +operations; the validator will still find whether these locks can be +acquired in a circular fashion. Furthermore, the following usage based lock dependencies are not allowed between any two lock-classes: diff --git a/Documentation/media/kapi/dtv-core.rst b/Documentation/media/kapi/dtv-core.rst index ac005b46f23e..82c5b85ed9b1 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/kapi/dtv-core.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/kapi/dtv-core.rst @@ -11,12 +11,12 @@ Digital TV devices are implemented by several different drivers: - Frontend drivers that are usually implemented as two separate drivers: - - A tuner driver that implements the logic with commands the part of the - hardware with is responsible to tune into a digital TV transponder or + - A tuner driver that implements the logic which commands the part of + the hardware responsible for tuning into a digital TV transponder or physical channel. The output of a tuner is usually a baseband or Intermediate Frequency (IF) signal; - - A demodulator driver (a.k.a "demod") that implements the logic with + - A demodulator driver (a.k.a "demod") that implements the logic which commands the digital TV decoding hardware. The output of a demod is a digital stream, with multiple audio, video and data channels typically multiplexed using MPEG Transport Stream [#f1]_. diff --git a/Documentation/media/kapi/v4l2-controls.rst b/Documentation/media/kapi/v4l2-controls.rst index 64ab99abf0b6..ebe2a55908be 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/kapi/v4l2-controls.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/kapi/v4l2-controls.rst @@ -26,8 +26,9 @@ The control framework was created in order to implement all the rules of the V4L2 specification with respect to controls in a central place. And to make life as easy as possible for the driver developer. -Note that the control framework relies on the presence of a struct v4l2_device -for V4L2 drivers and struct v4l2_subdev for sub-device drivers. +Note that the control framework relies on the presence of a struct +:c:type:`v4l2_device` for V4L2 drivers and struct :c:type:`v4l2_subdev` for +sub-device drivers. Objects in the framework @@ -35,12 +36,13 @@ Objects in the framework There are two main objects: -The v4l2_ctrl object describes the control properties and keeps track of the -control's value (both the current value and the proposed new value). +The :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl` object describes the control properties and keeps +track of the control's value (both the current value and the proposed new +value). -v4l2_ctrl_handler is the object that keeps track of controls. It maintains a -list of v4l2_ctrl objects that it owns and another list of references to -controls, possibly to controls owned by other handlers. +:c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_handler` is the object that keeps track of controls. It +maintains a list of v4l2_ctrl objects that it owns and another list of +references to controls, possibly to controls owned by other handlers. Basic usage for V4L2 and sub-device drivers @@ -48,21 +50,39 @@ Basic usage for V4L2 and sub-device drivers 1) Prepare the driver: +.. code-block:: c + + #include <media/v4l2-ctrls.h> + 1.1) Add the handler to your driver's top-level struct: -.. code-block:: none +For V4L2 drivers: + +.. code-block:: c struct foo_dev { ... + struct v4l2_device v4l2_dev; + ... struct v4l2_ctrl_handler ctrl_handler; ... }; - struct foo_dev *foo; +For sub-device drivers: + +.. code-block:: c + + struct foo_dev { + ... + struct v4l2_subdev sd; + ... + struct v4l2_ctrl_handler ctrl_handler; + ... + }; 1.2) Initialize the handler: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c v4l2_ctrl_handler_init(&foo->ctrl_handler, nr_of_controls); @@ -72,72 +92,48 @@ information. It is a hint only. 1.3) Hook the control handler into the driver: -1.3.1) For V4L2 drivers do this: +For V4L2 drivers: -.. code-block:: none - - struct foo_dev { - ... - struct v4l2_device v4l2_dev; - ... - struct v4l2_ctrl_handler ctrl_handler; - ... - }; +.. code-block:: c foo->v4l2_dev.ctrl_handler = &foo->ctrl_handler; -Where foo->v4l2_dev is of type struct v4l2_device. - -Finally, remove all control functions from your v4l2_ioctl_ops (if any): -vidioc_queryctrl, vidioc_query_ext_ctrl, vidioc_querymenu, vidioc_g_ctrl, -vidioc_s_ctrl, vidioc_g_ext_ctrls, vidioc_try_ext_ctrls and vidioc_s_ext_ctrls. -Those are now no longer needed. - -1.3.2) For sub-device drivers do this: - -.. code-block:: none +For sub-device drivers: - struct foo_dev { - ... - struct v4l2_subdev sd; - ... - struct v4l2_ctrl_handler ctrl_handler; - ... - }; +.. code-block:: c foo->sd.ctrl_handler = &foo->ctrl_handler; -Where foo->sd is of type struct v4l2_subdev. - 1.4) Clean up the handler at the end: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c v4l2_ctrl_handler_free(&foo->ctrl_handler); 2) Add controls: -You add non-menu controls by calling v4l2_ctrl_new_std: +You add non-menu controls by calling :c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_std`: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct v4l2_ctrl *v4l2_ctrl_new_std(struct v4l2_ctrl_handler *hdl, const struct v4l2_ctrl_ops *ops, u32 id, s32 min, s32 max, u32 step, s32 def); -Menu and integer menu controls are added by calling v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu: +Menu and integer menu controls are added by calling +:c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu`: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct v4l2_ctrl *v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu(struct v4l2_ctrl_handler *hdl, const struct v4l2_ctrl_ops *ops, u32 id, s32 max, s32 skip_mask, s32 def); Menu controls with a driver specific menu are added by calling -v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu_items: +:c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu_items`: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct v4l2_ctrl *v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu_items( struct v4l2_ctrl_handler *hdl, @@ -145,17 +141,18 @@ v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu_items: s32 skip_mask, s32 def, const char * const *qmenu); Integer menu controls with a driver specific menu can be added by calling -v4l2_ctrl_new_int_menu: +:c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_int_menu`: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct v4l2_ctrl *v4l2_ctrl_new_int_menu(struct v4l2_ctrl_handler *hdl, const struct v4l2_ctrl_ops *ops, u32 id, s32 max, s32 def, const s64 *qmenu_int); -These functions are typically called right after the v4l2_ctrl_handler_init: +These functions are typically called right after the +:c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_handler_init`: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c static const s64 exp_bias_qmenu[] = { -2, -1, 0, 1, 2 @@ -192,33 +189,34 @@ These functions are typically called right after the v4l2_ctrl_handler_init: return err; } -The v4l2_ctrl_new_std function returns the v4l2_ctrl pointer to the new -control, but if you do not need to access the pointer outside the control ops, -then there is no need to store it. - -The v4l2_ctrl_new_std function will fill in most fields based on the control -ID except for the min, max, step and default values. These are passed in the -last four arguments. These values are driver specific while control attributes -like type, name, flags are all global. The control's current value will be set -to the default value. - -The v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu function is very similar but it is used for menu -controls. There is no min argument since that is always 0 for menu controls, -and instead of a step there is a skip_mask argument: if bit X is 1, then menu -item X is skipped. - -The v4l2_ctrl_new_int_menu function creates a new standard integer menu -control with driver-specific items in the menu. It differs from -v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu in that it doesn't have the mask argument and takes -as the last argument an array of signed 64-bit integers that form an exact -menu item list. - -The v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu_items function is very similar to -v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu but takes an extra parameter qmenu, which is the driver -specific menu for an otherwise standard menu control. A good example for this -control is the test pattern control for capture/display/sensors devices that -have the capability to generate test patterns. These test patterns are hardware -specific, so the contents of the menu will vary from device to device. +The :c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_std` function returns the v4l2_ctrl pointer to +the new control, but if you do not need to access the pointer outside the +control ops, then there is no need to store it. + +The :c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_std` function will fill in most fields based on +the control ID except for the min, max, step and default values. These are +passed in the last four arguments. These values are driver specific while +control attributes like type, name, flags are all global. The control's +current value will be set to the default value. + +The :c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu` function is very similar but it is +used for menu controls. There is no min argument since that is always 0 for +menu controls, and instead of a step there is a skip_mask argument: if bit +X is 1, then menu item X is skipped. + +The :c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_int_menu` function creates a new standard +integer menu control with driver-specific items in the menu. It differs +from v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu in that it doesn't have the mask argument and +takes as the last argument an array of signed 64-bit integers that form an +exact menu item list. + +The :c:func:`v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu_items` function is very similar to +v4l2_ctrl_new_std_menu but takes an extra parameter qmenu, which is the +driver specific menu for an otherwise standard menu control. A good example +for this control is the test pattern control for capture/display/sensors +devices that have the capability to generate test patterns. These test +patterns are hardware specific, so the contents of the menu will vary from +device to device. Note that if something fails, the function will return NULL or an error and set ctrl_handler->error to the error code. If ctrl_handler->error was already @@ -233,7 +231,7 @@ a bit faster that way. 3) Optionally force initial control setup: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c v4l2_ctrl_handler_setup(&foo->ctrl_handler); @@ -242,9 +240,9 @@ initializes the hardware to the default control values. It is recommended that you do this as this ensures that both the internal data structures and the hardware are in sync. -4) Finally: implement the v4l2_ctrl_ops +4) Finally: implement the :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_ops` -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c static const struct v4l2_ctrl_ops foo_ctrl_ops = { .s_ctrl = foo_s_ctrl, @@ -252,7 +250,7 @@ the hardware are in sync. Usually all you need is s_ctrl: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c static int foo_s_ctrl(struct v4l2_ctrl *ctrl) { @@ -305,7 +303,7 @@ Accessing Control Values The following union is used inside the control framework to access control values: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c union v4l2_ctrl_ptr { s32 *p_s32; @@ -317,7 +315,7 @@ values: The v4l2_ctrl struct contains these fields that can be used to access both current and new values: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c s32 val; struct { @@ -330,7 +328,7 @@ current and new values: If the control has a simple s32 type type, then: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c &ctrl->val == ctrl->p_new.p_s32 &ctrl->cur.val == ctrl->p_cur.p_s32 @@ -354,7 +352,7 @@ exception is for controls that return a volatile register such as a signal strength read-out that changes continuously. In that case you will need to implement g_volatile_ctrl like this: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c static int foo_g_volatile_ctrl(struct v4l2_ctrl *ctrl) { @@ -372,7 +370,7 @@ changes. To mark a control as volatile you have to set V4L2_CTRL_FLAG_VOLATILE: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c ctrl = v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&sd->ctrl_handler, ...); if (ctrl) @@ -393,7 +391,7 @@ not to introduce deadlocks. Outside of the control ops you have to go through to helper functions to get or set a single control value safely in your driver: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c s32 v4l2_ctrl_g_ctrl(struct v4l2_ctrl *ctrl); int v4l2_ctrl_s_ctrl(struct v4l2_ctrl *ctrl, s32 val); @@ -404,7 +402,7 @@ will result in a deadlock since these helpers lock the handler as well. You can also take the handler lock yourself: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c mutex_lock(&state->ctrl_handler.lock); pr_info("String value is '%s'\n", ctrl1->p_cur.p_char); @@ -417,7 +415,7 @@ Menu Controls The v4l2_ctrl struct contains this union: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c union { u32 step; @@ -445,7 +443,7 @@ Custom Controls Driver specific controls can be created using v4l2_ctrl_new_custom(): -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c static const struct v4l2_ctrl_config ctrl_filter = { .ops = &ctrl_custom_ops, @@ -499,7 +497,7 @@ By default all controls are independent from the others. But in more complex scenarios you can get dependencies from one control to another. In that case you need to 'cluster' them: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct foo { struct v4l2_ctrl_handler ctrl_handler; @@ -523,7 +521,7 @@ composite control. Similar to how a 'struct' works in C. So when s_ctrl is called with V4L2_CID_AUDIO_VOLUME as argument, you should set all two controls belonging to the audio_cluster: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c static int foo_s_ctrl(struct v4l2_ctrl *ctrl) { @@ -545,7 +543,7 @@ all two controls belonging to the audio_cluster: In the example above the following are equivalent for the VOLUME case: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c ctrl == ctrl->cluster[AUDIO_CL_VOLUME] == state->audio_cluster[AUDIO_CL_VOLUME] ctrl->cluster[AUDIO_CL_MUTE] == state->audio_cluster[AUDIO_CL_MUTE] @@ -553,7 +551,7 @@ In the example above the following are equivalent for the VOLUME case: In practice using cluster arrays like this becomes very tiresome. So instead the following equivalent method is used: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct { /* audio cluster */ @@ -565,7 +563,7 @@ The anonymous struct is used to clearly 'cluster' these two control pointers, but it serves no other purpose. The effect is the same as creating an array with two control pointers. So you can just do: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c state->volume = v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&state->ctrl_handler, ...); state->mute = v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&state->ctrl_handler, ...); @@ -621,7 +619,7 @@ changing that control affects the control flags of the manual controls. In order to simplify this a special variation of v4l2_ctrl_cluster was introduced: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c void v4l2_ctrl_auto_cluster(unsigned ncontrols, struct v4l2_ctrl **controls, u8 manual_val, bool set_volatile); @@ -676,7 +674,7 @@ of another handler (e.g. for a video device node), then you should first add the controls to the first handler, add the other controls to the second handler and finally add the first handler to the second. For example: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&radio_ctrl_handler, &radio_ops, V4L2_CID_AUDIO_VOLUME, ...); v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&radio_ctrl_handler, &radio_ops, V4L2_CID_AUDIO_MUTE, ...); @@ -690,7 +688,7 @@ all controls. Or you can add specific controls to a handler: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c volume = v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&video_ctrl_handler, &ops, V4L2_CID_AUDIO_VOLUME, ...); v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&video_ctrl_handler, &ops, V4L2_CID_BRIGHTNESS, ...); @@ -699,7 +697,7 @@ Or you can add specific controls to a handler: What you should not do is make two identical controls for two handlers. For example: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&radio_ctrl_handler, &radio_ops, V4L2_CID_AUDIO_MUTE, ...); v4l2_ctrl_new_std(&video_ctrl_handler, &video_ops, V4L2_CID_AUDIO_MUTE, ...); @@ -720,7 +718,7 @@ not own. For example, if you have to find a volume control from a subdev. You can do that by calling v4l2_ctrl_find: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct v4l2_ctrl *volume; @@ -729,7 +727,7 @@ You can do that by calling v4l2_ctrl_find: Since v4l2_ctrl_find will lock the handler you have to be careful where you use it. For example, this is not a good idea: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c struct v4l2_ctrl_handler ctrl_handler; @@ -738,7 +736,7 @@ use it. For example, this is not a good idea: ...and in video_ops.s_ctrl: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c case V4L2_CID_BRIGHTNESS: contrast = v4l2_find_ctrl(&ctrl_handler, V4L2_CID_CONTRAST); @@ -760,7 +758,7 @@ not when it is used in consumer-level hardware. In that case you want to keep those low-level controls local to the subdev. You can do this by simply setting the 'is_private' flag of the control to 1: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c static const struct v4l2_ctrl_config ctrl_private = { .ops = &ctrl_custom_ops, @@ -797,7 +795,7 @@ Sometimes the platform or bridge driver needs to be notified when a control from a sub-device driver changes. You can set a notify callback by calling this function: -.. code-block:: none +.. code-block:: c void v4l2_ctrl_notify(struct v4l2_ctrl *ctrl, void (*notify)(struct v4l2_ctrl *ctrl, void *priv), void *priv); diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-api.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-api.rst index b614bf81aa20..0780ba07995a 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-api.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-api.rst @@ -39,7 +39,7 @@ Revision and Copyright ********************** Authors: -- Verkuil, Hans <hans.verkuil@cisco.com> +- Verkuil, Hans <hverkuil-cisco@xs4all.nl> - Initial version. diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-g-mode.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-g-mode.rst index c53bb5f73f0d..d0902f356d65 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-g-mode.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-g-mode.rst @@ -294,7 +294,8 @@ EINVAL The requested mode is invalid. EPERM - Monitor mode is requested without having root permissions + Monitor mode is requested, but the process does have the ``CAP_NET_ADMIN`` + capability. EBUSY Someone else is already an exclusive follower or initiator. diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-receive.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-receive.rst index c3a685ff05cb..4137903d672e 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-receive.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/cec/cec-ioc-receive.rst @@ -223,6 +223,18 @@ View On' messages from initiator 0xf ('Unregistered') to destination 0 ('TV'). result of the :ref:`ioctl CEC_TRANSMIT <CEC_TRANSMIT>`, and once via :ref:`ioctl CEC_RECEIVE <CEC_RECEIVE>`. + * .. _`CEC-MSG-FL-RAW`: + + - ``CEC_MSG_FL_RAW`` + - 2 + - Normally CEC messages are validated before transmitting them. If this + flag is set when :ref:`ioctl CEC_TRANSMIT <CEC_TRANSMIT>` is called, + then no validation takes place and the message is transmitted as-is. + This is useful when debugging CEC issues. + This flag is only allowed if the process has the ``CAP_SYS_RAWIO`` + capability. If that is not set, then the ``EPERM`` error code is + returned. + .. tabularcolumns:: |p{5.6cm}|p{0.9cm}|p{11.0cm}| @@ -358,7 +370,8 @@ ENOTTY EPERM The CEC adapter is not configured, i.e. :ref:`ioctl CEC_ADAP_S_LOG_ADDRS <CEC_ADAP_S_LOG_ADDRS>` - has never been called. + has never been called, or ``CEC_MSG_FL_RAW`` was used from a process that + did not have the ``CAP_SYS_RAWIO`` capability. ENONET The CEC adapter is not configured, i.e. :ref:`ioctl CEC_ADAP_S_LOG_ADDRS <CEC_ADAP_S_LOG_ADDRS>` diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/mediactl/media-ioc-enum-links.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/mediactl/media-ioc-enum-links.rst index a982f16e55a4..b827ebc398f8 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/mediactl/media-ioc-enum-links.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/mediactl/media-ioc-enum-links.rst @@ -84,6 +84,11 @@ returned during the enumeration process. - Pointer to a links array allocated by the application. Ignored if NULL. + * - __u32 + - ``reserved[4]`` + - Reserved for future extensions. Drivers and applications must set + the array to zero. + .. c:type:: media_pad_desc @@ -135,7 +140,7 @@ returned during the enumeration process. - Link flags, see :ref:`media-link-flag` for more details. * - __u32 - - ``reserved[4]`` + - ``reserved[2]`` - Reserved for future extensions. Drivers and applications must set the array to zero. diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/rc/rc-tables.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/rc/rc-tables.rst index 177ac44fa0fa..20d7c686922b 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/rc/rc-tables.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/rc/rc-tables.rst @@ -54,7 +54,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 3 - - ``KEY_0`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_0`` - Keyboard digit 0 @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 4 - - ``KEY_1`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_1`` - Keyboard digit 1 @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 5 - - ``KEY_2`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_2`` - Keyboard digit 2 @@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 6 - - ``KEY_3`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_3`` - Keyboard digit 3 @@ -86,7 +86,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 7 - - ``KEY_4`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_4`` - Keyboard digit 4 @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 8 - - ``KEY_5`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_5`` - Keyboard digit 5 @@ -102,7 +102,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 9 - - ``KEY_6`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_6`` - Keyboard digit 6 @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 10 - - ``KEY_7`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_7`` - Keyboard digit 7 @@ -118,7 +118,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 11 - - ``KEY_8`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_8`` - Keyboard digit 8 @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - .. row 12 - - ``KEY_9`` + - ``KEY_NUMERIC_9`` - Keyboard digit 9 @@ -196,7 +196,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - ``KEY_PAUSE`` - - Pause sroweam + - Pause stream - PAUSE / FREEZE @@ -220,7 +220,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - ``KEY_STOP`` - - Stop sroweam + - Stop stream - STOP @@ -228,7 +228,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - ``KEY_RECORD`` - - Start/stop recording sroweam + - Start/stop recording stream - CAPTURE / REC / RECORD/PAUSE @@ -577,7 +577,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - ``KEY_CLEAR`` - - Stop sroweam and return to default input video/audio + - Stop stream and return to default input video/audio - CLEAR / RESET / BOSS KEY @@ -593,7 +593,7 @@ the remote via /dev/input/event devices. - ``KEY_FAVORITES`` - - Open the favorites sroweam window + - Open the favorites stream window - TV WALL / Favorites diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/biblio.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/biblio.rst index ec33768c055e..8f4eb8823d82 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/biblio.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/biblio.rst @@ -122,6 +122,15 @@ ITU BT.1119 :author: International Telecommunication Union (http://www.itu.ch) +.. _h264: + +ITU-T Rec. H.264 Specification (04/2017 Edition) +================================================ + +:title: ITU-T Recommendation H.264 "Advanced Video Coding for Generic Audiovisual Services" + +:author: International Telecommunication Union (http://www.itu.ch) + .. _jfif: JFIF diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/ext-ctrls-codec.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/ext-ctrls-codec.rst index 4a8446203085..d6ea2ffd65c5 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/ext-ctrls-codec.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/ext-ctrls-codec.rst @@ -759,6 +759,32 @@ enum v4l2_mpeg_video_h264_level - +.. _v4l2-mpeg-video-mpeg2-level: + +``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_LEVEL`` + (enum) + +enum v4l2_mpeg_video_mpeg2_level - + The level information for the MPEG2 elementary stream. Applicable to + MPEG2 codecs. Possible values are: + + + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_LEVEL_LOW`` + - Low Level (LL) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_LEVEL_MAIN`` + - Main Level (ML) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_LEVEL_HIGH_1440`` + - High-1440 Level (H-14) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_LEVEL_HIGH`` + - High Level (HL) + + + .. _v4l2-mpeg-video-mpeg4-level: ``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG4_LEVEL`` @@ -845,6 +871,36 @@ enum v4l2_mpeg_video_h264_profile - +.. _v4l2-mpeg-video-mpeg2-profile: + +``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_PROFILE`` + (enum) + +enum v4l2_mpeg_video_mpeg2_profile - + The profile information for MPEG2. Applicable to MPEG2 codecs. + Possible values are: + + + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_PROFILE_SIMPLE`` + - Simple profile (SP) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_PROFILE_MAIN`` + - Main profile (MP) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_PROFILE_SNR_SCALABLE`` + - SNR Scalable profile (SNR) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_PROFILE_SPATIALLY_SCALABLE`` + - Spatially Scalable profile (Spt) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_PROFILE_HIGH`` + - High profile (HP) + * - ``V4L2_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG2_PROFILE_MULTIVIEW`` + - Multi-view profile (MVP) + + + .. _v4l2-mpeg-video-mpeg4-profile: ``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_MPEG4_PROFILE`` @@ -1395,6 +1451,575 @@ enum v4l2_mpeg_video_h264_hierarchical_coding_type - - Layer number +.. _v4l2-mpeg-h264: + +``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_SPS (struct)`` + Specifies the sequence parameter set (as extracted from the + bitstream) for the associated H264 slice data. This includes the + necessary parameters for configuring a stateless hardware decoding + pipeline for H264. The bitstream parameters are defined according + to :ref:`h264`, section 7.4.2.1.1 "Sequence Parameter Set Data + Semantics". For further documentation, refer to the above + specification, unless there is an explicit comment stating + otherwise. + + .. note:: + + This compound control is not yet part of the public kernel API and + it is expected to change. + +.. c:type:: v4l2_ctrl_h264_sps + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_ctrl_h264_sps + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - __u8 + - ``profile_idc`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``constraint_set_flags`` + - See :ref:`Sequence Parameter Set Constraints Set Flags <h264_sps_constraints_set_flags>` + * - __u8 + - ``level_idc`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``seq_parameter_set_id`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``chroma_format_idc`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``bit_depth_luma_minus8`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``bit_depth_chroma_minus8`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``log2_max_frame_num_minus4`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``pic_order_cnt_type`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``log2_max_pic_order_cnt_lsb_minus4`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``max_num_ref_frames`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``num_ref_frames_in_pic_order_cnt_cycle`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``offset_for_ref_frame[255]`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``offset_for_non_ref_pic`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``offset_for_top_to_bottom_field`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``pic_width_in_mbs_minus1`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``pic_height_in_map_units_minus1`` + - + * - __u32 + - ``flags`` + - See :ref:`Sequence Parameter Set Flags <h264_sps_flags>` + +.. _h264_sps_constraints_set_flags: + +``Sequence Parameter Set Constraints Set Flags`` + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_CONSTRAINT_SET0_FLAG`` + - 0x00000001 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_CONSTRAINT_SET1_FLAG`` + - 0x00000002 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_CONSTRAINT_SET2_FLAG`` + - 0x00000004 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_CONSTRAINT_SET3_FLAG`` + - 0x00000008 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_CONSTRAINT_SET4_FLAG`` + - 0x00000010 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_CONSTRAINT_SET5_FLAG`` + - 0x00000020 + - + +.. _h264_sps_flags: + +``Sequence Parameter Set Flags`` + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_FLAG_SEPARATE_COLOUR_PLANE`` + - 0x00000001 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_FLAG_QPPRIME_Y_ZERO_TRANSFORM_BYPASS`` + - 0x00000002 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_FLAG_DELTA_PIC_ORDER_ALWAYS_ZERO`` + - 0x00000004 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_FLAG_GAPS_IN_FRAME_NUM_VALUE_ALLOWED`` + - 0x00000008 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_FLAG_FRAME_MBS_ONLY`` + - 0x00000010 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_FLAG_MB_ADAPTIVE_FRAME_FIELD`` + - 0x00000020 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SPS_FLAG_DIRECT_8X8_INFERENCE`` + - 0x00000040 + - + +``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_PPS (struct)`` + Specifies the picture parameter set (as extracted from the + bitstream) for the associated H264 slice data. This includes the + necessary parameters for configuring a stateless hardware decoding + pipeline for H264. The bitstream parameters are defined according + to :ref:`h264`, section 7.4.2.2 "Picture Parameter Set RBSP + Semantics". For further documentation, refer to the above + specification, unless there is an explicit comment stating + otherwise. + + .. note:: + + This compound control is not yet part of the public kernel API and + it is expected to change. + +.. c:type:: v4l2_ctrl_h264_pps + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_ctrl_h264_pps + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - __u8 + - ``pic_parameter_set_id`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``seq_parameter_set_id`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``num_slice_groups_minus1`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``num_ref_idx_l0_default_active_minus1`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``num_ref_idx_l1_default_active_minus1`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``weighted_bipred_idc`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``pic_init_qp_minus26`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``pic_init_qs_minus26`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``chroma_qp_index_offset`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``second_chroma_qp_index_offset`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``flags`` + - See :ref:`Picture Parameter Set Flags <h264_pps_flags>` + +.. _h264_pps_flags: + +``Picture Parameter Set Flags`` + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_ENTROPY_CODING_MODE`` + - 0x00000001 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_BOTTOM_FIELD_PIC_ORDER_IN_FRAME_PRESENT`` + - 0x00000002 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_WEIGHTED_PRED`` + - 0x00000004 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_DEBLOCKING_FILTER_CONTROL_PRESENT`` + - 0x00000008 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_CONSTRAINED_INTRA_PRED`` + - 0x00000010 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_REDUNDANT_PIC_CNT_PRESENT`` + - 0x00000020 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_TRANSFORM_8X8_MODE`` + - 0x00000040 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_PPS_FLAG_PIC_SCALING_MATRIX_PRESENT`` + - 0x00000080 + - + +``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_SCALING_MATRIX (struct)`` + Specifies the scaling matrix (as extracted from the bitstream) for + the associated H264 slice data. The bitstream parameters are + defined according to :ref:`h264`, section 7.4.2.1.1.1 "Scaling + List Semantics". For further documentation, refer to the above + specification, unless there is an explicit comment stating + otherwise. + + .. note:: + + This compound control is not yet part of the public kernel API and + it is expected to change. + +.. c:type:: v4l2_ctrl_h264_scaling_matrix + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_ctrl_h264_scaling_matrix + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - __u8 + - ``scaling_list_4x4[6][16]`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``scaling_list_8x8[6][64]`` + - + +``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_SLICE_PARAMS (struct)`` + Specifies the slice parameters (as extracted from the bitstream) + for the associated H264 slice data. This includes the necessary + parameters for configuring a stateless hardware decoding pipeline + for H264. The bitstream parameters are defined according to + :ref:`h264`, section 7.4.3 "Slice Header Semantics". For further + documentation, refer to the above specification, unless there is + an explicit comment stating otherwise. + + .. note:: + + This compound control is not yet part of the public kernel API + and it is expected to change. + + This structure is expected to be passed as an array, with one + entry for each slice included in the bitstream buffer. + +.. c:type:: v4l2_ctrl_h264_slice_params + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_ctrl_h264_slice_params + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - __u32 + - ``size`` + - + * - __u32 + - ``header_bit_size`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``first_mb_in_slice`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``slice_type`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``pic_parameter_set_id`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``colour_plane_id`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``redundant_pic_cnt`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``frame_num`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``idr_pic_id`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``pic_order_cnt_lsb`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``delta_pic_order_cnt_bottom`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``delta_pic_order_cnt0`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``delta_pic_order_cnt1`` + - + * - struct :c:type:`v4l2_h264_pred_weight_table` + - ``pred_weight_table`` + - + * - __u32 + - ``dec_ref_pic_marking_bit_size`` + - + * - __u32 + - ``pic_order_cnt_bit_size`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``cabac_init_idc`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``slice_qp_delta`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``slice_qs_delta`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``disable_deblocking_filter_idc`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``slice_alpha_c0_offset_div2`` + - + * - __s8 + - ``slice_beta_offset_div2`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``num_ref_idx_l0_active_minus1`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``num_ref_idx_l1_active_minus1`` + - + * - __u32 + - ``slice_group_change_cycle`` + - + * - __u8 + - ``ref_pic_list0[32]`` + - Reference picture list after applying the per-slice modifications + * - __u8 + - ``ref_pic_list1[32]`` + - Reference picture list after applying the per-slice modifications + * - __u32 + - ``flags`` + - See :ref:`Slice Parameter Flags <h264_slice_flags>` + +.. _h264_slice_flags: + +``Slice Parameter Set Flags`` + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - ``V4L2_H264_SLICE_FLAG_FIELD_PIC`` + - 0x00000001 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SLICE_FLAG_BOTTOM_FIELD`` + - 0x00000002 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SLICE_FLAG_DIRECT_SPATIAL_MV_PRED`` + - 0x00000004 + - + * - ``V4L2_H264_SLICE_FLAG_SP_FOR_SWITCH`` + - 0x00000008 + - + +``Prediction Weight Table`` + + The bitstream parameters are defined according to :ref:`h264`, + section 7.4.3.2 "Prediction Weight Table Semantics". For further + documentation, refer to the above specification, unless there is + an explicit comment stating otherwise. + +.. c:type:: v4l2_h264_pred_weight_table + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_h264_pred_weight_table + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - __u16 + - ``luma_log2_weight_denom`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``chroma_log2_weight_denom`` + - + * - struct :c:type:`v4l2_h264_weight_factors` + - ``weight_factors[2]`` + - The weight factors at index 0 are the weight factors for the reference + list 0, the one at index 1 for the reference list 1. + +.. c:type:: v4l2_h264_weight_factors + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_h264_weight_factors + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - __s16 + - ``luma_weight[32]`` + - + * - __s16 + - ``luma_offset[32]`` + - + * - __s16 + - ``chroma_weight[32][2]`` + - + * - __s16 + - ``chroma_offset[32][2]`` + - + +``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_DECODE_PARAMS (struct)`` + Specifies the decode parameters (as extracted from the bitstream) + for the associated H264 slice data. This includes the necessary + parameters for configuring a stateless hardware decoding pipeline + for H264. The bitstream parameters are defined according to + :ref:`h264`. For further documentation, refer to the above + specification, unless there is an explicit comment stating + otherwise. + + .. note:: + + This compound control is not yet part of the public kernel API and + it is expected to change. + +.. c:type:: v4l2_ctrl_h264_decode_params + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_ctrl_h264_decode_params + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - struct :c:type:`v4l2_h264_dpb_entry` + - ``dpb[16]`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``num_slices`` + - Number of slices needed to decode the current frame + * - __u16 + - ``nal_ref_idc`` + - NAL reference ID value coming from the NAL Unit header + * - __u8 + - ``ref_pic_list_p0[32]`` + - Backward reference list used by P-frames in the original bitstream order + * - __u8 + - ``ref_pic_list_b0[32]`` + - Backward reference list used by B-frames in the original bitstream order + * - __u8 + - ``ref_pic_list_b1[32]`` + - Forward reference list used by B-frames in the original bitstream order + * - __s32 + - ``top_field_order_cnt`` + - Picture Order Count for the coded top field + * - __s32 + - ``bottom_field_order_cnt`` + - Picture Order Count for the coded bottom field + * - __u32 + - ``flags`` + - See :ref:`Decode Parameters Flags <h264_decode_params_flags>` + +.. _h264_decode_params_flags: + +``Decode Parameters Flags`` + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - ``V4L2_H264_DECODE_PARAM_FLAG_IDR_PIC`` + - 0x00000001 + - That picture is an IDR picture + +.. c:type:: v4l2_h264_dpb_entry + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: struct v4l2_h264_dpb_entry + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - __u64 + - ``reference_ts`` + - Timestamp of the V4L2 capture buffer to use as reference, used + with B-coded and P-coded frames. The timestamp refers to the + ``timestamp`` field in struct :c:type:`v4l2_buffer`. Use the + :c:func:`v4l2_timeval_to_ns()` function to convert the struct + :c:type:`timeval` in struct :c:type:`v4l2_buffer` to a __u64. + * - __u16 + - ``frame_num`` + - + * - __u16 + - ``pic_num`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``top_field_order_cnt`` + - + * - __s32 + - ``bottom_field_order_cnt`` + - + * - __u32 + - ``flags`` + - See :ref:`DPB Entry Flags <h264_dpb_flags>` + +.. _h264_dpb_flags: + +``DPB Entries Flags`` + +.. cssclass:: longtable + +.. flat-table:: + :header-rows: 0 + :stub-columns: 0 + :widths: 1 1 2 + + * - ``V4L2_H264_DPB_ENTRY_FLAG_VALID`` + - 0x00000001 + - The DPB entry is valid and should be considered + * - ``V4L2_H264_DPB_ENTRY_FLAG_ACTIVE`` + - 0x00000002 + - The DPB entry is currently being used as a reference frame + * - ``V4L2_H264_DPB_ENTRY_FLAG_LONG_TERM`` + - 0x00000004 + - The DPB entry is a long term reference frame .. _v4l2-mpeg-mpeg2: diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/extended-controls.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/extended-controls.rst index 24274b398e63..655362483730 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/extended-controls.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/extended-controls.rst @@ -85,20 +85,17 @@ be able to see such compound controls. In other words, these controls with compound types should only be used programmatically. Since such compound controls need to expose more information about -themselves than is possible with -:ref:`VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL` the -:ref:`VIDIOC_QUERY_EXT_CTRL <VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL>` ioctl was added. In -particular, this ioctl gives the dimensions of the N-dimensional array -if this control consists of more than one element. +themselves than is possible with :ref:`VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL <VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL>` +the :ref:`VIDIOC_QUERY_EXT_CTRL <VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL>` ioctl was added. In +particular, this ioctl gives the dimensions of the N-dimensional array if +this control consists of more than one element. .. note:: #. It is important to realize that due to the flexibility of controls it is necessary to check whether the control you want to set actually is supported in the driver and what the valid range of values is. So use - the :ref:`VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL` (or :ref:`VIDIOC_QUERY_EXT_CTRL - <VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL>`) and :ref:`VIDIOC_QUERYMENU <VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL>` - ioctls to check this. + :ref:`VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL` to check this. #. It is possible that some of the menu indices in a control of type ``V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_MENU`` may not be supported (``VIDIOC_QUERYMENU`` @@ -144,7 +141,7 @@ control class is found: while (0 == ioctl(fd, VIDIOC_QUERYCTRL, &qctrl)) { if (V4L2_CTRL_ID2CLASS(qctrl.id) != V4L2_CTRL_CLASS_MPEG) break; - /* ... */ + /* ... */ qctrl.id |= V4L2_CTRL_FLAG_NEXT_CTRL; } diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/field-order.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/field-order.rst index d640e922a974..c422bebe4314 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/field-order.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/field-order.rst @@ -51,6 +51,11 @@ determined by the video standard. Hence the distinction between temporal and spatial order of fields. The diagrams below should make this clearer. +In V4L it is assumed that all video cameras transmit fields on the media +bus in the same order they were captured, so if the top field was +captured first (is the older field), the top field is also transmitted +first on the bus. + All video capture and output devices must report the current field order. Some drivers may permit the selection of a different order, to this end applications initialize the ``field`` field of struct @@ -101,10 +106,10 @@ enum v4l2_field * - ``V4L2_FIELD_INTERLACED`` - 4 - Images contain both fields, interleaved line by line. The temporal - order of the fields (whether the top or bottom field is first - transmitted) depends on the current video standard. M/NTSC - transmits the bottom field first, all other standards the top - field first. + order of the fields (whether the top or bottom field is older) + depends on the current video standard. In M/NTSC the bottom + field is the older field. In all other standards the top field + is the older field. * - ``V4L2_FIELD_SEQ_TB`` - 5 - Images contain both fields, the top field lines are stored first @@ -135,11 +140,11 @@ enum v4l2_field * - ``V4L2_FIELD_INTERLACED_TB`` - 8 - Images contain both fields, interleaved line by line, top field - first. The top field is transmitted first. + first. The top field is the older field. * - ``V4L2_FIELD_INTERLACED_BT`` - 9 - Images contain both fields, interleaved line by line, top field - first. The bottom field is transmitted first. + first. The bottom field is the older field. diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-compressed.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-compressed.rst index 6c961cfb74da..4b701fc7653e 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-compressed.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-compressed.rst @@ -52,6 +52,31 @@ Compressed Formats - ``V4L2_PIX_FMT_H264_MVC`` - 'M264' - H264 MVC video elementary stream. + * .. _V4L2-PIX-FMT-H264-SLICE-RAW: + + - ``V4L2_PIX_FMT_H264_SLICE_RAW`` + - 'S264' + - H264 parsed slice data, without the start code and as + extracted from the H264 bitstream. This format is adapted for + stateless video decoders that implement an H264 pipeline + (using the :ref:`mem2mem` and :ref:`media-request-api`). + Metadata associated with the frame to decode are required to + be passed through the ``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_SPS``, + ``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_PPS``, + ``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_SCALING_MATRIX``, + ``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_SLICE_PARAMS`` and + ``V4L2_CID_MPEG_VIDEO_H264_DECODE_PARAMS`` controls. See the + :ref:`associated Codec Control IDs <v4l2-mpeg-h264>`. Exactly + one output and one capture buffer must be provided for use + with this pixel format. The output buffer must contain the + appropriate number of macroblocks to decode a full + corresponding frame to the matching capture buffer. + + .. note:: + + This format is not yet part of the public kernel API and it + is expected to change. + * .. _V4L2-PIX-FMT-H263: - ``V4L2_PIX_FMT_H263`` diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2-mplane.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2-mplane.rst index 5688c816e334..db43dda5aafb 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2-mplane.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2-mplane.rst @@ -31,7 +31,20 @@ describing all planes of that format. * - __u32 - ``sizeimage`` - - Maximum size in bytes required for image data in this plane. + - Maximum size in bytes required for image data in this plane, + set by the driver. When the image consists of variable length + compressed data this is the number of bytes required by the + codec to support the worst-case compression scenario. + + The driver will set the value for uncompressed images. + + Clients are allowed to set the sizeimage field for variable length + compressed data flagged with ``V4L2_FMT_FLAG_COMPRESSED`` at + :ref:`VIDIOC_ENUM_FMT`, but the driver may ignore it and set the + value itself, or it may modify the provided value based on + alignment requirements or minimum/maximum size requirements. + If the client wants to leave this to the driver, then it should + set sizeimage to 0. * - __u32 - ``bytesperline`` - Distance in bytes between the leftmost pixels in two adjacent diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2.rst index 71eebfc6d853..da6da2ef139a 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/pixfmt-v4l2.rst @@ -89,7 +89,18 @@ Single-planar format structure - Size in bytes of the buffer to hold a complete image, set by the driver. Usually this is ``bytesperline`` times ``height``. When the image consists of variable length compressed data this is the - maximum number of bytes required to hold an image. + number of bytes required by the codec to support the worst-case + compression scenario. + + The driver will set the value for uncompressed images. + + Clients are allowed to set the sizeimage field for variable length + compressed data flagged with ``V4L2_FMT_FLAG_COMPRESSED`` at + :ref:`VIDIOC_ENUM_FMT`, but the driver may ignore it and set the + value itself, or it may modify the provided value based on + alignment requirements or minimum/maximum size requirements. + If the client wants to leave this to the driver, then it should + set sizeimage to 0. * - __u32 - ``colorspace`` - Image colorspace, from enum :c:type:`v4l2_colorspace`. diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-qbuf.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-qbuf.rst index dbf7b445a27b..407302d80684 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-qbuf.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-qbuf.rst @@ -139,6 +139,14 @@ may continue as normal, but should be aware that data in the dequeued buffer might be corrupted. When using the multi-planar API, the planes array must be passed in as well. +If the application sets the ``memory`` field to ``V4L2_MEMORY_DMABUF`` to +dequeue a :ref:`DMABUF <dmabuf>` buffer, the driver fills the ``m.fd`` field +with a file descriptor numerically the same as the one given to ``VIDIOC_QBUF`` +when the buffer was enqueued. No new file descriptor is created at dequeue time +and the value is only for the application convenience. When the multi-planar +API is used the ``m.fd`` fields of the passed array of struct +:c:type:`v4l2_plane` are filled instead. + By default ``VIDIOC_DQBUF`` blocks when no buffer is in the outgoing queue. When the ``O_NONBLOCK`` flag was given to the :ref:`open() <func-open>` function, ``VIDIOC_DQBUF`` returns diff --git a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-queryctrl.rst b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-queryctrl.rst index f824162d0ea9..dc500632095d 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-queryctrl.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/uapi/v4l/vidioc-queryctrl.rst @@ -443,6 +443,36 @@ See also the examples in :ref:`control`. - n/a - A struct :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_mpeg2_quantization`, containing MPEG-2 quantization matrices for stateless video decoders. + * - ``V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_SPS`` + - n/a + - n/a + - n/a + - A struct :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_h264_sps`, containing H264 + sequence parameters for stateless video decoders. + * - ``V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_PPS`` + - n/a + - n/a + - n/a + - A struct :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_h264_pps`, containing H264 + picture parameters for stateless video decoders. + * - ``V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_SCALING_MATRIX`` + - n/a + - n/a + - n/a + - A struct :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_h264_scaling_matrix`, containing H264 + scaling matrices for stateless video decoders. + * - ``V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_SLICE_PARAMS`` + - n/a + - n/a + - n/a + - A struct :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_h264_slice_params`, containing H264 + slice parameters for stateless video decoders. + * - ``V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_DECODE_PARAMS`` + - n/a + - n/a + - n/a + - A struct :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_h264_decode_params`, containing H264 + decode parameters for stateless video decoders. .. tabularcolumns:: |p{6.6cm}|p{2.2cm}|p{8.7cm}| diff --git a/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/index.rst b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/index.rst index 33a055907258..c4c78a28654c 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/index.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/index.rst @@ -64,5 +64,6 @@ For more details see the file COPYING in the source distribution of Linux. si476x soc-camera uvcvideo + vimc vivid zr364xx diff --git a/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vimc.dot b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vimc.dot new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..57863a13fa39 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vimc.dot @@ -0,0 +1,22 @@ +# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 + +digraph board { + rankdir=TB + n00000001 [label="{{} | Sensor A\n/dev/v4l-subdev0 | {<port0> 0}}", shape=Mrecord, style=filled, fillcolor=green] + n00000001:port0 -> n00000005:port0 [style=bold] + n00000001:port0 -> n0000000b [style=bold] + n00000003 [label="{{} | Sensor B\n/dev/v4l-subdev1 | {<port0> 0}}", shape=Mrecord, style=filled, fillcolor=green] + n00000003:port0 -> n00000008:port0 [style=bold] + n00000003:port0 -> n0000000f [style=bold] + n00000005 [label="{{<port0> 0} | Debayer A\n/dev/v4l-subdev2 | {<port1> 1}}", shape=Mrecord, style=filled, fillcolor=green] + n00000005:port1 -> n00000017:port0 + n00000008 [label="{{<port0> 0} | Debayer B\n/dev/v4l-subdev3 | {<port1> 1}}", shape=Mrecord, style=filled, fillcolor=green] + n00000008:port1 -> n00000017:port0 [style=dashed] + n0000000b [label="Raw Capture 0\n/dev/video0", shape=box, style=filled, fillcolor=yellow] + n0000000f [label="Raw Capture 1\n/dev/video1", shape=box, style=filled, fillcolor=yellow] + n00000013 [label="RGB/YUV Input\n/dev/video2", shape=box, style=filled, fillcolor=yellow] + n00000013 -> n00000017:port0 [style=dashed] + n00000017 [label="{{<port0> 0} | Scaler\n/dev/v4l-subdev4 | {<port1> 1}}", shape=Mrecord, style=filled, fillcolor=green] + n00000017:port1 -> n0000001a [style=bold] + n0000001a [label="RGB/YUV Capture\n/dev/video3", shape=box, style=filled, fillcolor=yellow] +} diff --git a/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vimc.rst b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vimc.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..4628b12d417f --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vimc.rst @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +.. SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 + +The Virtual Media Controller Driver (vimc) +========================================== + +The vimc driver emulates complex video hardware using the V4L2 API and the Media +API. It has a capture device and three subdevices: sensor, debayer and scaler. + +Topology +-------- + +The topology is hardcoded, although you could modify it in vimc-core and +recompile the driver to achieve your own topology. This is the default topology: + +.. _vimc_topology_graph: + +.. kernel-figure:: vimc.dot + :alt: vimc.dot + :align: center + + Media pipeline graph on vimc + +Configuring the topology +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +Each subdevice will come with its default configuration (pixelformat, height, +width, ...). One needs to configure the topology in order to match the +configuration on each linked subdevice to stream frames through the pipeline. +If the configuration doesn't match, the stream will fail. The ``v4l-utils`` +package is a bundle of user-space applications, that comes with ``media-ctl`` and +``v4l2-ctl`` that can be used to configure the vimc configuration. This sequence +of commands fits for the default topology: + +.. code-block:: bash + + media-ctl -d platform:vimc -V '"Sensor A":0[fmt:SBGGR8_1X8/640x480]' + media-ctl -d platform:vimc -V '"Debayer A":0[fmt:SBGGR8_1X8/640x480]' + media-ctl -d platform:vimc -V '"Sensor B":0[fmt:SBGGR8_1X8/640x480]' + media-ctl -d platform:vimc -V '"Debayer B":0[fmt:SBGGR8_1X8/640x480]' + v4l2-ctl -z platform:vimc -d "RGB/YUV Capture" -v width=1920,height=1440 + v4l2-ctl -z platform:vimc -d "Raw Capture 0" -v pixelformat=BA81 + v4l2-ctl -z platform:vimc -d "Raw Capture 1" -v pixelformat=BA81 + +Subdevices +---------- + +Subdevices define the behavior of an entity in the topology. Depending on the +subdevice, the entity can have multiple pads of type source or sink. + +vimc-sensor: + Generates images in several formats using video test pattern generator. + Exposes: + + * 1 Pad source + +vimc-debayer: + Transforms images in bayer format into a non-bayer format. + Exposes: + + * 1 Pad sink + * 1 Pad source + +vimc-scaler: + Scale up the image by a factor of 3. E.g.: a 640x480 image becomes a + 1920x1440 image. (this value can be configured, see at + `Module options`_). + Exposes: + + * 1 Pad sink + * 1 Pad source + +vimc-capture: + Exposes node /dev/videoX to allow userspace to capture the stream. + Exposes: + + * 1 Pad sink + * 1 Pad source + +Module options +--------------- + +Vimc has a few module parameters to configure the driver. You should pass +those arguments to each subdevice, not to the vimc module. For example:: + + vimc_subdevice.param=value + +* ``vimc_scaler.sca_mult=<unsigned int>`` + + Image size multiplier factor to be used to multiply both width and + height, so the image size will be ``sca_mult^2`` bigger than the + original one. Currently, only supports scaling up (the default value + is 3). + +* ``vimc_debayer.deb_mean_win_size=<unsigned int>`` + + Window size to calculate the mean. Note: the window size needs to be an + odd number, as the main pixel stays in the center of the window, + otherwise the next odd number is considered (the default value is 3). diff --git a/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vivid.rst b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vivid.rst index edb6f33e029c..7082fec4075d 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vivid.rst +++ b/Documentation/media/v4l-drivers/vivid.rst @@ -941,6 +941,11 @@ Digital Video Controls affects the reported colorspace since DVI_D outputs will always use sRGB. +- Display Present: + + sets the presence of a "display" on the HDMI output. This affects + the tx_edid_present, tx_hotplug and tx_rxsense controls. + FM Radio Receiver Controls ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ diff --git a/Documentation/media/videodev2.h.rst.exceptions b/Documentation/media/videodev2.h.rst.exceptions index 64d348e67df9..55cbe324b9fc 100644 --- a/Documentation/media/videodev2.h.rst.exceptions +++ b/Documentation/media/videodev2.h.rst.exceptions @@ -136,6 +136,11 @@ replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_U32 :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_U8 :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_MPEG2_SLICE_PARAMS :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_MPEG2_QUANTIZATION :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` +replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_SPS :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` +replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_PPS :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` +replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_SCALING_MATRIX :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` +replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_SLICE_PARAMS :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` +replace symbol V4L2_CTRL_TYPE_H264_DECODE_PARAMS :c:type:`v4l2_ctrl_type` # V4L2 capability defines replace define V4L2_CAP_VIDEO_CAPTURE device-capabilities diff --git a/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt b/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt index f70ebcdfe592..e4e07c8ab89e 100644 --- a/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt +++ b/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ============================ By: David Howells <dhowells@redhat.com> - Paul E. McKenney <paulmck@linux.vnet.ibm.com> + Paul E. McKenney <paulmck@linux.ibm.com> Will Deacon <will.deacon@arm.com> Peter Zijlstra <peterz@infradead.org> diff --git a/Documentation/process/changes.rst b/Documentation/process/changes.rst index 18735dc460a0..0a18075c485e 100644 --- a/Documentation/process/changes.rst +++ b/Documentation/process/changes.rst @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ you probably needn't concern yourself with isdn4k-utils. ====================== =============== ======================================== GNU C 4.6 gcc --version GNU make 3.81 make --version -binutils 2.20 ld -v +binutils 2.21 ld -v flex 2.5.35 flex --version bison 2.0 bison --version util-linux 2.10o fdformat --version @@ -77,9 +77,7 @@ You will need GNU make 3.81 or later to build the kernel. Binutils -------- -The build system has, as of 4.13, switched to using thin archives (`ar T`) -rather than incremental linking (`ld -r`) for built-in.a intermediate steps. -This requires binutils 2.20 or newer. +Binutils 2.21 or newer is needed to build the kernel. pkg-config ---------- diff --git a/Documentation/pwm.txt b/Documentation/pwm.txt index 8fbf0aa3ba2d..ab62f1bb0366 100644 --- a/Documentation/pwm.txt +++ b/Documentation/pwm.txt @@ -65,6 +65,10 @@ period). struct pwm_args contains 2 fields (period and polarity) and should be used to set the initial PWM config (usually done in the probe function of the PWM user). PWM arguments are retrieved with pwm_get_args(). +All consumers should really be reconfiguring the PWM upon resume as +appropriate. This is the only way to ensure that everything is resumed in +the proper order. + Using PWMs with the sysfs interface ----------------------------------- @@ -141,6 +145,9 @@ The implementation of ->get_state() (a method used to retrieve initial PWM state) is also encouraged for the same reason: letting the PWM user know about the current PWM state would allow him to avoid glitches. +Drivers should not implement any power management. In other words, +consumers should implement it as described in the "Using PWMs" section. + Locking ------- diff --git a/Documentation/s390/3270.txt b/Documentation/s390/3270.rst index 7c715de99774..e09e77954238 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/3270.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/3270.rst @@ -1,13 +1,17 @@ +=============================== IBM 3270 Display System support +=============================== This file describes the driver that supports local channel attachment of IBM 3270 devices. It consists of three sections: + * Introduction * Installation * Operation -INTRODUCTION. +Introduction +============ This paper describes installing and operating 3270 devices under Linux/390. A 3270 device is a block-mode rows-and-columns terminal of @@ -17,12 +21,12 @@ twenty and thirty years ago. You may have 3270s in-house and not know it. If you're using the VM-ESA operating system, define a 3270 to your virtual machine by using the command "DEF GRAF <hex-address>" This paper presumes you will be -defining four 3270s with the CP/CMS commands +defining four 3270s with the CP/CMS commands: - DEF GRAF 620 - DEF GRAF 621 - DEF GRAF 622 - DEF GRAF 623 + - DEF GRAF 620 + - DEF GRAF 621 + - DEF GRAF 622 + - DEF GRAF 623 Your network connection from VM-ESA allows you to use x3270, tn3270, or another 3270 emulator, started from an xterm window on your PC or @@ -34,7 +38,8 @@ This paper covers installation of the driver and operation of a dialed-in x3270. -INSTALLATION. +Installation +============ You install the driver by installing a patch, doing a kernel build, and running the configuration script (config3270.sh, in this directory). @@ -59,13 +64,15 @@ Use #CP TERM CONMODE 3270 to change it to 3270. If you generate only at boot time to a 3270 if it is a 3215. In brief, these are the steps: + 1. Install the tub3270 patch - 2. (If a module) add a line to a file in /etc/modprobe.d/*.conf + 2. (If a module) add a line to a file in `/etc/modprobe.d/*.conf` 3. (If VM) define devices with DEF GRAF 4. Reboot 5. Configure To test that everything works, assuming VM and x3270, + 1. Bring up an x3270 window. 2. Use the DIAL command in that window. 3. You should immediately see a Linux login screen. @@ -74,7 +81,8 @@ Here are the installation steps in detail: 1. The 3270 driver is a part of the official Linux kernel source. Build a tree with the kernel source and any necessary - patches. Then do + patches. Then do:: + make oldconfig (If you wish to disable 3215 console support, edit .config; change CONFIG_TN3215's value to "n"; @@ -84,20 +92,22 @@ Here are the installation steps in detail: make modules_install 2. (Perform this step only if you have configured tub3270 as a - module.) Add a line to a file /etc/modprobe.d/*.conf to automatically + module.) Add a line to a file `/etc/modprobe.d/*.conf` to automatically load the driver when it's needed. With this line added, you will see login prompts appear on your 3270s as soon as boot is complete (or with emulated 3270s, as soon as you dial into your vm guest using the command "DIAL <vmguestname>"). Since the line-mode major number is - 227, the line to add should be: + 227, the line to add should be:: + alias char-major-227 tub3270 3. Define graphic devices to your vm guest machine, if you haven't already. Define them before you reboot (reipl): - DEFINE GRAF 620 - DEFINE GRAF 621 - DEFINE GRAF 622 - DEFINE GRAF 623 + + - DEFINE GRAF 620 + - DEFINE GRAF 621 + - DEFINE GRAF 622 + - DEFINE GRAF 623 4. Reboot. The reboot process scans hardware devices, including 3270s, and this enables the tub3270 driver once loaded to respond @@ -107,21 +117,23 @@ Here are the installation steps in detail: 5. Run the 3270 configuration script config3270. It is distributed in this same directory, Documentation/s390, as - config3270.sh. Inspect the output script it produces, + config3270.sh. Inspect the output script it produces, /tmp/mkdev3270, and then run that script. This will create the necessary character special device files and make the necessary changes to /etc/inittab. Then notify /sbin/init that /etc/inittab has changed, by issuing - the telinit command with the q operand: + the telinit command with the q operand:: + cd Documentation/s390 sh config3270.sh sh /tmp/mkdev3270 telinit q - This should be sufficient for your first time. If your 3270 + This should be sufficient for your first time. If your 3270 configuration has changed and you're reusing config3270, you - should follow these steps: + should follow these steps:: + Change 3270 configuration Reboot Run config3270 and /tmp/mkdev3270 @@ -132,8 +144,10 @@ Here are the testing steps in detail: 1. Bring up an x3270 window, or use an actual hardware 3278 or 3279, or use the 3270 emulator of your choice. You would be running the emulator on your PC or workstation. You would use - the command, for example, + the command, for example:: + x3270 vm-esa-domain-name & + if you wanted a 3278 Model 4 with 43 rows of 80 columns, the default model number. The driver does not take advantage of extended attributes. @@ -144,7 +158,8 @@ Here are the testing steps in detail: 2. Use the DIAL command instead of the LOGIN command to connect to one of the virtual 3270s you defined with the DEF GRAF - commands: + commands:: + dial my-vm-guest-name 3. You should immediately see a login prompt from your @@ -171,14 +186,17 @@ Here are the testing steps in detail: Wrong major number? Wrong minor number? There's your problem! - D. Do you get the message + D. Do you get the message:: + "HCPDIA047E my-vm-guest-name 0620 does not exist"? + If so, you must issue the command "DEF GRAF 620" from your VM 3215 console and then reboot the system. OPERATION. +========== The driver defines three areas on the 3270 screen: the log area, the input area, and the status area. @@ -203,8 +221,10 @@ which indicates no scrolling will occur. (If you hit ENTER with "Linux Running" and nothing typed, the application receives a newline.) You may change the scrolling timeout value. For example, the following -command line: +command line:: + echo scrolltime=60 > /proc/tty/driver/tty3270 + changes the scrolling timeout value to 60 sec. Set scrolltime to 0 if you wish to prevent scrolling entirely. @@ -228,7 +248,8 @@ cause an EOF also by typing "^D" and hitting ENTER. No PF key is preassigned to cause a job suspension, but you may cause a job suspension by typing "^Z" and hitting ENTER. You may wish to assign this function to a PF key. To make PF7 cause job suspension, -execute the command: +execute the command:: + echo pf7=^z > /proc/tty/driver/tty3270 If the input you type does not end with the two characters "^n", the @@ -243,8 +264,10 @@ command is entered into the stack only when the input area is not made invisible (such as for password entry) and it is not identical to the current top entry. PF10 rotates backward through the command stack; PF11 rotates forward. You may assign the backward function to any PF -key (or PA key, for that matter), say, PA3, with the command: +key (or PA key, for that matter), say, PA3, with the command:: + echo -e pa3=\\033k > /proc/tty/driver/tty3270 + This assigns the string ESC-k to PA3. Similarly, the string ESC-j performs the forward function. (Rationale: In bash with vi-mode line editing, ESC-k and ESC-j retrieve backward and forward history. @@ -252,15 +275,19 @@ Suggestions welcome.) Is a stack size of twenty commands not to your liking? Change it on the fly. To change to saving the last 100 commands, execute the -command: +command:: + echo recallsize=100 > /proc/tty/driver/tty3270 Have a command you issue frequently? Assign it to a PF or PA key! Use -the command - echo pf24="mkdir foobar; cd foobar" > /proc/tty/driver/tty3270 +the command:: + + echo pf24="mkdir foobar; cd foobar" > /proc/tty/driver/tty3270 + to execute the commands mkdir foobar and cd foobar immediately when you hit PF24. Want to see the command line first, before you execute it? -Use the -n option of the echo command: +Use the -n option of the echo command:: + echo -n pf24="mkdir foo; cd foo" > /proc/tty/driver/tty3270 diff --git a/Documentation/s390/Debugging390.txt b/Documentation/s390/Debugging390.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 5ae7f868a007..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/s390/Debugging390.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2142 +0,0 @@ - - Debugging on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture - by - Denis Joseph Barrow (djbarrow@de.ibm.com,barrow_dj@yahoo.com) - Copyright (C) 2000-2001 IBM Deutschland Entwicklung GmbH, IBM Corporation - Best viewed with fixed width fonts - -Overview of Document: -===================== -This document is intended to give a good overview of how to debug Linux for -s/390 and z/Architecture. It is not intended as a complete reference and not a -tutorial on the fundamentals of C & assembly. It doesn't go into -390 IO in any detail. It is intended to complement the documents in the -reference section below & any other worthwhile references you get. - -It is intended like the Enterprise Systems Architecture/390 Reference Summary -to be printed out & used as a quick cheat sheet self help style reference when -problems occur. - -Contents -======== -Register Set -Address Spaces on Intel Linux -Address Spaces on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture -The Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture Kernel Task Structure -Register Usage & Stackframes on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture -A sample program with comments -Compiling programs for debugging on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture -Debugging under VM -s/390 & z/Architecture IO Overview -Debugging IO on s/390 & z/Architecture under VM -GDB on s/390 & z/Architecture -Stack chaining in gdb by hand -Examining core dumps -ldd -Debugging modules -The proc file system -SysRq -References -Special Thanks - -Register Set -============ -The current architectures have the following registers. - -16 General propose registers, 32 bit on s/390 and 64 bit on z/Architecture, -r0-r15 (or gpr0-gpr15), used for arithmetic and addressing. - -16 Control registers, 32 bit on s/390 and 64 bit on z/Architecture, cr0-cr15, -kernel usage only, used for memory management, interrupt control, debugging -control etc. - -16 Access registers (ar0-ar15), 32 bit on both s/390 and z/Architecture, -normally not used by normal programs but potentially could be used as -temporary storage. These registers have a 1:1 association with general -purpose registers and are designed to be used in the so-called access -register mode to select different address spaces. -Access register 0 (and access register 1 on z/Architecture, which needs a -64 bit pointer) is currently used by the pthread library as a pointer to -the current running threads private area. - -16 64 bit floating point registers (fp0-fp15 ) IEEE & HFP floating -point format compliant on G5 upwards & a Floating point control reg (FPC) -4 64 bit registers (fp0,fp2,fp4 & fp6) HFP only on older machines. -Note: -Linux (currently) always uses IEEE & emulates G5 IEEE format on older machines, -( provided the kernel is configured for this ). - - -The PSW is the most important register on the machine it -is 64 bit on s/390 & 128 bit on z/Architecture & serves the roles of -a program counter (pc), condition code register,memory space designator. -In IBM standard notation I am counting bit 0 as the MSB. -It has several advantages over a normal program counter -in that you can change address translation & program counter -in a single instruction. To change address translation, -e.g. switching address translation off requires that you -have a logical=physical mapping for the address you are -currently running at. - - Bit Value -s/390 z/Architecture -0 0 Reserved ( must be 0 ) otherwise specification exception occurs. - -1 1 Program Event Recording 1 PER enabled, - PER is used to facilitate debugging e.g. single stepping. - -2-4 2-4 Reserved ( must be 0 ). - -5 5 Dynamic address translation 1=DAT on. - -6 6 Input/Output interrupt Mask - -7 7 External interrupt Mask used primarily for interprocessor - signalling and clock interrupts. - -8-11 8-11 PSW Key used for complex memory protection mechanism - (not used under linux) - -12 12 1 on s/390 0 on z/Architecture - -13 13 Machine Check Mask 1=enable machine check interrupts - -14 14 Wait State. Set this to 1 to stop the processor except for - interrupts and give time to other LPARS. Used in CPU idle in - the kernel to increase overall usage of processor resources. - -15 15 Problem state ( if set to 1 certain instructions are disabled ) - all linux user programs run with this bit 1 - ( useful info for debugging under VM ). - -16-17 16-17 Address Space Control - - 00 Primary Space Mode: - The register CR1 contains the primary address-space control ele- - ment (PASCE), which points to the primary space region/segment - table origin. - - 01 Access register mode - - 10 Secondary Space Mode: - The register CR7 contains the secondary address-space control - element (SASCE), which points to the secondary space region or - segment table origin. - - 11 Home Space Mode: - The register CR13 contains the home space address-space control - element (HASCE), which points to the home space region/segment - table origin. - - See "Address Spaces on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture" below - for more information about address space usage in Linux. - -18-19 18-19 Condition codes (CC) - -20 20 Fixed point overflow mask if 1=FPU exceptions for this event - occur ( normally 0 ) - -21 21 Decimal overflow mask if 1=FPU exceptions for this event occur - ( normally 0 ) - -22 22 Exponent underflow mask if 1=FPU exceptions for this event occur - ( normally 0 ) - -23 23 Significance Mask if 1=FPU exceptions for this event occur - ( normally 0 ) - -24-31 24-30 Reserved Must be 0. - - 31 Extended Addressing Mode - 32 Basic Addressing Mode - Used to set addressing mode - PSW 31 PSW 32 - 0 0 24 bit - 0 1 31 bit - 1 1 64 bit - -32 1=31 bit addressing mode 0=24 bit addressing mode (for backward - compatibility), linux always runs with this bit set to 1 - -33-64 Instruction address. - 33-63 Reserved must be 0 - 64-127 Address - In 24 bits mode bits 64-103=0 bits 104-127 Address - In 31 bits mode bits 64-96=0 bits 97-127 Address - Note: unlike 31 bit mode on s/390 bit 96 must be zero - when loading the address with LPSWE otherwise a - specification exception occurs, LPSW is fully backward - compatible. - - -Prefix Page(s) --------------- -This per cpu memory area is too intimately tied to the processor not to mention. -It exists between the real addresses 0-4096 on s/390 and between 0-8192 on -z/Architecture and is exchanged with one page on s/390 or two pages on -z/Architecture in absolute storage by the set prefix instruction during Linux -startup. -This page is mapped to a different prefix for each processor in an SMP -configuration (assuming the OS designer is sane of course). -Bytes 0-512 (200 hex) on s/390 and 0-512, 4096-4544, 4604-5119 currently on -z/Architecture are used by the processor itself for holding such information -as exception indications and entry points for exceptions. -Bytes after 0xc00 hex are used by linux for per processor globals on s/390 and -z/Architecture (there is a gap on z/Architecture currently between 0xc00 and -0x1000, too, which is used by Linux). -The closest thing to this on traditional architectures is the interrupt -vector table. This is a good thing & does simplify some of the kernel coding -however it means that we now cannot catch stray NULL pointers in the -kernel without hard coded checks. - - - -Address Spaces on Intel Linux -============================= - -The traditional Intel Linux is approximately mapped as follows forgive -the ascii art. -0xFFFFFFFF 4GB Himem ***************** - * * - * Kernel Space * - * * - ***************** **************** -User Space Himem * User Stack * * * -(typically 0xC0000000 3GB ) ***************** * * - * Shared Libs * * Next Process * - ***************** * to * - * * <== * Run * <== - * User Program * * * - * Data BSS * * * - * Text * * * - * Sections * * * -0x00000000 ***************** **************** - -Now it is easy to see that on Intel it is quite easy to recognise a kernel -address as being one greater than user space himem (in this case 0xC0000000), -and addresses of less than this are the ones in the current running program on -this processor (if an smp box). -If using the virtual machine ( VM ) as a debugger it is quite difficult to -know which user process is running as the address space you are looking at -could be from any process in the run queue. - -The limitation of Intels addressing technique is that the linux -kernel uses a very simple real address to virtual addressing technique -of Real Address=Virtual Address-User Space Himem. -This means that on Intel the kernel linux can typically only address -Himem=0xFFFFFFFF-0xC0000000=1GB & this is all the RAM these machines -can typically use. -They can lower User Himem to 2GB or lower & thus be -able to use 2GB of RAM however this shrinks the maximum size -of User Space from 3GB to 2GB they have a no win limit of 4GB unless -they go to 64 Bit. - - -On 390 our limitations & strengths make us slightly different. -For backward compatibility we are only allowed use 31 bits (2GB) -of our 32 bit addresses, however, we use entirely separate address -spaces for the user & kernel. - -This means we can support 2GB of non Extended RAM on s/390, & more -with the Extended memory management swap device & -currently 4TB of physical memory currently on z/Architecture. - - -Address Spaces on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture -================================================== - -Our addressing scheme is basically as follows: - - Primary Space Home Space -Himem 0x7fffffff 2GB on s/390 ***************** **************** -currently 0x3ffffffffff (2^42)-1 * User Stack * * * -on z/Architecture. ***************** * * - * Shared Libs * * * - ***************** * * - * * * Kernel * - * User Program * * * - * Data BSS * * * - * Text * * * - * Sections * * * -0x00000000 ***************** **************** - -This also means that we need to look at the PSW problem state bit and the -addressing mode to decide whether we are looking at user or kernel space. - -User space runs in primary address mode (or access register mode within -the vdso code). - -The kernel usually also runs in home space mode, however when accessing -user space the kernel switches to primary or secondary address mode if -the mvcos instruction is not available or if a compare-and-swap (futex) -instruction on a user space address is performed. - -When also looking at the ASCE control registers, this means: - -User space: -- runs in primary or access register mode -- cr1 contains the user asce -- cr7 contains the user asce -- cr13 contains the kernel asce - -Kernel space: -- runs in home space mode -- cr1 contains the user or kernel asce - -> the kernel asce is loaded when a uaccess requires primary or - secondary address mode -- cr7 contains the user or kernel asce, (changed with set_fs()) -- cr13 contains the kernel asce - -In case of uaccess the kernel changes to: -- primary space mode in case of a uaccess (copy_to_user) and uses - e.g. the mvcp instruction to access user space. However the kernel - will stay in home space mode if the mvcos instruction is available -- secondary space mode in case of futex atomic operations, so that the - instructions come from primary address space and data from secondary - space - -In case of KVM, the kernel runs in home space mode, but cr1 gets switched -to contain the gmap asce before the SIE instruction gets executed. When -the SIE instruction is finished, cr1 will be switched back to contain the -user asce. - - -Virtual Addresses on s/390 & z/Architecture -=========================================== - -A virtual address on s/390 is made up of 3 parts -The SX (segment index, roughly corresponding to the PGD & PMD in Linux -terminology) being bits 1-11. -The PX (page index, corresponding to the page table entry (pte) in Linux -terminology) being bits 12-19. -The remaining bits BX (the byte index are the offset in the page ) -i.e. bits 20 to 31. - -On z/Architecture in linux we currently make up an address from 4 parts. -The region index bits (RX) 0-32 we currently use bits 22-32 -The segment index (SX) being bits 33-43 -The page index (PX) being bits 44-51 -The byte index (BX) being bits 52-63 - -Notes: -1) s/390 has no PMD so the PMD is really the PGD also. -A lot of this stuff is defined in pgtable.h. - -2) Also seeing as s/390's page indexes are only 1k in size -(bits 12-19 x 4 bytes per pte ) we use 1 ( page 4k ) -to make the best use of memory by updating 4 segment indices -entries each time we mess with a PMD & use offsets -0,1024,2048 & 3072 in this page as for our segment indexes. -On z/Architecture our page indexes are now 2k in size -( bits 12-19 x 8 bytes per pte ) we do a similar trick -but only mess with 2 segment indices each time we mess with -a PMD. - -3) As z/Architecture supports up to a massive 5-level page table lookup we -can only use 3 currently on Linux ( as this is all the generic kernel -currently supports ) however this may change in future -this allows us to access ( according to my sums ) -4TB of virtual storage per process i.e. -4096*512(PTES)*1024(PMDS)*2048(PGD) = 4398046511104 bytes, -enough for another 2 or 3 of years I think :-). -to do this we use a region-third-table designation type in -our address space control registers. - - -The Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture Kernel Task Structure -========================================================== -Each process/thread under Linux for S390 has its own kernel task_struct -defined in linux/include/linux/sched.h -The S390 on initialisation & resuming of a process on a cpu sets -the __LC_KERNEL_STACK variable in the spare prefix area for this cpu -(which we use for per-processor globals). - -The kernel stack pointer is intimately tied with the task structure for -each processor as follows. - - s/390 - ************************ - * 1 page kernel stack * - * ( 4K ) * - ************************ - * 1 page task_struct * - * ( 4K ) * -8K aligned ************************ - - z/Architecture - ************************ - * 2 page kernel stack * - * ( 8K ) * - ************************ - * 2 page task_struct * - * ( 8K ) * -16K aligned ************************ - -What this means is that we don't need to dedicate any register or global -variable to point to the current running process & can retrieve it with the -following very simple construct for s/390 & one very similar for z/Architecture. - -static inline struct task_struct * get_current(void) -{ - struct task_struct *current; - __asm__("lhi %0,-8192\n\t" - "nr %0,15" - : "=r" (current) ); - return current; -} - -i.e. just anding the current kernel stack pointer with the mask -8192. -Thankfully because Linux doesn't have support for nested IO interrupts -& our devices have large buffers can survive interrupts being shut for -short amounts of time we don't need a separate stack for interrupts. - - - - -Register Usage & Stackframes on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture -================================================================= -Overview: ---------- -This is the code that gcc produces at the top & the bottom of -each function. It usually is fairly consistent & similar from -function to function & if you know its layout you can probably -make some headway in finding the ultimate cause of a problem -after a crash without a source level debugger. - -Note: To follow stackframes requires a knowledge of C or Pascal & -limited knowledge of one assembly language. - -It should be noted that there are some differences between the -s/390 and z/Architecture stack layouts as the z/Architecture stack layout -didn't have to maintain compatibility with older linkage formats. - -Glossary: ---------- -alloca: -This is a built in compiler function for runtime allocation -of extra space on the callers stack which is obviously freed -up on function exit ( e.g. the caller may choose to allocate nothing -of a buffer of 4k if required for temporary purposes ), it generates -very efficient code ( a few cycles ) when compared to alternatives -like malloc. - -automatics: These are local variables on the stack, -i.e they aren't in registers & they aren't static. - -back-chain: -This is a pointer to the stack pointer before entering a -framed functions ( see frameless function ) prologue got by -dereferencing the address of the current stack pointer, - i.e. got by accessing the 32 bit value at the stack pointers -current location. - -base-pointer: -This is a pointer to the back of the literal pool which -is an area just behind each procedure used to store constants -in each function. - -call-clobbered: The caller probably needs to save these registers if there -is something of value in them, on the stack or elsewhere before making a -call to another procedure so that it can restore it later. - -epilogue: -The code generated by the compiler to return to the caller. - -frameless-function -A frameless function in Linux for s390 & z/Architecture is one which doesn't -need more than the register save area (96 bytes on s/390, 160 on z/Architecture) -given to it by the caller. -A frameless function never: -1) Sets up a back chain. -2) Calls alloca. -3) Calls other normal functions -4) Has automatics. - -GOT-pointer: -This is a pointer to the global-offset-table in ELF -( Executable Linkable Format, Linux'es most common executable format ), -all globals & shared library objects are found using this pointer. - -lazy-binding -ELF shared libraries are typically only loaded when routines in the shared -library are actually first called at runtime. This is lazy binding. - -procedure-linkage-table -This is a table found from the GOT which contains pointers to routines -in other shared libraries which can't be called to by easier means. - -prologue: -The code generated by the compiler to set up the stack frame. - -outgoing-args: -This is extra area allocated on the stack of the calling function if the -parameters for the callee's cannot all be put in registers, the same -area can be reused by each function the caller calls. - -routine-descriptor: -A COFF executable format based concept of a procedure reference -actually being 8 bytes or more as opposed to a simple pointer to the routine. -This is typically defined as follows -Routine Descriptor offset 0=Pointer to Function -Routine Descriptor offset 4=Pointer to Table of Contents -The table of contents/TOC is roughly equivalent to a GOT pointer. -& it means that shared libraries etc. can be shared between several -environments each with their own TOC. - - -static-chain: This is used in nested functions a concept adopted from pascal -by gcc not used in ansi C or C++ ( although quite useful ), basically it -is a pointer used to reference local variables of enclosing functions. -You might come across this stuff once or twice in your lifetime. - -e.g. -The function below should return 11 though gcc may get upset & toss warnings -about unused variables. -int FunctionA(int a) -{ - int b; - FunctionC(int c) - { - b=c+1; - } - FunctionC(10); - return(b); -} - - -s/390 & z/Architecture Register usage -===================================== -r0 used by syscalls/assembly call-clobbered -r1 used by syscalls/assembly call-clobbered -r2 argument 0 / return value 0 call-clobbered -r3 argument 1 / return value 1 (if long long) call-clobbered -r4 argument 2 call-clobbered -r5 argument 3 call-clobbered -r6 argument 4 saved -r7 pointer-to arguments 5 to ... saved -r8 this & that saved -r9 this & that saved -r10 static-chain ( if nested function ) saved -r11 frame-pointer ( if function used alloca ) saved -r12 got-pointer saved -r13 base-pointer saved -r14 return-address saved -r15 stack-pointer saved - -f0 argument 0 / return value ( float/double ) call-clobbered -f2 argument 1 call-clobbered -f4 z/Architecture argument 2 saved -f6 z/Architecture argument 3 saved -The remaining floating points -f1,f3,f5 f7-f15 are call-clobbered. - -Notes: ------- -1) The only requirement is that registers which are used -by the callee are saved, e.g. the compiler is perfectly -capable of using r11 for purposes other than a frame a -frame pointer if a frame pointer is not needed. -2) In functions with variable arguments e.g. printf the calling procedure -is identical to one without variable arguments & the same number of -parameters. However, the prologue of this function is somewhat more -hairy owing to it having to move these parameters to the stack to -get va_start, va_arg & va_end to work. -3) Access registers are currently unused by gcc but are used in -the kernel. Possibilities exist to use them at the moment for -temporary storage but it isn't recommended. -4) Only 4 of the floating point registers are used for -parameter passing as older machines such as G3 only have only 4 -& it keeps the stack frame compatible with other compilers. -However with IEEE floating point emulation under linux on the -older machines you are free to use the other 12. -5) A long long or double parameter cannot be have the -first 4 bytes in a register & the second four bytes in the -outgoing args area. It must be purely in the outgoing args -area if crossing this boundary. -6) Floating point parameters are mixed with outgoing args -on the outgoing args area in the order the are passed in as parameters. -7) Floating point arguments 2 & 3 are saved in the outgoing args area for -z/Architecture - - -Stack Frame Layout ------------------- -s/390 z/Architecture -0 0 back chain ( a 0 here signifies end of back chain ) -4 8 eos ( end of stack, not used on Linux for S390 used in other linkage formats ) -8 16 glue used in other s/390 linkage formats for saved routine descriptors etc. -12 24 glue used in other s/390 linkage formats for saved routine descriptors etc. -16 32 scratch area -20 40 scratch area -24 48 saved r6 of caller function -28 56 saved r7 of caller function -32 64 saved r8 of caller function -36 72 saved r9 of caller function -40 80 saved r10 of caller function -44 88 saved r11 of caller function -48 96 saved r12 of caller function -52 104 saved r13 of caller function -56 112 saved r14 of caller function -60 120 saved r15 of caller function -64 128 saved f4 of caller function -72 132 saved f6 of caller function -80 undefined -96 160 outgoing args passed from caller to callee -96+x 160+x possible stack alignment ( 8 bytes desirable ) -96+x+y 160+x+y alloca space of caller ( if used ) -96+x+y+z 160+x+y+z automatics of caller ( if used ) -0 back-chain - -A sample program with comments. -=============================== - -Comments on the function test ------------------------------ -1) It didn't need to set up a pointer to the constant pool gpr13 as it is not -used ( :-( ). -2) This is a frameless function & no stack is bought. -3) The compiler was clever enough to recognise that it could return the -value in r2 as well as use it for the passed in parameter ( :-) ). -4) The basr ( branch relative & save ) trick works as follows the instruction -has a special case with r0,r0 with some instruction operands is understood as -the literal value 0, some risc architectures also do this ). So now -we are branching to the next address & the address new program counter is -in r13,so now we subtract the size of the function prologue we have executed -+ the size of the literal pool to get to the top of the literal pool -0040037c int test(int b) -{ # Function prologue below - 40037c: 90 de f0 34 stm %r13,%r14,52(%r15) # Save registers r13 & r14 - 400380: 0d d0 basr %r13,%r0 # Set up pointer to constant pool using - 400382: a7 da ff fa ahi %r13,-6 # basr trick - return(5+b); - # Huge main program - 400386: a7 2a 00 05 ahi %r2,5 # add 5 to r2 - - # Function epilogue below - 40038a: 98 de f0 34 lm %r13,%r14,52(%r15) # restore registers r13 & 14 - 40038e: 07 fe br %r14 # return -} - -Comments on the function main ------------------------------ -1) The compiler did this function optimally ( 8-) ) - -Literal pool for main. -400390: ff ff ff ec .long 0xffffffec -main(int argc,char *argv[]) -{ # Function prologue below - 400394: 90 bf f0 2c stm %r11,%r15,44(%r15) # Save necessary registers - 400398: 18 0f lr %r0,%r15 # copy stack pointer to r0 - 40039a: a7 fa ff a0 ahi %r15,-96 # Make area for callee saving - 40039e: 0d d0 basr %r13,%r0 # Set up r13 to point to - 4003a0: a7 da ff f0 ahi %r13,-16 # literal pool - 4003a4: 50 00 f0 00 st %r0,0(%r15) # Save backchain - - return(test(5)); # Main Program Below - 4003a8: 58 e0 d0 00 l %r14,0(%r13) # load relative address of test from - # literal pool - 4003ac: a7 28 00 05 lhi %r2,5 # Set first parameter to 5 - 4003b0: 4d ee d0 00 bas %r14,0(%r14,%r13) # jump to test setting r14 as return - # address using branch & save instruction. - - # Function Epilogue below - 4003b4: 98 bf f0 8c lm %r11,%r15,140(%r15)# Restore necessary registers. - 4003b8: 07 fe br %r14 # return to do program exit -} - - -Compiler updates ----------------- - -main(int argc,char *argv[]) -{ - 4004fc: 90 7f f0 1c stm %r7,%r15,28(%r15) - 400500: a7 d5 00 04 bras %r13,400508 <main+0xc> - 400504: 00 40 04 f4 .long 0x004004f4 - # compiler now puts constant pool in code to so it saves an instruction - 400508: 18 0f lr %r0,%r15 - 40050a: a7 fa ff a0 ahi %r15,-96 - 40050e: 50 00 f0 00 st %r0,0(%r15) - return(test(5)); - 400512: 58 10 d0 00 l %r1,0(%r13) - 400516: a7 28 00 05 lhi %r2,5 - 40051a: 0d e1 basr %r14,%r1 - # compiler adds 1 extra instruction to epilogue this is done to - # avoid processor pipeline stalls owing to data dependencies on g5 & - # above as register 14 in the old code was needed directly after being loaded - # by the lm %r11,%r15,140(%r15) for the br %14. - 40051c: 58 40 f0 98 l %r4,152(%r15) - 400520: 98 7f f0 7c lm %r7,%r15,124(%r15) - 400524: 07 f4 br %r4 -} - - -Hartmut ( our compiler developer ) also has been threatening to take out the -stack backchain in optimised code as this also causes pipeline stalls, you -have been warned. - -64 bit z/Architecture code disassembly --------------------------------------- - -If you understand the stuff above you'll understand the stuff -below too so I'll avoid repeating myself & just say that -some of the instructions have g's on the end of them to indicate -they are 64 bit & the stack offsets are a bigger, -the only other difference you'll find between 32 & 64 bit is that -we now use f4 & f6 for floating point arguments on 64 bit. -00000000800005b0 <test>: -int test(int b) -{ - return(5+b); - 800005b0: a7 2a 00 05 ahi %r2,5 - 800005b4: b9 14 00 22 lgfr %r2,%r2 # downcast to integer - 800005b8: 07 fe br %r14 - 800005ba: 07 07 bcr 0,%r7 - - -} - -00000000800005bc <main>: -main(int argc,char *argv[]) -{ - 800005bc: eb bf f0 58 00 24 stmg %r11,%r15,88(%r15) - 800005c2: b9 04 00 1f lgr %r1,%r15 - 800005c6: a7 fb ff 60 aghi %r15,-160 - 800005ca: e3 10 f0 00 00 24 stg %r1,0(%r15) - return(test(5)); - 800005d0: a7 29 00 05 lghi %r2,5 - # brasl allows jumps > 64k & is overkill here bras would do fune - 800005d4: c0 e5 ff ff ff ee brasl %r14,800005b0 <test> - 800005da: e3 40 f1 10 00 04 lg %r4,272(%r15) - 800005e0: eb bf f0 f8 00 04 lmg %r11,%r15,248(%r15) - 800005e6: 07 f4 br %r4 -} - - - -Compiling programs for debugging on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture -==================================================================== --gdwarf-2 now works it should be considered the default debugging -format for s/390 & z/Architecture as it is more reliable for debugging -shared libraries, normal -g debugging works much better now -Thanks to the IBM java compiler developers bug reports. - -This is typically done adding/appending the flags -g or -gdwarf-2 to the -CFLAGS & LDFLAGS variables Makefile of the program concerned. - -If using gdb & you would like accurate displays of registers & - stack traces compile without optimisation i.e make sure -that there is no -O2 or similar on the CFLAGS line of the Makefile & -the emitted gcc commands, obviously this will produce worse code -( not advisable for shipment ) but it is an aid to the debugging process. - -This aids debugging because the compiler will copy parameters passed in -in registers onto the stack so backtracing & looking at passed in -parameters will work, however some larger programs which use inline functions -will not compile without optimisation. - -Debugging with optimisation has since much improved after fixing -some bugs, please make sure you are using gdb-5.0 or later developed -after Nov'2000. - - - -Debugging under VM -================== - -Notes ------ -Addresses & values in the VM debugger are always hex never decimal -Address ranges are of the format <HexValue1>-<HexValue2> or -<HexValue1>.<HexValue2> -For example, the address range 0x2000 to 0x3000 can be described as 2000-3000 -or 2000.1000 - -The VM Debugger is case insensitive. - -VM's strengths are usually other debuggers weaknesses you can get at any -resource no matter how sensitive e.g. memory management resources, change -address translation in the PSW. For kernel hacking you will reap dividends if -you get good at it. - -The VM Debugger displays operators but not operands, and also the debugger -displays useful information on the same line as the author of the code probably -felt that it was a good idea not to go over the 80 columns on the screen. -This isn't as unintuitive as it may seem as the s/390 instructions are easy to -decode mentally and you can make a good guess at a lot of them as all the -operands are nibble (half byte aligned). -So if you have an objdump listing by hand, it is quite easy to follow, and if -you don't have an objdump listing keep a copy of the s/390 Reference Summary -or alternatively the s/390 principles of operation next to you. -e.g. even I can guess that -0001AFF8' LR 180F CC 0 -is a ( load register ) lr r0,r15 - -Also it is very easy to tell the length of a 390 instruction from the 2 most -significant bits in the instruction (not that this info is really useful except -if you are trying to make sense of a hexdump of code). -Here is a table -Bits Instruction Length ------------------------------------------- -00 2 Bytes -01 4 Bytes -10 4 Bytes -11 6 Bytes - -The debugger also displays other useful info on the same line such as the -addresses being operated on destination addresses of branches & condition codes. -e.g. -00019736' AHI A7DAFF0E CC 1 -000198BA' BRC A7840004 -> 000198C2' CC 0 -000198CE' STM 900EF068 >> 0FA95E78 CC 2 - - - -Useful VM debugger commands ---------------------------- - -I suppose I'd better mention this before I start -to list the current active traces do -Q TR -there can be a maximum of 255 of these per set -( more about trace sets later ). -To stop traces issue a -TR END. -To delete a particular breakpoint issue -TR DEL <breakpoint number> - -The PA1 key drops to CP mode so you can issue debugger commands, -Doing alt c (on my 3270 console at least ) clears the screen. -hitting b <enter> comes back to the running operating system -from cp mode ( in our case linux ). -It is typically useful to add shortcuts to your profile.exec file -if you have one ( this is roughly equivalent to autoexec.bat in DOS ). -file here are a few from mine. -/* this gives me command history on issuing f12 */ -set pf12 retrieve -/* this continues */ -set pf8 imm b -/* goes to trace set a */ -set pf1 imm tr goto a -/* goes to trace set b */ -set pf2 imm tr goto b -/* goes to trace set c */ -set pf3 imm tr goto c - - - -Instruction Tracing -------------------- -Setting a simple breakpoint -TR I PSWA <address> -To debug a particular function try -TR I R <function address range> -TR I on its own will single step. -TR I DATA <MNEMONIC> <OPTIONAL RANGE> will trace for particular mnemonics -e.g. -TR I DATA 4D R 0197BC.4000 -will trace for BAS'es ( opcode 4D ) in the range 0197BC.4000 -if you were inclined you could add traces for all branch instructions & -suffix them with the run prefix so you would have a backtrace on screen -when a program crashes. -TR BR <INTO OR FROM> will trace branches into or out of an address. -e.g. -TR BR INTO 0 is often quite useful if a program is getting awkward & deciding -to branch to 0 & crashing as this will stop at the address before in jumps to 0. -TR I R <address range> RUN cmd d g -single steps a range of addresses but stays running & -displays the gprs on each step. - - - -Displaying & modifying Registers --------------------------------- -D G will display all the gprs -Adding a extra G to all the commands is necessary to access the full 64 bit -content in VM on z/Architecture. Obviously this isn't required for access -registers as these are still 32 bit. -e.g. DGG instead of DG -D X will display all the control registers -D AR will display all the access registers -D AR4-7 will display access registers 4 to 7 -CPU ALL D G will display the GRPS of all CPUS in the configuration -D PSW will display the current PSW -st PSW 2000 will put the value 2000 into the PSW & -cause crash your machine. -D PREFIX displays the prefix offset - - -Displaying Memory ------------------ -To display memory mapped using the current PSW's mapping try -D <range> -To make VM display a message each time it hits a particular address and -continue try -D I<range> will disassemble/display a range of instructions. -ST addr 32 bit word will store a 32 bit aligned address -D T<range> will display the EBCDIC in an address (if you are that way inclined) -D R<range> will display real addresses ( without DAT ) but with prefixing. -There are other complex options to display if you need to get at say home space -but are in primary space the easiest thing to do is to temporarily -modify the PSW to the other addressing mode, display the stuff & then -restore it. - - - -Hints ------ -If you want to issue a debugger command without halting your virtual machine -with the PA1 key try prefixing the command with #CP e.g. -#cp tr i pswa 2000 -also suffixing most debugger commands with RUN will cause them not -to stop just display the mnemonic at the current instruction on the console. -If you have several breakpoints you want to put into your program & -you get fed up of cross referencing with System.map -you can do the following trick for several symbols. -grep do_signal System.map -which emits the following among other things -0001f4e0 T do_signal -now you can do - -TR I PSWA 0001f4e0 cmd msg * do_signal -This sends a message to your own console each time do_signal is entered. -( As an aside I wrote a perl script once which automatically generated a REXX -script with breakpoints on every kernel procedure, this isn't a good idea -because there are thousands of these routines & VM can only set 255 breakpoints -at a time so you nearly had to spend as long pruning the file down as you would -entering the msgs by hand), however, the trick might be useful for a single -object file. In the 3270 terminal emulator x3270 there is a very useful option -in the file menu called "Save Screen In File" - this is very good for keeping a -copy of traces. - -From CMS help <command name> will give you online help on a particular command. -e.g. -HELP DISPLAY - -Also CP has a file called profile.exec which automatically gets called -on startup of CMS ( like autoexec.bat ), keeping on a DOS analogy session -CP has a feature similar to doskey, it may be useful for you to -use profile.exec to define some keystrokes. -e.g. -SET PF9 IMM B -This does a single step in VM on pressing F8. -SET PF10 ^ -This sets up the ^ key. -which can be used for ^c (ctrl-c),^z (ctrl-z) which can't be typed directly -into some 3270 consoles. -SET PF11 ^- -This types the starting keystrokes for a sysrq see SysRq below. -SET PF12 RETRIEVE -This retrieves command history on pressing F12. - - -Sometimes in VM the display is set up to scroll automatically this -can be very annoying if there are messages you wish to look at -to stop this do -TERM MORE 255 255 -This will nearly stop automatic screen updates, however it will -cause a denial of service if lots of messages go to the 3270 console, -so it would be foolish to use this as the default on a production machine. - - -Tracing particular processes ----------------------------- -The kernel's text segment is intentionally at an address in memory that it will -very seldom collide with text segments of user programs ( thanks Martin ), -this simplifies debugging the kernel. -However it is quite common for user processes to have addresses which collide -this can make debugging a particular process under VM painful under normal -circumstances as the process may change when doing a -TR I R <address range>. -Thankfully after reading VM's online help I figured out how to debug -I particular process. - -Your first problem is to find the STD ( segment table designation ) -of the program you wish to debug. -There are several ways you can do this here are a few -1) objdump --syms <program to be debugged> | grep main -To get the address of main in the program. -tr i pswa <address of main> -Start the program, if VM drops to CP on what looks like the entry -point of the main function this is most likely the process you wish to debug. -Now do a D X13 or D XG13 on z/Architecture. -On 31 bit the STD is bits 1-19 ( the STO segment table origin ) -& 25-31 ( the STL segment table length ) of CR13. -now type -TR I R STD <CR13's value> 0.7fffffff -e.g. -TR I R STD 8F32E1FF 0.7fffffff -Another very useful variation is -TR STORE INTO STD <CR13's value> <address range> -for finding out when a particular variable changes. - -An alternative way of finding the STD of a currently running process -is to do the following, ( this method is more complex but -could be quite convenient if you aren't updating the kernel much & -so your kernel structures will stay constant for a reasonable period of -time ). - -grep task /proc/<pid>/status -from this you should see something like -task: 0f160000 ksp: 0f161de8 pt_regs: 0f161f68 -This now gives you a pointer to the task structure. -Now make CC:="s390-gcc -g" kernel/sched.s -To get the task_struct stabinfo. -( task_struct is defined in include/linux/sched.h ). -Now we want to look at -task->active_mm->pgd -on my machine the active_mm in the task structure stab is -active_mm:(4,12),672,32 -its offset is 672/8=84=0x54 -the pgd member in the mm_struct stab is -pgd:(4,6)=*(29,5),96,32 -so its offset is 96/8=12=0xc - -so we'll -hexdump -s 0xf160054 /dev/mem | more -i.e. task_struct+active_mm offset -to look at the active_mm member -f160054 0fee cc60 0019 e334 0000 0000 0000 0011 -hexdump -s 0x0feecc6c /dev/mem | more -i.e. active_mm+pgd offset -feecc6c 0f2c 0000 0000 0001 0000 0001 0000 0010 -we get something like -now do -TR I R STD <pgd|0x7f> 0.7fffffff -i.e. the 0x7f is added because the pgd only -gives the page table origin & we need to set the low bits -to the maximum possible segment table length. -TR I R STD 0f2c007f 0.7fffffff -on z/Architecture you'll probably need to do -TR I R STD <pgd|0x7> 0.ffffffffffffffff -to set the TableType to 0x1 & the Table length to 3. - - - -Tracing Program Exceptions --------------------------- -If you get a crash which says something like -illegal operation or specification exception followed by a register dump -You can restart linux & trace these using the tr prog <range or value> trace -option. - - -The most common ones you will normally be tracing for is -1=operation exception -2=privileged operation exception -4=protection exception -5=addressing exception -6=specification exception -10=segment translation exception -11=page translation exception - -The full list of these is on page 22 of the current s/390 Reference Summary. -e.g. -tr prog 10 will trace segment translation exceptions. -tr prog on its own will trace all program interruption codes. - -Trace Sets ----------- -On starting VM you are initially in the INITIAL trace set. -You can do a Q TR to verify this. -If you have a complex tracing situation where you wish to wait for instance -till a driver is open before you start tracing IO, but know in your -heart that you are going to have to make several runs through the code till you -have a clue whats going on. - -What you can do is -TR I PSWA <Driver open address> -hit b to continue till breakpoint -reach the breakpoint -now do your -TR GOTO B -TR IO 7c08-7c09 inst int run -or whatever the IO channels you wish to trace are & hit b - -To got back to the initial trace set do -TR GOTO INITIAL -& the TR I PSWA <Driver open address> will be the only active breakpoint again. - - -Tracing linux syscalls under VM -------------------------------- -Syscalls are implemented on Linux for S390 by the Supervisor call instruction -(SVC). There 256 possibilities of these as the instruction is made up of a 0xA -opcode and the second byte being the syscall number. They are traced using the -simple command: -TR SVC <Optional value or range> -the syscalls are defined in linux/arch/s390/include/asm/unistd.h -e.g. to trace all file opens just do -TR SVC 5 ( as this is the syscall number of open ) - - -SMP Specific commands ---------------------- -To find out how many cpus you have -Q CPUS displays all the CPU's available to your virtual machine -To find the cpu that the current cpu VM debugger commands are being directed at -do Q CPU to change the current cpu VM debugger commands are being directed at do -CPU <desired cpu no> - -On a SMP guest issue a command to all CPUs try prefixing the command with cpu -all. To issue a command to a particular cpu try cpu <cpu number> e.g. -CPU 01 TR I R 2000.3000 -If you are running on a guest with several cpus & you have a IO related problem -& cannot follow the flow of code but you know it isn't smp related. -from the bash prompt issue -shutdown -h now or halt. -do a Q CPUS to find out how many cpus you have -detach each one of them from cp except cpu 0 -by issuing a -DETACH CPU 01-(number of cpus in configuration) -& boot linux again. -TR SIGP will trace inter processor signal processor instructions. -DEFINE CPU 01-(number in configuration) -will get your guests cpus back. - - -Help for displaying ascii textstrings -------------------------------------- -On the very latest VM Nucleus'es VM can now display ascii -( thanks Neale for the hint ) by doing -D TX<lowaddr>.<len> -e.g. -D TX0.100 - -Alternatively -============= -Under older VM debuggers (I love EBDIC too) you can use following little -program which converts a command line of hex digits to ascii text. It can be -compiled under linux and you can copy the hex digits from your x3270 terminal -to your xterm if you are debugging from a linuxbox. - -This is quite useful when looking at a parameter passed in as a text string -under VM ( unless you are good at decoding ASCII in your head ). - -e.g. consider tracing an open syscall -TR SVC 5 -We have stopped at a breakpoint -000151B0' SVC 0A05 -> 0001909A' CC 0 - -D 20.8 to check the SVC old psw in the prefix area and see was it from userspace -(for the layout of the prefix area consult the "Fixed Storage Locations" -chapter of the s/390 Reference Summary if you have it available). -V00000020 070C2000 800151B2 -The problem state bit wasn't set & it's also too early in the boot sequence -for it to be a userspace SVC if it was we would have to temporarily switch the -psw to user space addressing so we could get at the first parameter of the open -in gpr2. -Next do a -D G2 -GPR 2 = 00014CB4 -Now display what gpr2 is pointing to -D 00014CB4.20 -V00014CB4 2F646576 2F636F6E 736F6C65 00001BF5 -V00014CC4 FC00014C B4001001 E0001000 B8070707 -Now copy the text till the first 00 hex ( which is the end of the string -to an xterm & do hex2ascii on it. -hex2ascii 2F646576 2F636F6E 736F6C65 00 -outputs -Decoded Hex:=/ d e v / c o n s o l e 0x00 -We were opening the console device, - -You can compile the code below yourself for practice :-), -/* - * hex2ascii.c - * a useful little tool for converting a hexadecimal command line to ascii - * - * Author(s): Denis Joseph Barrow (djbarrow@de.ibm.com,barrow_dj@yahoo.com) - * (C) 2000 IBM Deutschland Entwicklung GmbH, IBM Corporation. - */ -#include <stdio.h> - -int main(int argc,char *argv[]) -{ - int cnt1,cnt2,len,toggle=0; - int startcnt=1; - unsigned char c,hex; - - if(argc>1&&(strcmp(argv[1],"-a")==0)) - startcnt=2; - printf("Decoded Hex:="); - for(cnt1=startcnt;cnt1<argc;cnt1++) - { - len=strlen(argv[cnt1]); - for(cnt2=0;cnt2<len;cnt2++) - { - c=argv[cnt1][cnt2]; - if(c>='0'&&c<='9') - c=c-'0'; - if(c>='A'&&c<='F') - c=c-'A'+10; - if(c>='a'&&c<='f') - c=c-'a'+10; - switch(toggle) - { - case 0: - hex=c<<4; - toggle=1; - break; - case 1: - hex+=c; - if(hex<32||hex>127) - { - if(startcnt==1) - printf("0x%02X ",(int)hex); - else - printf("."); - } - else - { - printf("%c",hex); - if(startcnt==1) - printf(" "); - } - toggle=0; - break; - } - } - } - printf("\n"); -} - - - - -Stack tracing under VM ----------------------- -A basic backtrace ------------------ - -Here are the tricks I use 9 out of 10 times it works pretty well, - -When your backchain reaches a dead end --------------------------------------- -This can happen when an exception happens in the kernel and the kernel is -entered twice. If you reach the NULL pointer at the end of the back chain you -should be able to sniff further back if you follow the following tricks. -1) A kernel address should be easy to recognise since it is in -primary space & the problem state bit isn't set & also -The Hi bit of the address is set. -2) Another backchain should also be easy to recognise since it is an -address pointing to another address approximately 100 bytes or 0x70 hex -behind the current stackpointer. - - -Here is some practice. -boot the kernel & hit PA1 at some random time -d g to display the gprs, this should display something like -GPR 0 = 00000001 00156018 0014359C 00000000 -GPR 4 = 00000001 001B8888 000003E0 00000000 -GPR 8 = 00100080 00100084 00000000 000FE000 -GPR 12 = 00010400 8001B2DC 8001B36A 000FFED8 -Note that GPR14 is a return address but as we are real men we are going to -trace the stack. -display 0x40 bytes after the stack pointer. - -V000FFED8 000FFF38 8001B838 80014C8E 000FFF38 -V000FFEE8 00000000 00000000 000003E0 00000000 -V000FFEF8 00100080 00100084 00000000 000FE000 -V000FFF08 00010400 8001B2DC 8001B36A 000FFED8 - - -Ah now look at whats in sp+56 (sp+0x38) this is 8001B36A our saved r14 if -you look above at our stackframe & also agrees with GPR14. - -now backchain -d 000FFF38.40 -we now are taking the contents of SP to get our first backchain. - -V000FFF38 000FFFA0 00000000 00014995 00147094 -V000FFF48 00147090 001470A0 000003E0 00000000 -V000FFF58 00100080 00100084 00000000 001BF1D0 -V000FFF68 00010400 800149BA 80014CA6 000FFF38 - -This displays a 2nd return address of 80014CA6 - -now do d 000FFFA0.40 for our 3rd backchain - -V000FFFA0 04B52002 0001107F 00000000 00000000 -V000FFFB0 00000000 00000000 FF000000 0001107F -V000FFFC0 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 -V000FFFD0 00010400 80010802 8001085A 000FFFA0 - - -our 3rd return address is 8001085A - -as the 04B52002 looks suspiciously like rubbish it is fair to assume that the -kernel entry routines for the sake of optimisation don't set up a backchain. - -now look at System.map to see if the addresses make any sense. - -grep -i 0001b3 System.map -outputs among other things -0001b304 T cpu_idle -so 8001B36A -is cpu_idle+0x66 ( quiet the cpu is asleep, don't wake it ) - - -grep -i 00014 System.map -produces among other things -00014a78 T start_kernel -so 0014CA6 is start_kernel+some hex number I can't add in my head. - -grep -i 00108 System.map -this produces -00010800 T _stext -so 8001085A is _stext+0x5a - -Congrats you've done your first backchain. - - - -s/390 & z/Architecture IO Overview -================================== - -I am not going to give a course in 390 IO architecture as this would take me -quite a while and I'm no expert. Instead I'll give a 390 IO architecture -summary for Dummies. If you have the s/390 principles of operation available -read this instead. If nothing else you may find a few useful keywords in here -and be able to use them on a web search engine to find more useful information. - -Unlike other bus architectures modern 390 systems do their IO using mostly -fibre optics and devices such as tapes and disks can be shared between several -mainframes. Also S390 can support up to 65536 devices while a high end PC based -system might be choking with around 64. - -Here is some of the common IO terminology: - -Subchannel: -This is the logical number most IO commands use to talk to an IO device. There -can be up to 0x10000 (65536) of these in a configuration, typically there are a -few hundred. Under VM for simplicity they are allocated contiguously, however -on the native hardware they are not. They typically stay consistent between -boots provided no new hardware is inserted or removed. -Under Linux for s390 we use these as IRQ's and also when issuing an IO command -(CLEAR SUBCHANNEL, HALT SUBCHANNEL, MODIFY SUBCHANNEL, RESUME SUBCHANNEL, -START SUBCHANNEL, STORE SUBCHANNEL and TEST SUBCHANNEL). We use this as the ID -of the device we wish to talk to. The most important of these instructions are -START SUBCHANNEL (to start IO), TEST SUBCHANNEL (to check whether the IO -completed successfully) and HALT SUBCHANNEL (to kill IO). A subchannel can have -up to 8 channel paths to a device, this offers redundancy if one is not -available. - -Device Number: -This number remains static and is closely tied to the hardware. There are 65536 -of these, made up of a CHPID (Channel Path ID, the most significant 8 bits) and -another lsb 8 bits. These remain static even if more devices are inserted or -removed from the hardware. There is a 1 to 1 mapping between subchannels and -device numbers, provided devices aren't inserted or removed. - -Channel Control Words: -CCWs are linked lists of instructions initially pointed to by an operation -request block (ORB), which is initially given to Start Subchannel (SSCH) -command along with the subchannel number for the IO subsystem to process -while the CPU continues executing normal code. -CCWs come in two flavours, Format 0 (24 bit for backward compatibility) and -Format 1 (31 bit). These are typically used to issue read and write (and many -other) instructions. They consist of a length field and an absolute address -field. -Each IO typically gets 1 or 2 interrupts, one for channel end (primary status) -when the channel is idle, and the second for device end (secondary status). -Sometimes you get both concurrently. You check how the IO went on by issuing a -TEST SUBCHANNEL at each interrupt, from which you receive an Interruption -response block (IRB). If you get channel and device end status in the IRB -without channel checks etc. your IO probably went okay. If you didn't you -probably need to examine the IRB, extended status word etc. -If an error occurs, more sophisticated control units have a facility known as -concurrent sense. This means that if an error occurs Extended sense information -will be presented in the Extended status word in the IRB. If not you have to -issue a subsequent SENSE CCW command after the test subchannel. - - -TPI (Test pending interrupt) can also be used for polled IO, but in -multitasking multiprocessor systems it isn't recommended except for -checking special cases (i.e. non looping checks for pending IO etc.). - -Store Subchannel and Modify Subchannel can be used to examine and modify -operating characteristics of a subchannel (e.g. channel paths). - -Other IO related Terms: -Sysplex: S390's Clustering Technology -QDIO: S390's new high speed IO architecture to support devices such as gigabit -ethernet, this architecture is also designed to be forward compatible with -upcoming 64 bit machines. - - -General Concepts - -Input Output Processors (IOP's) are responsible for communicating between -the mainframe CPU's & the channel & relieve the mainframe CPU's from the -burden of communicating with IO devices directly, this allows the CPU's to -concentrate on data processing. - -IOP's can use one or more links ( known as channel paths ) to talk to each -IO device. It first checks for path availability & chooses an available one, -then starts ( & sometimes terminates IO ). -There are two types of channel path: ESCON & the Parallel IO interface. - -IO devices are attached to control units, control units provide the -logic to interface the channel paths & channel path IO protocols to -the IO devices, they can be integrated with the devices or housed separately -& often talk to several similar devices ( typical examples would be raid -controllers or a control unit which connects to 1000 3270 terminals ). - - - +---------------------------------------------------------------+ - | +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +----------+ +----------+ | - | | CPU | | CPU | | CPU | | CPU | | Main | | Expanded | | - | | | | | | | | | | Memory | | Storage | | - | +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +----------+ +----------+ | - |---------------------------------------------------------------+ - | IOP | IOP | IOP | - |--------------------------------------------------------------- - | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | - ---------------------------------------------------------------- - || || - || Bus & Tag Channel Path || ESCON - || ====================== || Channel - || || || || Path - +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ - | | | | | | - | CU | | CU | | CU | - | | | | | | - +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ - | | | | | -+----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ -|I/O Device| |I/O Device| |I/O Device| |I/O Device| |I/O Device| -+----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ - CPU = Central Processing Unit - C = Channel - IOP = IP Processor - CU = Control Unit - -The 390 IO systems come in 2 flavours the current 390 machines support both - -The Older 360 & 370 Interface,sometimes called the Parallel I/O interface, -sometimes called Bus-and Tag & sometimes Original Equipment Manufacturers -Interface (OEMI). - -This byte wide Parallel channel path/bus has parity & data on the "Bus" cable -and control lines on the "Tag" cable. These can operate in byte multiplex mode -for sharing between several slow devices or burst mode and monopolize the -channel for the whole burst. Up to 256 devices can be addressed on one of these -cables. These cables are about one inch in diameter. The maximum unextended -length supported by these cables is 125 Meters but this can be extended up to -2km with a fibre optic channel extended such as a 3044. The maximum burst speed -supported is 4.5 megabytes per second. However, some really old processors -support only transfer rates of 3.0, 2.0 & 1.0 MB/sec. -One of these paths can be daisy chained to up to 8 control units. - - -ESCON if fibre optic it is also called FICON -Was introduced by IBM in 1990. Has 2 fibre optic cables and uses either leds or -lasers for communication at a signaling rate of up to 200 megabits/sec. As -10bits are transferred for every 8 bits info this drops to 160 megabits/sec -and to 18.6 Megabytes/sec once control info and CRC are added. ESCON only -operates in burst mode. - -ESCONs typical max cable length is 3km for the led version and 20km for the -laser version known as XDF (extended distance facility). This can be further -extended by using an ESCON director which triples the above mentioned ranges. -Unlike Bus & Tag as ESCON is serial it uses a packet switching architecture, -the standard Bus & Tag control protocol is however present within the packets. -Up to 256 devices can be attached to each control unit that uses one of these -interfaces. - -Common 390 Devices include: -Network adapters typically OSA2,3172's,2116's & OSA-E gigabit ethernet adapters, -Consoles 3270 & 3215 (a teletype emulated under linux for a line mode console). -DASD's direct access storage devices ( otherwise known as hard disks ). -Tape Drives. -CTC ( Channel to Channel Adapters ), -ESCON or Parallel Cables used as a very high speed serial link -between 2 machines. - - -Debugging IO on s/390 & z/Architecture under VM -=============================================== - -Now we are ready to go on with IO tracing commands under VM - -A few self explanatory queries: -Q OSA -Q CTC -Q DISK ( This command is CMS specific ) -Q DASD - - - - - - -Q OSA on my machine returns -OSA 7C08 ON OSA 7C08 SUBCHANNEL = 0000 -OSA 7C09 ON OSA 7C09 SUBCHANNEL = 0001 -OSA 7C14 ON OSA 7C14 SUBCHANNEL = 0002 -OSA 7C15 ON OSA 7C15 SUBCHANNEL = 0003 - -If you have a guest with certain privileges you may be able to see devices -which don't belong to you. To avoid this, add the option V. -e.g. -Q V OSA - -Now using the device numbers returned by this command we will -Trace the io starting up on the first device 7c08 & 7c09 -In our simplest case we can trace the -start subchannels -like TR SSCH 7C08-7C09 -or the halt subchannels -or TR HSCH 7C08-7C09 -MSCH's ,STSCH's I think you can guess the rest - -A good trick is tracing all the IO's and CCWS and spooling them into the reader -of another VM guest so he can ftp the logfile back to his own machine. I'll do -a small bit of this and give you a look at the output. - -1) Spool stdout to VM reader -SP PRT TO (another vm guest ) or * for the local vm guest -2) Fill the reader with the trace -TR IO 7c08-7c09 INST INT CCW PRT RUN -3) Start up linux -i 00c -4) Finish the trace -TR END -5) close the reader -C PRT -6) list reader contents -RDRLIST -7) copy it to linux4's minidisk -RECEIVE / LOG TXT A1 ( replace -8) -filel & press F11 to look at it -You should see something like: - -00020942' SSCH B2334000 0048813C CC 0 SCH 0000 DEV 7C08 - CPA 000FFDF0 PARM 00E2C9C4 KEY 0 FPI C0 LPM 80 - CCW 000FFDF0 E4200100 00487FE8 0000 E4240100 ........ - IDAL 43D8AFE8 - IDAL 0FB76000 -00020B0A' I/O DEV 7C08 -> 000197BC' SCH 0000 PARM 00E2C9C4 -00021628' TSCH B2354000 >> 00488164 CC 0 SCH 0000 DEV 7C08 - CCWA 000FFDF8 DEV STS 0C SCH STS 00 CNT 00EC - KEY 0 FPI C0 CC 0 CTLS 4007 -00022238' STSCH B2344000 >> 00488108 CC 0 SCH 0000 DEV 7C08 - -If you don't like messing up your readed ( because you possibly booted from it ) -you can alternatively spool it to another readers guest. - - -Other common VM device related commands ---------------------------------------------- -These commands are listed only because they have -been of use to me in the past & may be of use to -you too. For more complete info on each of the commands -use type HELP <command> from CMS. -detaching devices -DET <devno range> -ATT <devno range> <guest> -attach a device to guest * for your own guest -READY <devno> cause VM to issue a fake interrupt. - -The VARY command is normally only available to VM administrators. -VARY ON PATH <path> TO <devno range> -VARY OFF PATH <PATH> FROM <devno range> -This is used to switch on or off channel paths to devices. - -Q CHPID <channel path ID> -This displays state of devices using this channel path -D SCHIB <subchannel> -This displays the subchannel information SCHIB block for the device. -this I believe is also only available to administrators. -DEFINE CTC <devno> -defines a virtual CTC channel to channel connection -2 need to be defined on each guest for the CTC driver to use. -COUPLE devno userid remote devno -Joins a local virtual device to a remote virtual device -( commonly used for the CTC driver ). - -Building a VM ramdisk under CMS which linux can use -def vfb-<blocksize> <subchannel> <number blocks> -blocksize is commonly 4096 for linux. -Formatting it -format <subchannel> <driver letter e.g. x> (blksize <blocksize> - -Sharing a disk between multiple guests -LINK userid devno1 devno2 mode password - - - -GDB on S390 -=========== -N.B. if compiling for debugging gdb works better without optimisation -( see Compiling programs for debugging ) - -invocation ----------- -gdb <victim program> <optional corefile> - -Online help ------------ -help: gives help on commands -e.g. -help -help display -Note gdb's online help is very good use it. - - -Assembly --------- -info registers: displays registers other than floating point. -info all-registers: displays floating points as well. -disassemble: disassembles -e.g. -disassemble without parameters will disassemble the current function -disassemble $pc $pc+10 - -Viewing & modifying variables ------------------------------ -print or p: displays variable or register -e.g. p/x $sp will display the stack pointer - -display: prints variable or register each time program stops -e.g. -display/x $pc will display the program counter -display argc - -undisplay : undo's display's - -info breakpoints: shows all current breakpoints - -info stack: shows stack back trace (if this doesn't work too well, I'll show -you the stacktrace by hand below). - -info locals: displays local variables. - -info args: display current procedure arguments. - -set args: will set argc & argv each time the victim program is invoked. - -set <variable>=value -set argc=100 -set $pc=0 - - - -Modifying execution -------------------- -step: steps n lines of sourcecode -step steps 1 line. -step 100 steps 100 lines of code. - -next: like step except this will not step into subroutines - -stepi: steps a single machine code instruction. -e.g. stepi 100 - -nexti: steps a single machine code instruction but will not step into -subroutines. - -finish: will run until exit of the current routine - -run: (re)starts a program - -cont: continues a program - -quit: exits gdb. - - -breakpoints ------------- - -break -sets a breakpoint -e.g. - -break main - -break *$pc - -break *0x400618 - -Here's a really useful one for large programs -rbr -Set a breakpoint for all functions matching REGEXP -e.g. -rbr 390 -will set a breakpoint with all functions with 390 in their name. - -info breakpoints -lists all breakpoints - -delete: delete breakpoint by number or delete them all -e.g. -delete 1 will delete the first breakpoint -delete will delete them all - -watch: This will set a watchpoint ( usually hardware assisted ), -This will watch a variable till it changes -e.g. -watch cnt, will watch the variable cnt till it changes. -As an aside unfortunately gdb's, architecture independent watchpoint code -is inconsistent & not very good, watchpoints usually work but not always. - -info watchpoints: Display currently active watchpoints - -condition: ( another useful one ) -Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true. -Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an -expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached. - - - -User defined functions/macros ------------------------------ -define: ( Note this is very very useful,simple & powerful ) -usage define <name> <list of commands> end - -examples which you should consider putting into .gdbinit in your home directory -define d -stepi -disassemble $pc $pc+10 -end - -define e -nexti -disassemble $pc $pc+10 -end - - -Other hard to classify stuff ----------------------------- -signal n: -sends the victim program a signal. -e.g. signal 3 will send a SIGQUIT. - -info signals: -what gdb does when the victim receives certain signals. - -list: -e.g. -list lists current function source -list 1,10 list first 10 lines of current file. -list test.c:1,10 - - -directory: -Adds directories to be searched for source if gdb cannot find the source. -(note it is a bit sensitive about slashes) -e.g. To add the root of the filesystem to the searchpath do -directory // - - -call <function> -This calls a function in the victim program, this is pretty powerful -e.g. -(gdb) call printf("hello world") -outputs: -$1 = 11 - -You might now be thinking that the line above didn't work, something extra had -to be done. -(gdb) call fflush(stdout) -hello world$2 = 0 -As an aside the debugger also calls malloc & free under the hood -to make space for the "hello world" string. - - - -hints ------ -1) command completion works just like bash -( if you are a bad typist like me this really helps ) -e.g. hit br <TAB> & cursor up & down :-). - -2) if you have a debugging problem that takes a few steps to recreate -put the steps into a file called .gdbinit in your current working directory -if you have defined a few extra useful user defined commands put these in -your home directory & they will be read each time gdb is launched. - -A typical .gdbinit file might be. -break main -run -break runtime_exception -cont - - -stack chaining in gdb by hand ------------------------------ -This is done using a the same trick described for VM -p/x (*($sp+56))&0x7fffffff get the first backchain. - -For z/Architecture -Replace 56 with 112 & ignore the &0x7fffffff -in the macros below & do nasty casts to longs like the following -as gdb unfortunately deals with printed arguments as ints which -messes up everything. -i.e. here is a 3rd backchain dereference -p/x *(long *)(***(long ***)$sp+112) - - -this outputs -$5 = 0x528f18 -on my machine. -Now you can use -info symbol (*($sp+56))&0x7fffffff -you might see something like. -rl_getc + 36 in section .text telling you what is located at address 0x528f18 -Now do. -p/x (*(*$sp+56))&0x7fffffff -This outputs -$6 = 0x528ed0 -Now do. -info symbol (*(*$sp+56))&0x7fffffff -rl_read_key + 180 in section .text -now do -p/x (*(**$sp+56))&0x7fffffff -& so on. - -Disassembling instructions without debug info ---------------------------------------------- -gdb typically complains if there is a lack of debugging -symbols in the disassemble command with -"No function contains specified address." To get around -this do -x/<number lines to disassemble>xi <address> -e.g. -x/20xi 0x400730 - - - -Note: Remember gdb has history just like bash you don't need to retype the -whole line just use the up & down arrows. - - - -For more info -------------- -From your linuxbox do -man gdb or info gdb. - -core dumps ----------- -What a core dump ?, -A core dump is a file generated by the kernel (if allowed) which contains the -registers and all active pages of the program which has crashed. -From this file gdb will allow you to look at the registers, stack trace and -memory of the program as if it just crashed on your system. It is usually -called core and created in the current working directory. -This is very useful in that a customer can mail a core dump to a technical -support department and the technical support department can reconstruct what -happened. Provided they have an identical copy of this program with debugging -symbols compiled in and the source base of this build is available. -In short it is far more useful than something like a crash log could ever hope -to be. - -Why have I never seen one ?. -Probably because you haven't used the command -ulimit -c unlimited in bash -to allow core dumps, now do -ulimit -a -to verify that the limit was accepted. - -A sample core dump -To create this I'm going to do -ulimit -c unlimited -gdb -to launch gdb (my victim app. ) now be bad & do the following from another -telnet/xterm session to the same machine -ps -aux | grep gdb -kill -SIGSEGV <gdb's pid> -or alternatively use killall -SIGSEGV gdb if you have the killall command. -Now look at the core dump. -./gdb core -Displays the following -GNU gdb 4.18 -Copyright 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and you are -welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under certain conditions. -Type "show copying" to see the conditions. -There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for details. -This GDB was configured as "s390-ibm-linux"... -Core was generated by `./gdb'. -Program terminated with signal 11, Segmentation fault. -Reading symbols from /usr/lib/libncurses.so.4...done. -Reading symbols from /lib/libm.so.6...done. -Reading symbols from /lib/libc.so.6...done. -Reading symbols from /lib/ld-linux.so.2...done. -#0 0x40126d1a in read () from /lib/libc.so.6 -Setting up the environment for debugging gdb. -Breakpoint 1 at 0x4dc6f8: file utils.c, line 471. -Breakpoint 2 at 0x4d87a4: file top.c, line 2609. -(top-gdb) info stack -#0 0x40126d1a in read () from /lib/libc.so.6 -#1 0x528f26 in rl_getc (stream=0x7ffffde8) at input.c:402 -#2 0x528ed0 in rl_read_key () at input.c:381 -#3 0x5167e6 in readline_internal_char () at readline.c:454 -#4 0x5168ee in readline_internal_charloop () at readline.c:507 -#5 0x51692c in readline_internal () at readline.c:521 -#6 0x5164fe in readline (prompt=0x7ffff810) - at readline.c:349 -#7 0x4d7a8a in command_line_input (prompt=0x564420 "(gdb) ", repeat=1, - annotation_suffix=0x4d6b44 "prompt") at top.c:2091 -#8 0x4d6cf0 in command_loop () at top.c:1345 -#9 0x4e25bc in main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffdf4) at main.c:635 - - -LDD -=== -This is a program which lists the shared libraries which a library needs, -Note you also get the relocations of the shared library text segments which -help when using objdump --source. -e.g. - ldd ./gdb -outputs -libncurses.so.4 => /usr/lib/libncurses.so.4 (0x40018000) -libm.so.6 => /lib/libm.so.6 (0x4005e000) -libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x40084000) -/lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000) - - -Debugging shared libraries -========================== -Most programs use shared libraries, however it can be very painful -when you single step instruction into a function like printf for the -first time & you end up in functions like _dl_runtime_resolve this is -the ld.so doing lazy binding, lazy binding is a concept in ELF where -shared library functions are not loaded into memory unless they are -actually used, great for saving memory but a pain to debug. -To get around this either relink the program -static or exit gdb type -export LD_BIND_NOW=true this will stop lazy binding & restart the gdb'ing -the program in question. - - - -Debugging modules -================= -As modules are dynamically loaded into the kernel their address can be -anywhere to get around this use the -m option with insmod to emit a load -map which can be piped into a file if required. - -The proc file system -==================== -What is it ?. -It is a filesystem created by the kernel with files which are created on demand -by the kernel if read, or can be used to modify kernel parameters, -it is a powerful concept. - -e.g. - -cat /proc/sys/net/ipv4/ip_forward -On my machine outputs -0 -telling me ip_forwarding is not on to switch it on I can do -echo 1 > /proc/sys/net/ipv4/ip_forward -cat it again -cat /proc/sys/net/ipv4/ip_forward -On my machine now outputs -1 -IP forwarding is on. -There is a lot of useful info in here best found by going in and having a look -around, so I'll take you through some entries I consider important. - -All the processes running on the machine have their own entry defined by -/proc/<pid> -So lets have a look at the init process -cd /proc/1 - -cat cmdline -emits -init [2] - -cd /proc/1/fd -This contains numerical entries of all the open files, -some of these you can cat e.g. stdout (2) - -cat /proc/29/maps -on my machine emits - -00400000-00478000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 4103 /bin/bash -00478000-0047e000 rw-p 00077000 5f:00 4103 /bin/bash -0047e000-00492000 rwxp 00000000 00:00 0 -40000000-40015000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14382 /lib/ld-2.1.2.so -40015000-40016000 rw-p 00014000 5f:00 14382 /lib/ld-2.1.2.so -40016000-40017000 rwxp 00000000 00:00 0 -40017000-40018000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0 -40018000-4001b000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14435 /lib/libtermcap.so.2.0.8 -4001b000-4001c000 rw-p 00002000 5f:00 14435 /lib/libtermcap.so.2.0.8 -4001c000-4010d000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14387 /lib/libc-2.1.2.so -4010d000-40111000 rw-p 000f0000 5f:00 14387 /lib/libc-2.1.2.so -40111000-40114000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0 -40114000-4011e000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14408 /lib/libnss_files-2.1.2.so -4011e000-4011f000 rw-p 00009000 5f:00 14408 /lib/libnss_files-2.1.2.so -7fffd000-80000000 rwxp ffffe000 00:00 0 - - -Showing us the shared libraries init uses where they are in memory -& memory access permissions for each virtual memory area. - -/proc/1/cwd is a softlink to the current working directory. -/proc/1/root is the root of the filesystem for this process. - -/proc/1/mem is the current running processes memory which you -can read & write to like a file. -strace uses this sometimes as it is a bit faster than the -rather inefficient ptrace interface for peeking at DATA. - - -cat status - -Name: init -State: S (sleeping) -Pid: 1 -PPid: 0 -Uid: 0 0 0 0 -Gid: 0 0 0 0 -Groups: -VmSize: 408 kB -VmLck: 0 kB -VmRSS: 208 kB -VmData: 24 kB -VmStk: 8 kB -VmExe: 368 kB -VmLib: 0 kB -SigPnd: 0000000000000000 -SigBlk: 0000000000000000 -SigIgn: 7fffffffd7f0d8fc -SigCgt: 00000000280b2603 -CapInh: 00000000fffffeff -CapPrm: 00000000ffffffff -CapEff: 00000000fffffeff - -User PSW: 070de000 80414146 -task: 004b6000 tss: 004b62d8 ksp: 004b7ca8 pt_regs: 004b7f68 -User GPRS: -00000400 00000000 0000000b 7ffffa90 -00000000 00000000 00000000 0045d9f4 -0045cafc 7ffffa90 7fffff18 0045cb08 -00010400 804039e8 80403af8 7ffff8b0 -User ACRS: -00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 -00000001 00000000 00000000 00000000 -00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 -00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 -Kernel BackChain CallChain BackChain CallChain - 004b7ca8 8002bd0c 004b7d18 8002b92c - 004b7db8 8005cd50 004b7e38 8005d12a - 004b7f08 80019114 -Showing among other things memory usage & status of some signals & -the processes'es registers from the kernel task_structure -as well as a backchain which may be useful if a process crashes -in the kernel for some unknown reason. - -Some driver debugging techniques -================================ -debug feature -------------- -Some of our drivers now support a "debug feature" in -/proc/s390dbf see s390dbf.txt in the linux/Documentation directory -for more info. -e.g. -to switch on the lcs "debug feature" -echo 5 > /proc/s390dbf/lcs/level -& then after the error occurred. -cat /proc/s390dbf/lcs/sprintf >/logfile -the logfile now contains some information which may help -tech support resolve a problem in the field. - - - -high level debugging network drivers ------------------------------------- -ifconfig is a quite useful command -it gives the current state of network drivers. - -If you suspect your network device driver is dead -one way to check is type -ifconfig <network device> -e.g. tr0 -You should see something like -tr0 Link encap:16/4 Mbps Token Ring (New) HWaddr 00:04:AC:20:8E:48 - inet addr:9.164.185.132 Bcast:9.164.191.255 Mask:255.255.224.0 - UP BROADCAST RUNNING MULTICAST MTU:2000 Metric:1 - RX packets:246134 errors:0 dropped:0 overruns:0 frame:0 - TX packets:5 errors:0 dropped:0 overruns:0 carrier:0 - collisions:0 txqueuelen:100 - -if the device doesn't say up -try -/etc/rc.d/init.d/network start -( this starts the network stack & hopefully calls ifconfig tr0 up ). -ifconfig looks at the output of /proc/net/dev and presents it in a more -presentable form. -Now ping the device from a machine in the same subnet. -if the RX packets count & TX packets counts don't increment you probably -have problems. -next -cat /proc/net/arp -Do you see any hardware addresses in the cache if not you may have problems. -Next try -ping -c 5 <broadcast_addr> i.e. the Bcast field above in the output of -ifconfig. Do you see any replies from machines other than the local machine -if not you may have problems. also if the TX packets count in ifconfig -hasn't incremented either you have serious problems in your driver -(e.g. the txbusy field of the network device being stuck on ) -or you may have multiple network devices connected. - - -chandev -------- -There is a new device layer for channel devices, some -drivers e.g. lcs are registered with this layer. -If the device uses the channel device layer you'll be -able to find what interrupts it uses & the current state -of the device. -See the manpage chandev.8 &type cat /proc/chandev for more info. - - -SysRq -===== -This is now supported by linux for s/390 & z/Architecture. -To enable it do compile the kernel with -Kernel Hacking -> Magic SysRq Key Enabled -echo "1" > /proc/sys/kernel/sysrq -also type -echo "8" >/proc/sys/kernel/printk -To make printk output go to console. -On 390 all commands are prefixed with -^- -e.g. -^-t will show tasks. -^-? or some unknown command will display help. -The sysrq key reading is very picky ( I have to type the keys in an - xterm session & paste them into the x3270 console ) -& it may be wise to predefine the keys as described in the VM hints above - -This is particularly useful for syncing disks unmounting & rebooting -if the machine gets partially hung. - -Read Documentation/admin-guide/sysrq.rst for more info - -References: -=========== -Enterprise Systems Architecture Reference Summary -Enterprise Systems Architecture Principles of Operation -Hartmut Penners s390 stack frame sheet. -IBM Mainframe Channel Attachment a technology brief from a CISCO webpage -Various bits of man & info pages of Linux. -Linux & GDB source. -Various info & man pages. -CMS Help on tracing commands. -Linux for s/390 Elf Application Binary Interface -Linux for z/Series Elf Application Binary Interface ( Both Highly Recommended ) -z/Architecture Principles of Operation SA22-7832-00 -Enterprise Systems Architecture/390 Reference Summary SA22-7209-01 & the -Enterprise Systems Architecture/390 Principles of Operation SA22-7201-05 - -Special Thanks -============== -Special thanks to Neale Ferguson who maintains a much -prettier HTML version of this page at -http://linuxvm.org/penguinvm/ -Bob Grainger Stefan Bader & others for reporting bugs diff --git a/Documentation/s390/cds.txt b/Documentation/s390/cds.rst index 480a78ef5a1e..7006d8209d2e 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/cds.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/cds.rst @@ -1,14 +1,18 @@ +=========================== Linux for S/390 and zSeries +=========================== Common Device Support (CDS) Device Driver I/O Support Routines -Authors : Ingo Adlung - Cornelia Huck +Authors: + - Ingo Adlung + - Cornelia Huck Copyright, IBM Corp. 1999-2002 Introduction +============ This document describes the common device support routines for Linux/390. Different than other hardware architectures, ESA/390 has defined a unified @@ -27,18 +31,20 @@ Operation manual (IBM Form. No. SA22-7201). In order to build common device support for ESA/390 I/O interfaces, a functional layer was introduced that provides generic I/O access methods to -the hardware. +the hardware. -The common device support layer comprises the I/O support routines defined -below. Some of them implement common Linux device driver interfaces, while +The common device support layer comprises the I/O support routines defined +below. Some of them implement common Linux device driver interfaces, while some of them are ESA/390 platform specific. Note: -In order to write a driver for S/390, you also need to look into the interface -described in Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt. + In order to write a driver for S/390, you also need to look into the interface + described in Documentation/s390/driver-model.rst. Note for porting drivers from 2.4: + The major changes are: + * The functions use a ccw_device instead of an irq (subchannel). * All drivers must define a ccw_driver (see driver-model.txt) and the associated functions. @@ -57,19 +63,16 @@ The major changes are: ccw_device_get_ciw() get commands from extended sense data. -ccw_device_start() -ccw_device_start_timeout() -ccw_device_start_key() -ccw_device_start_key_timeout() +ccw_device_start(), ccw_device_start_timeout(), ccw_device_start_key(), ccw_device_start_key_timeout() initiate an I/O request. ccw_device_resume() resume channel program execution. -ccw_device_halt() +ccw_device_halt() terminate the current I/O request processed on the device. -do_IRQ() +do_IRQ() generic interrupt routine. This function is called by the interrupt entry routine whenever an I/O interrupt is presented to the system. The do_IRQ() routine determines the interrupt status and calls the device specific @@ -82,12 +85,15 @@ first level interrupt handler only and does not comprise a device driver callable interface. Instead, the functional description of do_IO() also describes the input to the device specific interrupt handler. -Note: All explanations apply also to the 64 bit architecture s390x. +Note: + All explanations apply also to the 64 bit architecture s390x. Common Device Support (CDS) for Linux/390 Device Drivers +======================================================== General Information +------------------- The following chapters describe the I/O related interface routines the Linux/390 common device support (CDS) provides to allow for device specific @@ -101,6 +107,7 @@ can be found in the architecture specific C header file linux/arch/s390/include/asm/irq.h. Overview of CDS interface concepts +---------------------------------- Different to other hardware platforms, the ESA/390 architecture doesn't define interrupt lines managed by a specific interrupt controller and bus systems @@ -126,7 +133,7 @@ has to call every single device driver registered on this IRQ in order to determine the device driver owning the device that raised the interrupt. Up to kernel 2.4, Linux/390 used to provide interfaces via the IRQ (subchannel). -For internal use of the common I/O layer, these are still there. However, +For internal use of the common I/O layer, these are still there. However, device drivers should use the new calling interface via the ccw_device only. During its startup the Linux/390 system checks for peripheral devices. Each @@ -134,7 +141,7 @@ of those devices is uniquely defined by a so called subchannel by the ESA/390 channel subsystem. While the subchannel numbers are system generated, each subchannel also takes a user defined attribute, the so called device number. Both subchannel number and device number cannot exceed 65535. During sysfs -initialisation, the information about control unit type and device types that +initialisation, the information about control unit type and device types that imply specific I/O commands (channel command words - CCWs) in order to operate the device are gathered. Device drivers can retrieve this set of hardware information during their initialization step to recognize the devices they @@ -164,18 +171,26 @@ get_ciw() - get command information word This call enables a device driver to get information about supported commands from the extended SenseID data. -struct ciw * -ccw_device_get_ciw(struct ccw_device *cdev, __u32 cmd); +:: -cdev - The ccw_device for which the command is to be retrieved. -cmd - The command type to be retrieved. + struct ciw * + ccw_device_get_ciw(struct ccw_device *cdev, __u32 cmd); + +==== ======================================================== +cdev The ccw_device for which the command is to be retrieved. +cmd The command type to be retrieved. +==== ======================================================== ccw_device_get_ciw() returns: -NULL - No extended data available, invalid device or command not found. -!NULL - The command requested. +===== ================================================================ + NULL No extended data available, invalid device or command not found. +!NULL The command requested. +===== ================================================================ + +:: -ccw_device_start() - Initiate I/O Request + ccw_device_start() - Initiate I/O Request The ccw_device_start() routines is the I/O request front-end processor. All device driver I/O requests must be issued using this routine. A device driver @@ -186,93 +201,105 @@ This description also covers the status information passed to the device driver's interrupt handler as this is related to the rules (flags) defined with the associated I/O request when calling ccw_device_start(). -int ccw_device_start(struct ccw_device *cdev, - struct ccw1 *cpa, - unsigned long intparm, - __u8 lpm, - unsigned long flags); -int ccw_device_start_timeout(struct ccw_device *cdev, - struct ccw1 *cpa, - unsigned long intparm, - __u8 lpm, - unsigned long flags, - int expires); -int ccw_device_start_key(struct ccw_device *cdev, - struct ccw1 *cpa, - unsigned long intparm, - __u8 lpm, - __u8 key, - unsigned long flags); -int ccw_device_start_key_timeout(struct ccw_device *cdev, - struct ccw1 *cpa, - unsigned long intparm, - __u8 lpm, - __u8 key, - unsigned long flags, - int expires); - -cdev : ccw_device the I/O is destined for -cpa : logical start address of channel program -user_intparm : user specific interrupt information; will be presented - back to the device driver's interrupt handler. Allows a - device driver to associate the interrupt with a - particular I/O request. -lpm : defines the channel path to be used for a specific I/O - request. A value of 0 will make cio use the opm. -key : the storage key to use for the I/O (useful for operating on a - storage with a storage key != default key) -flag : defines the action to be performed for I/O processing -expires : timeout value in jiffies. The common I/O layer will terminate - the running program after this and call the interrupt handler - with ERR_PTR(-ETIMEDOUT) as irb. - -Possible flag values are : - -DOIO_ALLOW_SUSPEND - channel program may become suspended -DOIO_DENY_PREFETCH - don't allow for CCW prefetch; usually - this implies the channel program might - become modified -DOIO_SUPPRESS_INTER - don't call the handler on intermediate status - -The cpa parameter points to the first format 1 CCW of a channel program : - -struct ccw1 { - __u8 cmd_code;/* command code */ - __u8 flags; /* flags, like IDA addressing, etc. */ - __u16 count; /* byte count */ - __u32 cda; /* data address */ -} __attribute__ ((packed,aligned(8))); - -with the following CCW flags values defined : - -CCW_FLAG_DC - data chaining -CCW_FLAG_CC - command chaining -CCW_FLAG_SLI - suppress incorrect length -CCW_FLAG_SKIP - skip -CCW_FLAG_PCI - PCI -CCW_FLAG_IDA - indirect addressing -CCW_FLAG_SUSPEND - suspend +:: + + int ccw_device_start(struct ccw_device *cdev, + struct ccw1 *cpa, + unsigned long intparm, + __u8 lpm, + unsigned long flags); + int ccw_device_start_timeout(struct ccw_device *cdev, + struct ccw1 *cpa, + unsigned long intparm, + __u8 lpm, + unsigned long flags, + int expires); + int ccw_device_start_key(struct ccw_device *cdev, + struct ccw1 *cpa, + unsigned long intparm, + __u8 lpm, + __u8 key, + unsigned long flags); + int ccw_device_start_key_timeout(struct ccw_device *cdev, + struct ccw1 *cpa, + unsigned long intparm, + __u8 lpm, + __u8 key, + unsigned long flags, + int expires); + +============= ============================================================= +cdev ccw_device the I/O is destined for +cpa logical start address of channel program +user_intparm user specific interrupt information; will be presented + back to the device driver's interrupt handler. Allows a + device driver to associate the interrupt with a + particular I/O request. +lpm defines the channel path to be used for a specific I/O + request. A value of 0 will make cio use the opm. +key the storage key to use for the I/O (useful for operating on a + storage with a storage key != default key) +flag defines the action to be performed for I/O processing +expires timeout value in jiffies. The common I/O layer will terminate + the running program after this and call the interrupt handler + with ERR_PTR(-ETIMEDOUT) as irb. +============= ============================================================= + +Possible flag values are: + +========================= ============================================= +DOIO_ALLOW_SUSPEND channel program may become suspended +DOIO_DENY_PREFETCH don't allow for CCW prefetch; usually + this implies the channel program might + become modified +DOIO_SUPPRESS_INTER don't call the handler on intermediate status +========================= ============================================= + +The cpa parameter points to the first format 1 CCW of a channel program:: + + struct ccw1 { + __u8 cmd_code;/* command code */ + __u8 flags; /* flags, like IDA addressing, etc. */ + __u16 count; /* byte count */ + __u32 cda; /* data address */ + } __attribute__ ((packed,aligned(8))); + +with the following CCW flags values defined: + +=================== ========================= +CCW_FLAG_DC data chaining +CCW_FLAG_CC command chaining +CCW_FLAG_SLI suppress incorrect length +CCW_FLAG_SKIP skip +CCW_FLAG_PCI PCI +CCW_FLAG_IDA indirect addressing +CCW_FLAG_SUSPEND suspend +=================== ========================= Via ccw_device_set_options(), the device driver may specify the following options for the device: -DOIO_EARLY_NOTIFICATION - allow for early interrupt notification -DOIO_REPORT_ALL - report all interrupt conditions +========================= ====================================== +DOIO_EARLY_NOTIFICATION allow for early interrupt notification +DOIO_REPORT_ALL report all interrupt conditions +========================= ====================================== -The ccw_device_start() function returns : +The ccw_device_start() function returns: - 0 - successful completion or request successfully initiated --EBUSY - The device is currently processing a previous I/O request, or there is - a status pending at the device. --ENODEV - cdev is invalid, the device is not operational or the ccw_device is - not online. +======== ====================================================================== + 0 successful completion or request successfully initiated + -EBUSY The device is currently processing a previous I/O request, or there is + a status pending at the device. +-ENODEV cdev is invalid, the device is not operational or the ccw_device is + not online. +======== ====================================================================== When the I/O request completes, the CDS first level interrupt handler will accumulate the status in a struct irb and then call the device interrupt handler. -The intparm field will contain the value the device driver has associated with a -particular I/O request. If a pending device status was recognized, +The intparm field will contain the value the device driver has associated with a +particular I/O request. If a pending device status was recognized, intparm will be set to 0 (zero). This may happen during I/O initiation or delayed by an alert status notification. In any case this status is not related to the current (last) I/O request. In case of a delayed status notification no special @@ -282,9 +309,11 @@ never started, even though ccw_device_start() returned with successful completio The irb may contain an error value, and the device driver should check for this first: --ETIMEDOUT: the common I/O layer terminated the request after the specified - timeout value --EIO: the common I/O layer terminated the request due to an error state +========== ================================================================= +-ETIMEDOUT the common I/O layer terminated the request after the specified + timeout value +-EIO the common I/O layer terminated the request due to an error state +========== ================================================================= If the concurrent sense flag in the extended status word (esw) in the irb is set, the field erw.scnt in the esw describes the number of device specific @@ -294,6 +323,7 @@ sensing by the device driver itself is required. The device interrupt handler can use the following definitions to investigate the primary unit check source coded in sense byte 0 : +======================= ==== SNS0_CMD_REJECT 0x80 SNS0_INTERVENTION_REQ 0x40 SNS0_BUS_OUT_CHECK 0x20 @@ -301,36 +331,41 @@ SNS0_EQUIPMENT_CHECK 0x10 SNS0_DATA_CHECK 0x08 SNS0_OVERRUN 0x04 SNS0_INCOMPL_DOMAIN 0x01 +======================= ==== Depending on the device status, multiple of those values may be set together. Please refer to the device specific documentation for details. The irb->scsw.cstat field provides the (accumulated) subchannel status : -SCHN_STAT_PCI - program controlled interrupt -SCHN_STAT_INCORR_LEN - incorrect length -SCHN_STAT_PROG_CHECK - program check -SCHN_STAT_PROT_CHECK - protection check -SCHN_STAT_CHN_DATA_CHK - channel data check -SCHN_STAT_CHN_CTRL_CHK - channel control check -SCHN_STAT_INTF_CTRL_CHK - interface control check -SCHN_STAT_CHAIN_CHECK - chaining check +========================= ============================ +SCHN_STAT_PCI program controlled interrupt +SCHN_STAT_INCORR_LEN incorrect length +SCHN_STAT_PROG_CHECK program check +SCHN_STAT_PROT_CHECK protection check +SCHN_STAT_CHN_DATA_CHK channel data check +SCHN_STAT_CHN_CTRL_CHK channel control check +SCHN_STAT_INTF_CTRL_CHK interface control check +SCHN_STAT_CHAIN_CHECK chaining check +========================= ============================ The irb->scsw.dstat field provides the (accumulated) device status : -DEV_STAT_ATTENTION - attention -DEV_STAT_STAT_MOD - status modifier -DEV_STAT_CU_END - control unit end -DEV_STAT_BUSY - busy -DEV_STAT_CHN_END - channel end -DEV_STAT_DEV_END - device end -DEV_STAT_UNIT_CHECK - unit check -DEV_STAT_UNIT_EXCEP - unit exception +===================== ================= +DEV_STAT_ATTENTION attention +DEV_STAT_STAT_MOD status modifier +DEV_STAT_CU_END control unit end +DEV_STAT_BUSY busy +DEV_STAT_CHN_END channel end +DEV_STAT_DEV_END device end +DEV_STAT_UNIT_CHECK unit check +DEV_STAT_UNIT_EXCEP unit exception +===================== ================= Please see the ESA/390 Principles of Operation manual for details on the individual flag meanings. -Usage Notes : +Usage Notes: ccw_device_start() must be called disabled and with the ccw device lock held. @@ -374,32 +409,39 @@ secondary status without error (alert status) is presented, this indicates successful completion for all overlapping ccw_device_start() requests that have been issued since the last secondary (final) status. -Channel programs that intend to set the suspend flag on a channel command word -(CCW) must start the I/O operation with the DOIO_ALLOW_SUSPEND option or the -suspend flag will cause a channel program check. At the time the channel program -becomes suspended an intermediate interrupt will be generated by the channel +Channel programs that intend to set the suspend flag on a channel command word +(CCW) must start the I/O operation with the DOIO_ALLOW_SUSPEND option or the +suspend flag will cause a channel program check. At the time the channel program +becomes suspended an intermediate interrupt will be generated by the channel subsystem. -ccw_device_resume() - Resume Channel Program Execution +ccw_device_resume() - Resume Channel Program Execution -If a device driver chooses to suspend the current channel program execution by -setting the CCW suspend flag on a particular CCW, the channel program execution -is suspended. In order to resume channel program execution the CIO layer -provides the ccw_device_resume() routine. +If a device driver chooses to suspend the current channel program execution by +setting the CCW suspend flag on a particular CCW, the channel program execution +is suspended. In order to resume channel program execution the CIO layer +provides the ccw_device_resume() routine. -int ccw_device_resume(struct ccw_device *cdev); +:: -cdev - ccw_device the resume operation is requested for + int ccw_device_resume(struct ccw_device *cdev); + +==== ================================================ +cdev ccw_device the resume operation is requested for +==== ================================================ The ccw_device_resume() function returns: - 0 - suspended channel program is resumed --EBUSY - status pending --ENODEV - cdev invalid or not-operational subchannel --EINVAL - resume function not applicable --ENOTCONN - there is no I/O request pending for completion +========= ============================================== + 0 suspended channel program is resumed + -EBUSY status pending + -ENODEV cdev invalid or not-operational subchannel + -EINVAL resume function not applicable +-ENOTCONN there is no I/O request pending for completion +========= ============================================== Usage Notes: + Please have a look at the ccw_device_start() usage notes for more details on suspended channel programs. @@ -412,22 +454,28 @@ command is provided. ccw_device_halt() must be called disabled and with the ccw device lock held. -int ccw_device_halt(struct ccw_device *cdev, - unsigned long intparm); +:: + + int ccw_device_halt(struct ccw_device *cdev, + unsigned long intparm); -cdev : ccw_device the halt operation is requested for -intparm : interruption parameter; value is only used if no I/O - is outstanding, otherwise the intparm associated with - the I/O request is returned +======= ===================================================== +cdev ccw_device the halt operation is requested for +intparm interruption parameter; value is only used if no I/O + is outstanding, otherwise the intparm associated with + the I/O request is returned +======= ===================================================== -The ccw_device_halt() function returns : +The ccw_device_halt() function returns: - 0 - request successfully initiated --EBUSY - the device is currently busy, or status pending. --ENODEV - cdev invalid. --EINVAL - The device is not operational or the ccw device is not online. +======= ============================================================== + 0 request successfully initiated +-EBUSY the device is currently busy, or status pending. +-ENODEV cdev invalid. +-EINVAL The device is not operational or the ccw device is not online. +======= ============================================================== -Usage Notes : +Usage Notes: A device driver may write a never-ending channel program by writing a channel program that at its end loops back to its beginning by means of a transfer in @@ -438,25 +486,34 @@ can then perform an appropriate action. Prior to interrupt of an outstanding read to a network device (with or without PCI flag) a ccw_device_halt() is required to end the pending operation. -ccw_device_clear() - Terminage I/O Request Processing +:: + + ccw_device_clear() - Terminage I/O Request Processing In order to terminate all I/O processing at the subchannel, the clear subchannel (CSCH) command is used. It can be issued via ccw_device_clear(). ccw_device_clear() must be called disabled and with the ccw device lock held. -int ccw_device_clear(struct ccw_device *cdev, unsigned long intparm); +:: + + int ccw_device_clear(struct ccw_device *cdev, unsigned long intparm); -cdev: ccw_device the clear operation is requested for -intparm: interruption parameter (see ccw_device_halt()) +======= =============================================== +cdev ccw_device the clear operation is requested for +intparm interruption parameter (see ccw_device_halt()) +======= =============================================== The ccw_device_clear() function returns: - 0 - request successfully initiated --ENODEV - cdev invalid --EINVAL - The device is not operational or the ccw device is not online. +======= ============================================================== + 0 request successfully initiated +-ENODEV cdev invalid +-EINVAL The device is not operational or the ccw device is not online. +======= ============================================================== Miscellaneous Support Routines +------------------------------ This chapter describes various routines to be used in a Linux/390 device driver programming environment. @@ -466,7 +523,8 @@ get_ccwdev_lock() Get the address of the device specific lock. This is then used in spin_lock() / spin_unlock() calls. +:: -__u8 ccw_device_get_path_mask(struct ccw_device *cdev); + __u8 ccw_device_get_path_mask(struct ccw_device *cdev); Get the mask of the path currently available for cdev. diff --git a/Documentation/s390/CommonIO b/Documentation/s390/common_io.rst index 6e0f63f343b4..846485681ce7 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/CommonIO +++ b/Documentation/s390/common_io.rst @@ -1,5 +1,9 @@ -S/390 common I/O-Layer - command line parameters, procfs and debugfs entries -============================================================================ +====================== +S/390 common I/O-Layer +====================== + +command line parameters, procfs and debugfs entries +=================================================== Command line parameters ----------------------- @@ -13,7 +17,7 @@ Command line parameters device := {all | [!]ipldev | [!]condev | [!]<devno> | [!]<devno>-<devno>} The given devices will be ignored by the common I/O-layer; no detection - and device sensing will be done on any of those devices. The subchannel to + and device sensing will be done on any of those devices. The subchannel to which the device in question is attached will be treated as if no device was attached. @@ -28,14 +32,20 @@ Command line parameters keywords can be used to refer to the CCW based boot device and CCW console device respectively (these are probably useful only when combined with the '!' operator). The '!' operator will cause the I/O-layer to _not_ ignore a device. - The command line is parsed from left to right. + The command line + is parsed from left to right. + + For example:: - For example, cio_ignore=0.0.0023-0.0.0042,0.0.4711 + will ignore all devices ranging from 0.0.0023 to 0.0.0042 and the device 0.0.4711, if detected. - As another example, + + As another example:: + cio_ignore=all,!0.0.4711,!0.0.fd00-0.0.fd02 + will ignore all devices but 0.0.4711, 0.0.fd00, 0.0.fd01, 0.0.fd02. By default, no devices are ignored. @@ -48,40 +58,45 @@ Command line parameters Lists the ranges of devices (by bus id) which are ignored by common I/O. - You can un-ignore certain or all devices by piping to /proc/cio_ignore. - "free all" will un-ignore all ignored devices, + You can un-ignore certain or all devices by piping to /proc/cio_ignore. + "free all" will un-ignore all ignored devices, "free <device range>, <device range>, ..." will un-ignore the specified devices. For example, if devices 0.0.0023 to 0.0.0042 and 0.0.4711 are ignored, + - echo free 0.0.0030-0.0.0032 > /proc/cio_ignore will un-ignore devices 0.0.0030 to 0.0.0032 and will leave devices 0.0.0023 to 0.0.002f, 0.0.0033 to 0.0.0042 and 0.0.4711 ignored; - echo free 0.0.0041 > /proc/cio_ignore will furthermore un-ignore device 0.0.0041; - - echo free all > /proc/cio_ignore will un-ignore all remaining ignored + - echo free all > /proc/cio_ignore will un-ignore all remaining ignored devices. - When a device is un-ignored, device recognition and sensing is performed and + When a device is un-ignored, device recognition and sensing is performed and the device driver will be notified if possible, so the device will become available to the system. Note that un-ignoring is performed asynchronously. - You can also add ranges of devices to be ignored by piping to + You can also add ranges of devices to be ignored by piping to /proc/cio_ignore; "add <device range>, <device range>, ..." will ignore the specified devices. Note: While already known devices can be added to the list of devices to be - ignored, there will be no effect on then. However, if such a device + ignored, there will be no effect on then. However, if such a device disappears and then reappears, it will then be ignored. To make known devices go away, you need the "purge" command (see below). - For example, + For example:: + "echo add 0.0.a000-0.0.accc, 0.0.af00-0.0.afff > /proc/cio_ignore" + will add 0.0.a000-0.0.accc and 0.0.af00-0.0.afff to the list of ignored devices. - You can remove already known but now ignored devices via + You can remove already known but now ignored devices via:: + "echo purge > /proc/cio_ignore" + All devices ignored but still registered and not online (= not in use) will be deregistered and thus removed from the system. @@ -115,11 +130,11 @@ debugfs entries Various debug messages from the common I/O-layer. - /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/cio_trace/hex_ascii - Logs the calling of functions in the common I/O-layer and, if applicable, + Logs the calling of functions in the common I/O-layer and, if applicable, which subchannel they were called for, as well as dumps of some data structures (like irb in an error case). - The level of logging can be changed to be more or less verbose by piping to + The level of logging can be changed to be more or less verbose by piping to /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/cio_*/level a number between 0 and 6; see the - documentation on the S/390 debug feature (Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt) + documentation on the S/390 debug feature (Documentation/s390/s390dbf.rst) for details. diff --git a/Documentation/s390/DASD b/Documentation/s390/dasd.rst index 9963f1e9c98a..9e22247285c8 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/DASD +++ b/Documentation/s390/dasd.rst @@ -1,4 +1,6 @@ +================== DASD device driver +================== S/390's disk devices (DASDs) are managed by Linux via the DASD device driver. It is valid for all types of DASDs and represents them to @@ -14,14 +16,14 @@ parameters are to be given in hexadecimal notation without a leading If you supply kernel parameters the different instances are processed in order of appearance and a minor number is reserved for any device covered by the supplied range up to 64 volumes. Additional DASDs are -ignored. If you do not supply the 'dasd=' kernel parameter at all, the +ignored. If you do not supply the 'dasd=' kernel parameter at all, the DASD driver registers all supported DASDs of your system to a minor number in ascending order of the subchannel number. The driver currently supports ECKD-devices and there are stubs for support of the FBA and CKD architectures. For the FBA architecture only some smart data structures are missing to make the support -complete. +complete. We performed our testing on 3380 and 3390 type disks of different sizes, under VM and on the bare hardware (LPAR), using internal disks of the multiprise as well as a RAMAC virtual array. Disks exported by @@ -34,19 +36,22 @@ accessibility of the DASD from other OSs. In a later stage we will provide support of partitions, maybe VTOC oriented or using a kind of partition table in the label record. -USAGE +Usage +===== -Low-level format (?CKD only) For using an ECKD-DASD as a Linux harddisk you have to low-level format the tracks by issuing the BLKDASDFORMAT-ioctl on that device. This will erase any data on that volume including IBM volume -labels, VTOCs etc. The ioctl may take a 'struct format_data *' or -'NULL' as an argument. -typedef struct { +labels, VTOCs etc. The ioctl may take a `struct format_data *` or +'NULL' as an argument:: + + typedef struct { int start_unit; int stop_unit; int blksize; -} format_data_t; + } format_data_t; + When a NULL argument is passed to the BLKDASDFORMAT ioctl the whole disk is formatted to a blocksize of 1024 bytes. Otherwise start_unit and stop_unit are the first and last track to be formatted. If @@ -56,17 +61,23 @@ up to the last track. blksize can be any power of two between 512 and 1kB blocks anyway and you gain approx. 50% of capacity increasing your blksize from 512 byte to 1kB. --Make a filesystem +Make a filesystem +================= + Then you can mk??fs the filesystem of your choice on that volume or partition. For reasons of sanity you should build your filesystem on -the partition /dev/dd?1 instead of the whole volume. You only lose 3kB +the partition /dev/dd?1 instead of the whole volume. You only lose 3kB but may be sure that you can reuse your data after introduction of a real partition table. -BUGS: +Bugs +==== + - Performance sometimes is rather low because we don't fully exploit clustering -TODO-List: +TODO-List +========= + - Add IBM'S Disk layout to genhd - Enhance driver to use more than one major number - Enable usage as a module diff --git a/Documentation/s390/debugging390.rst b/Documentation/s390/debugging390.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..d49305fd5e1a --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/s390/debugging390.rst @@ -0,0 +1,2613 @@ +============================================= +Debugging on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture +============================================= + +Denis Joseph Barrow (djbarrow@de.ibm.com,barrow_dj@yahoo.com) + +Copyright (C) 2000-2001 IBM Deutschland Entwicklung GmbH, IBM Corporation + +.. Best viewed with fixed width fonts + +Overview of Document: +===================== +This document is intended to give a good overview of how to debug Linux for +s/390 and z/Architecture. It is not intended as a complete reference and not a +tutorial on the fundamentals of C & assembly. It doesn't go into +390 IO in any detail. It is intended to complement the documents in the +reference section below & any other worthwhile references you get. + +It is intended like the Enterprise Systems Architecture/390 Reference Summary +to be printed out & used as a quick cheat sheet self help style reference when +problems occur. + +.. Contents + ======== + Register Set + Address Spaces on Intel Linux + Address Spaces on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture + The Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture Kernel Task Structure + Register Usage & Stackframes on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture + A sample program with comments + Compiling programs for debugging on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture + Debugging under VM + s/390 & z/Architecture IO Overview + Debugging IO on s/390 & z/Architecture under VM + GDB on s/390 & z/Architecture + Stack chaining in gdb by hand + Examining core dumps + ldd + Debugging modules + The proc file system + SysRq + References + Special Thanks + +Register Set +============ +The current architectures have the following registers. + +16 General propose registers, 32 bit on s/390 and 64 bit on z/Architecture, +r0-r15 (or gpr0-gpr15), used for arithmetic and addressing. + +16 Control registers, 32 bit on s/390 and 64 bit on z/Architecture, cr0-cr15, +kernel usage only, used for memory management, interrupt control, debugging +control etc. + +16 Access registers (ar0-ar15), 32 bit on both s/390 and z/Architecture, +normally not used by normal programs but potentially could be used as +temporary storage. These registers have a 1:1 association with general +purpose registers and are designed to be used in the so-called access +register mode to select different address spaces. +Access register 0 (and access register 1 on z/Architecture, which needs a +64 bit pointer) is currently used by the pthread library as a pointer to +the current running threads private area. + +16 64-bit floating point registers (fp0-fp15 ) IEEE & HFP floating +point format compliant on G5 upwards & a Floating point control reg (FPC) + +4 64-bit registers (fp0,fp2,fp4 & fp6) HFP only on older machines. + +Note: + Linux (currently) always uses IEEE & emulates G5 IEEE format on older + machines, ( provided the kernel is configured for this ). + + +The PSW is the most important register on the machine it +is 64 bit on s/390 & 128 bit on z/Architecture & serves the roles of +a program counter (pc), condition code register,memory space designator. +In IBM standard notation I am counting bit 0 as the MSB. +It has several advantages over a normal program counter +in that you can change address translation & program counter +in a single instruction. To change address translation, +e.g. switching address translation off requires that you +have a logical=physical mapping for the address you are +currently running at. + ++-------------------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| Bit | | ++--------+----------------+ Value | +| s/390 | z/Architecture | | ++========+================+=================================================+ +| 0 | 0 | Reserved (must be 0) otherwise specification | +| | | exception occurs. | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 1 | 1 | Program Event Recording 1 PER enabled, | +| | | PER is used to facilitate debugging e.g. | +| | | single stepping. | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 2-4 | 2-4 | Reserved (must be 0). | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 5 | 5 | Dynamic address translation 1=DAT on. | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 6 | 6 | Input/Output interrupt Mask | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 7 | 7 | External interrupt Mask used primarily for | +| | | interprocessor signalling and clock interrupts. | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 8-11 | 8-11 | PSW Key used for complex memory protection | +| | | mechanism (not used under linux) | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 12 | 12 | 1 on s/390 0 on z/Architecture | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 13 | 13 | Machine Check Mask 1=enable machine check | +| | | interrupts | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 14 | 14 | Wait State. Set this to 1 to stop the processor | +| | | except for interrupts and give time to other | +| | | LPARS. Used in CPU idle in the kernel to | +| | | increase overall usage of processor resources. | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 15 | 15 | Problem state (if set to 1 certain instructions | +| | | are disabled). All linux user programs run with | +| | | this bit 1 (useful info for debugging under VM).| ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 16-17 | 16-17 | Address Space Control | +| | | | +| | | 00 Primary Space Mode: | +| | | | +| | | The register CR1 contains the primary | +| | | address-space control element (PASCE), which | +| | | points to the primary space region/segment | +| | | table origin. | +| | | | +| | | 01 Access register mode | +| | | | +| | | 10 Secondary Space Mode: | +| | | | +| | | The register CR7 contains the secondary | +| | | address-space control element (SASCE), which | +| | | points to the secondary space region or | +| | | segment table origin. | +| | | | +| | | 11 Home Space Mode: | +| | | | +| | | The register CR13 contains the home space | +| | | address-space control element (HASCE), which | +| | | points to the home space region/segment | +| | | table origin. | +| | | | +| | | See "Address Spaces on Linux for s/390 & | +| | | z/Architecture" below for more information | +| | | about address space usage in Linux. | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 18-19 | 18-19 | Condition codes (CC) | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 20 | 20 | Fixed point overflow mask if 1=FPU exceptions | +| | | for this event occur (normally 0) | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 21 | 21 | Decimal overflow mask if 1=FPU exceptions for | +| | | this event occur (normally 0) | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 22 | 22 | Exponent underflow mask if 1=FPU exceptions | +| | | for this event occur (normally 0) | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 23 | 23 | Significance Mask if 1=FPU exceptions for this | +| | | event occur (normally 0) | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 24-31 | 24-30 | Reserved Must be 0. | +| +----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| | 31 | Extended Addressing Mode | +| +----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| | 32 | Basic Addressing Mode | +| | | | +| | | Used to set addressing mode | +| | | | +| | | +---------+----------+----------+ | +| | | | PSW 31 | PSW 32 | | | +| | | +---------+----------+----------+ | +| | | | 0 | 0 | 24 bit | | +| | | +---------+----------+----------+ | +| | | | 0 | 1 | 31 bit | | +| | | +---------+----------+----------+ | +| | | | 1 | 1 | 64 bit | | +| | | +---------+----------+----------+ | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 32 | | 1=31 bit addressing mode 0=24 bit addressing | +| | | mode (for backward compatibility), linux | +| | | always runs with this bit set to 1 | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| 33-64 | | Instruction address. | +| +----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| | 33-63 | Reserved must be 0 | +| +----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ +| | 64-127 | Address | +| | | | +| | | - In 24 bits mode bits 64-103=0 bits 104-127 | +| | | Address | +| | | - In 31 bits mode bits 64-96=0 bits 97-127 | +| | | Address | +| | | | +| | | Note: | +| | | unlike 31 bit mode on s/390 bit 96 must be | +| | | zero when loading the address with LPSWE | +| | | otherwise a specification exception occurs, | +| | | LPSW is fully backward compatible. | ++--------+----------------+-------------------------------------------------+ + +Prefix Page(s) +-------------- +This per cpu memory area is too intimately tied to the processor not to mention. +It exists between the real addresses 0-4096 on s/390 and between 0-8192 on +z/Architecture and is exchanged with one page on s/390 or two pages on +z/Architecture in absolute storage by the set prefix instruction during Linux +startup. + +This page is mapped to a different prefix for each processor in an SMP +configuration (assuming the OS designer is sane of course). + +Bytes 0-512 (200 hex) on s/390 and 0-512, 4096-4544, 4604-5119 currently on +z/Architecture are used by the processor itself for holding such information +as exception indications and entry points for exceptions. + +Bytes after 0xc00 hex are used by linux for per processor globals on s/390 and +z/Architecture (there is a gap on z/Architecture currently between 0xc00 and +0x1000, too, which is used by Linux). + +The closest thing to this on traditional architectures is the interrupt +vector table. This is a good thing & does simplify some of the kernel coding +however it means that we now cannot catch stray NULL pointers in the +kernel without hard coded checks. + + + +Address Spaces on Intel Linux +============================= + +The traditional Intel Linux is approximately mapped as follows forgive +the ascii art:: + + 0xFFFFFFFF 4GB Himem ***************** + * * + * Kernel Space * + * * + ***************** **************** + User Space Himem * User Stack * * * + (typically 0xC0000000 3GB ) ***************** * * + * Shared Libs * * Next Process * + ***************** * to * + * * <== * Run * <== + * User Program * * * + * Data BSS * * * + * Text * * * + * Sections * * * + 0x00000000 ***************** **************** + +Now it is easy to see that on Intel it is quite easy to recognise a kernel +address as being one greater than user space himem (in this case 0xC0000000), +and addresses of less than this are the ones in the current running program on +this processor (if an smp box). + +If using the virtual machine ( VM ) as a debugger it is quite difficult to +know which user process is running as the address space you are looking at +could be from any process in the run queue. + +The limitation of Intels addressing technique is that the linux +kernel uses a very simple real address to virtual addressing technique +of Real Address=Virtual Address-User Space Himem. +This means that on Intel the kernel linux can typically only address +Himem=0xFFFFFFFF-0xC0000000=1GB & this is all the RAM these machines +can typically use. + +They can lower User Himem to 2GB or lower & thus be +able to use 2GB of RAM however this shrinks the maximum size +of User Space from 3GB to 2GB they have a no win limit of 4GB unless +they go to 64 Bit. + + +On 390 our limitations & strengths make us slightly different. +For backward compatibility we are only allowed use 31 bits (2GB) +of our 32 bit addresses, however, we use entirely separate address +spaces for the user & kernel. + +This means we can support 2GB of non Extended RAM on s/390, & more +with the Extended memory management swap device & +currently 4TB of physical memory currently on z/Architecture. + + +Address Spaces on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture +================================================== + +Our addressing scheme is basically as follows:: + + Primary Space Home Space + Himem 0x7fffffff 2GB on s/390 ***************** **************** + currently 0x3ffffffffff (2^42)-1 * User Stack * * * + on z/Architecture. ***************** * * + * Shared Libs * * * + ***************** * * + * * * Kernel * + * User Program * * * + * Data BSS * * * + * Text * * * + * Sections * * * + 0x00000000 ***************** **************** + +This also means that we need to look at the PSW problem state bit and the +addressing mode to decide whether we are looking at user or kernel space. + +User space runs in primary address mode (or access register mode within +the vdso code). + +The kernel usually also runs in home space mode, however when accessing +user space the kernel switches to primary or secondary address mode if +the mvcos instruction is not available or if a compare-and-swap (futex) +instruction on a user space address is performed. + +When also looking at the ASCE control registers, this means: + +User space: + +- runs in primary or access register mode +- cr1 contains the user asce +- cr7 contains the user asce +- cr13 contains the kernel asce + +Kernel space: + +- runs in home space mode +- cr1 contains the user or kernel asce + + - the kernel asce is loaded when a uaccess requires primary or + secondary address mode + +- cr7 contains the user or kernel asce, (changed with set_fs()) +- cr13 contains the kernel asce + +In case of uaccess the kernel changes to: + +- primary space mode in case of a uaccess (copy_to_user) and uses + e.g. the mvcp instruction to access user space. However the kernel + will stay in home space mode if the mvcos instruction is available +- secondary space mode in case of futex atomic operations, so that the + instructions come from primary address space and data from secondary + space + +In case of KVM, the kernel runs in home space mode, but cr1 gets switched +to contain the gmap asce before the SIE instruction gets executed. When +the SIE instruction is finished, cr1 will be switched back to contain the +user asce. + + +Virtual Addresses on s/390 & z/Architecture +=========================================== + +A virtual address on s/390 is made up of 3 parts +The SX (segment index, roughly corresponding to the PGD & PMD in Linux +terminology) being bits 1-11. + +The PX (page index, corresponding to the page table entry (pte) in Linux +terminology) being bits 12-19. + +The remaining bits BX (the byte index are the offset in the page ) +i.e. bits 20 to 31. + +On z/Architecture in linux we currently make up an address from 4 parts. + +- The region index bits (RX) 0-32 we currently use bits 22-32 +- The segment index (SX) being bits 33-43 +- The page index (PX) being bits 44-51 +- The byte index (BX) being bits 52-63 + +Notes: + 1) s/390 has no PMD so the PMD is really the PGD also. + A lot of this stuff is defined in pgtable.h. + + 2) Also seeing as s/390's page indexes are only 1k in size + (bits 12-19 x 4 bytes per pte ) we use 1 ( page 4k ) + to make the best use of memory by updating 4 segment indices + entries each time we mess with a PMD & use offsets + 0,1024,2048 & 3072 in this page as for our segment indexes. + On z/Architecture our page indexes are now 2k in size + ( bits 12-19 x 8 bytes per pte ) we do a similar trick + but only mess with 2 segment indices each time we mess with + a PMD. + + 3) As z/Architecture supports up to a massive 5-level page table lookup we + can only use 3 currently on Linux ( as this is all the generic kernel + currently supports ) however this may change in future + this allows us to access ( according to my sums ) + 4TB of virtual storage per process i.e. + 4096*512(PTES)*1024(PMDS)*2048(PGD) = 4398046511104 bytes, + enough for another 2 or 3 of years I think :-). + to do this we use a region-third-table designation type in + our address space control registers. + + +The Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture Kernel Task Structure +========================================================== +Each process/thread under Linux for S390 has its own kernel task_struct +defined in linux/include/linux/sched.h +The S390 on initialisation & resuming of a process on a cpu sets +the __LC_KERNEL_STACK variable in the spare prefix area for this cpu +(which we use for per-processor globals). + +The kernel stack pointer is intimately tied with the task structure for +each processor as follows:: + + s/390 + ************************ + * 1 page kernel stack * + * ( 4K ) * + ************************ + * 1 page task_struct * + * ( 4K ) * + 8K aligned ************************ + + z/Architecture + ************************ + * 2 page kernel stack * + * ( 8K ) * + ************************ + * 2 page task_struct * + * ( 8K ) * + 16K aligned ************************ + +What this means is that we don't need to dedicate any register or global +variable to point to the current running process & can retrieve it with the +following very simple construct for s/390 & one very similar for +z/Architecture:: + + static inline struct task_struct * get_current(void) + { + struct task_struct *current; + __asm__("lhi %0,-8192\n\t" + "nr %0,15" + : "=r" (current) ); + return current; + } + +i.e. just anding the current kernel stack pointer with the mask -8192. +Thankfully because Linux doesn't have support for nested IO interrupts +& our devices have large buffers can survive interrupts being shut for +short amounts of time we don't need a separate stack for interrupts. + + + + +Register Usage & Stackframes on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture +================================================================= +Overview: +--------- +This is the code that gcc produces at the top & the bottom of +each function. It usually is fairly consistent & similar from +function to function & if you know its layout you can probably +make some headway in finding the ultimate cause of a problem +after a crash without a source level debugger. + +Note: To follow stackframes requires a knowledge of C or Pascal & +limited knowledge of one assembly language. + +It should be noted that there are some differences between the +s/390 and z/Architecture stack layouts as the z/Architecture stack layout +didn't have to maintain compatibility with older linkage formats. + +Glossary: +--------- +alloca: + This is a built in compiler function for runtime allocation + of extra space on the callers stack which is obviously freed + up on function exit ( e.g. the caller may choose to allocate nothing + of a buffer of 4k if required for temporary purposes ), it generates + very efficient code ( a few cycles ) when compared to alternatives + like malloc. + +automatics: + These are local variables on the stack, i.e they aren't in registers & + they aren't static. + +back-chain: + This is a pointer to the stack pointer before entering a + framed functions ( see frameless function ) prologue got by + dereferencing the address of the current stack pointer, + i.e. got by accessing the 32 bit value at the stack pointers + current location. + +base-pointer: + This is a pointer to the back of the literal pool which + is an area just behind each procedure used to store constants + in each function. + +call-clobbered: + The caller probably needs to save these registers if there + is something of value in them, on the stack or elsewhere before making a + call to another procedure so that it can restore it later. + +epilogue: + The code generated by the compiler to return to the caller. + +frameless-function: + A frameless function in Linux for s390 & z/Architecture is one which doesn't + need more than the register save area (96 bytes on s/390, 160 on z/Architecture) + given to it by the caller. + + A frameless function never: + + 1) Sets up a back chain. + 2) Calls alloca. + 3) Calls other normal functions + 4) Has automatics. + +GOT-pointer: + This is a pointer to the global-offset-table in ELF + ( Executable Linkable Format, Linux'es most common executable format ), + all globals & shared library objects are found using this pointer. + +lazy-binding + ELF shared libraries are typically only loaded when routines in the shared + library are actually first called at runtime. This is lazy binding. + +procedure-linkage-table + This is a table found from the GOT which contains pointers to routines + in other shared libraries which can't be called to by easier means. + +prologue: + The code generated by the compiler to set up the stack frame. + +outgoing-args: + This is extra area allocated on the stack of the calling function if the + parameters for the callee's cannot all be put in registers, the same + area can be reused by each function the caller calls. + +routine-descriptor: + A COFF executable format based concept of a procedure reference + actually being 8 bytes or more as opposed to a simple pointer to the routine. + This is typically defined as follows: + + - Routine Descriptor offset 0=Pointer to Function + - Routine Descriptor offset 4=Pointer to Table of Contents + + The table of contents/TOC is roughly equivalent to a GOT pointer. + & it means that shared libraries etc. can be shared between several + environments each with their own TOC. + +static-chain: + This is used in nested functions a concept adopted from pascal + by gcc not used in ansi C or C++ ( although quite useful ), basically it + is a pointer used to reference local variables of enclosing functions. + You might come across this stuff once or twice in your lifetime. + + e.g. + + The function below should return 11 though gcc may get upset & toss warnings + about unused variables:: + + int FunctionA(int a) + { + int b; + FunctionC(int c) + { + b=c+1; + } + FunctionC(10); + return(b); + } + + +s/390 & z/Architecture Register usage +===================================== + +======== ========================================== =============== +r0 used by syscalls/assembly call-clobbered +r1 used by syscalls/assembly call-clobbered +r2 argument 0 / return value 0 call-clobbered +r3 argument 1 / return value 1 (if long long) call-clobbered +r4 argument 2 call-clobbered +r5 argument 3 call-clobbered +r6 argument 4 saved +r7 pointer-to arguments 5 to ... saved +r8 this & that saved +r9 this & that saved +r10 static-chain ( if nested function ) saved +r11 frame-pointer ( if function used alloca ) saved +r12 got-pointer saved +r13 base-pointer saved +r14 return-address saved +r15 stack-pointer saved + +f0 argument 0 / return value ( float/double ) call-clobbered +f2 argument 1 call-clobbered +f4 z/Architecture argument 2 saved +f6 z/Architecture argument 3 saved +======== ========================================== =============== + +The remaining floating points +f1,f3,f5 f7-f15 are call-clobbered. + +Notes: +------ +1) The only requirement is that registers which are used + by the callee are saved, e.g. the compiler is perfectly + capable of using r11 for purposes other than a frame a + frame pointer if a frame pointer is not needed. +2) In functions with variable arguments e.g. printf the calling procedure + is identical to one without variable arguments & the same number of + parameters. However, the prologue of this function is somewhat more + hairy owing to it having to move these parameters to the stack to + get va_start, va_arg & va_end to work. +3) Access registers are currently unused by gcc but are used in + the kernel. Possibilities exist to use them at the moment for + temporary storage but it isn't recommended. +4) Only 4 of the floating point registers are used for + parameter passing as older machines such as G3 only have only 4 + & it keeps the stack frame compatible with other compilers. + However with IEEE floating point emulation under linux on the + older machines you are free to use the other 12. +5) A long long or double parameter cannot be have the + first 4 bytes in a register & the second four bytes in the + outgoing args area. It must be purely in the outgoing args + area if crossing this boundary. +6) Floating point parameters are mixed with outgoing args + on the outgoing args area in the order the are passed in as parameters. +7) Floating point arguments 2 & 3 are saved in the outgoing args area for + z/Architecture + + +Stack Frame Layout +------------------ + +========= ============== ====================================================== +s/390 z/Architecture +========= ============== ====================================================== +0 0 back chain ( a 0 here signifies end of back chain ) +4 8 eos ( end of stack, not used on Linux for S390 used + in other linkage formats ) +8 16 glue used in other s/390 linkage formats for saved + routine descriptors etc. +12 24 glue used in other s/390 linkage formats for saved + routine descriptors etc. +16 32 scratch area +20 40 scratch area +24 48 saved r6 of caller function +28 56 saved r7 of caller function +32 64 saved r8 of caller function +36 72 saved r9 of caller function +40 80 saved r10 of caller function +44 88 saved r11 of caller function +48 96 saved r12 of caller function +52 104 saved r13 of caller function +56 112 saved r14 of caller function +60 120 saved r15 of caller function +64 128 saved f4 of caller function +72 132 saved f6 of caller function +80 undefined +96 160 outgoing args passed from caller to callee +96+x 160+x possible stack alignment ( 8 bytes desirable ) +96+x+y 160+x+y alloca space of caller ( if used ) +96+x+y+z 160+x+y+z automatics of caller ( if used ) +0 back-chain +========= ============== ====================================================== + +A sample program with comments. +=============================== + +Comments on the function test +----------------------------- +1) It didn't need to set up a pointer to the constant pool gpr13 as it is not + used ( :-( ). +2) This is a frameless function & no stack is bought. +3) The compiler was clever enough to recognise that it could return the + value in r2 as well as use it for the passed in parameter ( :-) ). +4) The basr ( branch relative & save ) trick works as follows the instruction + has a special case with r0,r0 with some instruction operands is understood as + the literal value 0, some risc architectures also do this ). So now + we are branching to the next address & the address new program counter is + in r13,so now we subtract the size of the function prologue we have executed + the size of the literal pool to get to the top of the literal pool:: + + + 0040037c int test(int b) + { # Function prologue below + 40037c: 90 de f0 34 stm %r13,%r14,52(%r15) # Save registers r13 & r14 + 400380: 0d d0 basr %r13,%r0 # Set up pointer to constant pool using + 400382: a7 da ff fa ahi %r13,-6 # basr trick + return(5+b); + # Huge main program + 400386: a7 2a 00 05 ahi %r2,5 # add 5 to r2 + + # Function epilogue below + 40038a: 98 de f0 34 lm %r13,%r14,52(%r15) # restore registers r13 & 14 + 40038e: 07 fe br %r14 # return + } + +Comments on the function main +----------------------------- +1) The compiler did this function optimally ( 8-) ):: + + Literal pool for main. + 400390: ff ff ff ec .long 0xffffffec + main(int argc,char *argv[]) + { # Function prologue below + 400394: 90 bf f0 2c stm %r11,%r15,44(%r15) # Save necessary registers + 400398: 18 0f lr %r0,%r15 # copy stack pointer to r0 + 40039a: a7 fa ff a0 ahi %r15,-96 # Make area for callee saving + 40039e: 0d d0 basr %r13,%r0 # Set up r13 to point to + 4003a0: a7 da ff f0 ahi %r13,-16 # literal pool + 4003a4: 50 00 f0 00 st %r0,0(%r15) # Save backchain + + return(test(5)); # Main Program Below + 4003a8: 58 e0 d0 00 l %r14,0(%r13) # load relative address of test from + # literal pool + 4003ac: a7 28 00 05 lhi %r2,5 # Set first parameter to 5 + 4003b0: 4d ee d0 00 bas %r14,0(%r14,%r13) # jump to test setting r14 as return + # address using branch & save instruction. + + # Function Epilogue below + 4003b4: 98 bf f0 8c lm %r11,%r15,140(%r15)# Restore necessary registers. + 4003b8: 07 fe br %r14 # return to do program exit + } + + +Compiler updates +---------------- + +:: + + main(int argc,char *argv[]) + { + 4004fc: 90 7f f0 1c stm %r7,%r15,28(%r15) + 400500: a7 d5 00 04 bras %r13,400508 <main+0xc> + 400504: 00 40 04 f4 .long 0x004004f4 + # compiler now puts constant pool in code to so it saves an instruction + 400508: 18 0f lr %r0,%r15 + 40050a: a7 fa ff a0 ahi %r15,-96 + 40050e: 50 00 f0 00 st %r0,0(%r15) + return(test(5)); + 400512: 58 10 d0 00 l %r1,0(%r13) + 400516: a7 28 00 05 lhi %r2,5 + 40051a: 0d e1 basr %r14,%r1 + # compiler adds 1 extra instruction to epilogue this is done to + # avoid processor pipeline stalls owing to data dependencies on g5 & + # above as register 14 in the old code was needed directly after being loaded + # by the lm %r11,%r15,140(%r15) for the br %14. + 40051c: 58 40 f0 98 l %r4,152(%r15) + 400520: 98 7f f0 7c lm %r7,%r15,124(%r15) + 400524: 07 f4 br %r4 + } + + +Hartmut ( our compiler developer ) also has been threatening to take out the +stack backchain in optimised code as this also causes pipeline stalls, you +have been warned. + +64 bit z/Architecture code disassembly +-------------------------------------- + +If you understand the stuff above you'll understand the stuff +below too so I'll avoid repeating myself & just say that +some of the instructions have g's on the end of them to indicate +they are 64 bit & the stack offsets are a bigger, +the only other difference you'll find between 32 & 64 bit is that +we now use f4 & f6 for floating point arguments on 64 bit:: + + 00000000800005b0 <test>: + int test(int b) + { + return(5+b); + 800005b0: a7 2a 00 05 ahi %r2,5 + 800005b4: b9 14 00 22 lgfr %r2,%r2 # downcast to integer + 800005b8: 07 fe br %r14 + 800005ba: 07 07 bcr 0,%r7 + + + } + + 00000000800005bc <main>: + main(int argc,char *argv[]) + { + 800005bc: eb bf f0 58 00 24 stmg %r11,%r15,88(%r15) + 800005c2: b9 04 00 1f lgr %r1,%r15 + 800005c6: a7 fb ff 60 aghi %r15,-160 + 800005ca: e3 10 f0 00 00 24 stg %r1,0(%r15) + return(test(5)); + 800005d0: a7 29 00 05 lghi %r2,5 + # brasl allows jumps > 64k & is overkill here bras would do fune + 800005d4: c0 e5 ff ff ff ee brasl %r14,800005b0 <test> + 800005da: e3 40 f1 10 00 04 lg %r4,272(%r15) + 800005e0: eb bf f0 f8 00 04 lmg %r11,%r15,248(%r15) + 800005e6: 07 f4 br %r4 + } + + + +Compiling programs for debugging on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture +==================================================================== +-gdwarf-2 now works it should be considered the default debugging +format for s/390 & z/Architecture as it is more reliable for debugging +shared libraries, normal -g debugging works much better now +Thanks to the IBM java compiler developers bug reports. + +This is typically done adding/appending the flags -g or -gdwarf-2 to the +CFLAGS & LDFLAGS variables Makefile of the program concerned. + +If using gdb & you would like accurate displays of registers & +stack traces compile without optimisation i.e make sure +that there is no -O2 or similar on the CFLAGS line of the Makefile & +the emitted gcc commands, obviously this will produce worse code +( not advisable for shipment ) but it is an aid to the debugging process. + +This aids debugging because the compiler will copy parameters passed in +in registers onto the stack so backtracing & looking at passed in +parameters will work, however some larger programs which use inline functions +will not compile without optimisation. + +Debugging with optimisation has since much improved after fixing +some bugs, please make sure you are using gdb-5.0 or later developed +after Nov'2000. + + + +Debugging under VM +================== + +Notes +----- +Addresses & values in the VM debugger are always hex never decimal +Address ranges are of the format <HexValue1>-<HexValue2> or +<HexValue1>.<HexValue2> +For example, the address range 0x2000 to 0x3000 can be described as 2000-3000 +or 2000.1000 + +The VM Debugger is case insensitive. + +VM's strengths are usually other debuggers weaknesses you can get at any +resource no matter how sensitive e.g. memory management resources, change +address translation in the PSW. For kernel hacking you will reap dividends if +you get good at it. + +The VM Debugger displays operators but not operands, and also the debugger +displays useful information on the same line as the author of the code probably +felt that it was a good idea not to go over the 80 columns on the screen. +This isn't as unintuitive as it may seem as the s/390 instructions are easy to +decode mentally and you can make a good guess at a lot of them as all the +operands are nibble (half byte aligned). +So if you have an objdump listing by hand, it is quite easy to follow, and if +you don't have an objdump listing keep a copy of the s/390 Reference Summary +or alternatively the s/390 principles of operation next to you. +e.g. even I can guess that +0001AFF8' LR 180F CC 0 +is a ( load register ) lr r0,r15 + +Also it is very easy to tell the length of a 390 instruction from the 2 most +significant bits in the instruction (not that this info is really useful except +if you are trying to make sense of a hexdump of code). +Here is a table + +======================= ================== +Bits Instruction Length +======================= ================== +00 2 Bytes +01 4 Bytes +10 4 Bytes +11 6 Bytes +======================= ================== + +The debugger also displays other useful info on the same line such as the +addresses being operated on destination addresses of branches & condition codes. +e.g.:: + + 00019736' AHI A7DAFF0E CC 1 + 000198BA' BRC A7840004 -> 000198C2' CC 0 + 000198CE' STM 900EF068 >> 0FA95E78 CC 2 + + + +Useful VM debugger commands +--------------------------- + +I suppose I'd better mention this before I start +to list the current active traces do:: + + Q TR + +there can be a maximum of 255 of these per set +( more about trace sets later ). + +To stop traces issue a:: + + TR END. + +To delete a particular breakpoint issue:: + + TR DEL <breakpoint number> + +The PA1 key drops to CP mode so you can issue debugger commands, +Doing alt c (on my 3270 console at least ) clears the screen. + +hitting b <enter> comes back to the running operating system +from cp mode ( in our case linux ). + +It is typically useful to add shortcuts to your profile.exec file +if you have one ( this is roughly equivalent to autoexec.bat in DOS ). +file here are a few from mine:: + + /* this gives me command history on issuing f12 */ + set pf12 retrieve + /* this continues */ + set pf8 imm b + /* goes to trace set a */ + set pf1 imm tr goto a + /* goes to trace set b */ + set pf2 imm tr goto b + /* goes to trace set c */ + set pf3 imm tr goto c + + + +Instruction Tracing +------------------- +Setting a simple breakpoint:: + + TR I PSWA <address> + +To debug a particular function try:: + + TR I R <function address range> + TR I on its own will single step. + TR I DATA <MNEMONIC> <OPTIONAL RANGE> will trace for particular mnemonics + +e.g.:: + + TR I DATA 4D R 0197BC.4000 + +will trace for BAS'es ( opcode 4D ) in the range 0197BC.4000 + +if you were inclined you could add traces for all branch instructions & +suffix them with the run prefix so you would have a backtrace on screen +when a program crashes:: + + TR BR <INTO OR FROM> will trace branches into or out of an address. + +e.g.:: + + TR BR INTO 0 + +is often quite useful if a program is getting awkward & deciding +to branch to 0 & crashing as this will stop at the address before in jumps to 0. + +:: + + TR I R <address range> RUN cmd d g + +single steps a range of addresses but stays running & +displays the gprs on each step. + + + +Displaying & modifying Registers +-------------------------------- +D G + will display all the gprs + +Adding a extra G to all the commands is necessary to access the full 64 bit +content in VM on z/Architecture. Obviously this isn't required for access +registers as these are still 32 bit. + +e.g. + +DGG + instead of DG + +D X + will display all the control registers +D AR + will display all the access registers +D AR4-7 + will display access registers 4 to 7 +CPU ALL D G + will display the GRPS of all CPUS in the configuration +D PSW + will display the current PSW +st PSW 2000 + will put the value 2000 into the PSW & cause crash your machine. +D PREFIX + displays the prefix offset + + +Displaying Memory +----------------- +To display memory mapped using the current PSW's mapping try:: + + D <range> + +To make VM display a message each time it hits a particular address and +continue try: + +D I<range> + will disassemble/display a range of instructions. + +ST addr 32 bit word + will store a 32 bit aligned address +D T<range> + will display the EBCDIC in an address (if you are that way inclined) +D R<range> + will display real addresses ( without DAT ) but with prefixing. + +There are other complex options to display if you need to get at say home space +but are in primary space the easiest thing to do is to temporarily +modify the PSW to the other addressing mode, display the stuff & then +restore it. + + + +Hints +----- +If you want to issue a debugger command without halting your virtual machine +with the PA1 key try prefixing the command with #CP e.g.:: + + #cp tr i pswa 2000 + +also suffixing most debugger commands with RUN will cause them not +to stop just display the mnemonic at the current instruction on the console. + +If you have several breakpoints you want to put into your program & +you get fed up of cross referencing with System.map +you can do the following trick for several symbols. + +:: + + grep do_signal System.map + +which emits the following among other things:: + + 0001f4e0 T do_signal + +now you can do:: + + TR I PSWA 0001f4e0 cmd msg * do_signal + +This sends a message to your own console each time do_signal is entered. +( As an aside I wrote a perl script once which automatically generated a REXX +script with breakpoints on every kernel procedure, this isn't a good idea +because there are thousands of these routines & VM can only set 255 breakpoints +at a time so you nearly had to spend as long pruning the file down as you would +entering the msgs by hand), however, the trick might be useful for a single +object file. In the 3270 terminal emulator x3270 there is a very useful option +in the file menu called "Save Screen In File" - this is very good for keeping a +copy of traces. + +From CMS help <command name> will give you online help on a particular command. +e.g.:: + + HELP DISPLAY + +Also CP has a file called profile.exec which automatically gets called +on startup of CMS ( like autoexec.bat ), keeping on a DOS analogy session +CP has a feature similar to doskey, it may be useful for you to +use profile.exec to define some keystrokes. + +SET PF9 IMM B + This does a single step in VM on pressing F8. + +SET PF10 ^ + This sets up the ^ key. + which can be used for ^c (ctrl-c),^z (ctrl-z) which can't be typed + directly into some 3270 consoles. + +SET PF11 ^- + This types the starting keystrokes for a sysrq see SysRq below. +SET PF12 RETRIEVE + This retrieves command history on pressing F12. + + +Sometimes in VM the display is set up to scroll automatically this +can be very annoying if there are messages you wish to look at +to stop this do + +TERM MORE 255 255 + This will nearly stop automatic screen updates, however it will + cause a denial of service if lots of messages go to the 3270 console, + so it would be foolish to use this as the default on a production machine. + + +Tracing particular processes +---------------------------- +The kernel's text segment is intentionally at an address in memory that it will +very seldom collide with text segments of user programs ( thanks Martin ), +this simplifies debugging the kernel. +However it is quite common for user processes to have addresses which collide +this can make debugging a particular process under VM painful under normal +circumstances as the process may change when doing a:: + + TR I R <address range>. + +Thankfully after reading VM's online help I figured out how to debug +I particular process. + +Your first problem is to find the STD ( segment table designation ) +of the program you wish to debug. +There are several ways you can do this here are a few + +Run:: + + objdump --syms <program to be debugged> | grep main + +To get the address of main in the program. Then:: + + tr i pswa <address of main> + +Start the program, if VM drops to CP on what looks like the entry +point of the main function this is most likely the process you wish to debug. +Now do a D X13 or D XG13 on z/Architecture. + +On 31 bit the STD is bits 1-19 ( the STO segment table origin ) +& 25-31 ( the STL segment table length ) of CR13. + +now type:: + + TR I R STD <CR13's value> 0.7fffffff + +e.g.:: + + TR I R STD 8F32E1FF 0.7fffffff + +Another very useful variation is:: + + TR STORE INTO STD <CR13's value> <address range> + +for finding out when a particular variable changes. + +An alternative way of finding the STD of a currently running process +is to do the following, ( this method is more complex but +could be quite convenient if you aren't updating the kernel much & +so your kernel structures will stay constant for a reasonable period of +time ). + +:: + + grep task /proc/<pid>/status + +from this you should see something like:: + + task: 0f160000 ksp: 0f161de8 pt_regs: 0f161f68 + +This now gives you a pointer to the task structure. + +Now make:: + + CC:="s390-gcc -g" kernel/sched.s + +To get the task_struct stabinfo. + +( task_struct is defined in include/linux/sched.h ). + +Now we want to look at +task->active_mm->pgd + +on my machine the active_mm in the task structure stab is +active_mm:(4,12),672,32 + +its offset is 672/8=84=0x54 + +the pgd member in the mm_struct stab is +pgd:(4,6)=*(29,5),96,32 +so its offset is 96/8=12=0xc + +so we'll:: + + hexdump -s 0xf160054 /dev/mem | more + +i.e. task_struct+active_mm offset +to look at the active_mm member:: + + f160054 0fee cc60 0019 e334 0000 0000 0000 0011 + +:: + + hexdump -s 0x0feecc6c /dev/mem | more + +i.e. active_mm+pgd offset:: + + feecc6c 0f2c 0000 0000 0001 0000 0001 0000 0010 + +we get something like +now do:: + + TR I R STD <pgd|0x7f> 0.7fffffff + +i.e. the 0x7f is added because the pgd only +gives the page table origin & we need to set the low bits +to the maximum possible segment table length. + +:: + + TR I R STD 0f2c007f 0.7fffffff + +on z/Architecture you'll probably need to do:: + + TR I R STD <pgd|0x7> 0.ffffffffffffffff + +to set the TableType to 0x1 & the Table length to 3. + + + +Tracing Program Exceptions +-------------------------- +If you get a crash which says something like +illegal operation or specification exception followed by a register dump +You can restart linux & trace these using the tr prog <range or value> trace +option. + + +The most common ones you will normally be tracing for is: + +- 1=operation exception +- 2=privileged operation exception +- 4=protection exception +- 5=addressing exception +- 6=specification exception +- 10=segment translation exception +- 11=page translation exception + +The full list of these is on page 22 of the current s/390 Reference Summary. +e.g. + +tr prog 10 will trace segment translation exceptions. + +tr prog on its own will trace all program interruption codes. + +Trace Sets +---------- +On starting VM you are initially in the INITIAL trace set. +You can do a Q TR to verify this. +If you have a complex tracing situation where you wish to wait for instance +till a driver is open before you start tracing IO, but know in your +heart that you are going to have to make several runs through the code till you +have a clue whats going on. + +What you can do is:: + + TR I PSWA <Driver open address> + +hit b to continue till breakpoint + +reach the breakpoint + +now do your:: + + TR GOTO B + TR IO 7c08-7c09 inst int run + +or whatever the IO channels you wish to trace are & hit b + +To got back to the initial trace set do:: + + TR GOTO INITIAL + +& the TR I PSWA <Driver open address> will be the only active breakpoint again. + + +Tracing linux syscalls under VM +------------------------------- +Syscalls are implemented on Linux for S390 by the Supervisor call instruction +(SVC). There 256 possibilities of these as the instruction is made up of a 0xA +opcode and the second byte being the syscall number. They are traced using the +simple command:: + + TR SVC <Optional value or range> + +the syscalls are defined in linux/arch/s390/include/asm/unistd.h +e.g. to trace all file opens just do:: + + TR SVC 5 ( as this is the syscall number of open ) + + +SMP Specific commands +--------------------- +To find out how many cpus you have +Q CPUS displays all the CPU's available to your virtual machine +To find the cpu that the current cpu VM debugger commands are being directed at +do Q CPU to change the current cpu VM debugger commands are being directed at +do:: + + CPU <desired cpu no> + +On a SMP guest issue a command to all CPUs try prefixing the command with cpu +all. To issue a command to a particular cpu try cpu <cpu number> e.g.:: + + CPU 01 TR I R 2000.3000 + +If you are running on a guest with several cpus & you have a IO related problem +& cannot follow the flow of code but you know it isn't smp related. + +from the bash prompt issue:: + + shutdown -h now or halt. + +do a:: + + Q CPUS + +to find out how many cpus you have detach each one of them from cp except +cpu 0 by issuing a:: + + DETACH CPU 01-(number of cpus in configuration) + +& boot linux again. + +TR SIGP + will trace inter processor signal processor instructions. + +DEFINE CPU 01-(number in configuration) + will get your guests cpus back. + + +Help for displaying ascii textstrings +------------------------------------- +On the very latest VM Nucleus'es VM can now display ascii +( thanks Neale for the hint ) by doing:: + + D TX<lowaddr>.<len> + +e.g.:: + + D TX0.100 + +Alternatively +============= +Under older VM debuggers (I love EBDIC too) you can use following little +program which converts a command line of hex digits to ascii text. It can be +compiled under linux and you can copy the hex digits from your x3270 terminal +to your xterm if you are debugging from a linuxbox. + +This is quite useful when looking at a parameter passed in as a text string +under VM ( unless you are good at decoding ASCII in your head ). + +e.g. consider tracing an open syscall:: + + TR SVC 5 + +We have stopped at a breakpoint:: + + 000151B0' SVC 0A05 -> 0001909A' CC 0 + +D 20.8 to check the SVC old psw in the prefix area and see was it from userspace +(for the layout of the prefix area consult the "Fixed Storage Locations" +chapter of the s/390 Reference Summary if you have it available). + +:: + + V00000020 070C2000 800151B2 + +The problem state bit wasn't set & it's also too early in the boot sequence +for it to be a userspace SVC if it was we would have to temporarily switch the +psw to user space addressing so we could get at the first parameter of the open +in gpr2. + +Next do a:: + + D G2 + GPR 2 = 00014CB4 + +Now display what gpr2 is pointing to:: + + D 00014CB4.20 + V00014CB4 2F646576 2F636F6E 736F6C65 00001BF5 + V00014CC4 FC00014C B4001001 E0001000 B8070707 + +Now copy the text till the first 00 hex ( which is the end of the string +to an xterm & do hex2ascii on it:: + + hex2ascii 2F646576 2F636F6E 736F6C65 00 + +outputs:: + + Decoded Hex:=/ d e v / c o n s o l e 0x00 + +We were opening the console device, + +You can compile the code below yourself for practice :-), + +:: + + /* + * hex2ascii.c + * a useful little tool for converting a hexadecimal command line to ascii + * + * Author(s): Denis Joseph Barrow (djbarrow@de.ibm.com,barrow_dj@yahoo.com) + * (C) 2000 IBM Deutschland Entwicklung GmbH, IBM Corporation. + */ + #include <stdio.h> + + int main(int argc,char *argv[]) + { + int cnt1,cnt2,len,toggle=0; + int startcnt=1; + unsigned char c,hex; + + if(argc>1&&(strcmp(argv[1],"-a")==0)) + startcnt=2; + printf("Decoded Hex:="); + for(cnt1=startcnt;cnt1<argc;cnt1++) + { + len=strlen(argv[cnt1]); + for(cnt2=0;cnt2<len;cnt2++) + { + c=argv[cnt1][cnt2]; + if(c>='0'&&c<='9') + c=c-'0'; + if(c>='A'&&c<='F') + c=c-'A'+10; + if(c>='a'&&c<='f') + c=c-'a'+10; + switch(toggle) + { + case 0: + hex=c<<4; + toggle=1; + break; + case 1: + hex+=c; + if(hex<32||hex>127) + { + if(startcnt==1) + printf("0x%02X ",(int)hex); + else + printf("."); + } + else + { + printf("%c",hex); + if(startcnt==1) + printf(" "); + } + toggle=0; + break; + } + } + } + printf("\n"); + } + + + + +Stack tracing under VM +---------------------- +A basic backtrace +----------------- + +Here are the tricks I use 9 out of 10 times it works pretty well, + +When your backchain reaches a dead end +-------------------------------------- +This can happen when an exception happens in the kernel and the kernel is +entered twice. If you reach the NULL pointer at the end of the back chain you +should be able to sniff further back if you follow the following tricks. +1) A kernel address should be easy to recognise since it is in +primary space & the problem state bit isn't set & also +The Hi bit of the address is set. +2) Another backchain should also be easy to recognise since it is an +address pointing to another address approximately 100 bytes or 0x70 hex +behind the current stackpointer. + + +Here is some practice. + +boot the kernel & hit PA1 at some random time + +d g to display the gprs, this should display something like:: + + GPR 0 = 00000001 00156018 0014359C 00000000 + GPR 4 = 00000001 001B8888 000003E0 00000000 + GPR 8 = 00100080 00100084 00000000 000FE000 + GPR 12 = 00010400 8001B2DC 8001B36A 000FFED8 + +Note that GPR14 is a return address but as we are real men we are going to +trace the stack. +display 0x40 bytes after the stack pointer:: + + V000FFED8 000FFF38 8001B838 80014C8E 000FFF38 + V000FFEE8 00000000 00000000 000003E0 00000000 + V000FFEF8 00100080 00100084 00000000 000FE000 + V000FFF08 00010400 8001B2DC 8001B36A 000FFED8 + + +Ah now look at whats in sp+56 (sp+0x38) this is 8001B36A our saved r14 if +you look above at our stackframe & also agrees with GPR14. + +now backchain:: + + d 000FFF38.40 + +we now are taking the contents of SP to get our first backchain:: + + V000FFF38 000FFFA0 00000000 00014995 00147094 + V000FFF48 00147090 001470A0 000003E0 00000000 + V000FFF58 00100080 00100084 00000000 001BF1D0 + V000FFF68 00010400 800149BA 80014CA6 000FFF38 + +This displays a 2nd return address of 80014CA6 + +now do:: + + d 000FFFA0.40 + +for our 3rd backchain:: + + V000FFFA0 04B52002 0001107F 00000000 00000000 + V000FFFB0 00000000 00000000 FF000000 0001107F + V000FFFC0 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 + V000FFFD0 00010400 80010802 8001085A 000FFFA0 + + +our 3rd return address is 8001085A + +as the 04B52002 looks suspiciously like rubbish it is fair to assume that the +kernel entry routines for the sake of optimisation don't set up a backchain. + +now look at System.map to see if the addresses make any sense:: + + grep -i 0001b3 System.map + +outputs among other things:: + + 0001b304 T cpu_idle + +so 8001B36A +is cpu_idle+0x66 ( quiet the cpu is asleep, don't wake it ) + +:: + + grep -i 00014 System.map + +produces among other things:: + + 00014a78 T start_kernel + +so 0014CA6 is start_kernel+some hex number I can't add in my head. + +:: + + grep -i 00108 System.map + +this produces:: + + 00010800 T _stext + +so 8001085A is _stext+0x5a + +Congrats you've done your first backchain. + + + +s/390 & z/Architecture IO Overview +================================== + +I am not going to give a course in 390 IO architecture as this would take me +quite a while and I'm no expert. Instead I'll give a 390 IO architecture +summary for Dummies. If you have the s/390 principles of operation available +read this instead. If nothing else you may find a few useful keywords in here +and be able to use them on a web search engine to find more useful information. + +Unlike other bus architectures modern 390 systems do their IO using mostly +fibre optics and devices such as tapes and disks can be shared between several +mainframes. Also S390 can support up to 65536 devices while a high end PC based +system might be choking with around 64. + +Here is some of the common IO terminology: + +Subchannel: + This is the logical number most IO commands use to talk to an IO device. There + can be up to 0x10000 (65536) of these in a configuration, typically there are a + few hundred. Under VM for simplicity they are allocated contiguously, however + on the native hardware they are not. They typically stay consistent between + boots provided no new hardware is inserted or removed. + + Under Linux for s390 we use these as IRQ's and also when issuing an IO command + (CLEAR SUBCHANNEL, HALT SUBCHANNEL, MODIFY SUBCHANNEL, RESUME SUBCHANNEL, + START SUBCHANNEL, STORE SUBCHANNEL and TEST SUBCHANNEL). We use this as the ID + of the device we wish to talk to. The most important of these instructions are + START SUBCHANNEL (to start IO), TEST SUBCHANNEL (to check whether the IO + completed successfully) and HALT SUBCHANNEL (to kill IO). A subchannel can have + up to 8 channel paths to a device, this offers redundancy if one is not + available. + +Device Number: + This number remains static and is closely tied to the hardware. There are 65536 + of these, made up of a CHPID (Channel Path ID, the most significant 8 bits) and + another lsb 8 bits. These remain static even if more devices are inserted or + removed from the hardware. There is a 1 to 1 mapping between subchannels and + device numbers, provided devices aren't inserted or removed. + +Channel Control Words: + CCWs are linked lists of instructions initially pointed to by an operation + request block (ORB), which is initially given to Start Subchannel (SSCH) + command along with the subchannel number for the IO subsystem to process + while the CPU continues executing normal code. + CCWs come in two flavours, Format 0 (24 bit for backward compatibility) and + Format 1 (31 bit). These are typically used to issue read and write (and many + other) instructions. They consist of a length field and an absolute address + field. + + Each IO typically gets 1 or 2 interrupts, one for channel end (primary status) + when the channel is idle, and the second for device end (secondary status). + Sometimes you get both concurrently. You check how the IO went on by issuing a + TEST SUBCHANNEL at each interrupt, from which you receive an Interruption + response block (IRB). If you get channel and device end status in the IRB + without channel checks etc. your IO probably went okay. If you didn't you + probably need to examine the IRB, extended status word etc. + If an error occurs, more sophisticated control units have a facility known as + concurrent sense. This means that if an error occurs Extended sense information + will be presented in the Extended status word in the IRB. If not you have to + issue a subsequent SENSE CCW command after the test subchannel. + + +TPI (Test pending interrupt) can also be used for polled IO, but in +multitasking multiprocessor systems it isn't recommended except for +checking special cases (i.e. non looping checks for pending IO etc.). + +Store Subchannel and Modify Subchannel can be used to examine and modify +operating characteristics of a subchannel (e.g. channel paths). + +Other IO related Terms: + +Sysplex: + S390's Clustering Technology +QDIO: + S390's new high speed IO architecture to support devices such as gigabit + ethernet, this architecture is also designed to be forward compatible with + upcoming 64 bit machines. + + +General Concepts +---------------- + +Input Output Processors (IOP's) are responsible for communicating between +the mainframe CPU's & the channel & relieve the mainframe CPU's from the +burden of communicating with IO devices directly, this allows the CPU's to +concentrate on data processing. + +IOP's can use one or more links ( known as channel paths ) to talk to each +IO device. It first checks for path availability & chooses an available one, +then starts ( & sometimes terminates IO ). +There are two types of channel path: ESCON & the Parallel IO interface. + +IO devices are attached to control units, control units provide the +logic to interface the channel paths & channel path IO protocols to +the IO devices, they can be integrated with the devices or housed separately +& often talk to several similar devices ( typical examples would be raid +controllers or a control unit which connects to 1000 3270 terminals ):: + + + +---------------------------------------------------------------+ + | +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +----------+ +----------+ | + | | CPU | | CPU | | CPU | | CPU | | Main | | Expanded | | + | | | | | | | | | | Memory | | Storage | | + | +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +-----+ +----------+ +----------+ | + |---------------------------------------------------------------+ + | IOP | IOP | IOP | + |--------------------------------------------------------------- + | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | C | + ---------------------------------------------------------------- + || || + || Bus & Tag Channel Path || ESCON + || ====================== || Channel + || || || || Path + +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ + | | | | | | + | CU | | CU | | CU | + | | | | | | + +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ + | | | | | + +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ + |I/O Device| |I/O Device| |I/O Device| |I/O Device| |I/O Device| + +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ +----------+ + CPU = Central Processing Unit + C = Channel + IOP = IP Processor + CU = Control Unit + +The 390 IO systems come in 2 flavours the current 390 machines support both + +The Older 360 & 370 Interface,sometimes called the Parallel I/O interface, +sometimes called Bus-and Tag & sometimes Original Equipment Manufacturers +Interface (OEMI). + +This byte wide Parallel channel path/bus has parity & data on the "Bus" cable +and control lines on the "Tag" cable. These can operate in byte multiplex mode +for sharing between several slow devices or burst mode and monopolize the +channel for the whole burst. Up to 256 devices can be addressed on one of these +cables. These cables are about one inch in diameter. The maximum unextended +length supported by these cables is 125 Meters but this can be extended up to +2km with a fibre optic channel extended such as a 3044. The maximum burst speed +supported is 4.5 megabytes per second. However, some really old processors +support only transfer rates of 3.0, 2.0 & 1.0 MB/sec. +One of these paths can be daisy chained to up to 8 control units. + + +ESCON if fibre optic it is also called FICON +Was introduced by IBM in 1990. Has 2 fibre optic cables and uses either leds or +lasers for communication at a signaling rate of up to 200 megabits/sec. As +10bits are transferred for every 8 bits info this drops to 160 megabits/sec +and to 18.6 Megabytes/sec once control info and CRC are added. ESCON only +operates in burst mode. + +ESCONs typical max cable length is 3km for the led version and 20km for the +laser version known as XDF (extended distance facility). This can be further +extended by using an ESCON director which triples the above mentioned ranges. +Unlike Bus & Tag as ESCON is serial it uses a packet switching architecture, +the standard Bus & Tag control protocol is however present within the packets. +Up to 256 devices can be attached to each control unit that uses one of these +interfaces. + +Common 390 Devices include: +Network adapters typically OSA2,3172's,2116's & OSA-E gigabit ethernet adapters, +Consoles 3270 & 3215 (a teletype emulated under linux for a line mode console). +DASD's direct access storage devices ( otherwise known as hard disks ). +Tape Drives. +CTC ( Channel to Channel Adapters ), +ESCON or Parallel Cables used as a very high speed serial link +between 2 machines. + + +Debugging IO on s/390 & z/Architecture under VM +=============================================== + +Now we are ready to go on with IO tracing commands under VM + +A few self explanatory queries:: + + Q OSA + Q CTC + Q DISK ( This command is CMS specific ) + Q DASD + +Q OSA on my machine returns:: + + OSA 7C08 ON OSA 7C08 SUBCHANNEL = 0000 + OSA 7C09 ON OSA 7C09 SUBCHANNEL = 0001 + OSA 7C14 ON OSA 7C14 SUBCHANNEL = 0002 + OSA 7C15 ON OSA 7C15 SUBCHANNEL = 0003 + +If you have a guest with certain privileges you may be able to see devices +which don't belong to you. To avoid this, add the option V. +e.g.:: + + Q V OSA + +Now using the device numbers returned by this command we will +Trace the io starting up on the first device 7c08 & 7c09 +In our simplest case we can trace the +start subchannels +like TR SSCH 7C08-7C09 +or the halt subchannels +or TR HSCH 7C08-7C09 +MSCH's ,STSCH's I think you can guess the rest + +A good trick is tracing all the IO's and CCWS and spooling them into the reader +of another VM guest so he can ftp the logfile back to his own machine. I'll do +a small bit of this and give you a look at the output. + +1) Spool stdout to VM reader:: + + SP PRT TO (another vm guest ) or * for the local vm guest + +2) Fill the reader with the trace:: + + TR IO 7c08-7c09 INST INT CCW PRT RUN + +3) Start up linux:: + + i 00c +4) Finish the trace:: + + TR END + +5) close the reader:: + + C PRT + +6) list reader contents:: + + RDRLIST + +7) copy it to linux4's minidisk:: + + RECEIVE / LOG TXT A1 ( replace + +8) +filel & press F11 to look at it +You should see something like:: + + 00020942' SSCH B2334000 0048813C CC 0 SCH 0000 DEV 7C08 + CPA 000FFDF0 PARM 00E2C9C4 KEY 0 FPI C0 LPM 80 + CCW 000FFDF0 E4200100 00487FE8 0000 E4240100 ........ + IDAL 43D8AFE8 + IDAL 0FB76000 + 00020B0A' I/O DEV 7C08 -> 000197BC' SCH 0000 PARM 00E2C9C4 + 00021628' TSCH B2354000 >> 00488164 CC 0 SCH 0000 DEV 7C08 + CCWA 000FFDF8 DEV STS 0C SCH STS 00 CNT 00EC + KEY 0 FPI C0 CC 0 CTLS 4007 + 00022238' STSCH B2344000 >> 00488108 CC 0 SCH 0000 DEV 7C08 + +If you don't like messing up your readed ( because you possibly booted from it ) +you can alternatively spool it to another readers guest. + + +Other common VM device related commands +--------------------------------------------- +These commands are listed only because they have +been of use to me in the past & may be of use to +you too. For more complete info on each of the commands +use type HELP <command> from CMS. + +detaching devices:: + + DET <devno range> + ATT <devno range> <guest> + +attach a device to guest * for your own guest + +READY <devno> + cause VM to issue a fake interrupt. + +The VARY command is normally only available to VM administrators:: + + VARY ON PATH <path> TO <devno range> + VARY OFF PATH <PATH> FROM <devno range> + +This is used to switch on or off channel paths to devices. + +Q CHPID <channel path ID> + This displays state of devices using this channel path + +D SCHIB <subchannel> + This displays the subchannel information SCHIB block for the device. + this I believe is also only available to administrators. + +DEFINE CTC <devno> + defines a virtual CTC channel to channel connection + 2 need to be defined on each guest for the CTC driver to use. + +COUPLE devno userid remote devno + Joins a local virtual device to a remote virtual device + ( commonly used for the CTC driver ). + +Building a VM ramdisk under CMS which linux can use:: + + def vfb-<blocksize> <subchannel> <number blocks> + +blocksize is commonly 4096 for linux. + +Formatting it:: + + format <subchannel> <driver letter e.g. x> (blksize <blocksize> + +Sharing a disk between multiple guests:: + + LINK userid devno1 devno2 mode password + + + +GDB on S390 +=========== +N.B. if compiling for debugging gdb works better without optimisation +( see Compiling programs for debugging ) + +invocation +---------- +gdb <victim program> <optional corefile> + +Online help +----------- +help: gives help on commands + +e.g.:: + + help + help display + +Note gdb's online help is very good use it. + + +Assembly +-------- +info registers: + displays registers other than floating point. + +info all-registers: + displays floating points as well. + +disassemble: + disassembles + +e.g.:: + + disassemble without parameters will disassemble the current function + disassemble $pc $pc+10 + +Viewing & modifying variables +----------------------------- +print or p: + displays variable or register + +e.g. p/x $sp will display the stack pointer + +display: + prints variable or register each time program stops + +e.g.:: + + display/x $pc will display the program counter + display argc + +undisplay: + undo's display's + +info breakpoints: + shows all current breakpoints + +info stack: + shows stack back trace (if this doesn't work too well, I'll show + you the stacktrace by hand below). + +info locals: + displays local variables. + +info args: + display current procedure arguments. + +set args: + will set argc & argv each time the victim program is invoked + +e.g.:: + + set <variable>=value + set argc=100 + set $pc=0 + + + +Modifying execution +------------------- +step: + steps n lines of sourcecode + +step + steps 1 line. + +step 100 + steps 100 lines of code. + +next: + like step except this will not step into subroutines + +stepi: + steps a single machine code instruction. + +e.g.:: + + stepi 100 + +nexti: + steps a single machine code instruction but will not step into + subroutines. + +finish: + will run until exit of the current routine + +run: + (re)starts a program + +cont: + continues a program + +quit: + exits gdb. + + +breakpoints +------------ + +break + sets a breakpoint + +e.g.:: + + break main + break *$pc + break *0x400618 + +Here's a really useful one for large programs + +rbr + Set a breakpoint for all functions matching REGEXP + +e.g.:: + + rbr 390 + +will set a breakpoint with all functions with 390 in their name. + +info breakpoints + lists all breakpoints + +delete: + delete breakpoint by number or delete them all + +e.g. + +delete 1 + will delete the first breakpoint + + +delete + will delete them all + +watch: + This will set a watchpoint ( usually hardware assisted ), + +This will watch a variable till it changes + +e.g. + +watch cnt + will watch the variable cnt till it changes. + +As an aside unfortunately gdb's, architecture independent watchpoint code +is inconsistent & not very good, watchpoints usually work but not always. + +info watchpoints: + Display currently active watchpoints + +condition: ( another useful one ) + Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true. + +Usage is `condition N COND`, where N is an integer and COND is an +expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached. + + + +User defined functions/macros +----------------------------- +define: ( Note this is very very useful,simple & powerful ) + +usage define <name> <list of commands> end + +examples which you should consider putting into .gdbinit in your home +directory:: + + define d + stepi + disassemble $pc $pc+10 + end + define e + nexti + disassemble $pc $pc+10 + end + + +Other hard to classify stuff +---------------------------- +signal n: + sends the victim program a signal. + +e.g. `signal 3` will send a SIGQUIT. + +info signals: + what gdb does when the victim receives certain signals. + +list: + +e.g.: + +list + lists current function source +list 1,10 + list first 10 lines of current file. + +list test.c:1,10 + + +directory: + Adds directories to be searched for source if gdb cannot find the source. + (note it is a bit sensitive about slashes) + +e.g. To add the root of the filesystem to the searchpath do:: + + directory // + + +call <function> +This calls a function in the victim program, this is pretty powerful +e.g. +(gdb) call printf("hello world") +outputs: +$1 = 11 + +You might now be thinking that the line above didn't work, something extra had +to be done. +(gdb) call fflush(stdout) +hello world$2 = 0 +As an aside the debugger also calls malloc & free under the hood +to make space for the "hello world" string. + + + +hints +----- +1) command completion works just like bash + ( if you are a bad typist like me this really helps ) + +e.g. hit br <TAB> & cursor up & down :-). + +2) if you have a debugging problem that takes a few steps to recreate +put the steps into a file called .gdbinit in your current working directory +if you have defined a few extra useful user defined commands put these in +your home directory & they will be read each time gdb is launched. + +A typical .gdbinit file might be.:: + + break main + run + break runtime_exception + cont + + +stack chaining in gdb by hand +----------------------------- +This is done using a the same trick described for VM:: + + p/x (*($sp+56))&0x7fffffff + +get the first backchain. + +For z/Architecture +Replace 56 with 112 & ignore the &0x7fffffff +in the macros below & do nasty casts to longs like the following +as gdb unfortunately deals with printed arguments as ints which +messes up everything. + +i.e. here is a 3rd backchain dereference:: + + p/x *(long *)(***(long ***)$sp+112) + + +this outputs:: + + $5 = 0x528f18 + +on my machine. + +Now you can use:: + + info symbol (*($sp+56))&0x7fffffff + +you might see something like:: + + rl_getc + 36 in section .text + +telling you what is located at address 0x528f18 +Now do:: + + p/x (*(*$sp+56))&0x7fffffff + +This outputs:: + + $6 = 0x528ed0 + +Now do:: + + info symbol (*(*$sp+56))&0x7fffffff + rl_read_key + 180 in section .text + +now do:: + + p/x (*(**$sp+56))&0x7fffffff + +& so on. + +Disassembling instructions without debug info +--------------------------------------------- +gdb typically complains if there is a lack of debugging +symbols in the disassemble command with +"No function contains specified address." To get around +this do:: + + x/<number lines to disassemble>xi <address> + +e.g.:: + + x/20xi 0x400730 + + + +Note: + Remember gdb has history just like bash you don't need to retype the + whole line just use the up & down arrows. + + + +For more info +------------- +From your linuxbox do:: + + man gdb + +or:: + + info gdb. + +core dumps +---------- + +What a core dump ? +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +A core dump is a file generated by the kernel (if allowed) which contains the +registers and all active pages of the program which has crashed. + +From this file gdb will allow you to look at the registers, stack trace and +memory of the program as if it just crashed on your system. It is usually +called core and created in the current working directory. + +This is very useful in that a customer can mail a core dump to a technical +support department and the technical support department can reconstruct what +happened. Provided they have an identical copy of this program with debugging +symbols compiled in and the source base of this build is available. + +In short it is far more useful than something like a crash log could ever hope +to be. + +Why have I never seen one ? +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Probably because you haven't used the command:: + + ulimit -c unlimited in bash + +to allow core dumps, now do:: + + ulimit -a + +to verify that the limit was accepted. + +A sample core dump + To create this I'm going to do:: + + ulimit -c unlimited + gdb + +to launch gdb (my victim app. ) now be bad & do the following from another +telnet/xterm session to the same machine:: + + ps -aux | grep gdb + kill -SIGSEGV <gdb's pid> + +or alternatively use `killall -SIGSEGV gdb` if you have the killall command. + +Now look at the core dump:: + + ./gdb core + +Displays the following:: + + GNU gdb 4.18 + Copyright 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and you are + welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under certain conditions. + Type "show copying" to see the conditions. + There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for details. + This GDB was configured as "s390-ibm-linux"... + Core was generated by `./gdb'. + Program terminated with signal 11, Segmentation fault. + Reading symbols from /usr/lib/libncurses.so.4...done. + Reading symbols from /lib/libm.so.6...done. + Reading symbols from /lib/libc.so.6...done. + Reading symbols from /lib/ld-linux.so.2...done. + #0 0x40126d1a in read () from /lib/libc.so.6 + Setting up the environment for debugging gdb. + Breakpoint 1 at 0x4dc6f8: file utils.c, line 471. + Breakpoint 2 at 0x4d87a4: file top.c, line 2609. + (top-gdb) info stack + #0 0x40126d1a in read () from /lib/libc.so.6 + #1 0x528f26 in rl_getc (stream=0x7ffffde8) at input.c:402 + #2 0x528ed0 in rl_read_key () at input.c:381 + #3 0x5167e6 in readline_internal_char () at readline.c:454 + #4 0x5168ee in readline_internal_charloop () at readline.c:507 + #5 0x51692c in readline_internal () at readline.c:521 + #6 0x5164fe in readline (prompt=0x7ffff810) + at readline.c:349 + #7 0x4d7a8a in command_line_input (prompt=0x564420 "(gdb) ", repeat=1, + annotation_suffix=0x4d6b44 "prompt") at top.c:2091 + #8 0x4d6cf0 in command_loop () at top.c:1345 + #9 0x4e25bc in main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffdf4) at main.c:635 + + +LDD +=== +This is a program which lists the shared libraries which a library needs, +Note you also get the relocations of the shared library text segments which +help when using objdump --source. + +e.g.:: + + ldd ./gdb + +outputs:: + + libncurses.so.4 => /usr/lib/libncurses.so.4 (0x40018000) + libm.so.6 => /lib/libm.so.6 (0x4005e000) + libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x40084000) + /lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000) + + +Debugging shared libraries +========================== +Most programs use shared libraries, however it can be very painful +when you single step instruction into a function like printf for the +first time & you end up in functions like _dl_runtime_resolve this is +the ld.so doing lazy binding, lazy binding is a concept in ELF where +shared library functions are not loaded into memory unless they are +actually used, great for saving memory but a pain to debug. + +To get around this either relink the program -static or exit gdb type +export LD_BIND_NOW=true this will stop lazy binding & restart the gdb'ing +the program in question. + + + +Debugging modules +================= +As modules are dynamically loaded into the kernel their address can be +anywhere to get around this use the -m option with insmod to emit a load +map which can be piped into a file if required. + +The proc file system +==================== +What is it ?. +It is a filesystem created by the kernel with files which are created on demand +by the kernel if read, or can be used to modify kernel parameters, +it is a powerful concept. + +e.g.:: + + cat /proc/sys/net/ipv4/ip_forward + +On my machine outputs:: + + 0 + +telling me ip_forwarding is not on to switch it on I can do:: + + echo 1 > /proc/sys/net/ipv4/ip_forward + +cat it again:: + + cat /proc/sys/net/ipv4/ip_forward + +On my machine now outputs:: + + 1 + +IP forwarding is on. + +There is a lot of useful info in here best found by going in and having a look +around, so I'll take you through some entries I consider important. + +All the processes running on the machine have their own entry defined by +/proc/<pid> + +So lets have a look at the init process:: + + cd /proc/1 + cat cmdline + +emits:: + + init [2] + +:: + + cd /proc/1/fd + +This contains numerical entries of all the open files, +some of these you can cat e.g. stdout (2):: + + cat /proc/29/maps + +on my machine emits:: + + 00400000-00478000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 4103 /bin/bash + 00478000-0047e000 rw-p 00077000 5f:00 4103 /bin/bash + 0047e000-00492000 rwxp 00000000 00:00 0 + 40000000-40015000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14382 /lib/ld-2.1.2.so + 40015000-40016000 rw-p 00014000 5f:00 14382 /lib/ld-2.1.2.so + 40016000-40017000 rwxp 00000000 00:00 0 + 40017000-40018000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0 + 40018000-4001b000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14435 /lib/libtermcap.so.2.0.8 + 4001b000-4001c000 rw-p 00002000 5f:00 14435 /lib/libtermcap.so.2.0.8 + 4001c000-4010d000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14387 /lib/libc-2.1.2.so + 4010d000-40111000 rw-p 000f0000 5f:00 14387 /lib/libc-2.1.2.so + 40111000-40114000 rw-p 00000000 00:00 0 + 40114000-4011e000 r-xp 00000000 5f:00 14408 /lib/libnss_files-2.1.2.so + 4011e000-4011f000 rw-p 00009000 5f:00 14408 /lib/libnss_files-2.1.2.so + 7fffd000-80000000 rwxp ffffe000 00:00 0 + + +Showing us the shared libraries init uses where they are in memory +& memory access permissions for each virtual memory area. + +/proc/1/cwd is a softlink to the current working directory. + +/proc/1/root is the root of the filesystem for this process. + +/proc/1/mem is the current running processes memory which you +can read & write to like a file. + +strace uses this sometimes as it is a bit faster than the +rather inefficient ptrace interface for peeking at DATA. + +:: + + cat status + + Name: init + State: S (sleeping) + Pid: 1 + PPid: 0 + Uid: 0 0 0 0 + Gid: 0 0 0 0 + Groups: + VmSize: 408 kB + VmLck: 0 kB + VmRSS: 208 kB + VmData: 24 kB + VmStk: 8 kB + VmExe: 368 kB + VmLib: 0 kB + SigPnd: 0000000000000000 + SigBlk: 0000000000000000 + SigIgn: 7fffffffd7f0d8fc + SigCgt: 00000000280b2603 + CapInh: 00000000fffffeff + CapPrm: 00000000ffffffff + CapEff: 00000000fffffeff + + User PSW: 070de000 80414146 + task: 004b6000 tss: 004b62d8 ksp: 004b7ca8 pt_regs: 004b7f68 + User GPRS: + 00000400 00000000 0000000b 7ffffa90 + 00000000 00000000 00000000 0045d9f4 + 0045cafc 7ffffa90 7fffff18 0045cb08 + 00010400 804039e8 80403af8 7ffff8b0 + User ACRS: + 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 + 00000001 00000000 00000000 00000000 + 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 + 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 + Kernel BackChain CallChain BackChain CallChain + 004b7ca8 8002bd0c 004b7d18 8002b92c + 004b7db8 8005cd50 004b7e38 8005d12a + 004b7f08 80019114 + +Showing among other things memory usage & status of some signals & +the processes'es registers from the kernel task_structure +as well as a backchain which may be useful if a process crashes +in the kernel for some unknown reason. + +Some driver debugging techniques +================================ +debug feature +------------- +Some of our drivers now support a "debug feature" in +/proc/s390dbf see s390dbf.txt in the linux/Documentation directory +for more info. + +e.g. +to switch on the lcs "debug feature":: + + echo 5 > /proc/s390dbf/lcs/level + +& then after the error occurred:: + + cat /proc/s390dbf/lcs/sprintf >/logfile + +the logfile now contains some information which may help +tech support resolve a problem in the field. + + + +high level debugging network drivers +------------------------------------ +ifconfig is a quite useful command +it gives the current state of network drivers. + +If you suspect your network device driver is dead +one way to check is type:: + + ifconfig <network device> + +e.g. tr0 + +You should see something like:: + + ifconfig tr0 + tr0 Link encap:16/4 Mbps Token Ring (New) HWaddr 00:04:AC:20:8E:48 + inet addr:9.164.185.132 Bcast:9.164.191.255 Mask:255.255.224.0 + UP BROADCAST RUNNING MULTICAST MTU:2000 Metric:1 + RX packets:246134 errors:0 dropped:0 overruns:0 frame:0 + TX packets:5 errors:0 dropped:0 overruns:0 carrier:0 + collisions:0 txqueuelen:100 + +if the device doesn't say up +try:: + + /etc/rc.d/init.d/network start + +( this starts the network stack & hopefully calls ifconfig tr0 up ). +ifconfig looks at the output of /proc/net/dev and presents it in a more +presentable form. + +Now ping the device from a machine in the same subnet. + +if the RX packets count & TX packets counts don't increment you probably +have problems. + +next:: + + cat /proc/net/arp + +Do you see any hardware addresses in the cache if not you may have problems. +Next try:: + + ping -c 5 <broadcast_addr> + +i.e. the Bcast field above in the output of +ifconfig. Do you see any replies from machines other than the local machine +if not you may have problems. also if the TX packets count in ifconfig +hasn't incremented either you have serious problems in your driver +(e.g. the txbusy field of the network device being stuck on ) +or you may have multiple network devices connected. + + +chandev +------- +There is a new device layer for channel devices, some +drivers e.g. lcs are registered with this layer. + +If the device uses the channel device layer you'll be +able to find what interrupts it uses & the current state +of the device. + +See the manpage chandev.8 &type cat /proc/chandev for more info. + + +SysRq +===== +This is now supported by linux for s/390 & z/Architecture. + +To enable it do compile the kernel with:: + + Kernel Hacking -> Magic SysRq Key Enabled + +Then:: + + echo "1" > /proc/sys/kernel/sysrq + +also type:: + + echo "8" >/proc/sys/kernel/printk + +To make printk output go to console. + +On 390 all commands are prefixed with:: + + ^- + +e.g.:: + + ^-t will show tasks. + ^-? or some unknown command will display help. + +The sysrq key reading is very picky ( I have to type the keys in an +xterm session & paste them into the x3270 console ) +& it may be wise to predefine the keys as described in the VM hints above + +This is particularly useful for syncing disks unmounting & rebooting +if the machine gets partially hung. + +Read Documentation/admin-guide/sysrq.rst for more info + +References: +=========== +- Enterprise Systems Architecture Reference Summary +- Enterprise Systems Architecture Principles of Operation +- Hartmut Penners s390 stack frame sheet. +- IBM Mainframe Channel Attachment a technology brief from a CISCO webpage +- Various bits of man & info pages of Linux. +- Linux & GDB source. +- Various info & man pages. +- CMS Help on tracing commands. +- Linux for s/390 Elf Application Binary Interface +- Linux for z/Series Elf Application Binary Interface ( Both Highly Recommended ) +- z/Architecture Principles of Operation SA22-7832-00 +- Enterprise Systems Architecture/390 Reference Summary SA22-7209-01 & the +- Enterprise Systems Architecture/390 Principles of Operation SA22-7201-05 + +Special Thanks +============== +Special thanks to Neale Ferguson who maintains a much +prettier HTML version of this page at +http://linuxvm.org/penguinvm/ +Bob Grainger Stefan Bader & others for reporting bugs diff --git a/Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt b/Documentation/s390/driver-model.rst index ed265cf54cde..ad4bc2dbea43 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/driver-model.rst @@ -1,5 +1,6 @@ +============================= S/390 driver model interfaces ------------------------------ +============================= 1. CCW devices -------------- @@ -7,13 +8,13 @@ S/390 driver model interfaces All devices which can be addressed by means of ccws are called 'CCW devices' - even if they aren't actually driven by ccws. -All ccw devices are accessed via a subchannel, this is reflected in the -structures under devices/: +All ccw devices are accessed via a subchannel, this is reflected in the +structures under devices/:: -devices/ + devices/ - system/ - css0/ - - 0.0.0000/0.0.0815/ + - 0.0.0000/0.0.0815/ - 0.0.0001/0.0.4711/ - 0.0.0002/ - 0.1.0000/0.1.1234/ @@ -35,14 +36,18 @@ be found under bus/ccw/devices/. All ccw devices export some data via sysfs. -cutype: The control unit type / model. +cutype: + The control unit type / model. -devtype: The device type / model, if applicable. +devtype: + The device type / model, if applicable. -availability: Can be 'good' or 'boxed'; 'no path' or 'no device' for +availability: + Can be 'good' or 'boxed'; 'no path' or 'no device' for disconnected devices. -online: An interface to set the device online and offline. +online: + An interface to set the device online and offline. In the special case of the device being disconnected (see the notify function under 1.2), piping 0 to online will forcibly delete the device. @@ -52,9 +57,11 @@ The device drivers can add entries to export per-device data and interfaces. There is also some data exported on a per-subchannel basis (see under bus/css/devices/): -chpids: Via which chpids the device is connected. +chpids: + Via which chpids the device is connected. -pimpampom: The path installed, path available and path operational masks. +pimpampom: + The path installed, path available and path operational masks. There also might be additional data, for example for block devices. @@ -74,77 +81,93 @@ b. After a. has been performed, if necessary, the device is finally brought up ------------------------------------ The basic struct ccw_device and struct ccw_driver data structures can be found -under include/asm/ccwdev.h. +under include/asm/ccwdev.h:: -struct ccw_device { - spinlock_t *ccwlock; - struct ccw_device_private *private; - struct ccw_device_id id; + struct ccw_device { + spinlock_t *ccwlock; + struct ccw_device_private *private; + struct ccw_device_id id; - struct ccw_driver *drv; - struct device dev; + struct ccw_driver *drv; + struct device dev; int online; void (*handler) (struct ccw_device *dev, unsigned long intparm, - struct irb *irb); -}; + struct irb *irb); + }; -struct ccw_driver { - struct module *owner; - struct ccw_device_id *ids; - int (*probe) (struct ccw_device *); + struct ccw_driver { + struct module *owner; + struct ccw_device_id *ids; + int (*probe) (struct ccw_device *); int (*remove) (struct ccw_device *); int (*set_online) (struct ccw_device *); int (*set_offline) (struct ccw_device *); int (*notify) (struct ccw_device *, int); struct device_driver driver; char *name; -}; + }; The 'private' field contains data needed for internal i/o operation only, and is not available to the device driver. Each driver should declare in a MODULE_DEVICE_TABLE into which CU types/models and/or device types/models it is interested. This information can later be found -in the struct ccw_device_id fields: +in the struct ccw_device_id fields:: -struct ccw_device_id { - __u16 match_flags; + struct ccw_device_id { + __u16 match_flags; - __u16 cu_type; - __u16 dev_type; - __u8 cu_model; - __u8 dev_model; + __u16 cu_type; + __u16 dev_type; + __u8 cu_model; + __u8 dev_model; unsigned long driver_info; -}; + }; The functions in ccw_driver should be used in the following way: -probe: This function is called by the device layer for each device the driver + +probe: + This function is called by the device layer for each device the driver is interested in. The driver should only allocate private structures to put in dev->driver_data and create attributes (if needed). Also, the interrupt handler (see below) should be set here. -int (*probe) (struct ccw_device *cdev); +:: + + int (*probe) (struct ccw_device *cdev); -Parameters: cdev - the device to be probed. +Parameters: + cdev + - the device to be probed. -remove: This function is called by the device layer upon removal of the driver, +remove: + This function is called by the device layer upon removal of the driver, the device or the module. The driver should perform cleanups here. -int (*remove) (struct ccw_device *cdev); +:: -Parameters: cdev - the device to be removed. + int (*remove) (struct ccw_device *cdev); +Parameters: + cdev + - the device to be removed. -set_online: This function is called by the common I/O layer when the device is + +set_online: + This function is called by the common I/O layer when the device is activated via the 'online' attribute. The driver should finally setup and activate the device here. -int (*set_online) (struct ccw_device *); +:: + + int (*set_online) (struct ccw_device *); -Parameters: cdev - the device to be activated. The common layer has +Parameters: + cdev + - the device to be activated. The common layer has verified that the device is not already online. @@ -152,15 +175,22 @@ set_offline: This function is called by the common I/O layer when the device is de-activated via the 'online' attribute. The driver should shut down the device, but not de-allocate its private data. -int (*set_offline) (struct ccw_device *); +:: -Parameters: cdev - the device to be deactivated. The common layer has + int (*set_offline) (struct ccw_device *); + +Parameters: + cdev + - the device to be deactivated. The common layer has verified that the device is online. -notify: This function is called by the common I/O layer for some state changes +notify: + This function is called by the common I/O layer for some state changes of the device. + Signalled to the driver are: + * In online state, device detached (CIO_GONE) or last path gone (CIO_NO_PATH). The driver must return !0 to keep the device; for return code 0, the device will be deleted as usual (also when no @@ -173,32 +203,40 @@ notify: This function is called by the common I/O layer for some state changes return code of the notify function the device driver signals if it wants the device back: !0 for keeping, 0 to make the device being removed and re-registered. - -int (*notify) (struct ccw_device *, int); -Parameters: cdev - the device whose state changed. - event - the event that happened. This can be one of CIO_GONE, - CIO_NO_PATH or CIO_OPER. +:: + + int (*notify) (struct ccw_device *, int); + +Parameters: + cdev + - the device whose state changed. + + event + - the event that happened. This can be one of CIO_GONE, + CIO_NO_PATH or CIO_OPER. The handler field of the struct ccw_device is meant to be set to the interrupt -handler for the device. In order to accommodate drivers which use several +handler for the device. In order to accommodate drivers which use several distinct handlers (e.g. multi subchannel devices), this is a member of ccw_device instead of ccw_driver. The handler is registered with the common layer during set_online() processing before the driver is called, and is deregistered during set_offline() after the -driver has been called. Also, after registering / before deregistering, path +driver has been called. Also, after registering / before deregistering, path grouping resp. disbanding of the path group (if applicable) are performed. -void (*handler) (struct ccw_device *dev, unsigned long intparm, struct irb *irb); +:: -Parameters: dev - the device the handler is called for + void (*handler) (struct ccw_device *dev, unsigned long intparm, struct irb *irb); + +Parameters: dev - the device the handler is called for intparm - the intparm which allows the device driver to identify - the i/o the interrupt is associated with, or to recognize - the interrupt as unsolicited. - irb - interruption response block which contains the accumulated - status. + the i/o the interrupt is associated with, or to recognize + the interrupt as unsolicited. + irb - interruption response block which contains the accumulated + status. -The device driver is called from the common ccw_device layer and can retrieve +The device driver is called from the common ccw_device layer and can retrieve information about the interrupt from the irb parameter. @@ -237,23 +275,27 @@ only the logical state and not the physical state, since we cannot track the latter consistently due to lacking machine support (we don't need to be aware of it anyway). -status - Can be 'online' or 'offline'. +status + - Can be 'online' or 'offline'. Piping 'on' or 'off' sets the chpid logically online/offline. Piping 'on' to an online chpid triggers path reprobing for all devices the chpid connects to. This can be used to force the kernel to re-use a channel path the user knows to be online, but the machine hasn't created a machine check for. -type - The physical type of the channel path. +type + - The physical type of the channel path. -shared - Whether the channel path is shared. +shared + - Whether the channel path is shared. -cmg - The channel measurement group. +cmg + - The channel measurement group. 3. System devices ----------------- -3.1 xpram +3.1 xpram --------- xpram shows up under devices/system/ as 'xpram'. @@ -279,9 +321,8 @@ Netiucv connections show up under devices/iucv/ as "netiucv<ifnum>". The interfa number is assigned sequentially to the connections defined via the 'connection' attribute. -user - shows the connection partner. - -buffer - maximum buffer size. - Pipe to it to change buffer size. - +user + - shows the connection partner. +buffer + - maximum buffer size. Pipe to it to change buffer size. diff --git a/Documentation/s390/index.rst b/Documentation/s390/index.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..1a914da2a07b --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/s390/index.rst @@ -0,0 +1,30 @@ +:orphan: + +================= +s390 Architecture +================= + +.. toctree:: + :maxdepth: 1 + + cds + 3270 + debugging390 + driver-model + monreader + qeth + s390dbf + vfio-ap + vfio-ccw + zfcpdump + dasd + common_io + + text_files + +.. only:: subproject and html + + Indices + ======= + + * :ref:`genindex` diff --git a/Documentation/s390/monreader.txt b/Documentation/s390/monreader.rst index d3729585fdb0..1e857575c113 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/monreader.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/monreader.rst @@ -1,24 +1,26 @@ +================================================= +Linux API for read access to z/VM Monitor Records +================================================= Date : 2004-Nov-26 + Author: Gerald Schaefer (geraldsc@de.ibm.com) - Linux API for read access to z/VM Monitor Records - ================================================= Description =========== This item delivers a new Linux API in the form of a misc char device that is usable from user space and allows read access to the z/VM Monitor Records -collected by the *MONITOR System Service of z/VM. +collected by the `*MONITOR` System Service of z/VM. User Requirements ================= The z/VM guest on which you want to access this API needs to be configured in -order to allow IUCV connections to the *MONITOR service, i.e. it needs the -IUCV *MONITOR statement in its user entry. If the monitor DCSS to be used is +order to allow IUCV connections to the `*MONITOR` service, i.e. it needs the +IUCV `*MONITOR` statement in its user entry. If the monitor DCSS to be used is restricted (likely), you also need the NAMESAVE <DCSS NAME> statement. This item will use the IUCV device driver to access the z/VM services, so you need a kernel with IUCV support. You also need z/VM version 4.4 or 5.1. @@ -50,7 +52,9 @@ Your guest virtual storage has to end below the starting address of the DCSS and you have to specify the "mem=" kernel parameter in your parmfile with a value greater than the ending address of the DCSS. -Example: DEF STOR 140M +Example:: + + DEF STOR 140M This defines 140MB storage size for your guest, the parameter "mem=160M" is added to the parmfile. @@ -66,24 +70,27 @@ kernel, the kernel parameter "monreader.mondcss=<DCSS NAME>" can be specified in the parmfile. The default name for the DCSS is "MONDCSS" if none is specified. In case that -there are other users already connected to the *MONITOR service (e.g. +there are other users already connected to the `*MONITOR` service (e.g. Performance Toolkit), the monitor DCSS is already defined and you have to use the same DCSS. The CP command Q MONITOR (Class E privileged) shows the name of the monitor DCSS, if already defined, and the users connected to the -*MONITOR service. +`*MONITOR` service. Refer to the "z/VM Performance" book (SC24-6109-00) on how to create a monitor DCSS if your z/VM doesn't have one already, you need Class E privileges to define and save a DCSS. Example: -------- -modprobe monreader mondcss=MYDCSS + +:: + + modprobe monreader mondcss=MYDCSS This loads the module and sets the DCSS name to "MYDCSS". NOTE: ----- -This API provides no interface to control the *MONITOR service, e.g. specify +This API provides no interface to control the `*MONITOR` service, e.g. specify which data should be collected. This can be done by the CP command MONITOR (Class E privileged), see "CP Command and Utility Reference". @@ -98,6 +105,7 @@ If your distribution does not support udev, a device node will not be created automatically and you have to create it manually after loading the module. Therefore you need to know the major and minor numbers of the device. These numbers can be found in /sys/class/misc/monreader/dev. + Typing cat /sys/class/misc/monreader/dev will give an output of the form <major>:<minor>. The device node can be created via the mknod command, enter mknod <name> c <major> <minor>, where <name> is the name of the device node @@ -105,10 +113,13 @@ to be created. Example: -------- -# modprobe monreader -# cat /sys/class/misc/monreader/dev -10:63 -# mknod /dev/monreader c 10 63 + +:: + + # modprobe monreader + # cat /sys/class/misc/monreader/dev + 10:63 + # mknod /dev/monreader c 10 63 This loads the module with the default monitor DCSS (MONDCSS) and creates a device node. @@ -133,20 +144,21 @@ last byte of data. The start address is needed to handle "end-of-frame" records correctly (domain 1, record 13), i.e. it can be used to determine the record start offset relative to a 4K page (frame) boundary. -See "Appendix A: *MONITOR" in the "z/VM Performance" document for a description +See "Appendix A: `*MONITOR`" in the "z/VM Performance" document for a description of the monitor control element layout. The layout of the monitor records can be found here (z/VM 5.1): http://www.vm.ibm.com/pubs/mon510/index.html -The layout of the data stream provided by the monreader device is as follows: -... -<0 byte read> -<first MCE> \ -<first set of records> | -... |- data set -<last MCE> | -<last set of records> / -<0 byte read> -... +The layout of the data stream provided by the monreader device is as follows:: + + ... + <0 byte read> + <first MCE> \ + <first set of records> | + ... |- data set + <last MCE> | + <last set of records> / + <0 byte read> + ... There may be more than one combination of MCE and corresponding record set within one data set and the end of each data set is indicated by a successful @@ -165,15 +177,19 @@ As with most char devices, error conditions are indicated by returning a negative value for the number of bytes read. In this case, the errno variable indicates the error condition: -EIO: reply failed, read data is invalid and the application +EIO: + reply failed, read data is invalid and the application should discard the data read since the last successful read with 0 size. -EFAULT: copy_to_user failed, read data is invalid and the application should - discard the data read since the last successful read with 0 size. -EAGAIN: occurs on a non-blocking read if there is no data available at the - moment. There is no data missing or corrupted, just try again or rather - use polling for non-blocking reads. -EOVERFLOW: message limit reached, the data read since the last successful - read with 0 size is valid but subsequent records may be missing. +EFAULT: + copy_to_user failed, read data is invalid and the application should + discard the data read since the last successful read with 0 size. +EAGAIN: + occurs on a non-blocking read if there is no data available at the + moment. There is no data missing or corrupted, just try again or rather + use polling for non-blocking reads. +EOVERFLOW: + message limit reached, the data read since the last successful + read with 0 size is valid but subsequent records may be missing. In the last case (EOVERFLOW) there may be missing data, in the first two cases (EIO, EFAULT) there will be missing data. It's up to the application if it will @@ -183,7 +199,7 @@ Open: ----- Only one user is allowed to open the char device. If it is already in use, the open function will fail (return a negative value) and set errno to EBUSY. -The open function may also fail if an IUCV connection to the *MONITOR service +The open function may also fail if an IUCV connection to the `*MONITOR` service cannot be established. In this case errno will be set to EIO and an error message with an IPUSER SEVER code will be printed into syslog. The IPUSER SEVER codes are described in the "z/VM Performance" book, Appendix A. @@ -194,4 +210,3 @@ As soon as the device is opened, incoming messages will be accepted and they will account for the message limit, i.e. opening the device without reading from it will provoke the "message limit reached" error (EOVERFLOW error code) eventually. - diff --git a/Documentation/s390/qeth.txt b/Documentation/s390/qeth.rst index aa06fcf5f8c2..f02fdaa68de0 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/qeth.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/qeth.rst @@ -1,8 +1,12 @@ +============================= IBM s390 QDIO Ethernet Driver +============================= OSA and HiperSockets Bridge Port Support +======================================== Uevents +------- To generate the events the device must be assigned a role of either a primary or a secondary Bridge Port. For more information, see @@ -13,12 +17,15 @@ of some configured Bridge Port device on the channel changes, a udev event with ACTION=CHANGE is emitted on behalf of the corresponding ccwgroup device. The event has the following attributes: -BRIDGEPORT=statechange - indicates that the Bridge Port device changed +BRIDGEPORT=statechange + indicates that the Bridge Port device changed its state. -ROLE={primary|secondary|none} - the role assigned to the port. +ROLE={primary|secondary|none} + the role assigned to the port. -STATE={active|standby|inactive} - the newly assumed state of the port. +STATE={active|standby|inactive} + the newly assumed state of the port. When run on HiperSockets Bridge Capable Port hardware with host address notifications enabled, a udev event with ACTION=CHANGE is emitted. @@ -26,25 +33,32 @@ It is emitted on behalf of the corresponding ccwgroup device when a host or a VLAN is registered or unregistered on the network served by the device. The event has the following attributes: -BRIDGEDHOST={reset|register|deregister|abort} - host address +BRIDGEDHOST={reset|register|deregister|abort} + host address notifications are started afresh, a new host or VLAN is registered or deregistered on the Bridge Port HiperSockets channel, or address notifications are aborted. -VLAN=numeric-vlan-id - VLAN ID on which the event occurred. Not included +VLAN=numeric-vlan-id + VLAN ID on which the event occurred. Not included if no VLAN is involved in the event. -MAC=xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx - MAC address of the host that is being registered +MAC=xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx + MAC address of the host that is being registered or deregistered from the HiperSockets channel. Not reported if the event reports the creation or destruction of a VLAN. -NTOK_BUSID=x.y.zzzz - device bus ID (CSSID, SSID and device number). +NTOK_BUSID=x.y.zzzz + device bus ID (CSSID, SSID and device number). -NTOK_IID=xx - device IID. +NTOK_IID=xx + device IID. -NTOK_CHPID=xx - device CHPID. +NTOK_CHPID=xx + device CHPID. -NTOK_CHID=xxxx - device channel ID. +NTOK_CHID=xxxx + device channel ID. -Note that the NTOK_* attributes refer to devices other than the one +Note that the `NTOK_*` attributes refer to devices other than the one connected to the system on which the OS is running. diff --git a/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.rst b/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..cdb36842b898 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.rst @@ -0,0 +1,487 @@ +================== +S390 Debug Feature +================== + +files: + - arch/s390/kernel/debug.c + - arch/s390/include/asm/debug.h + +Description: +------------ +The goal of this feature is to provide a kernel debug logging API +where log records can be stored efficiently in memory, where each component +(e.g. device drivers) can have one separate debug log. +One purpose of this is to inspect the debug logs after a production system crash +in order to analyze the reason for the crash. + +If the system still runs but only a subcomponent which uses dbf fails, +it is possible to look at the debug logs on a live system via the Linux +debugfs filesystem. + +The debug feature may also very useful for kernel and driver development. + +Design: +------- +Kernel components (e.g. device drivers) can register themselves at the debug +feature with the function call :c:func:`debug_register()`. +This function initializes a +debug log for the caller. For each debug log exists a number of debug areas +where exactly one is active at one time. Each debug area consists of contiguous +pages in memory. In the debug areas there are stored debug entries (log records) +which are written by event- and exception-calls. + +An event-call writes the specified debug entry to the active debug +area and updates the log pointer for the active area. If the end +of the active debug area is reached, a wrap around is done (ring buffer) +and the next debug entry will be written at the beginning of the active +debug area. + +An exception-call writes the specified debug entry to the log and +switches to the next debug area. This is done in order to be sure +that the records which describe the origin of the exception are not +overwritten when a wrap around for the current area occurs. + +The debug areas themselves are also ordered in form of a ring buffer. +When an exception is thrown in the last debug area, the following debug +entries are then written again in the very first area. + +There are four versions for the event- and exception-calls: One for +logging raw data, one for text, one for numbers (unsigned int and long), +and one for sprintf-like formatted strings. + +Each debug entry contains the following data: + +- Timestamp +- Cpu-Number of calling task +- Level of debug entry (0...6) +- Return Address to caller +- Flag, if entry is an exception or not + +The debug logs can be inspected in a live system through entries in +the debugfs-filesystem. Under the toplevel directory "``s390dbf``" there is +a directory for each registered component, which is named like the +corresponding component. The debugfs normally should be mounted to +``/sys/kernel/debug`` therefore the debug feature can be accessed under +``/sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf``. + +The content of the directories are files which represent different views +to the debug log. Each component can decide which views should be +used through registering them with the function :c:func:`debug_register_view()`. +Predefined views for hex/ascii, sprintf and raw binary data are provided. +It is also possible to define other views. The content of +a view can be inspected simply by reading the corresponding debugfs file. + +All debug logs have an actual debug level (range from 0 to 6). +The default level is 3. Event and Exception functions have a :c:data:`level` +parameter. Only debug entries with a level that is lower or equal +than the actual level are written to the log. This means, when +writing events, high priority log entries should have a low level +value whereas low priority entries should have a high one. +The actual debug level can be changed with the help of the debugfs-filesystem +through writing a number string "x" to the ``level`` debugfs file which is +provided for every debug log. Debugging can be switched off completely +by using "-" on the ``level`` debugfs file. + +Example:: + + > echo "-" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level + +It is also possible to deactivate the debug feature globally for every +debug log. You can change the behavior using 2 sysctl parameters in +``/proc/sys/s390dbf``: + +There are currently 2 possible triggers, which stop the debug feature +globally. The first possibility is to use the ``debug_active`` sysctl. If +set to 1 the debug feature is running. If ``debug_active`` is set to 0 the +debug feature is turned off. + +The second trigger which stops the debug feature is a kernel oops. +That prevents the debug feature from overwriting debug information that +happened before the oops. After an oops you can reactivate the debug feature +by piping 1 to ``/proc/sys/s390dbf/debug_active``. Nevertheless, it's not +suggested to use an oopsed kernel in a production environment. + +If you want to disallow the deactivation of the debug feature, you can use +the ``debug_stoppable`` sysctl. If you set ``debug_stoppable`` to 0 the debug +feature cannot be stopped. If the debug feature is already stopped, it +will stay deactivated. + +Kernel Interfaces: +------------------ + +.. kernel-doc:: arch/s390/kernel/debug.c +.. kernel-doc:: arch/s390/include/asm/debug.h + +Predefined views: +----------------- + +.. code-block:: c + + extern struct debug_view debug_hex_ascii_view; + + extern struct debug_view debug_raw_view; + + extern struct debug_view debug_sprintf_view; + +Examples +-------- + +.. code-block:: c + + /* + * hex_ascii- + raw-view Example + */ + + #include <linux/init.h> + #include <asm/debug.h> + + static debug_info_t *debug_info; + + static int init(void) + { + /* register 4 debug areas with one page each and 4 byte data field */ + + debug_info = debug_register("test", 1, 4, 4 ); + debug_register_view(debug_info, &debug_hex_ascii_view); + debug_register_view(debug_info, &debug_raw_view); + + debug_text_event(debug_info, 4 , "one "); + debug_int_exception(debug_info, 4, 4711); + debug_event(debug_info, 3, &debug_info, 4); + + return 0; + } + + static void cleanup(void) + { + debug_unregister(debug_info); + } + + module_init(init); + module_exit(cleanup); + +.. code-block:: c + + /* + * sprintf-view Example + */ + + #include <linux/init.h> + #include <asm/debug.h> + + static debug_info_t *debug_info; + + static int init(void) + { + /* register 4 debug areas with one page each and data field for */ + /* format string pointer + 2 varargs (= 3 * sizeof(long)) */ + + debug_info = debug_register("test", 1, 4, sizeof(long) * 3); + debug_register_view(debug_info, &debug_sprintf_view); + + debug_sprintf_event(debug_info, 2 , "first event in %s:%i\n",__FILE__,__LINE__); + debug_sprintf_exception(debug_info, 1, "pointer to debug info: %p\n",&debug_info); + + return 0; + } + + static void cleanup(void) + { + debug_unregister(debug_info); + } + + module_init(init); + module_exit(cleanup); + +Debugfs Interface +----------------- +Views to the debug logs can be investigated through reading the corresponding +debugfs-files: + +Example:: + + > ls /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd + flush hex_ascii level pages raw + > cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/hex_ascii | sort -k2,2 -s + 00 00974733272:680099 2 - 02 0006ad7e 07 ea 4a 90 | .... + 00 00974733272:682210 2 - 02 0006ade6 46 52 45 45 | FREE + 00 00974733272:682213 2 - 02 0006adf6 07 ea 4a 90 | .... + 00 00974733272:682281 1 * 02 0006ab08 41 4c 4c 43 | EXCP + 01 00974733272:682284 2 - 02 0006ab16 45 43 4b 44 | ECKD + 01 00974733272:682287 2 - 02 0006ab28 00 00 00 04 | .... + 01 00974733272:682289 2 - 02 0006ab3e 00 00 00 20 | ... + 01 00974733272:682297 2 - 02 0006ad7e 07 ea 4a 90 | .... + 01 00974733272:684384 2 - 00 0006ade6 46 52 45 45 | FREE + 01 00974733272:684388 2 - 00 0006adf6 07 ea 4a 90 | .... + +See section about predefined views for explanation of the above output! + +Changing the debug level +------------------------ + +Example:: + + + > cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level + 3 + > echo "5" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level + > cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level + 5 + +Flushing debug areas +-------------------- +Debug areas can be flushed with piping the number of the desired +area (0...n) to the debugfs file "flush". When using "-" all debug areas +are flushed. + +Examples: + +1. Flush debug area 0:: + + > echo "0" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/flush + +2. Flush all debug areas:: + + > echo "-" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/flush + +Changing the size of debug areas +------------------------------------ +It is possible the change the size of debug areas through piping +the number of pages to the debugfs file "pages". The resize request will +also flush the debug areas. + +Example: + +Define 4 pages for the debug areas of debug feature "dasd":: + + > echo "4" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/pages + +Stopping the debug feature +-------------------------- +Example: + +1. Check if stopping is allowed:: + + > cat /proc/sys/s390dbf/debug_stoppable + +2. Stop debug feature:: + + > echo 0 > /proc/sys/s390dbf/debug_active + +crash Interface +---------------- +The ``crash`` tool since v5.1.0 has a built-in command +``s390dbf`` to display all the debug logs or export them to the file system. +With this tool it is possible +to investigate the debug logs on a live system and with a memory dump after +a system crash. + +Investigating raw memory +------------------------ +One last possibility to investigate the debug logs at a live +system and after a system crash is to look at the raw memory +under VM or at the Service Element. +It is possible to find the anchor of the debug-logs through +the ``debug_area_first`` symbol in the System map. Then one has +to follow the correct pointers of the data-structures defined +in debug.h and find the debug-areas in memory. +Normally modules which use the debug feature will also have +a global variable with the pointer to the debug-logs. Following +this pointer it will also be possible to find the debug logs in +memory. + +For this method it is recommended to use '16 * x + 4' byte (x = 0..n) +for the length of the data field in :c:func:`debug_register()` in +order to see the debug entries well formatted. + + +Predefined Views +---------------- + +There are three predefined views: hex_ascii, raw and sprintf. +The hex_ascii view shows the data field in hex and ascii representation +(e.g. ``45 43 4b 44 | ECKD``). +The raw view returns a bytestream as the debug areas are stored in memory. + +The sprintf view formats the debug entries in the same way as the sprintf +function would do. The sprintf event/exception functions write to the +debug entry a pointer to the format string (size = sizeof(long)) +and for each vararg a long value. So e.g. for a debug entry with a format +string plus two varargs one would need to allocate a (3 * sizeof(long)) +byte data area in the debug_register() function. + +IMPORTANT: + Using "%s" in sprintf event functions is dangerous. You can only + use "%s" in the sprintf event functions, if the memory for the passed string + is available as long as the debug feature exists. The reason behind this is + that due to performance considerations only a pointer to the string is stored + in the debug feature. If you log a string that is freed afterwards, you will + get an OOPS when inspecting the debug feature, because then the debug feature + will access the already freed memory. + +NOTE: + If using the sprintf view do NOT use other event/exception functions + than the sprintf-event and -exception functions. + +The format of the hex_ascii and sprintf view is as follows: + +- Number of area +- Timestamp (formatted as seconds and microseconds since 00:00:00 Coordinated + Universal Time (UTC), January 1, 1970) +- level of debug entry +- Exception flag (* = Exception) +- Cpu-Number of calling task +- Return Address to caller +- data field + +The format of the raw view is: + +- Header as described in debug.h +- datafield + +A typical line of the hex_ascii view will look like the following (first line +is only for explanation and will not be displayed when 'cating' the view):: + + area time level exception cpu caller data (hex + ascii) + -------------------------------------------------------------------------- + 00 00964419409:440690 1 - 00 88023fe + + +Defining views +-------------- + +Views are specified with the 'debug_view' structure. There are defined +callback functions which are used for reading and writing the debugfs files: + +.. code-block:: c + + struct debug_view { + char name[DEBUG_MAX_PROCF_LEN]; + debug_prolog_proc_t* prolog_proc; + debug_header_proc_t* header_proc; + debug_format_proc_t* format_proc; + debug_input_proc_t* input_proc; + void* private_data; + }; + +where: + +.. code-block:: c + + typedef int (debug_header_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, + struct debug_view* view, + int area, + debug_entry_t* entry, + char* out_buf); + + typedef int (debug_format_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, + struct debug_view* view, char* out_buf, + const char* in_buf); + typedef int (debug_prolog_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, + struct debug_view* view, + char* out_buf); + typedef int (debug_input_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, + struct debug_view* view, + struct file* file, const char* user_buf, + size_t in_buf_size, loff_t* offset); + + +The "private_data" member can be used as pointer to view specific data. +It is not used by the debug feature itself. + +The output when reading a debugfs file is structured like this:: + + "prolog_proc output" + + "header_proc output 1" "format_proc output 1" + "header_proc output 2" "format_proc output 2" + "header_proc output 3" "format_proc output 3" + ... + +When a view is read from the debugfs, the Debug Feature calls the +'prolog_proc' once for writing the prolog. +Then 'header_proc' and 'format_proc' are called for each +existing debug entry. + +The input_proc can be used to implement functionality when it is written to +the view (e.g. like with ``echo "0" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level``). + +For header_proc there can be used the default function +:c:func:`debug_dflt_header_fn()` which is defined in debug.h. +and which produces the same header output as the predefined views. +E.g:: + + 00 00964419409:440761 2 - 00 88023ec + +In order to see how to use the callback functions check the implementation +of the default views! + +Example: + +.. code-block:: c + + #include <asm/debug.h> + + #define UNKNOWNSTR "data: %08x" + + const char* messages[] = + {"This error...........\n", + "That error...........\n", + "Problem..............\n", + "Something went wrong.\n", + "Everything ok........\n", + NULL + }; + + static int debug_test_format_fn( + debug_info_t *id, struct debug_view *view, + char *out_buf, const char *in_buf + ) + { + int i, rc = 0; + + if (id->buf_size >= 4) { + int msg_nr = *((int*)in_buf); + if (msg_nr < sizeof(messages) / sizeof(char*) - 1) + rc += sprintf(out_buf, "%s", messages[msg_nr]); + else + rc += sprintf(out_buf, UNKNOWNSTR, msg_nr); + } + return rc; + } + + struct debug_view debug_test_view = { + "myview", /* name of view */ + NULL, /* no prolog */ + &debug_dflt_header_fn, /* default header for each entry */ + &debug_test_format_fn, /* our own format function */ + NULL, /* no input function */ + NULL /* no private data */ + }; + +test: +===== + +.. code-block:: c + + debug_info_t *debug_info; + int i; + ... + debug_info = debug_register("test", 0, 4, 4); + debug_register_view(debug_info, &debug_test_view); + for (i = 0; i < 10; i ++) + debug_int_event(debug_info, 1, i); + +:: + + > cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/test/myview + 00 00964419734:611402 1 - 00 88042ca This error........... + 00 00964419734:611405 1 - 00 88042ca That error........... + 00 00964419734:611408 1 - 00 88042ca Problem.............. + 00 00964419734:611411 1 - 00 88042ca Something went wrong. + 00 00964419734:611414 1 - 00 88042ca Everything ok........ + 00 00964419734:611417 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000005 + 00 00964419734:611419 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000006 + 00 00964419734:611422 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000007 + 00 00964419734:611425 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000008 + 00 00964419734:611428 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000009 diff --git a/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt b/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt deleted file mode 100644 index 61329fd62e89..000000000000 --- a/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt +++ /dev/null @@ -1,667 +0,0 @@ -S390 Debug Feature -================== - -files: arch/s390/kernel/debug.c - arch/s390/include/asm/debug.h - -Description: ------------- -The goal of this feature is to provide a kernel debug logging API -where log records can be stored efficiently in memory, where each component -(e.g. device drivers) can have one separate debug log. -One purpose of this is to inspect the debug logs after a production system crash -in order to analyze the reason for the crash. -If the system still runs but only a subcomponent which uses dbf fails, -it is possible to look at the debug logs on a live system via the Linux -debugfs filesystem. -The debug feature may also very useful for kernel and driver development. - -Design: -------- -Kernel components (e.g. device drivers) can register themselves at the debug -feature with the function call debug_register(). This function initializes a -debug log for the caller. For each debug log exists a number of debug areas -where exactly one is active at one time. Each debug area consists of contiguous -pages in memory. In the debug areas there are stored debug entries (log records) -which are written by event- and exception-calls. - -An event-call writes the specified debug entry to the active debug -area and updates the log pointer for the active area. If the end -of the active debug area is reached, a wrap around is done (ring buffer) -and the next debug entry will be written at the beginning of the active -debug area. - -An exception-call writes the specified debug entry to the log and -switches to the next debug area. This is done in order to be sure -that the records which describe the origin of the exception are not -overwritten when a wrap around for the current area occurs. - -The debug areas themselves are also ordered in form of a ring buffer. -When an exception is thrown in the last debug area, the following debug -entries are then written again in the very first area. - -There are three versions for the event- and exception-calls: One for -logging raw data, one for text and one for numbers. - -Each debug entry contains the following data: - -- Timestamp -- Cpu-Number of calling task -- Level of debug entry (0...6) -- Return Address to caller -- Flag, if entry is an exception or not - -The debug logs can be inspected in a live system through entries in -the debugfs-filesystem. Under the toplevel directory "s390dbf" there is -a directory for each registered component, which is named like the -corresponding component. The debugfs normally should be mounted to -/sys/kernel/debug therefore the debug feature can be accessed under -/sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf. - -The content of the directories are files which represent different views -to the debug log. Each component can decide which views should be -used through registering them with the function debug_register_view(). -Predefined views for hex/ascii, sprintf and raw binary data are provided. -It is also possible to define other views. The content of -a view can be inspected simply by reading the corresponding debugfs file. - -All debug logs have an actual debug level (range from 0 to 6). -The default level is 3. Event and Exception functions have a 'level' -parameter. Only debug entries with a level that is lower or equal -than the actual level are written to the log. This means, when -writing events, high priority log entries should have a low level -value whereas low priority entries should have a high one. -The actual debug level can be changed with the help of the debugfs-filesystem -through writing a number string "x" to the 'level' debugfs file which is -provided for every debug log. Debugging can be switched off completely -by using "-" on the 'level' debugfs file. - -Example: - -> echo "-" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level - -It is also possible to deactivate the debug feature globally for every -debug log. You can change the behavior using 2 sysctl parameters in -/proc/sys/s390dbf: -There are currently 2 possible triggers, which stop the debug feature -globally. The first possibility is to use the "debug_active" sysctl. If -set to 1 the debug feature is running. If "debug_active" is set to 0 the -debug feature is turned off. -The second trigger which stops the debug feature is a kernel oops. -That prevents the debug feature from overwriting debug information that -happened before the oops. After an oops you can reactivate the debug feature -by piping 1 to /proc/sys/s390dbf/debug_active. Nevertheless, its not -suggested to use an oopsed kernel in a production environment. -If you want to disallow the deactivation of the debug feature, you can use -the "debug_stoppable" sysctl. If you set "debug_stoppable" to 0 the debug -feature cannot be stopped. If the debug feature is already stopped, it -will stay deactivated. - -Kernel Interfaces: ------------------- - ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_info_t *debug_register(char *name, int pages, int nr_areas, - int buf_size); - -Parameter: name: Name of debug log (e.g. used for debugfs entry) - pages: number of pages, which will be allocated per area - nr_areas: number of debug areas - buf_size: size of data area in each debug entry - -Return Value: Handle for generated debug area - NULL if register failed - -Description: Allocates memory for a debug log - Must not be called within an interrupt handler - ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_info_t *debug_register_mode(char *name, int pages, int nr_areas, - int buf_size, mode_t mode, uid_t uid, - gid_t gid); - -Parameter: name: Name of debug log (e.g. used for debugfs entry) - pages: Number of pages, which will be allocated per area - nr_areas: Number of debug areas - buf_size: Size of data area in each debug entry - mode: File mode for debugfs files. E.g. S_IRWXUGO - uid: User ID for debugfs files. Currently only 0 is - supported. - gid: Group ID for debugfs files. Currently only 0 is - supported. - -Return Value: Handle for generated debug area - NULL if register failed - -Description: Allocates memory for a debug log - Must not be called within an interrupt handler - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -void debug_unregister (debug_info_t * id); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - -Return Value: none - -Description: frees memory for a debug log and removes all registered debug - views. - Must not be called within an interrupt handler - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -void debug_set_level (debug_info_t * id, int new_level); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - new_level: new debug level - -Return Value: none - -Description: Sets new actual debug level if new_level is valid. - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -bool debug_level_enabled (debug_info_t * id, int level); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - -Return Value: True if level is less or equal to the current debug level. - -Description: Returns true if debug events for the specified level would be - logged. Otherwise returns false. ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -void debug_stop_all(void); - -Parameter: none - -Return Value: none - -Description: stops the debug feature if stopping is allowed. Currently - used in case of a kernel oops. - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_entry_t* debug_event (debug_info_t* id, int level, void* data, - int length); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - data: pointer to data for debug entry - length: length of data in bytes - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry to active debug area (if level <= actual - debug level) - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_entry_t* debug_int_event (debug_info_t * id, int level, - unsigned int data); -debug_entry_t* debug_long_event(debug_info_t * id, int level, - unsigned long data); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - data: integer value for debug entry - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry to active debug area (if level <= actual - debug level) - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_entry_t* debug_text_event (debug_info_t * id, int level, - const char* data); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - data: string for debug entry - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry in ascii format to active debug area - (if level <= actual debug level) - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_entry_t* debug_sprintf_event (debug_info_t * id, int level, - char* string,...); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - string: format string for debug entry - ...: varargs used as in sprintf() - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry with format string and varargs (longs) to - active debug area (if level $<=$ actual debug level). - floats and long long datatypes cannot be used as varargs. - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -debug_entry_t* debug_exception (debug_info_t* id, int level, void* data, - int length); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - data: pointer to data for debug entry - length: length of data in bytes - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry to active debug area (if level <= actual - debug level) and switches to next debug area - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_entry_t* debug_int_exception (debug_info_t * id, int level, - unsigned int data); -debug_entry_t* debug_long_exception(debug_info_t * id, int level, - unsigned long data); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - data: integer value for debug entry - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry to active debug area (if level <= actual - debug level) and switches to next debug area - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_entry_t* debug_text_exception (debug_info_t * id, int level, - const char* data); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - data: string for debug entry - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry in ascii format to active debug area - (if level <= actual debug level) and switches to next debug - area - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -debug_entry_t* debug_sprintf_exception (debug_info_t * id, int level, - char* string,...); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - level: debug level - string: format string for debug entry - ...: varargs used as in sprintf() - -Return Value: Address of written debug entry - -Description: writes debug entry with format string and varargs (longs) to - active debug area (if level $<=$ actual debug level) and - switches to next debug area. - floats and long long datatypes cannot be used as varargs. - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -int debug_register_view (debug_info_t * id, struct debug_view *view); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - view: pointer to debug view struct - -Return Value: 0 : ok - < 0: Error - -Description: registers new debug view and creates debugfs dir entry - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- -int debug_unregister_view (debug_info_t * id, struct debug_view *view); - -Parameter: id: handle for debug log - view: pointer to debug view struct - -Return Value: 0 : ok - < 0: Error - -Description: unregisters debug view and removes debugfs dir entry - - - -Predefined views: ------------------ - -extern struct debug_view debug_hex_ascii_view; -extern struct debug_view debug_raw_view; -extern struct debug_view debug_sprintf_view; - -Examples --------- - -/* - * hex_ascii- + raw-view Example - */ - -#include <linux/init.h> -#include <asm/debug.h> - -static debug_info_t* debug_info; - -static int init(void) -{ - /* register 4 debug areas with one page each and 4 byte data field */ - - debug_info = debug_register ("test", 1, 4, 4 ); - debug_register_view(debug_info,&debug_hex_ascii_view); - debug_register_view(debug_info,&debug_raw_view); - - debug_text_event(debug_info, 4 , "one "); - debug_int_exception(debug_info, 4, 4711); - debug_event(debug_info, 3, &debug_info, 4); - - return 0; -} - -static void cleanup(void) -{ - debug_unregister (debug_info); -} - -module_init(init); -module_exit(cleanup); - ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -/* - * sprintf-view Example - */ - -#include <linux/init.h> -#include <asm/debug.h> - -static debug_info_t* debug_info; - -static int init(void) -{ - /* register 4 debug areas with one page each and data field for */ - /* format string pointer + 2 varargs (= 3 * sizeof(long)) */ - - debug_info = debug_register ("test", 1, 4, sizeof(long) * 3); - debug_register_view(debug_info,&debug_sprintf_view); - - debug_sprintf_event(debug_info, 2 , "first event in %s:%i\n",__FILE__,__LINE__); - debug_sprintf_exception(debug_info, 1, "pointer to debug info: %p\n",&debug_info); - - return 0; -} - -static void cleanup(void) -{ - debug_unregister (debug_info); -} - -module_init(init); -module_exit(cleanup); - - - -Debugfs Interface ----------------- -Views to the debug logs can be investigated through reading the corresponding -debugfs-files: - -Example: - -> ls /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd -flush hex_ascii level pages raw -> cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/hex_ascii | sort -k2,2 -s -00 00974733272:680099 2 - 02 0006ad7e 07 ea 4a 90 | .... -00 00974733272:682210 2 - 02 0006ade6 46 52 45 45 | FREE -00 00974733272:682213 2 - 02 0006adf6 07 ea 4a 90 | .... -00 00974733272:682281 1 * 02 0006ab08 41 4c 4c 43 | EXCP -01 00974733272:682284 2 - 02 0006ab16 45 43 4b 44 | ECKD -01 00974733272:682287 2 - 02 0006ab28 00 00 00 04 | .... -01 00974733272:682289 2 - 02 0006ab3e 00 00 00 20 | ... -01 00974733272:682297 2 - 02 0006ad7e 07 ea 4a 90 | .... -01 00974733272:684384 2 - 00 0006ade6 46 52 45 45 | FREE -01 00974733272:684388 2 - 00 0006adf6 07 ea 4a 90 | .... - -See section about predefined views for explanation of the above output! - -Changing the debug level ------------------------- - -Example: - - -> cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level -3 -> echo "5" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level -> cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level -5 - -Flushing debug areas --------------------- -Debug areas can be flushed with piping the number of the desired -area (0...n) to the debugfs file "flush". When using "-" all debug areas -are flushed. - -Examples: - -1. Flush debug area 0: -> echo "0" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/flush - -2. Flush all debug areas: -> echo "-" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/flush - -Changing the size of debug areas ------------------------------------- -It is possible the change the size of debug areas through piping -the number of pages to the debugfs file "pages". The resize request will -also flush the debug areas. - -Example: - -Define 4 pages for the debug areas of debug feature "dasd": -> echo "4" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/pages - -Stooping the debug feature --------------------------- -Example: - -1. Check if stopping is allowed -> cat /proc/sys/s390dbf/debug_stoppable -2. Stop debug feature -> echo 0 > /proc/sys/s390dbf/debug_active - -lcrash Interface ----------------- -It is planned that the dump analysis tool lcrash gets an additional command -'s390dbf' to display all the debug logs. With this tool it will be possible -to investigate the debug logs on a live system and with a memory dump after -a system crash. - -Investigating raw memory ------------------------- -One last possibility to investigate the debug logs at a live -system and after a system crash is to look at the raw memory -under VM or at the Service Element. -It is possible to find the anker of the debug-logs through -the 'debug_area_first' symbol in the System map. Then one has -to follow the correct pointers of the data-structures defined -in debug.h and find the debug-areas in memory. -Normally modules which use the debug feature will also have -a global variable with the pointer to the debug-logs. Following -this pointer it will also be possible to find the debug logs in -memory. - -For this method it is recommended to use '16 * x + 4' byte (x = 0..n) -for the length of the data field in debug_register() in -order to see the debug entries well formatted. - - -Predefined Views ----------------- - -There are three predefined views: hex_ascii, raw and sprintf. -The hex_ascii view shows the data field in hex and ascii representation -(e.g. '45 43 4b 44 | ECKD'). -The raw view returns a bytestream as the debug areas are stored in memory. - -The sprintf view formats the debug entries in the same way as the sprintf -function would do. The sprintf event/exception functions write to the -debug entry a pointer to the format string (size = sizeof(long)) -and for each vararg a long value. So e.g. for a debug entry with a format -string plus two varargs one would need to allocate a (3 * sizeof(long)) -byte data area in the debug_register() function. - -IMPORTANT: Using "%s" in sprintf event functions is dangerous. You can only -use "%s" in the sprintf event functions, if the memory for the passed string is -available as long as the debug feature exists. The reason behind this is that -due to performance considerations only a pointer to the string is stored in -the debug feature. If you log a string that is freed afterwards, you will get -an OOPS when inspecting the debug feature, because then the debug feature will -access the already freed memory. - -NOTE: If using the sprintf view do NOT use other event/exception functions -than the sprintf-event and -exception functions. - -The format of the hex_ascii and sprintf view is as follows: -- Number of area -- Timestamp (formatted as seconds and microseconds since 00:00:00 Coordinated - Universal Time (UTC), January 1, 1970) -- level of debug entry -- Exception flag (* = Exception) -- Cpu-Number of calling task -- Return Address to caller -- data field - -The format of the raw view is: -- Header as described in debug.h -- datafield - -A typical line of the hex_ascii view will look like the following (first line -is only for explanation and will not be displayed when 'cating' the view): - -area time level exception cpu caller data (hex + ascii) --------------------------------------------------------------------------- -00 00964419409:440690 1 - 00 88023fe - - -Defining views --------------- - -Views are specified with the 'debug_view' structure. There are defined -callback functions which are used for reading and writing the debugfs files: - -struct debug_view { - char name[DEBUG_MAX_PROCF_LEN]; - debug_prolog_proc_t* prolog_proc; - debug_header_proc_t* header_proc; - debug_format_proc_t* format_proc; - debug_input_proc_t* input_proc; - void* private_data; -}; - -where - -typedef int (debug_header_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, - struct debug_view* view, - int area, - debug_entry_t* entry, - char* out_buf); - -typedef int (debug_format_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, - struct debug_view* view, char* out_buf, - const char* in_buf); -typedef int (debug_prolog_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, - struct debug_view* view, - char* out_buf); -typedef int (debug_input_proc_t) (debug_info_t* id, - struct debug_view* view, - struct file* file, const char* user_buf, - size_t in_buf_size, loff_t* offset); - - -The "private_data" member can be used as pointer to view specific data. -It is not used by the debug feature itself. - -The output when reading a debugfs file is structured like this: - -"prolog_proc output" - -"header_proc output 1" "format_proc output 1" -"header_proc output 2" "format_proc output 2" -"header_proc output 3" "format_proc output 3" -... - -When a view is read from the debugfs, the Debug Feature calls the -'prolog_proc' once for writing the prolog. -Then 'header_proc' and 'format_proc' are called for each -existing debug entry. - -The input_proc can be used to implement functionality when it is written to -the view (e.g. like with 'echo "0" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level). - -For header_proc there can be used the default function -debug_dflt_header_fn() which is defined in debug.h. -and which produces the same header output as the predefined views. -E.g: -00 00964419409:440761 2 - 00 88023ec - -In order to see how to use the callback functions check the implementation -of the default views! - -Example - -#include <asm/debug.h> - -#define UNKNOWNSTR "data: %08x" - -const char* messages[] = -{"This error...........\n", - "That error...........\n", - "Problem..............\n", - "Something went wrong.\n", - "Everything ok........\n", - NULL -}; - -static int debug_test_format_fn( - debug_info_t * id, struct debug_view *view, - char *out_buf, const char *in_buf -) -{ - int i, rc = 0; - - if(id->buf_size >= 4) { - int msg_nr = *((int*)in_buf); - if(msg_nr < sizeof(messages)/sizeof(char*) - 1) - rc += sprintf(out_buf, "%s", messages[msg_nr]); - else - rc += sprintf(out_buf, UNKNOWNSTR, msg_nr); - } - out: - return rc; -} - -struct debug_view debug_test_view = { - "myview", /* name of view */ - NULL, /* no prolog */ - &debug_dflt_header_fn, /* default header for each entry */ - &debug_test_format_fn, /* our own format function */ - NULL, /* no input function */ - NULL /* no private data */ -}; - -===== -test: -===== -debug_info_t *debug_info; -... -debug_info = debug_register ("test", 0, 4, 4 )); -debug_register_view(debug_info, &debug_test_view); -for(i = 0; i < 10; i ++) debug_int_event(debug_info, 1, i); - -> cat /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/test/myview -00 00964419734:611402 1 - 00 88042ca This error........... -00 00964419734:611405 1 - 00 88042ca That error........... -00 00964419734:611408 1 - 00 88042ca Problem.............. -00 00964419734:611411 1 - 00 88042ca Something went wrong. -00 00964419734:611414 1 - 00 88042ca Everything ok........ -00 00964419734:611417 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000005 -00 00964419734:611419 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000006 -00 00964419734:611422 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000007 -00 00964419734:611425 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000008 -00 00964419734:611428 1 - 00 88042ca data: 00000009 diff --git a/Documentation/s390/text_files.rst b/Documentation/s390/text_files.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000000..c94d05d4fa17 --- /dev/null +++ b/Documentation/s390/text_files.rst @@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ +ibm 3270 changelog +------------------ + +.. include:: 3270.ChangeLog + :literal: + +ibm 3270 config3270.sh +---------------------- + +.. literalinclude:: config3270.sh + :language: shell diff --git a/Documentation/s390/vfio-ap.txt b/Documentation/s390/vfio-ap.rst index 65167cfe4485..b5c51f7c748d 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/vfio-ap.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/vfio-ap.rst @@ -1,4 +1,9 @@ -Introduction: +=============================== +Adjunct Processor (AP) facility +=============================== + + +Introduction ============ The Adjunct Processor (AP) facility is an IBM Z cryptographic facility comprised of three AP instructions and from 1 up to 256 PCIe cryptographic adapter cards. @@ -11,7 +16,7 @@ framework. This implementation relies considerably on the s390 virtualization facilities which do most of the hard work of providing direct access to AP devices. -AP Architectural Overview: +AP Architectural Overview ========================= To facilitate the comprehension of the design, let's start with some definitions: @@ -31,13 +36,13 @@ definitions: in the LPAR, the AP bus detects the AP adapter cards assigned to the LPAR and creates a sysfs device for each assigned adapter. For example, if AP adapters 4 and 10 (0x0a) are assigned to the LPAR, the AP bus will create the following - sysfs device entries: + sysfs device entries:: /sys/devices/ap/card04 /sys/devices/ap/card0a Symbolic links to these devices will also be created in the AP bus devices - sub-directory: + sub-directory:: /sys/bus/ap/devices/[card04] /sys/bus/ap/devices/[card04] @@ -84,7 +89,7 @@ definitions: the cross product of the AP adapter and usage domain numbers detected when the AP bus module is loaded. For example, if adapters 4 and 10 (0x0a) and usage domains 6 and 71 (0x47) are assigned to the LPAR, the AP bus will create the - following sysfs entries: + following sysfs entries:: /sys/devices/ap/card04/04.0006 /sys/devices/ap/card04/04.0047 @@ -92,7 +97,7 @@ definitions: /sys/devices/ap/card0a/0a.0047 The following symbolic links to these devices will be created in the AP bus - devices subdirectory: + devices subdirectory:: /sys/bus/ap/devices/[04.0006] /sys/bus/ap/devices/[04.0047] @@ -112,7 +117,7 @@ definitions: domain that is not one of the usage domains, but the modified domain must be one of the control domains. -AP and SIE: +AP and SIE ========== Let's now take a look at how AP instructions executed on a guest are interpreted by the hardware. @@ -153,7 +158,7 @@ and 2 and usage domains 5 and 6 are assigned to a guest, the APQNs (1,5), (1,6), The APQNs can provide secure key functionality - i.e., a private key is stored on the adapter card for each of its domains - so each APQN must be assigned to -at most one guest or to the linux host. +at most one guest or to the linux host:: Example 1: Valid configuration: ------------------------------ @@ -181,8 +186,8 @@ at most one guest or to the linux host. This is an invalid configuration because both guests have access to APQN (1,6). -The Design: -=========== +The Design +========== The design introduces three new objects: 1. AP matrix device @@ -205,43 +210,43 @@ The VFIO AP (vfio_ap) device driver serves the following purposes: Reserve APQNs for exclusive use of KVM guests --------------------------------------------- The following block diagram illustrates the mechanism by which APQNs are -reserved: - - +------------------+ - 7 remove | | - +--------------------> cex4queue driver | - | | | - | +------------------+ - | - | - | +------------------+ +-----------------+ - | 5 register driver | | 3 create | | - | +----------------> Device core +----------> matrix device | - | | | | | | - | | +--------^---------+ +-----------------+ - | | | - | | +-------------------+ - | | +-----------------------------------+ | - | | | 4 register AP driver | | 2 register device - | | | | | -+--------+---+-v---+ +--------+-------+-+ -| | | | -| ap_bus +--------------------- > vfio_ap driver | -| | 8 probe | | -+--------^---------+ +--^--^------------+ -6 edit | | | - apmask | +-----------------------------+ | 9 mdev create - aqmask | | 1 modprobe | -+--------+-----+---+ +----------------+-+ +------------------+ -| | | |8 create | mediated | -| admin | | VFIO device core |---------> matrix | -| + | | | device | -+------+-+---------+ +--------^---------+ +--------^---------+ - | | | | - | | 9 create vfio_ap-passthrough | | - | +------------------------------+ | - +-------------------------------------------------------------+ - 10 assign adapter/domain/control domain +reserved:: + + +------------------+ + 7 remove | | + +--------------------> cex4queue driver | + | | | + | +------------------+ + | + | + | +------------------+ +----------------+ + | 5 register driver | | 3 create | | + | +----------------> Device core +----------> matrix device | + | | | | | | + | | +--------^---------+ +----------------+ + | | | + | | +-------------------+ + | | +-----------------------------------+ | + | | | 4 register AP driver | | 2 register device + | | | | | + +--------+---+-v---+ +--------+-------+-+ + | | | | + | ap_bus +--------------------- > vfio_ap driver | + | | 8 probe | | + +--------^---------+ +--^--^------------+ + 6 edit | | | + apmask | +-----------------------------+ | 9 mdev create + aqmask | | 1 modprobe | + +--------+-----+---+ +----------------+-+ +----------------+ + | | | |8 create | mediated | + | admin | | VFIO device core |---------> matrix | + | + | | | device | + +------+-+---------+ +--------^---------+ +--------^-------+ + | | | | + | | 9 create vfio_ap-passthrough | | + | +------------------------------+ | + +-------------------------------------------------------------+ + 10 assign adapter/domain/control domain The process for reserving an AP queue for use by a KVM guest is: @@ -250,7 +255,7 @@ The process for reserving an AP queue for use by a KVM guest is: device with the device core. This will serve as the parent device for all mediated matrix devices used to configure an AP matrix for a guest. 3. The /sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix device is created by the device core -4 The vfio_ap device driver will register with the AP bus for AP queue devices +4. The vfio_ap device driver will register with the AP bus for AP queue devices of type 10 and higher (CEX4 and newer). The driver will provide the vfio_ap driver's probe and remove callback interfaces. Devices older than CEX4 queues are not supported to simplify the implementation by not needlessly @@ -266,13 +271,14 @@ The process for reserving an AP queue for use by a KVM guest is: it. 9. The administrator creates a passthrough type mediated matrix device to be used by a guest -10 The administrator assigns the adapters, usage domains and control domains - to be exclusively used by a guest. +10. The administrator assigns the adapters, usage domains and control domains + to be exclusively used by a guest. Set up the VFIO mediated device interfaces ------------------------------------------ The VFIO AP device driver utilizes the common interface of the VFIO mediated device core driver to: + * Register an AP mediated bus driver to add a mediated matrix device to and remove it from a VFIO group. * Create and destroy a mediated matrix device @@ -280,25 +286,25 @@ device core driver to: * Add a mediated matrix device to and remove it from an IOMMU group The following high-level block diagram shows the main components and interfaces -of the VFIO AP mediated matrix device driver: - - +-------------+ - | | - | +---------+ | mdev_register_driver() +--------------+ - | | Mdev | +<-----------------------+ | - | | bus | | | vfio_mdev.ko | - | | driver | +----------------------->+ |<-> VFIO user - | +---------+ | probe()/remove() +--------------+ APIs - | | - | MDEV CORE | - | MODULE | - | mdev.ko | - | +---------+ | mdev_register_device() +--------------+ - | |Physical | +<-----------------------+ | - | | device | | | vfio_ap.ko |<-> matrix - | |interface| +----------------------->+ | device - | +---------+ | callback +--------------+ - +-------------+ +of the VFIO AP mediated matrix device driver:: + + +-------------+ + | | + | +---------+ | mdev_register_driver() +--------------+ + | | Mdev | +<-----------------------+ | + | | bus | | | vfio_mdev.ko | + | | driver | +----------------------->+ |<-> VFIO user + | +---------+ | probe()/remove() +--------------+ APIs + | | + | MDEV CORE | + | MODULE | + | mdev.ko | + | +---------+ | mdev_register_device() +--------------+ + | |Physical | +<-----------------------+ | + | | device | | | vfio_ap.ko |<-> matrix + | |interface| +----------------------->+ | device + | +---------+ | callback +--------------+ + +-------------+ During initialization of the vfio_ap module, the matrix device is registered with an 'mdev_parent_ops' structure that provides the sysfs attribute @@ -306,7 +312,8 @@ structures, mdev functions and callback interfaces for managing the mediated matrix device. * sysfs attribute structures: - * supported_type_groups + + supported_type_groups The VFIO mediated device framework supports creation of user-defined mediated device types. These mediated device types are specified via the 'supported_type_groups' structure when a device is registered @@ -318,61 +325,72 @@ matrix device. The VFIO AP device driver will register one mediated device type for passthrough devices: + /sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/mdev_supported_types/vfio_ap-passthrough + Only the read-only attributes required by the VFIO mdev framework will - be provided: - ... name - ... device_api - ... available_instances - ... device_api - Where: - * name: specifies the name of the mediated device type - * device_api: the mediated device type's API - * available_instances: the number of mediated matrix passthrough devices - that can be created - * device_api: specifies the VFIO API - * mdev_attr_groups + be provided:: + + ... name + ... device_api + ... available_instances + ... device_api + + Where: + + * name: + specifies the name of the mediated device type + * device_api: + the mediated device type's API + * available_instances: + the number of mediated matrix passthrough devices + that can be created + * device_api: + specifies the VFIO API + mdev_attr_groups This attribute group identifies the user-defined sysfs attributes of the mediated device. When a device is registered with the VFIO mediated device framework, the sysfs attribute files identified in the 'mdev_attr_groups' structure will be created in the mediated matrix device's directory. The sysfs attributes for a mediated matrix device are: - * assign_adapter: - * unassign_adapter: + + assign_adapter / unassign_adapter: Write-only attributes for assigning/unassigning an AP adapter to/from the mediated matrix device. To assign/unassign an adapter, the APID of the adapter is echoed to the respective attribute file. - * assign_domain: - * unassign_domain: + assign_domain / unassign_domain: Write-only attributes for assigning/unassigning an AP usage domain to/from the mediated matrix device. To assign/unassign a domain, the domain number of the the usage domain is echoed to the respective attribute file. - * matrix: + matrix: A read-only file for displaying the APQNs derived from the cross product of the adapter and domain numbers assigned to the mediated matrix device. - * assign_control_domain: - * unassign_control_domain: + assign_control_domain / unassign_control_domain: Write-only attributes for assigning/unassigning an AP control domain to/from the mediated matrix device. To assign/unassign a control domain, the ID of the domain to be assigned/unassigned is echoed to the respective attribute file. - * control_domains: + control_domains: A read-only file for displaying the control domain numbers assigned to the mediated matrix device. * functions: - * create: + + create: allocates the ap_matrix_mdev structure used by the vfio_ap driver to: + * Store the reference to the KVM structure for the guest using the mdev * Store the AP matrix configuration for the adapters, domains, and control domains assigned via the corresponding sysfs attributes files - * remove: + + remove: deallocates the mediated matrix device's ap_matrix_mdev structure. This will be allowed only if a running guest is not using the mdev. * callback interfaces - * open: + + open: The vfio_ap driver uses this callback to register a VFIO_GROUP_NOTIFY_SET_KVM notifier callback function for the mdev matrix device. The open is invoked when QEMU connects the VFIO iommu group @@ -380,16 +398,17 @@ matrix device. to configure the KVM guest is provided via this callback. The KVM structure, is used to configure the guest's access to the AP matrix defined via the mediated matrix device's sysfs attribute files. - * release: + release: unregisters the VFIO_GROUP_NOTIFY_SET_KVM notifier callback function for the mdev matrix device and deconfigures the guest's AP matrix. -Configure the APM, AQM and ADM in the CRYCB: +Configure the APM, AQM and ADM in the CRYCB ------------------------------------------- Configuring the AP matrix for a KVM guest will be performed when the VFIO_GROUP_NOTIFY_SET_KVM notifier callback is invoked. The notifier function is called when QEMU connects to KVM. The guest's AP matrix is configured via it's CRYCB by: + * Setting the bits in the APM corresponding to the APIDs assigned to the mediated matrix device via its 'assign_adapter' interface. * Setting the bits in the AQM corresponding to the domains assigned to the @@ -418,12 +437,12 @@ available to a KVM guest via the following CPU model features: Note: If the user chooses to specify a CPU model different than the 'host' model to QEMU, the CPU model features and facilities need to be turned on -explicitly; for example: +explicitly; for example:: /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu z13,ap=on,apqci=on,apft=on A guest can be precluded from using AP features/facilities by turning them off -explicitly; for example: +explicitly; for example:: /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu host,ap=off,apqci=off,apft=off @@ -435,7 +454,7 @@ the APFT facility is not installed on the guest, then the probe of device drivers will fail since only type 10 and newer devices can be configured for guest use. -Example: +Example ======= Let's now provide an example to illustrate how KVM guests may be given access to AP facilities. For this example, we will show how to configure @@ -444,30 +463,36 @@ look like this: Guest1 ------ +=========== ===== ============ CARD.DOMAIN TYPE MODE ------------------------------- +=========== ===== ============ 05 CEX5C CCA-Coproc 05.0004 CEX5C CCA-Coproc 05.00ab CEX5C CCA-Coproc 06 CEX5A Accelerator 06.0004 CEX5A Accelerator 06.00ab CEX5C CCA-Coproc +=========== ===== ============ Guest2 ------ +=========== ===== ============ CARD.DOMAIN TYPE MODE ------------------------------- +=========== ===== ============ 05 CEX5A Accelerator 05.0047 CEX5A Accelerator 05.00ff CEX5A Accelerator +=========== ===== ============ Guest2 ------ +=========== ===== ============ CARD.DOMAIN TYPE MODE ------------------------------- +=========== ===== ============ 06 CEX5A Accelerator 06.0047 CEX5A Accelerator 06.00ff CEX5A Accelerator +=========== ===== ============ These are the steps: @@ -492,25 +517,26 @@ These are the steps: * VFIO_MDEV_DEVICE * KVM - If using make menuconfig select the following to build the vfio_ap module: - -> Device Drivers - -> IOMMU Hardware Support - select S390 AP IOMMU Support - -> VFIO Non-Privileged userspace driver framework - -> Mediated device driver frramework - -> VFIO driver for Mediated devices - -> I/O subsystem - -> VFIO support for AP devices + If using make menuconfig select the following to build the vfio_ap module:: + + -> Device Drivers + -> IOMMU Hardware Support + select S390 AP IOMMU Support + -> VFIO Non-Privileged userspace driver framework + -> Mediated device driver frramework + -> VFIO driver for Mediated devices + -> I/O subsystem + -> VFIO support for AP devices 2. Secure the AP queues to be used by the three guests so that the host can not access them. To secure them, there are two sysfs files that specify bitmasks marking a subset of the APQN range as 'usable by the default AP queue device drivers' or 'not usable by the default device drivers' and thus available for use by the vfio_ap device driver'. The location of the sysfs - files containing the masks are: + files containing the masks are:: - /sys/bus/ap/apmask - /sys/bus/ap/aqmask + /sys/bus/ap/apmask + /sys/bus/ap/aqmask The 'apmask' is a 256-bit mask that identifies a set of AP adapter IDs (APID). Each bit in the mask, from left to right (i.e., from most significant @@ -526,7 +552,7 @@ These are the steps: queue device drivers; otherwise, the APQI is usable by the vfio_ap device driver. - Take, for example, the following mask: + Take, for example, the following mask:: 0x7dffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff @@ -548,68 +574,70 @@ These are the steps: respective sysfs mask file in one of two formats: * An absolute hex string starting with 0x - like "0x12345678" - sets - the mask. If the given string is shorter than the mask, it is padded - with 0s on the right; for example, specifying a mask value of 0x41 is - the same as specifying: + the mask. If the given string is shorter than the mask, it is padded + with 0s on the right; for example, specifying a mask value of 0x41 is + the same as specifying:: - 0x4100000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 + 0x4100000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 - Keep in mind that the mask reads from left to right (i.e., most - significant to least significant bit in big endian order), so the mask - above identifies device numbers 1 and 7 (01000001). + Keep in mind that the mask reads from left to right (i.e., most + significant to least significant bit in big endian order), so the mask + above identifies device numbers 1 and 7 (01000001). - If the string is longer than the mask, the operation is terminated with - an error (EINVAL). + If the string is longer than the mask, the operation is terminated with + an error (EINVAL). * Individual bits in the mask can be switched on and off by specifying - each bit number to be switched in a comma separated list. Each bit - number string must be prepended with a ('+') or minus ('-') to indicate - the corresponding bit is to be switched on ('+') or off ('-'). Some - valid values are: + each bit number to be switched in a comma separated list. Each bit + number string must be prepended with a ('+') or minus ('-') to indicate + the corresponding bit is to be switched on ('+') or off ('-'). Some + valid values are: - "+0" switches bit 0 on - "-13" switches bit 13 off - "+0x41" switches bit 65 on - "-0xff" switches bit 255 off + - "+0" switches bit 0 on + - "-13" switches bit 13 off + - "+0x41" switches bit 65 on + - "-0xff" switches bit 255 off - The following example: - +0,-6,+0x47,-0xf0 + The following example: - Switches bits 0 and 71 (0x47) on - Switches bits 6 and 240 (0xf0) off + +0,-6,+0x47,-0xf0 - Note that the bits not specified in the list remain as they were before - the operation. + Switches bits 0 and 71 (0x47) on + + Switches bits 6 and 240 (0xf0) off + + Note that the bits not specified in the list remain as they were before + the operation. 2. The masks can also be changed at boot time via parameters on the kernel command line like this: - ap.apmask=0xffff ap.aqmask=0x40 + ap.apmask=0xffff ap.aqmask=0x40 - This would create the following masks: + This would create the following masks:: - apmask: - 0xffff000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 + apmask: + 0xffff000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 - aqmask: - 0x4000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 + aqmask: + 0x4000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 - Resulting in these two pools: + Resulting in these two pools:: - default drivers pool: adapter 0-15, domain 1 - alternate drivers pool: adapter 16-255, domains 0, 2-255 + default drivers pool: adapter 0-15, domain 1 + alternate drivers pool: adapter 16-255, domains 0, 2-255 - Securing the APQNs for our example: - ---------------------------------- +Securing the APQNs for our example +---------------------------------- To secure the AP queues 05.0004, 05.0047, 05.00ab, 05.00ff, 06.0004, 06.0047, 06.00ab, and 06.00ff for use by the vfio_ap device driver, the corresponding - APQNs can either be removed from the default masks: + APQNs can either be removed from the default masks:: echo -5,-6 > /sys/bus/ap/apmask echo -4,-0x47,-0xab,-0xff > /sys/bus/ap/aqmask - Or the masks can be set as follows: + Or the masks can be set as follows:: echo 0xf9ffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff \ > apmask @@ -620,19 +648,19 @@ These are the steps: This will result in AP queues 05.0004, 05.0047, 05.00ab, 05.00ff, 06.0004, 06.0047, 06.00ab, and 06.00ff getting bound to the vfio_ap device driver. The sysfs directory for the vfio_ap device driver will now contain symbolic links - to the AP queue devices bound to it: - - /sys/bus/ap - ... [drivers] - ...... [vfio_ap] - ......... [05.0004] - ......... [05.0047] - ......... [05.00ab] - ......... [05.00ff] - ......... [06.0004] - ......... [06.0047] - ......... [06.00ab] - ......... [06.00ff] + to the AP queue devices bound to it:: + + /sys/bus/ap + ... [drivers] + ...... [vfio_ap] + ......... [05.0004] + ......... [05.0047] + ......... [05.00ab] + ......... [05.00ff] + ......... [06.0004] + ......... [06.0047] + ......... [06.00ab] + ......... [06.00ff] Keep in mind that only type 10 and newer adapters (i.e., CEX4 and later) can be bound to the vfio_ap device driver. The reason for this is to @@ -645,96 +673,96 @@ These are the steps: queue device can be read from the parent card's sysfs directory. For example, to see the hardware type of the queue 05.0004: - cat /sys/bus/ap/devices/card05/hwtype + cat /sys/bus/ap/devices/card05/hwtype The hwtype must be 10 or higher (CEX4 or newer) in order to be bound to the vfio_ap device driver. 3. Create the mediated devices needed to configure the AP matrixes for the three guests and to provide an interface to the vfio_ap driver for - use by the guests: + use by the guests:: - /sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/ - --- [mdev_supported_types] - ------ [vfio_ap-passthrough] (passthrough mediated matrix device type) - --------- create - --------- [devices] + /sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/ + --- [mdev_supported_types] + ------ [vfio_ap-passthrough] (passthrough mediated matrix device type) + --------- create + --------- [devices] - To create the mediated devices for the three guests: + To create the mediated devices for the three guests:: uuidgen > create uuidgen > create uuidgen > create - or + or - echo $uuid1 > create - echo $uuid2 > create - echo $uuid3 > create + echo $uuid1 > create + echo $uuid2 > create + echo $uuid3 > create This will create three mediated devices in the [devices] subdirectory named after the UUID written to the create attribute file. We call them $uuid1, - $uuid2 and $uuid3 and this is the sysfs directory structure after creation: - - /sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/ - --- [mdev_supported_types] - ------ [vfio_ap-passthrough] - --------- [devices] - ------------ [$uuid1] - --------------- assign_adapter - --------------- assign_control_domain - --------------- assign_domain - --------------- matrix - --------------- unassign_adapter - --------------- unassign_control_domain - --------------- unassign_domain - - ------------ [$uuid2] - --------------- assign_adapter - --------------- assign_control_domain - --------------- assign_domain - --------------- matrix - --------------- unassign_adapter - ----------------unassign_control_domain - ----------------unassign_domain - - ------------ [$uuid3] - --------------- assign_adapter - --------------- assign_control_domain - --------------- assign_domain - --------------- matrix - --------------- unassign_adapter - ----------------unassign_control_domain - ----------------unassign_domain + $uuid2 and $uuid3 and this is the sysfs directory structure after creation:: + + /sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/ + --- [mdev_supported_types] + ------ [vfio_ap-passthrough] + --------- [devices] + ------------ [$uuid1] + --------------- assign_adapter + --------------- assign_control_domain + --------------- assign_domain + --------------- matrix + --------------- unassign_adapter + --------------- unassign_control_domain + --------------- unassign_domain + + ------------ [$uuid2] + --------------- assign_adapter + --------------- assign_control_domain + --------------- assign_domain + --------------- matrix + --------------- unassign_adapter + ----------------unassign_control_domain + ----------------unassign_domain + + ------------ [$uuid3] + --------------- assign_adapter + --------------- assign_control_domain + --------------- assign_domain + --------------- matrix + --------------- unassign_adapter + ----------------unassign_control_domain + ----------------unassign_domain 4. The administrator now needs to configure the matrixes for the mediated devices $uuid1 (for Guest1), $uuid2 (for Guest2) and $uuid3 (for Guest3). - This is how the matrix is configured for Guest1: + This is how the matrix is configured for Guest1:: echo 5 > assign_adapter echo 6 > assign_adapter echo 4 > assign_domain echo 0xab > assign_domain - Control domains can similarly be assigned using the assign_control_domain - sysfs file. + Control domains can similarly be assigned using the assign_control_domain + sysfs file. - If a mistake is made configuring an adapter, domain or control domain, - you can use the unassign_xxx files to unassign the adapter, domain or - control domain. + If a mistake is made configuring an adapter, domain or control domain, + you can use the unassign_xxx files to unassign the adapter, domain or + control domain. - To display the matrix configuration for Guest1: + To display the matrix configuration for Guest1:: - cat matrix + cat matrix - This is how the matrix is configured for Guest2: + This is how the matrix is configured for Guest2:: echo 5 > assign_adapter echo 0x47 > assign_domain echo 0xff > assign_domain - This is how the matrix is configured for Guest3: + This is how the matrix is configured for Guest3:: echo 6 > assign_adapter echo 0x47 > assign_domain @@ -783,24 +811,24 @@ These are the steps: configured for the system. If a control domain number higher than the maximum is specified, the operation will terminate with an error (ENODEV). -5. Start Guest1: +5. Start Guest1:: - /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu host,ap=on,apqci=on,apft=on \ - -device vfio-ap,sysfsdev=/sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/$uuid1 ... + /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu host,ap=on,apqci=on,apft=on \ + -device vfio-ap,sysfsdev=/sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/$uuid1 ... -7. Start Guest2: +7. Start Guest2:: - /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu host,ap=on,apqci=on,apft=on \ - -device vfio-ap,sysfsdev=/sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/$uuid2 ... + /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu host,ap=on,apqci=on,apft=on \ + -device vfio-ap,sysfsdev=/sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/$uuid2 ... -7. Start Guest3: +7. Start Guest3:: - /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu host,ap=on,apqci=on,apft=on \ - -device vfio-ap,sysfsdev=/sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/$uuid3 ... + /usr/bin/qemu-system-s390x ... -cpu host,ap=on,apqci=on,apft=on \ + -device vfio-ap,sysfsdev=/sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/$uuid3 ... When the guest is shut down, the mediated matrix devices may be removed. -Using our example again, to remove the mediated matrix device $uuid1: +Using our example again, to remove the mediated matrix device $uuid1:: /sys/devices/vfio_ap/matrix/ --- [mdev_supported_types] @@ -809,18 +837,19 @@ Using our example again, to remove the mediated matrix device $uuid1: ------------ [$uuid1] --------------- remove +:: echo 1 > remove - This will remove all of the mdev matrix device's sysfs structures including - the mdev device itself. To recreate and reconfigure the mdev matrix device, - all of the steps starting with step 3 will have to be performed again. Note - that the remove will fail if a guest using the mdev is still running. +This will remove all of the mdev matrix device's sysfs structures including +the mdev device itself. To recreate and reconfigure the mdev matrix device, +all of the steps starting with step 3 will have to be performed again. Note +that the remove will fail if a guest using the mdev is still running. - It is not necessary to remove an mdev matrix device, but one may want to - remove it if no guest will use it during the remaining lifetime of the linux - host. If the mdev matrix device is removed, one may want to also reconfigure - the pool of adapters and queues reserved for use by the default drivers. +It is not necessary to remove an mdev matrix device, but one may want to +remove it if no guest will use it during the remaining lifetime of the linux +host. If the mdev matrix device is removed, one may want to also reconfigure +the pool of adapters and queues reserved for use by the default drivers. Limitations =========== diff --git a/Documentation/s390/vfio-ccw.txt b/Documentation/s390/vfio-ccw.rst index 2be11ad864ff..1f6d0b56d53e 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/vfio-ccw.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/vfio-ccw.rst @@ -1,3 +1,4 @@ +================================== vfio-ccw: the basic infrastructure ================================== @@ -11,9 +12,11 @@ virtual machine, while vfio is the means. Different than other hardware architectures, s390 has defined a unified I/O access method, which is so called Channel I/O. It has its own access patterns: + - Channel programs run asynchronously on a separate (co)processor. - The channel subsystem will access any memory designated by the caller in the channel program directly, i.e. there is no iommu involved. + Thus when we introduce vfio support for these devices, we realize it with a mediated device (mdev) implementation. The vfio mdev will be added to an iommu group, so as to make itself able to be managed by the @@ -24,6 +27,7 @@ to perform I/O instructions. This document does not intend to explain the s390 I/O architecture in every detail. More information/reference could be found here: + - A good start to know Channel I/O in general: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Channel_I/O - s390 architecture: @@ -80,6 +84,7 @@ until interrupted. The I/O completion result is received by the interrupt handler in the form of interrupt response block (IRB). Back to vfio-ccw, in short: + - ORBs and channel programs are built in guest kernel (with guest physical addresses). - ORBs and channel programs are passed to the host kernel. @@ -106,6 +111,7 @@ it gets sent to hardware. Within this implementation, we have two drivers for two types of devices: + - The vfio_ccw driver for the physical subchannel device. This is an I/O subchannel driver for the real subchannel device. It realizes a group of callbacks and registers to the mdev framework as a @@ -137,7 +143,7 @@ devices: vfio_pin_pages and a vfio_unpin_pages interfaces from the vfio iommu backend for the physical devices to pin and unpin pages by demand. -Below is a high Level block diagram. +Below is a high Level block diagram:: +-------------+ | | @@ -158,6 +164,7 @@ Below is a high Level block diagram. +-------------+ The process of how these work together. + 1. vfio_ccw.ko drives the physical I/O subchannel, and registers the physical device (with callbacks) to mdev framework. When vfio_ccw probing the subchannel device, it registers device @@ -178,17 +185,17 @@ vfio-ccw I/O region An I/O region is used to accept channel program request from user space and store I/O interrupt result for user space to retrieve. The -definition of the region is: - -struct ccw_io_region { -#define ORB_AREA_SIZE 12 - __u8 orb_area[ORB_AREA_SIZE]; -#define SCSW_AREA_SIZE 12 - __u8 scsw_area[SCSW_AREA_SIZE]; -#define IRB_AREA_SIZE 96 - __u8 irb_area[IRB_AREA_SIZE]; - __u32 ret_code; -} __packed; +definition of the region is:: + + struct ccw_io_region { + #define ORB_AREA_SIZE 12 + __u8 orb_area[ORB_AREA_SIZE]; + #define SCSW_AREA_SIZE 12 + __u8 scsw_area[SCSW_AREA_SIZE]; + #define IRB_AREA_SIZE 96 + __u8 irb_area[IRB_AREA_SIZE]; + __u32 ret_code; + } __packed; While starting an I/O request, orb_area should be filled with the guest ORB, and scsw_area should be filled with the SCSW of the Virtual @@ -205,7 +212,7 @@ vfio-ccw follows what vfio-pci did on the s390 platform and uses vfio-iommu-type1 as the vfio iommu backend. * CCW translation APIs - A group of APIs (start with 'cp_') to do CCW translation. The CCWs + A group of APIs (start with `cp_`) to do CCW translation. The CCWs passed in by a user space program are organized with their guest physical memory addresses. These APIs will copy the CCWs into kernel space, and assemble a runnable kernel channel program by updating the @@ -217,12 +224,14 @@ vfio-iommu-type1 as the vfio iommu backend. This driver utilizes the CCW translation APIs and introduces vfio_ccw, which is the driver for the I/O subchannel devices you want to pass through. - vfio_ccw implements the following vfio ioctls: + vfio_ccw implements the following vfio ioctls:: + VFIO_DEVICE_GET_INFO VFIO_DEVICE_GET_IRQ_INFO VFIO_DEVICE_GET_REGION_INFO VFIO_DEVICE_RESET VFIO_DEVICE_SET_IRQS + This provides an I/O region, so that the user space program can pass a channel program to the kernel, to do further CCW translation before issuing them to a real device. @@ -236,32 +245,49 @@ bit more detail how an I/O request triggered by the QEMU guest will be handled (without error handling). Explanation: -Q1-Q7: QEMU side process. -K1-K5: Kernel side process. -Q1. Get I/O region info during initialization. -Q2. Setup event notifier and handler to handle I/O completion. +- Q1-Q7: QEMU side process. +- K1-K5: Kernel side process. + +Q1. + Get I/O region info during initialization. + +Q2. + Setup event notifier and handler to handle I/O completion. ... ... -Q3. Intercept a ssch instruction. -Q4. Write the guest channel program and ORB to the I/O region. - K1. Copy from guest to kernel. - K2. Translate the guest channel program to a host kernel space - channel program, which becomes runnable for a real device. - K3. With the necessary information contained in the orb passed in - by QEMU, issue the ccwchain to the device. - K4. Return the ssch CC code. -Q5. Return the CC code to the guest. +Q3. + Intercept a ssch instruction. +Q4. + Write the guest channel program and ORB to the I/O region. + + K1. + Copy from guest to kernel. + K2. + Translate the guest channel program to a host kernel space + channel program, which becomes runnable for a real device. + K3. + With the necessary information contained in the orb passed in + by QEMU, issue the ccwchain to the device. + K4. + Return the ssch CC code. +Q5. + Return the CC code to the guest. ... ... - K5. Interrupt handler gets the I/O result and write the result to - the I/O region. - K6. Signal QEMU to retrieve the result. -Q6. Get the signal and event handler reads out the result from the I/O + K5. + Interrupt handler gets the I/O result and write the result to + the I/O region. + K6. + Signal QEMU to retrieve the result. + +Q6. + Get the signal and event handler reads out the result from the I/O region. -Q7. Update the irb for the guest. +Q7. + Update the irb for the guest. Limitations ----------- @@ -295,6 +321,6 @@ Reference 1. ESA/s390 Principles of Operation manual (IBM Form. No. SA22-7832) 2. ESA/390 Common I/O Device Commands manual (IBM Form. No. SA22-7204) 3. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Channel_I/O -4. Documentation/s390/cds.txt +4. Documentation/s390/cds.rst 5. Documentation/vfio.txt 6. Documentation/vfio-mediated-device.txt diff --git a/Documentation/s390/zfcpdump.txt b/Documentation/s390/zfcpdump.rst index b064aa59714d..54e8e7caf7e7 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/zfcpdump.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/zfcpdump.rst @@ -1,4 +1,6 @@ +================================== The s390 SCSI dump tool (zfcpdump) +================================== System z machines (z900 or higher) provide hardware support for creating system dumps on SCSI disks. The dump process is initiated by booting a dump tool, which diff --git a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-deadline.txt b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-deadline.txt index b14e03ff3528..a7514343b660 100644 --- a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-deadline.txt +++ b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-deadline.txt @@ -652,7 +652,7 @@ CONTENTS -deadline tasks cannot have an affinity mask smaller that the entire root_domain they are created on. However, affinities can be specified - through the cpuset facility (Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt). + through the cpuset facility (Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst). 5.1 SCHED_DEADLINE and cpusets HOWTO ------------------------------------ diff --git a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-design-CFS.txt b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-design-CFS.txt index edd861c94c1b..d1328890ef28 100644 --- a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-design-CFS.txt +++ b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-design-CFS.txt @@ -215,7 +215,7 @@ SCHED_BATCH) tasks. These options need CONFIG_CGROUPS to be defined, and let the administrator create arbitrary groups of tasks, using the "cgroup" pseudo filesystem. See - Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.txt for more information about this filesystem. + Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.rst for more information about this filesystem. When CONFIG_FAIR_GROUP_SCHED is defined, a "cpu.shares" file is created for each group created using the pseudo filesystem. See example steps below to create diff --git a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-pelt.c b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-pelt.c index e4219139386a..7238b355919c 100644 --- a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-pelt.c +++ b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-pelt.c @@ -20,7 +20,8 @@ void calc_runnable_avg_yN_inv(void) int i; unsigned int x; - printf("static const u32 runnable_avg_yN_inv[] = {"); + /* To silence -Wunused-but-set-variable warnings. */ + printf("static const u32 runnable_avg_yN_inv[] __maybe_unused = {"); for (i = 0; i < HALFLIFE; i++) { x = ((1UL<<32)-1)*pow(y, i); diff --git a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-rt-group.txt b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-rt-group.txt index d8fce3e78457..c09f7a3fee66 100644 --- a/Documentation/scheduler/sched-rt-group.txt +++ b/Documentation/scheduler/sched-rt-group.txt @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ This uses the cgroup virtual file system and "<cgroup>/cpu.rt_runtime_us" to control the CPU time reserved for each control group. For more information on working with control groups, you should read -Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.txt as well. +Documentation/cgroup-v1/cgroups.rst as well. Group settings are checked against the following limits in order to keep the configuration schedulable: diff --git a/Documentation/security/IMA-templates.rst b/Documentation/security/IMA-templates.rst index 2cd0e273cc9a..3d1cca287aa4 100644 --- a/Documentation/security/IMA-templates.rst +++ b/Documentation/security/IMA-templates.rst @@ -69,15 +69,16 @@ descriptors by adding their identifier to the format string algorithm (field format: [<hash algo>:]digest, where the digest prefix is shown only if the hash algorithm is not SHA1 or MD5); - 'n-ng': the name of the event, without size limitations; - - 'sig': the file signature. + - 'sig': the file signature; + - 'buf': the buffer data that was used to generate the hash without size limitations; Below, there is the list of defined template descriptors: - "ima": its format is ``d|n``; - "ima-ng" (default): its format is ``d-ng|n-ng``; - - "ima-sig": its format is ``d-ng|n-ng|sig``. - + - "ima-sig": its format is ``d-ng|n-ng|sig``; + - "ima-buf": its format is ``d-ng|n-ng|buf``; Use diff --git a/Documentation/security/keys/core.rst b/Documentation/security/keys/core.rst index 9521c4207f01..1b3c907980ad 100644 --- a/Documentation/security/keys/core.rst +++ b/Documentation/security/keys/core.rst @@ -57,9 +57,9 @@ Each key has a number of attributes: type provides an operation to perform a match between the description on a key and a criterion string. - * Each key has an owner user ID, a group ID and a permissions mask. These - are used to control what a process may do to a key from userspace, and - whether a kernel service will be able to find the key. + * Each key has an owner user ID, a group ID and an ACL. These are used to + control what a process may do to a key from userspace, and whether a + kernel service will be able to find the key. * Each key can be set to expire at a specific time by the key type's instantiation function. Keys can also be immortal. @@ -198,43 +198,110 @@ The key service provides a number of features besides keys: Key Access Permissions ====================== -Keys have an owner user ID, a group access ID, and a permissions mask. The mask -has up to eight bits each for possessor, user, group and other access. Only -six of each set of eight bits are defined. These permissions granted are: +Keys have an owner user ID, a group ID and an ACL. The ACL is made up of a +sequence of ACEs that each contain three elements: - * View + * The type of subject. + * The subject. - This permits a key or keyring's attributes to be viewed - including key - type and description. + These two together indicate the subject to whom the permits are granted. + The type can be one of: - * Read + * ``KEY_ACE_SUBJ_STANDARD`` - This permits a key's payload to be viewed or a keyring's list of linked - keys. + The subject is a standard 'macro' type. The subject can be one of: + + * ``KEY_ACE_EVERYONE`` + + The permits are granted to everyone. It replaces the old 'other' + type on the assumption that you wouldn't grant a permission to other + that you you wouldn't grant to everyone else. + + * ``KEY_ACE_OWNER`` + + The permits are granted to the owner of the key (key->uid). + + * ``KEY_ACE_GROUP`` + + The permits are granted to the key's group (key->gid). + + * ``KEY_ACE_POSSESSOR`` + + The permits are granted to anyone who possesses the key. + + * The set of permits granted to the subject. These include: + + * ``KEY_ACE_VIEW`` + + This permits a key or keyring's attributes to be viewed - including the + key type and description. + + * ``KEY_ACE_READ`` + + This permits a key's payload to be viewed or a keyring's list of linked + keys. + + * ``KEY_ACE_WRITE`` + + This permits a key's payload to be instantiated or updated, or it allows + a link to be added to or removed from a keyring. + + * ``KEY_ACE_SEARCH`` + + This permits keyrings to be searched and keys to be found. Searches can + only recurse into nested keyrings that have search permission set. + + * ``KEY_ACE_LINK`` + + This permits a key or keyring to be linked to. To create a link from a + keyring to a key, a process must have Write permission on the keyring + and Link permission on the key. + + * ``KEY_ACE_SET_SECURITY`` + + This permits a key's UID, GID and permissions mask to be changed. - * Write + * ``KEY_ACE_INVAL`` - This permits a key's payload to be instantiated or updated, or it allows a - link to be added to or removed from a keyring. + This permits a key to be invalidated with KEYCTL_INVALIDATE. - * Search + * ``KEY_ACE_REVOKE`` - This permits keyrings to be searched and keys to be found. Searches can - only recurse into nested keyrings that have search permission set. + This permits a key to be revoked with KEYCTL_REVOKE. - * Link + * ``KEY_ACE_JOIN`` - This permits a key or keyring to be linked to. To create a link from a - keyring to a key, a process must have Write permission on the keyring and - Link permission on the key. + This permits a keyring to be joined as a session by + KEYCTL_JOIN_SESSION_KEYRING or KEYCTL_SESSION_TO_PARENT. - * Set Attribute + * ``KEY_ACE_CLEAR`` - This permits a key's UID, GID and permissions mask to be changed. + This permits a keyring to be cleared. For changing the ownership, group ID or permissions mask, being the owner of the key or having the sysadmin capability is sufficient. +The legacy KEYCTL_SETPERM and KEYCTL_DESCRIBE functions can only see/generate +View, Read, Write, Search, Link and SetAttr permits, and do this for each of +possessor, user, group and other permission sets as a 32-bit flag mask. These +will be approximated/inferred: + + SETPERM Permit Implied ACE Permit + =============== ======================= + Search Inval, Join + Write Revoke, Clear + Setattr Set Security, Revoke + + ACE Permit Described as + =============== ======================= + Inval Search + Join Search + Revoke Write (unless Setattr) + Clear write + Set Security Setattr + +'Other' will be approximated as/inferred from the 'Everyone' subject. + SELinux Support =============== @@ -433,6 +500,10 @@ The main syscalls are: /sbin/request-key will be invoked in an attempt to obtain a key. The callout_info string will be passed as an argument to the program. + To link a key into the destination keyring the key must grant link + permission on the key to the caller and the keyring must grant write + permission. + See also Documentation/security/keys/request-key.rst. @@ -577,6 +648,27 @@ The keyctl syscall functions are: added. + * Move a key from one keyring to another:: + + long keyctl(KEYCTL_MOVE, + key_serial_t id, + key_serial_t from_ring_id, + key_serial_t to_ring_id, + unsigned int flags); + + Move the key specified by "id" from the keyring specified by + "from_ring_id" to the keyring specified by "to_ring_id". If the two + keyrings are the same, nothing is done. + + "flags" can have KEYCTL_MOVE_EXCL set in it to cause the operation to fail + with EEXIST if a matching key exists in the destination keyring, otherwise + such a key will be replaced. + + A process must have link permission on the key for this function to be + successful and write permission on both keyrings. Any errors that can + occur from KEYCTL_LINK also apply on the destination keyring here. + + * Unlink a key or keyring from another keyring:: long keyctl(KEYCTL_UNLINK, key_serial_t keyring, key_serial_t key); @@ -1059,7 +1151,8 @@ payload contents" for more information. struct key *request_key(const struct key_type *type, const char *description, - const char *callout_info); + const char *callout_info, + struct key_acl *acl); This is used to request a key or keyring with a description that matches the description specified according to the key type's match_preparse() @@ -1074,52 +1167,50 @@ payload contents" for more information. If successful, the key will have been attached to the default keyring for implicitly obtained request-key keys, as set by KEYCTL_SET_REQKEY_KEYRING. + If a key is created, it will be given the specified ACL. + See also Documentation/security/keys/request-key.rst. + * To search for a key in a specific domain, call: + + struct key *request_key_tag(const struct key_type *type, + const char *description, + struct key_tag *domain_tag, + const char *callout_info, + struct key_acl *acl); + + This is identical to request_key(), except that a domain tag may be + specifies that causes search algorithm to only match keys matching that + tag. The domain_tag may be NULL, specifying a global domain that is + separate from any nominated domain. + + * To search for a key, passing auxiliary data to the upcaller, call:: struct key *request_key_with_auxdata(const struct key_type *type, const char *description, + struct key_tag *domain_tag, const void *callout_info, size_t callout_len, - void *aux); - - This is identical to request_key(), except that the auxiliary data is - passed to the key_type->request_key() op if it exists, and the callout_info - is a blob of length callout_len, if given (the length may be 0). - - - * A key can be requested asynchronously by calling one of:: - - struct key *request_key_async(const struct key_type *type, - const char *description, - const void *callout_info, - size_t callout_len); - - or:: - - struct key *request_key_async_with_auxdata(const struct key_type *type, - const char *description, - const char *callout_info, - size_t callout_len, - void *aux); + void *aux, + struct key_acl *acl); - which are asynchronous equivalents of request_key() and - request_key_with_auxdata() respectively. + This is identical to request_key_tag(), except that the auxiliary data is + passed to the key_type->request_key() op if it exists, and the + callout_info is a blob of length callout_len, if given (the length may be + 0). - These two functions return with the key potentially still under - construction. To wait for construction completion, the following should be - called:: - int wait_for_key_construction(struct key *key, bool intr); + * To search for a key under RCU conditions, call:: - The function will wait for the key to finish being constructed and then - invokes key_validate() to return an appropriate value to indicate the state - of the key (0 indicates the key is usable). + struct key *request_key_rcu(const struct key_type *type, + const char *description, + struct key_tag *domain_tag); - If intr is true, then the wait can be interrupted by a signal, in which - case error ERESTARTSYS will be returned. + which is similar to request_key_tag() except that it does not check for + keys that are under construction and it will not call out to userspace to + construct a key if it can't find a match. * When it is no longer required, the key should be released using:: @@ -1159,11 +1250,13 @@ payload contents" for more information. key_ref_t keyring_search(key_ref_t keyring_ref, const struct key_type *type, - const char *description) + const char *description, + bool recurse) - This searches the keyring tree specified for a matching key. Error ENOKEY - is returned upon failure (use IS_ERR/PTR_ERR to determine). If successful, - the returned key will need to be released. + This searches the specified keyring only (recurse == false) or keyring tree + (recurse == true) specified for a matching key. Error ENOKEY is returned + upon failure (use IS_ERR/PTR_ERR to determine). If successful, the returned + key will need to be released. The possession attribute from the keyring reference is used to control access through the permissions mask and is propagated to the returned key @@ -1174,7 +1267,7 @@ payload contents" for more information. struct key *keyring_alloc(const char *description, uid_t uid, gid_t gid, const struct cred *cred, - key_perm_t perm, + struct key_acl *acl, struct key_restriction *restrict_link, unsigned long flags, struct key *dest); diff --git a/Documentation/security/keys/request-key.rst b/Documentation/security/keys/request-key.rst index 600ad67d1707..f356fd06c8d5 100644 --- a/Documentation/security/keys/request-key.rst +++ b/Documentation/security/keys/request-key.rst @@ -11,30 +11,32 @@ The process starts by either the kernel requesting a service by calling struct key *request_key(const struct key_type *type, const char *description, - const char *callout_info); + const char *callout_info, + struct key_acl *acl); + +or:: + + struct key *request_key_tag(const struct key_type *type, + const char *description, + const struct key_tag *domain_tag, + const char *callout_info, + struct key_acl *acl); or:: struct key *request_key_with_auxdata(const struct key_type *type, const char *description, + const struct key_tag *domain_tag, const char *callout_info, size_t callout_len, - void *aux); + void *aux, + struct key_acl *acl); or:: - struct key *request_key_async(const struct key_type *type, - const char *description, - const char *callout_info, - size_t callout_len); - -or:: - - struct key *request_key_async_with_auxdata(const struct key_type *type, - const char *description, - const char *callout_info, - size_t callout_len, - void *aux); + struct key *request_key_rcu(const struct key_type *type, + const char *description, + const struct key_tag *domain_tag); Or by userspace invoking the request_key system call:: @@ -48,14 +50,18 @@ does not need to link the key to a keyring to prevent it from being immediately destroyed. The kernel interface returns a pointer directly to the key, and it's up to the caller to destroy the key. -The request_key*_with_auxdata() calls are like the in-kernel request_key*() -calls, except that they permit auxiliary data to be passed to the upcaller (the -default is NULL). This is only useful for those key types that define their -own upcall mechanism rather than using /sbin/request-key. +The request_key_tag() call is like the in-kernel request_key(), except that it +also takes a domain tag that allows keys to be separated by namespace and +killed off as a group. + +The request_key_with_auxdata() calls is like the request_key_tag() call, except +that they permit auxiliary data to be passed to the upcaller (the default is +NULL). This is only useful for those key types that define their own upcall +mechanism rather than using /sbin/request-key. -The two async in-kernel calls may return keys that are still in the process of -being constructed. The two non-async ones will wait for construction to -complete first. +The request_key_rcu() call is like the request_key_tag() call, except that it +doesn't check for keys that are under construction and doesn't attempt to +construct missing keys. The userspace interface links the key to a keyring associated with the process to prevent the key from going away, and returns the serial number of the key to @@ -148,7 +154,7 @@ The Search Algorithm A search of any particular keyring proceeds in the following fashion: - 1) When the key management code searches for a key (keyring_search_aux) it + 1) When the key management code searches for a key (keyring_search_rcu) it firstly calls key_permission(SEARCH) on the keyring it's starting with, if this denies permission, it doesn't search further. @@ -167,6 +173,9 @@ The process stops immediately a valid key is found with permission granted to use it. Any error from a previous match attempt is discarded and the key is returned. +When request_key() is invoked, if CONFIG_KEYS_REQUEST_CACHE=y, a per-task +one-key cache is first checked for a match. + When search_process_keyrings() is invoked, it performs the following searches until one succeeds: @@ -186,7 +195,9 @@ until one succeeds: c) The calling process's session keyring is searched. The moment one succeeds, all pending errors are discarded and the found key is -returned. +returned. If CONFIG_KEYS_REQUEST_CACHE=y, then that key is placed in the +per-task cache, displacing the previous key. The cache is cleared on exit or +just prior to resumption of userspace. Only if all these fail does the whole thing fail with the highest priority error. Note that several errors may have come from LSM. diff --git a/Documentation/sysctl/kernel.txt b/Documentation/sysctl/kernel.txt index f0c86fbb3b48..5af8b131ccbc 100644 --- a/Documentation/sysctl/kernel.txt +++ b/Documentation/sysctl/kernel.txt @@ -23,7 +23,6 @@ show up in /proc/sys/kernel: - auto_msgmni - bootloader_type [ X86 only ] - bootloader_version [ X86 only ] -- callhome [ S390 only ] - cap_last_cap - core_pattern - core_pipe_limit @@ -171,21 +170,6 @@ Documentation/x86/boot.txt for additional information. ============================================================== -callhome: - -Controls the kernel's callhome behavior in case of a kernel panic. - -The s390 hardware allows an operating system to send a notification -to a service organization (callhome) in case of an operating system panic. - -When the value in this file is 0 (which is the default behavior) -nothing happens in case of a kernel panic. If this value is set to "1" -the complete kernel oops message is send to the IBM customer service -organization in case the mainframe the Linux operating system is running -on has a service contract with IBM. - -============================================================== - cap_last_cap Highest valid capability of the running kernel. Exports diff --git a/Documentation/translations/ko_KR/memory-barriers.txt b/Documentation/translations/ko_KR/memory-barriers.txt index db0b9d8619f1..5f3c74dcad43 100644 --- a/Documentation/translations/ko_KR/memory-barriers.txt +++ b/Documentation/translations/ko_KR/memory-barriers.txt @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ Documentation/memory-barriers.txt ========================= 저자: David Howells <dhowells@redhat.com> - Paul E. McKenney <paulmck@linux.vnet.ibm.com> + Paul E. McKenney <paulmck@linux.ibm.com> Will Deacon <will.deacon@arm.com> Peter Zijlstra <peterz@infradead.org> diff --git a/Documentation/vm/numa.rst b/Documentation/vm/numa.rst index 5cae13e9a08b..0d830edae8fe 100644 --- a/Documentation/vm/numa.rst +++ b/Documentation/vm/numa.rst @@ -67,7 +67,7 @@ nodes. Each emulated node will manage a fraction of the underlying cells' physical memory. NUMA emluation is useful for testing NUMA kernel and application features on non-NUMA platforms, and as a sort of memory resource management mechanism when used together with cpusets. -[see Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt] +[see Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst] For each node with memory, Linux constructs an independent memory management subsystem, complete with its own free page lists, in-use page lists, usage @@ -114,7 +114,7 @@ allocation behavior using Linux NUMA memory policy. [see System administrators can restrict the CPUs and nodes' memories that a non- privileged user can specify in the scheduling or NUMA commands and functions -using control groups and CPUsets. [see Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt] +using control groups and CPUsets. [see Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst] On architectures that do not hide memoryless nodes, Linux will include only zones [nodes] with memory in the zonelists. This means that for a memoryless diff --git a/Documentation/vm/page_migration.rst b/Documentation/vm/page_migration.rst index f68d61335abb..35bba27d5fff 100644 --- a/Documentation/vm/page_migration.rst +++ b/Documentation/vm/page_migration.rst @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ locations. Larger installations usually partition the system using cpusets into sections of nodes. Paul Jackson has equipped cpusets with the ability to move pages when a task is moved to another cpuset (See -Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt). +Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst). Cpusets allows the automation of process locality. If a task is moved to a new cpuset then also all its pages are moved with it so that the performance of the process does not sink dramatically. Also the pages diff --git a/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.rst b/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.rst index b8e29f977f2d..c6d94118fbcc 100644 --- a/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.rst +++ b/Documentation/vm/unevictable-lru.rst @@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ Memory Control Group Interaction -------------------------------- The unevictable LRU facility interacts with the memory control group [aka -memory controller; see Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.txt] by extending the +memory controller; see Documentation/cgroup-v1/memory.rst] by extending the lru_list enum. The memory controller data structure automatically gets a per-zone unevictable diff --git a/Documentation/x86/exception-tables.rst b/Documentation/x86/exception-tables.rst index 24596c8210b5..ed6d4b0cf62c 100644 --- a/Documentation/x86/exception-tables.rst +++ b/Documentation/x86/exception-tables.rst @@ -35,7 +35,7 @@ page fault handler:: void do_page_fault(struct pt_regs *regs, unsigned long error_code) in arch/x86/mm/fault.c. The parameters on the stack are set up by -the low level assembly glue in arch/x86/kernel/entry_32.S. The parameter +the low level assembly glue in arch/x86/entry/entry_32.S. The parameter regs is a pointer to the saved registers on the stack, error_code contains a reason code for the exception. diff --git a/Documentation/x86/topology.rst b/Documentation/x86/topology.rst index 6e28dbe818ab..8e9704f61017 100644 --- a/Documentation/x86/topology.rst +++ b/Documentation/x86/topology.rst @@ -49,6 +49,10 @@ Package-related topology information in the kernel: The number of cores in a package. This information is retrieved via CPUID. + - cpuinfo_x86.x86_max_dies: + + The number of dies in a package. This information is retrieved via CPUID. + - cpuinfo_x86.phys_proc_id: The physical ID of the package. This information is retrieved via CPUID diff --git a/Documentation/x86/x86_64/fake-numa-for-cpusets.rst b/Documentation/x86/x86_64/fake-numa-for-cpusets.rst index 74fbb78b3c67..a6926cd40f70 100644 --- a/Documentation/x86/x86_64/fake-numa-for-cpusets.rst +++ b/Documentation/x86/x86_64/fake-numa-for-cpusets.rst @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ assign them to cpusets and their attached tasks. This is a way of limiting the amount of system memory that are available to a certain class of tasks. For more information on the features of cpusets, see -Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt. +Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst. There are a number of different configurations you can use for your needs. For more information on the numa=fake command line option and its various ways of configuring fake nodes, see Documentation/x86/x86_64/boot-options.txt. @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ A machine may be split as follows with "numa=fake=4*512," as reported by dmesg:: On node 3 totalpages: 131072 Now following the instructions for mounting the cpusets filesystem from -Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.txt, you can assign fake nodes (i.e. contiguous memory +Documentation/cgroup-v1/cpusets.rst, you can assign fake nodes (i.e. contiguous memory address spaces) to individual cpusets:: [root@xroads /]# mkdir exampleset |